suport curs – limba engleză, curs practic – – anul 1
Transcription
suport curs – limba engleză, curs practic – – anul 1
SUPORT CURS – LIMBA ENGLEZĂ, CURS PRACTIC – – ANUL 1 – (UZ INTERN) DEPARTAMENTUL DE JURNALISM – UNIVERSITATEA HYPERION LECTOR UNIV. DR. SORINA GEORGESCU 1 CONTENTS: LESSON 1: I. Grammar: Tenses...........................................................................................6 II. Vocabulary: General – Living Space...........................................................10 III. Vocabulary : Specific – The News – Cosumer Terrorism.........................13 LESSON 2: I. Grammar: Present Perfect; Future................................................................16 II. Vocabulary: General – Personal Matters....................................................21 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Domestic Violence...........................24 LESSON 3: I. Grammar: Revision – Present Tense, Past Tense, Present Perfect, Past Perfect, Future...........................................................................................28 II. Vocabulary: General – Family and Friends................................................32 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs – Come……………………………35 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Hurricanes.......................................38 LESSON 4: I. Grammar: Indirect Speech............................................................................41 II. Vocabulary: General – The Body and Clothes.............................................46 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs – Get ...............................................49 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Road Accidents.................................52 LESSON 5: I. Grammar: ‘If’ Clause....................................................................................55 II. Vocabulary: General –Everyday Problems..................................................65 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs – Go ................................................67 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Broken Marriages............................69 LESSON 6: I. Grammar: Wishes – “Wish” and “If only” ...................................................73 Passives........................................................................................75 II. Vocabulary: General – Interests and Free Time..........................................81 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs – Look..............................................83 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Forest Fires......................................86 LESSON 7: I. Grammar: Modal Verbs (1) ........................................................................89 II. Vocabulary: General – Places....................................................................96 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - Make............................................99 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Drought..........................................101 LESSON 8: I. Grammar: Modal Verbs (2) ........................................................................105 II. Vocabulary: General – Food and Drink....................................................115 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - Put...............................................117 2 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Famine............................................120 LESSON 9: I. Grammar: Revision – Reported Speech, Conditionals, Wishes, Passives, Modals.....................................................................................123 II. Vocabulary: General – Work and Study.....................................................129 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs – Take............................................131 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Floods.............................................134 LESSON 10: I. Grammar: Purpose......................................................................................137 Reason and Result.....................................................................140 II. Vocabulary: General – The Natural Environment.....................................146 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs – Up...............................................149 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News - Earthquake......................................151 LESSON 11: I. Grammar: Contrast......................................................................................154 II. Vocabulary: General – Tools and Technology...........................................158 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs – Out..............................................161 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Avalanches.....................................164 LESSON 12: I. Grammar: Relatives – who, whom, which, that, what, whose....................167 II. Vocabulary: General – Everyday Objects..................................................177 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs – Off...............................................179 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Volcanic Eruptions.........................182 LESSON 13: I. Grammar: Questions (1) .............................................................................186 II. Vocabulary: General – Travel and Holidays.............................................192 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - On and In.....................................194 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Gas Poisoning................................197 LESSON 14: I. Grammar: Questions (2) .............................................................................201 II. Vocabulary: General – Work and Employment..........................................212 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - Down and Over...........................216 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Surrogate Motherhood...................220 LESSON 15: I. Grammar: “It” and “There”.........................................................................222 Place and Position.....................................................................225 II. Vocabulary: General – Sport and Leisure.................................................230 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - Around and About.......................234 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Cosmetic Surgery...........................238 LESSON 16: I. Grammar: Revision – Purpose, Reason and Result, Contrast, Relatives, Questions, “It” and “There”, Place and Position....................241 3 II. Vocabulary: General – Clothes and Appearance.......................................246 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - For and With................................249 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Teenage Gambling.........................253 LESSON 17: I. Grammar: Nouns (1) ..................................................................................256 II. Vocabulary: General – Towns and Buildings............................................264 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - Into and Away.............................270 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – School Violence..............................273 LESSON 18: I. Grammar: Nouns (2) ..................................................................................277 II. Vocabulary: General – Vehicles and Transport........................................287 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - Time – Spending Time................291 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Soccer Hooliganism.......................293 LESSON 19: I. Grammar: Adjectives and Adverbs (1) ......................................................296 II. Vocabulary: General – Food, Restaurants and Cooking...........................305 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - Time – Passing of Time...............309 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – The Homeless.................................312 LESSON 20: I. Grammar: Adjectives and Adverbs (2) ......................................................315 II. Vocabulary: General – Shops and Shopping.............................................322 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs – Location......................................327 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Experiments on Animals.................329 LESSON 21: I. Grammar: Comparison (1) .........................................................................332 II. Vocabulary: General – Crime and The Law..............................................340 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs – Cause and Effect.........................346 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Curbs on Dogs...............................349 LESSON 22: I. Grammar: Comparison (2) .........................................................................352 II. Vocabulary: General – Entertainment and The Arts..................................360 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs – Change........................................366 III. Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Race-related Issues........................368 LESSON 23: I. Grammar: Articles – a/an and the (1) ........................................................371 II. Vocabulary: General – The Natural World................................................377 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - Success and Failure……………381 III.Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Political Refugees – Economic Migrants ....................................................................................................385 LESSON 24: I. Grammar: Articles – a/an and the (2) ........................................................389 II. Vocabulary: General – People and Behaviour..........................................397 4 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - Starting and Finishing.................403 III.Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Computer Viruses............................405 LESSON 25: I. Grammar: Determiners (1) .........................................................................409 II. Vocabulary: General – Technology and Machines....................................422 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - Action and Movement ..................426 III.Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Abusive Phone Calls.......................428 LESSON 26: I. Grammar: Determiners (2) .........................................................................432 II. Vocabulary: General – Problems...............................................................443 Vocabulary: General - Phrasal Verbs - Destroying and Reacting to Destruction..............................................................................................448 III.Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Traffic Jams....................................449 LESSON 27: I. Grammar: Determiners (3) .........................................................................455 II. Vocabulary: General – Health and The Body............................................463 III.Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Celebrations....................................468 LESSON 28: I. Grammar: General Revision.......................................................................471 II. Vocabulary: General – Money...................................................................479 III.Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Auctions..........................................483 Appendix: A. Tenses: Short Version ........................................................................................487 B. Tenses: Long Version..........................................................................................489 C. Sequence of Tenses .............................................................................................494 D. Irregular Verbs ...................................................................................................494 Bibliography………………………………………………………………………..497 5 LESSON 1 *Grammar: Tenses * Vocabulary: General – Living Space * Vocabulary : Specific – The News – Cosumer Terrorism *** I. GRAMMAR1 : TENSES 1. Be and have: revision test. Put the words in the right order: 1. problem/ seems/ to/ there/ be/ a/ …………………………………………………... 2. much/ soup/ is/ there/ in/ salt/ the/ too/……………………………………………… 3. snow/ is/ to/ tomorrow/ there/ likely/ be/……………………………………………. 4. any/ I/ there/ don’t/ to/ want/ be/ trouble/ …………………………………………… 5. any/ for/ letters/ me/ there/ were/? ………………………………………………….. 6. with/ wrong/ something/ there/ is/ car/ the/…………………………………………. 7. singing/ the/ bus/ was/ a/ woman/ there/ on/………………………………………… 8. shout/ to/ there/ no/ need/ is/ ………………………………………………………... 9. must/ somebody/ be/ there/ home/ at/……………………………………………….. 10. there/ an/ exam/ next/ will/ week/ be/ ?……………………………………………. 2. Be and have: revision test. Correct (v) or not (x)? 1. There might be snow tomorrow……….. 2. I would like that there is good weather for my holiday. ……. 3. It’s a big dog in the garden. ………. 4. Are you having a good time? ……… 5. We’ve got too much work. …………. 6. Are you having any brothers or sisters? ……….. 7. How much money do you have got? …………… 8. Did you have a good journey? ………….. 1 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 6 9. I’m going to have a talk with John……… 3. Present simple and Present Continuous - Choose the correct form: 1. Vegetarians are people who don’t eat/are not eating meat. 2. Look out! My husband comes/is coming. 3. Some people still think the sun goes/is going round the earth. 4. I play/’m playing tennis every weekend. 5. Who sits/’s sitting in my chair? 6. What happens/is happening in golf if you lose the ball? 7. An alcoholic is a person who drinks/is drinking too much and can’t stop. 8. Look! She wears/She’s wearing the same shoes as me. 9. ‘What are you looking/do you look at?’ ‘A strange bird’. 10. I stay/’m staying with John for a few weeks until my flat’s ready. 4. Present simple and Present Continuous - Put in the correct tense: 1. I…………………………………………………………………he’s away. (think) 2. You …………………what I ……………………………………….(know; mean) 3. Your sister………………………………………………………….you. (look like). 4. I…………………..we………………………………………a mistake. (feel; make) 5. While the butter ……………………, you ………………… three eggs and ……………………………………………. them into a bowl. (melt; take; break) 6. I…………………………………………………………about the weekend. (think) 7. Scientists…………………….the weather………………………..(believe; change) 8. I………………………………………………………what the problem is. (not see) 9. Why ……………………………………………………..at me like that? (you look) 10. Now I………………………………………………..what she wants. (understand) 5. Present simple and Present Continuous - Choose the correct form: 1. What sort of work do you do/are you doing? 2. I can’t talk now. I cook/I’m cooking dinner. 3. What shall we have? Do you like/Are you liking fish? 7 4. Can I borrow this typewriter? Or do you use/are you using it? 5. What do the people here do/are the people here doing in the evenings? 6. Follow that bus. Then you turn/are turning left. 7. A lot of people think that the Sun goes/is going around the Earth. 8. Excuse me, do you read/are you reading your newspaper? Could I borrow it? 9. Do you wait/Are you waiting for the bus to Newcastle? 10. Andy builds/is building his own house in the country. 6. Past Tense – Put in the correct forms: E.g.: At 6.00 this morning I was having a wonderful dream, but then the alarm went off. (have; go) This time yesterday I was lying on the beach. (lie) 1. When I walked in they ………………………………………about babies. (all talk) 2. I……………………………………………………….in Paris for a long time. (live) 3. I saw Sid when I ………………to work. He ………………………...(come; shop) 4. She ……………………..Jim while she………………………………(meet; travel) 5. While I …………………….to Mrs. Singleton, somebody …………………… into my office and ……………………………………...the computer. (talk; walk; steal) 6. When Jake …………………in everybody……………………talking. (come; stop) 7. I ………………………. out of the window and ……………… that we ………………… …………………………… over the mountains. (look; see; fly) 8. I…………………………up to find that water………………through the bedroom ceiling. (wake; pour) 9. He……………………….his leg while he …………………..football. (break; play) 7. Past Tense - Correct or not? E.g.: When you woke me I had a wonderful dream. This time yesterday I was playing tennis. 1. When I got to the party everybody had a great time. 8 was having correct …………. 2. When Columbus left Europe, he thought he sailed to India. …………. 3. Everybody was knowing that she was unhappy. …………. 4. We lived in New York when I was small. …………. 5. Did you want to pay now? …………. 6. I was learning the violin at school. …………. 7. Where I grew up, nobody was having a car. ………….. 8. We were on the wrong road. It went to Birmingham, not to Manchester.………… 9. When I was seeing Joe, he was talking to Angela. …………. 10. I broke my leg while I was skiing. ………….. 8. Past Tense – Make these sentences less direct: E.g.: We wonder if you feel like coming out with us. We wondered if you felt like coming out with us. I think you will like to see my holiday photos. I thought you would like to see my holiday photos. 1. How many days do you intend to stay? ……………………………………… 2. Can you give me a hand? ……………………………………… 3. We can ask Peter to help us. ……………………………………… 4. I think it will be a good idea to invite Simon. …………………………… 5. I wonder if you need any help. …………………………… 9. Past Tense – Complete the text with the verbs in the box (there is one verb too many). You will need five past continuous and three simple pasts. ask come dance grin hold not dance order play throw On the dance floor half a dozen couples (1)……………………themselves around. Most of them (2)…………………...cheek to cheek, if dancing is the word. The men wore white tuxedos and the girls wore bright eyes, ruby lips, and tennis or golf muscles. One couple (3)……………………cheek to cheek. Mitchell’s mouth was 9 open, he (4)…………………, his face was red and shiny, and his eyes had that glazed look. Betty (5)………………… her head as far as she could get away from him without breaking her neck. It was very obvious that she had had about all of Mr. Larry Mitchell that she could take. A Mexican waiter in a short green jacket and white pants with a green stripe down the side (6)………………up and I (7)……………….a double Gibson and (8)……………….if I could have a club sandwich. 10. Past Tense - Choose the correct form: a) While Diana watched/was watching her favorite television program, there was a power-cut. b) Tom used to live/ would live in the house at the end of the street. c) Who was driving/drove the car at the time of the accident? d) I did/was doing some shopping yesterday, when I saw that Dutch friend of yours. e) I used to like/was liking sweets much more than I do now. f) What exactly were you doing/did you do when I came into your office yesterday? g) Tanya would/used to be a doctor. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – LIVING SPACE2 1. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: carpet curtains sofa socket cushion drawer pillow radiator a) Is that chair comfortable, or would you like to use a cushion? b) Mark couldn’t use his computer as there wasn’t a ……………………..in the room. c) This house has central heating, and there’s a ………………………..in every room. d) I was so tired that I fell asleep as soon as my head touched the……………………. e) Could you draw the……………………..? Someone is staring through the window. f) My bedroom has a fitted……………………………..which covers the whole floor. g) The knives and forks are in the second…………………………………..on the left. 2 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice with Key. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 10 h) Come over here and sit next to me on the …………………………………………. 2. Each sentence contains an inappropriate word or phrase. Underline this word, and then replace it with a word or phrase from the box: bookcase chimney fence floor gate window step a) Unfortunately the ball hit the house and broke a glass. towel window b) I washed my hands in the bathroom and dried them with a cloth. ……….. c) There was a small wooden door leading into the field. ……….. d) As I sat down at the kitchen table, I knocked my cup onto the ground. ……….. e) In the corner of Joe’s room was a small library for his books. ………. f) All round the garden there was a high wooden wall. ………. g) On the roof tops Tina could see a tall fireplace pouring out smoke. ………. h) The floor of the kitchen is a bit lower, so mind the stair. ………. 3. Choose the correct word in each sentence: a) Will you be at home/at house later this evening? b) Paul’s room is at the top of the stairs/steps opposite the bathroom. c) Can you remember to clean the wash-basin/sink in the bathroom? d) The rooms downstairs are so low I can touch the roof/ceiling. e) Tony is a keen cooker/cook and always uses an electric cooker/cook. f) You’ll find plates in the cupboard/wardrobe next to the fridge. g) Ann was sitting at/to her desk, but Chris was sitting in/on an armchair. h) I won’t be long. I’m just going upstairs for a bath/a bathe. i) Lisa didn’t like doing homework/housework, so she paid a cleaner. j) Under the house there’s a cave/cellar where we keep our old things. 11 4. Complete the sentences with a compound word formed from two words in the box. One word is used twice: arm ash dust flower basin bed hole bin key book room case stairs chair tray dish wash down washer a) It’s very cold in my bedroom, and I find it hard to sleep. b) Sarah spent all afternoon sitting in a large ………………………in front of the TV. c) I left my socks soaking in the ……………………………………...in the bathroom. d) Do you think you could put all your rubbish outside in the ………………………..? e) There’s a beautiful ………………………….full of roses right outside my window. f) Don’t worry about the washing-up. We’ll put everything in the …………………… g) I can’t open the front door. Something is stuck in the ……………………………… h) If you really insist on smoking, please use this …………………………………….. i) Can you come………………………………? There’s someone at the door for you. j) In this …………………………………….are the dictionaries and an encyclopedia. 5. Complete each sentence with a verb from the box in a suitable form. You can use a verb more than once: drop finish get look move put take turn a) I’ve got nowhere to stay tonight. Can you put me up? b) We’ve bought a new house but we can’t ……………………....in until next month. c) Adrian doesn’t ……………………on with his neighbors, because they’re so noisy. d) Jan likes cooking, but she says it……………………………….up a lot of her time. e) Don’t forget to……………………………..off the television before you go to bed. f) Helen has done most of the decorating and plans to ……………….it off tomorrow. g) I have a large room, and it ……………………………..out onto a beautiful garden. h) Karen and Mike live next door and they often…………………………in for a chat. 12 III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – THE NEWS – CONSUMER TERRORISM3 1. A man was convicted today of a poison blackmail plot against a baby food manufacturer and sentenced to 17 years’ imprisonment. He was found guilty on six counts of blackmail, threatening to kill, attempting to obtain property by deception, and on two charges of contaminating food products. Robert Thomas had blackmailed Babyworld last year and tried to extort thousands of pounds by threatening to contaminate the company’s products with toxic substances. In cases when a popular brand is targeted, the ransom money is usually dwarfed by the potential loss in profits before consumers’ confidence in the product is restored. Babyworld, faced with the nightmare of a huge sales slump if the news was leaked out, decided to pay. To speed up the payments, however, the man carried out his threat, proving that he meant business. His intricate plot involved replacing jars of baby food in shops with those he had prepared at home, using caustic soda and cut-up razor blades. No one was hurt, but the company was forced to go public and recall all its products from shops, losing millions in unsold goods. After six months of exhaustive investigation Thomas was apprehended while collecting the ransom money, traditionally the weakest point of any blackmail or kidnap plot. Following the publicity given to the case, other food companies and supermarkets are now preparing for a predictable wave of copycat hoaxers. The incident has also led to the introduction of tamper-proof wrapping on jars and bottles to prevent interference with the product. 2. Customers were alerted today not to buy Veldonia-grown oranges following a warning of sabotage action from a terrorist group. The group, operating in one of the largest fruit distribution centers, poisoned oranges with mercury. Contaminated fruit is easy to spot because of injection marks and discoloration. The announcement set of a scare across the continent, launching a massive inspection of oranges. An official statement was issued condemning this act of barbarism. “Poisoning children just to harm a country’s economy”, said the statement, “is without parallel in human history”. 3 Barbara & Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 13 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Thomas’s sentence was so high because he knew that his action could have led to someone’s death. 2. Baby food producers did not know which company Thomas had chosen as his target. 3. Thomas asked for so much money that it did not matter to the company if the public knew about the threat or not. 4. It is not easy to convince people to buy the targeted company’s products even after the threat is over. 5. Babyworld preferred to keep the blackmail threat secret and do what Thomas demanded. 6. Thomas was happy with the way Babyworld met his demands and did not touch the company’s products. 7. The company had to tell its customers not to buy Babyworld food products because just one in a million jars might have been injurious to their health. 8. Thomas was caught before his action was able to cause the company a substantial loss. 9. It is still possible to do exactly what Thomas did. 10. Terrorists did not tell the public of what they had done. 11. The aim of the action was to discourage people all over the world from buying oranges. 12. This sabotage action showed that consumer terrorism is effective in making people do what terrorists want them to do. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B blackmail……………. action copycat……………… gain exhaustive………………. goods 14 political………………. hoaxers potential……………… investigation sabotage……………… loss sales………………… plot toxic………………… slump unsold………………. Substances 3. Rearrange the words to form the headlines to the stories: 1. BABYWORLD – SENTENCE- FOR- PRISON- LONG- BLACKMAILER …………………………………………………………………………………. 2. VELDONIAN – MERCURY- OF- PANIC- ORANGES- OVER- CONTAMINATION .................................................................................................................................... ................................................................................................................................... 4. Phrases to learn: - încercări de acaparare a bunurilor: a…………. to o………. p…………… - pierderea profitului: l……….. in p………………… - a reda încrederea: r……………. c…………………. - a grăbi plata: s……………. u………. p……………… - a duce la îndeplinire ameninţarea: c……….. o……….. a t……………… - a trata problema serios: m…………. b……………. - a anunţa opinia publică: g……. p……………….. - a face vâlvă, a căpăta ecou: g………….. p………….. - a preîntâmpina manipularea: p…………. i……………. - a crea panică: s………. o………. a s…………….. - a da o declaraţie: i……….. a s…………….. - fără precedent: w…………. p………… 15 LESSON 2 *Grammar: Present Perfect; Future * Vocabulary: General – Personal Matters * Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Domestic Violence *** I. GRAMMAR: PRESENT PERFECT; FUTURE 1. Present perfect and simple past: news and details: “A plane has crashed. It came down…..” – Put in present perfect and simple past verbs4. E.g.: The cat has eaten your supper. She took it off the table when I was out. (eat; take) 1. Anna ………… her job at the bank. She ………………...her boss. (leave; not like) 2. I………………a beautiful dress. I……………...it at Parker’s yesterday. (buy; find) 3. Cathy and Sam……………..their house. They…………..a very good price. (sell; get) 4. ‘Dad………………his glasses’. ‘Where …………..he………….them?’ ‘Under his pillow’. (find; find) 5. Mrs Collins……………into hospital. She ………….to the doctor this morning, and he ………………………………………………..her straight in. (go; go; send) 6. Bill……………..an accident. He ………………..off his bike last night. (have; fall) 7. I…………..from Jenny. She…………………us a postcard from Peru. (hear; send) 8. ‘I……………..your mother about us’. ‘What ………….she…………? ‘She was very nice about it.’ (tell; say) 9. Two climbers…………………in the Alps. They…………….their way in bad weather. (die; lose) 10. John and Sue…………..yet. They………………the wrong train. (not arrive; take) 4 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 16 2. Have you (ever)…..? and Did you (ever)?5 Look at each conversation and choose the best sentence a) or b). E.g.: Have you heard about the woman walking across the US? – Yes, she’s reached the Rockies. a) The walk is continuing b) The walk has finished 1) Have you ever played beach volleyball? – Yes, we played it on holiday. a) The holiday is still going on b) The holiday is over 2) Did you know old Mr. Green? – No, I never met him. a) Mr Green is probably alive. b) Mr. Green is probably dead. 3) Wayne Johnson is a great footballer. – Yes, he’s scored 200 goals for United. a) Wayne Johnson still plays for United. b) Wayne Johnson has left United. 3. Choose the correct word in each sentence6: a) Did you see/Have you seen my bag anywhere? I can’t find it. b) Larry is writing/has been writing/ has written his novel for the last two years. c) From the minute he got up this morning Gary asked/ has asked/ has been asking silly questions! d) Have you given/ Did you give Helen my message when you have seen/saw her? e) Sorry, could you say that again? I didn’t listen/haven’t listened/haven’t been listening to you. f) The police think that they found/have found your wallet, so call this number. g) Did you two meet/ Have you two met before? Eric, this is Amanda. h) Did you meet/Have you met anyone interesting at the reception? 5 Eastwood, John. Oxford Practice Grammar. Intermediate. Oxford: Oxford University Press, 2006/2013 6 Exercises 3 and 4: Vince, Michael & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 17 4. Put each verb in brackets into either the past simple, the present perfect simple, or the present perfect continuous: It was announced in London this morning that the British Oil Corporation (1) has discovered (discover) oil under the sea near the Welsh coast. The company, which (2) …………………(drill) for oil in the area since 2001, (3)……………….(find) small amounts of oil near Swansea last month, and since then (4)……………..(discover) larger amounts under (5)………………..(lend) the over seabed nearby. 50 Last million year pounds the to government BOC, and (6)……………….(give) permission for the company to build an oil refinery and other facilities in South Wales. The reaction of local people to today’s news (7)…………………(be) mixed so far. Local MPs (8) ……………………(already welcome) the news, pointing out that the oil industry will bring badly needed jobs to the area. But local residents are worried about the danger of pollution. ‘Nobody (9)………………(ask) us yet what we want’, said Ann Griffiths, leader of the Keep Out The Oil Campaign. ‘Look what (10)…………………(happen) when they (11)…………………(find) oil in Scotland in the 1960s. The oil companies (12)………………..(get) rich, not the local people. BOC (13)………………..(not tell) us the truth about what this is going to mean for our people’. A BOC spokesman later (14)……………………(refuse) to comment. Meanwhile local campaigners (15) ……………………(ask) the government to hold an inquiry. 5. Present and future: Read each pair of sentences and answer the question about them7. E.g.: a) I’ll see you on Thursday/ b) I saw you on Thursday. Which sentence is about the future? 1. a) a) I’m going to Manchester. I’m waiting for a connecting train. b) I’m going to get a train to Manchester, changing at Birmingham. Which is spoken during the journey? ……… 7 John Eastwood. Oxford Practice Grammar. Intermediate. OUP, 2006/2013. 18 2. a) We’ll know the results of the tests next week. b) We might know the results of the tests next week. Which sentence is more certain? 3. ……….. a) I’m doing two exams this year. b) I’m doing some work at the moment. In which sentence has the action already started? 4. ……… a) What time do we arrive in Swansea? b) What time will we arrive in Swansea? Which question is more likely if you are travelling by car? …… 5. a) I’m eating at the Thai restaurant tonight. b) I’ll eat at the Thai restaurant tonight. Which would you say if you’ve booked a table? ……….. 6. Future in the past: “I was going to ring you yesterday”8 Complete the sentences with expressions from the box: was going to happen was going to ring was going to say was catching was leaving was to change was to regret would be terrible would be married would spend 1. Carola and I hardly noticed each other the first evening. Two weeks later we ………………………………………………………………………………………. 2. He ……………………………………... that conversation for many years to come. 3. I ………………………………………………………...you yesterday, but I forgot. 4. She……………………………… in two hours, and she still hadn’t started packing. 5. So this was the school where I ………………………………….the next five years. 6. The letter that …………………….. ………….my life arrived one Friday morning. 7. I couldn’t decide what I ……………………………………………………to Mary. 8. I knew that the party ………………………………………………….. , and it was. 9. I got up early because I ……………………………………………….the 7.50 train. 10. John was the only person who realized what ……………………………………… 8 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 19 7. Choose the most suitable future form in each sentence9: a) Why are you going to buy/ will you buy a new mountain bike? b) Don’t phone between 8.00 and 9.00. I’ll study/ I’ll be studying then. c) Look out! That tree will/is going to fall! d) Let me know as soon as Louise will get/gets there. e) Great news! Jean and Chris will come/are coming to stay with us. f) According to this timetable, the bus is going to arrive/arrives at 6.00. g) Can you call me at 7.00, because I’ll leave/I’m leaving tomorrow. 8. Put each verb in brackets into a suitable form: a) I can’t see you on Thursday afternoon. I (visit) am visiting our Birmingham branch. b) George (not be)……………………………….back until six. Can I take a message? c) What (you buy)…………………………….with the money you won in the lottery? d) I don’t think you (have)………………………………...any problems at the airport. e) (you take)…………………………………………..your dog with you to Scotland? f) By the time we reach home, the rain (stop) will have stopped. g) This time next week I (lie)…………………………………on the beach in Spain. h) In ten years’ time I (work)………………………………..for a different company. i) If we don’t get there by 6.00, Jack (leave)………………………………………… j) In July they (be married)…………………………………………...for twenty years. 9. Put each verb in brackets into a suitable form: Have you ever wondered what exactly (1) you will be doing (you do) in ten years time? Well, according to computer expert Tom Vincent, computers (2)……………………….(soon be able) to make accurate predictions about the future. Professor Vincent, from Cambridge, (3)…………………(hold) a press conference 9 Exercises 7,8,9: Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 20 next week to describe the computer which he calls ‘Computafuture’. ‘This computer can tell us what life (4)……………………(be) like, based on data describing past events’, explains Professor Vincent. For example, Computafuture can predict how many people (5)………………..(live) in a particular area, or whether there (6)………………..(be) a lot of rain during a particular period. Professor Vincent also believes that by the year 2050, computers (7)…………………..(replace) teachers, and (8) …………….. (also do) most of the jobs now being done by the police. ‘Computers are becoming more intelligent all the time’, says Professor Vincent. ‘Soon they (9)………………………(direct) traffic and (10)………………(teach) our children. And telling us about the future. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL - PERSONAL MATTERS10 1. Choose the correct word in each sentence: a) When her bicycle was stolen, Jill became extremely angry/nervous. b) Peter felt ashamed/embarrassed when he had to make a speech. c) I always write thank-you letters, just to be gentle/polite. d) You never do anything to help me! You’re so lazy/tired. e) Penny never does anything silly. She’s very sensible/sensitive. f) The children had to stay in the house all day and felt bored/tired. g) Jackie doesn’t worry about anything and is always cheerful/sympathetic. h) Mr Jackson is very annoyed/bad-tempered and often shouts at people. i) When he heard about the accident, Alan was very damaged/upset. j) I’ve got an important exam tomorrow and I’m a bit jealous/nervous. 10 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice with Key. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 21 2. Complete each sentence with one of the verbs from the box. Use each verbs once only: cheer complain cry nod shake his head shout smile whistle a) Please look at the camera and smile. Say ‘cheese’! b) If you agree with what I say, just……………………………………………………. c) The food in the restaurant was terrible so we decided to…………………………… d) I had to……………………………….Ann’s name three times before she heard me. e) The little boy fell over and then started to …………………………………………. f) At the end of the President’s speech, the crowd began to………………………….. g) Paul hardly ever says ‘no’. He tends to……………………………………...instead. h) When I try to………………………………..I put my lips together but I can’t do it! 3. Complete each sentence with a word formed from the word in italics: a) You can’t rely on Joe. He’s very unreliable. b) Carla has very little patience. She’s very…………………………………………… c) Jack shows no interest in this subject. He’s ………………………………………... d) Pat is lacking in honesty. She’s ……………………………………………………... e) Bill doesn’t act like a friend. He’s ………………………………………………….. f) Lisa doesn’t have much experience of this work. She’s ……………………………. g) Peter never acts politely. He’s ……………………………………………………… h) The official did not help us very much. She was……………………………………. i) Graham doesn’t consider other people. He’s ………………………………………. j) Ann refused to co-operate with the police. She was………………………………... 22 4. Complete each sentence with one of the adjectives from the box. Use each adjective once only: ashamed annoyed jealous terrified disappointed exhausted fascinating glad a) When her team lost the cup final, Sue felt very disappointed. b) I was ……………….when Jack accepted my invitation to dinner but didn’t come. c) Mark was …………………...when he saw smoke coming from the plane’s engine. d) Thanks for your letter. I’m ……………………….to hear that you’re feeling better. e) David was ……………………….to tell his parents that he had been sent to prison. f) After running for fifteen kilometres, Zara felt completely………………………….. g) Helen felt ……………………...when she saw her boyfriend talking to another girl. h) Mrs Hobson told us about her life. She’s a ………………………………….person. 5. Replace the words in italics in each sentence with one of the phrases from the box: are fond of let me down fancy fed up with get on my nerves longing for put me off give up a) I’m really looking forward to a few weeks’ holiday! longing for b) Sarah has decided to do without eating chocolate. ………………… c) I wanted to study biology, but my teacher discouraged me. ………………… d) Sports programs on television really annoy me. …………………. e) Do you feel like going to the cinema this evening? …………………. f) Why can’t you tell the truth? I’m tired of your excuses! …………………. g) Terry and I like going for walks in the country. …………………. h) George agreed to help me, but then disappointed me. …………………. 23 6. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: conscience death hand heart temper thanks trouble voice mood tears a) The children were happy because their teacher was in a good mood. b) ……………………….to Mr Dawson, our car was repaired in time for our holiday. c) Ruth was helpful, and went to a lot of …………………….to make us comfortable. d) Harry was leaning out of the window and shouting at the top of his ………………. e) When Alice heard the bad news, she burst into……………………………………... f) Neil is a very kind person. His ………………………………....is in the right place. g) If you do something bad, it will be on your ………………………...for a long time. h) I was really angry, and lost my…………………………….., and shouted at people. i) We need some help. Could you give us a ………………………………………….? j) The first time I saw a horror film, I was scared to …………………………………. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC - THE NEWS – DOMESTIC VIOLENCE11 1. A young mother was accused yesterday of battering her two-year-old son to death. Sue Harlot was said to have hit the boy repeatedly with a broom. The boy died from a haemorrhage caused by a blow to the neck. The pathologist’s report said the child showed signs of having been regularly punched, pinched and slapped. The jury was shown pictures of the victim’s body, covered with bruises and other marks of violence. The mother denies killing her son or causing him unnecessary suffering. The trial continues. 2. A man battered his wife to death with a hammer in a quarrel over his drink money. Lesley Brown, 68, lost his temper because his wife would give him only £2 for a drinking session at the pub. The prosecution accepted his plea of manslaughter due to diminished responsibility. Brown, who has a story of alcohol abuse, was ordered to be detained without limit under the Mental Health Act. 11 Barbara & Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 24 3. A man appeared in court today charged with causing grievous bodily harm to his five-year-old stepson. The man was full of remorse and bitterly regretted what he had done. Weeping in the dock, Jack Corman, 28, described his own unhappy childhood as a battered child. The jury heard a psychiatric report which confirmed that between forty and sixty percent of male abusers were abused themselves as children, and that makes them vent their frustration as adults on other children. The man could not explain what made him drag the boy about the flat by his hair and repeatedly hit him. The mother of the boy spoke in dramatic words of systematic violence against herself and the boy, and of her shame and humiliation. She described how she had failed to get police protection as often there were no visible injuries. Corman would also press her do drop charges against him, using threats of further violence. In sentencing the man to two years’ imprisonment, the judge said that domestic violence should be treated with the same degree of seriousness as other violence. He said that Corman had been a bad and cruel stepfather who, instead of standing in for the absent parent, treated the child and his mother in an appalling way. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. The boy’s death was accidental. 2. According to the pathologist, the recent beating was an isolated accident. 3. The jury could not verify the pathologist’s report. 4. The mother pleaded guilty to the charge. 5. Lesley Brown killed his wife because she did not want to give him any money for alcohol. 6. According to him, he did not realize what he had done. 7. He is an alcoholic. 8. Brown knows when they will let him out. 9. Jack Corman tried to explain his actions as being the result of mental problems. 10. It is more than likely that Corman’s stepson will abuse his own children. 11. Corman said the boy had provoked him. 12. The boy’s mother never called the police for help. 13. The judge decided not to send Corman to prison despite the seriousness of the crime. 25 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B alcohol…………………. abuse battered…………………. abusers cruel…………………….. child diminished……………… childhood dramatic………………. harm drinking………………… injuries grievous………………….. protection male……………………… report police…………………….. responsibility psychiatric…………………. session systematic…………………. stepfather unhappy………………….. suffering unnecessary……………….. violence visible…………………….. words 3.Headline – Rearrange the words to form the headlines to the stories: 1. KILLING – BATTERED – MOTHER- SON – OF - ACCUSED ……………………………………………………………………………………… 2.DRINK-DOMESTIC-MANSLAUGHTER-OVER-LEADS-TO-QUARRELMONEY ………………………………………………………………………………………. 3. REVENGE – HIS- BATTERER – FOR – IMPRISONMENT – CHILDHOOD – WHO – FOR – TOOK ……………………………………………………………………………………… 26 4. Phrases to learn: - lovit (bătut) cu coada măturii – h…………. with a b………….. - urme de violenţă – m…………. of v…………….. - a face să sufere – c…………… s………………… - a-şi pierde stăpânirea de sine – l…………. one’s t………………… - responsabilitate limitată – d……………. r…………………….. - alcoolic cu vechi ştate – h………….. of a……….. a…………… - a produce vătămare corporală – c……………. b………….. h………………. - a regret amarnic – b…………… r……………. - leziuni vizibile – v…………… i……………. - a retrage acuzaţia – d………….. c…………….. - a înlocui pe unul din părinţii absenţi – s………….. i…………. f………….. the a………….. p……………. - a trata într-un mod groaznic – t………….. in an a……….. w…………. 27 LESSON 3 *Grammar: Revision – Present Tense, Past Tense, Present Perfect, Past Perfect, Future * Vocabulary: General – Family and Friends * Phrasal Verbs - Come * Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Hurricanes *** I. GRAMMAR – REVISION - Present Tense, Past Tense, Present Perfect, Past Perfect, Future 1. Choose the correct word or phrase in each sentence12: a) When I was a child I used to ride/I was riding a tricycle. b) That looks very heavy. Will I/Shall I help you? c) I’m waiting for Sue. Have you seen her/Did you see her? d) How long are you working/have you been working here? e) I can’t come out because I haven’t finished/I didn’t finish my homework yet. f) When the phone rang I washed/I was washing my hair in the bathroom. g) Why do you stare/are you staring at me like that? h) I’ve finished my exams so I’m having/ I have a party tomorrow. i) We’d better wait here until the rain stops/will stop. j) When did you last go/have you last been to the cinema? 2. Put each verb in brackets into the present simple or continuous, or the past simple or continuous: a) ‘What (you do) do you do?’ ‘I’m an engineer’. b) The door was open so the dog (run)…………………………..into the living room. c) When we arrived home Jan (sit)…………………………………...outside the door. d) Can you help me? I (not understand)……………………………………….Spanish. e) At the beginning of the film I (realize)……………………………I’d seen it before. 12 Exercices 1,2,3: Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 28 f) I’m sorry, I can’t talk long. I (study)……………………………for an examination. g) At the moment of the earthquake Pat (read)…………………………………in bed. h) I’ll phone you as soon as I (know)……………………………………….the results. i) I (stay)………………………………….at the Hotel Tirol. Why don’t you call me? j) ‘What (you do)…………………………………...when you saw the snake?’ ‘I ran’. 3. For each question, complete the second sentence so that it means the same as the first, using no more than three words: E.g.: a) Steve left before my arrival. When I arrived, Steve had already left. b) Do you need any help with your suitcase? Shall……………………………………………………you with your suitcase? c) What’s your usual time of arrival at school? When ………………………………………………………….arrive at school? d) Alice started playing tennis six months ago. Alice……………………………………………………...tennis for six months. e)I’ll wait here until it stops raining. When it stops raining…………………………………………………….leave. f) In the middle of my meal, the phone rang. While I ……………………………………………….my meal the phone rang. g) Jack has come to stay for the weekend. Jack………………………………………………….with me for the weekend. h) I last saw David in 1990. I……………………………………………………………...David since 1990. i) Are you free tomorrow evening? Are………………………………………………..anything tomorrow evening? 29 4. Look at these sentences and then tick the right answer13: E.g.: David and Tom were talking together when a young woman spoke to them. Which took more time, a) what David and Tom said, or b) what the woman said? 1. Mike had put up the tent, but Harriet was still unloading things from the car. Which finished first, a) putting up the tent? or b) unloading? 2. Mark went home and switched off the computer. What did he do first, a) go home? or b) switch off the computer? 3. When Claire arrived, Henry was walking up and down. Which started earlier, a) Claire’s arrival, or b) Henry’s walking? 4. When Sarah had phoned the office, she drove to the hotel. Did she phone the office a) before, or b) after driving to the hotel? 5. Past Simple, Continuous and Perfect: Daniel is telling the story of how he forgot his passport. Put the verbs into the correct form: It happened (it/happen) last August at the airport. A few weeks before, a group of us (1)………………………(decide) to go to Greece together for a holiday. (2)………………………..(we/wait) in the queue at passport control when suddenly (3) ………………………(I/realize) that (4)………………………(I/forget) my passport. (5)…………………..(it/be) quite a shock. (6)……………………..(I/hurry) to a phone and (7)……………………….(ring) (8)…………………….(they/work) in the garden, but my luckily parents. my mother (9)………………………(hear) the phone. (10)………………………(they/find) the passport and immediately (11) ……………………….(drive) to the airport with it. (12)………………….. (I/meet) them at the information desk. (13)…………………….(we/have) no time to talk, but (14) ……………………(I/say) goodbye to them earlier that morning. (15) ………………… (I/run) all the way to the plane. I was just in time. When (16)…………………….(I/get) there, the passengers (17)…………………… 13 (sit) in their seats ready for take-off. Exercises 4,5: John Eastwood. Oxford Practice Grammar. Intermediate. OUP, 2006/2013. 30 When (18)……………………….. (they/see) me, everyone (19)……………………(start) clapping. 6. Choose the correct forms to complete the sentences14: 1. I hope your exam goes well. I will be thinking/will have been thinking/am to think of you. 2. When I finish this job I am to work/ will have been working/ will be working on it for two years. 3. Tell the children they will be tidying/ would tidy/are to tidy their room. 4. I hope by next summer I will save/ will be saving/ will have saved enough money for a holiday. 5. So this was the man that I would be to/ am going to/ was going to work for. I didn’t like the look of him. 6. The Prime Minister is to open/ will have opened/ has opened the new hospital next month. 7. I didn’t go to Pete’s party, because I knew that I didn’t enjoy/wouldn’t enjoy/ wasn’t to enjoy it. 8. I saw Carola last year. She thought she would go/ would have gone/ had gone to America, but I don’t know if she went. 9. What time will you have got/ will you be getting/ are you to get up tomorrow? 10. ‘Is my car ready?’ ‘No, but we have finished/ would finish/will have finished by this evening’. 14 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 31 II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL - FAMILY AND FRIENDS15 1. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: alike children couple elder housewife husband single twin engaged friendship a) Jane got married to her husband, Bob, four years ago. b) Jane’s friends think that she and Bob are the perfect ………………………………. c) They haven’t got any……………………………..yet, but they want a large family. d) Jane’s ………………………….sister, Mary, was born half an hour before she was. e) Jane and Mary look…………........................................but are not exactly the same. f) Mary isn’t married. She says she prefers to be……………………………………… g) She says she believes in …………………………., but doesn’t believe in marriage. h) Diana is Jane and Mary’s ………………….sister. She calls them her ‘little sisters.’ i) Diana has been………………………….for three years, but hasn’t got married yet. j) She has a career and doesn’t like the idea of being a ……………………………… 2. Complete each sentence with a noun formed from a verb in the box: acquaint celebrate die engage greet marry relate resemble a) All Sue’s friends and relatives came to her party. b) I occasionally meet Terry, but he’s more an…………………………..than a friend. c) When Paul arrived, he received a warm and friendly………………………………. d) Six months after their………………………………, Michael and Lisa got married. e) There was a great………………………in the village when their team won the cup. f) In an ideal ……………………….., husband and wife share each other’s problems. g) Dina and her mother look alike. There is a strong…………………...between them. h) Tim cried when he heard about the ………………………………….of his old dog. 15 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 32 3. Underline the correct word in each sentence: a) Children are not allowed to see this film. It’s for adults/old only. b) By the time the vet arrived, the injured cat was already dead/died. c) Unfortunately it rained on Nick and Helen’s wedding/marriage day. d) David and Diana have two sons and one daughter/girl. e) I think we should try to understand the problems of aged/old people. f) There should be more facilities for youth/young people in this town. g) More than fifty relatives/parents were invited to Jack’s party. h) It’s my anniversary/birthday today. I’m eighteen years old. 4. Complete each part sentence (a-j) with an ending (1-10): a) I’ve started going - 6 1) takes after his father. b) When little Tina is grown 2) together again next Friday evening? c) I wonder if you could put 3) up by an aunt after their parents died. d) Carol doesn’t really get 4) in on Steve for a chat. e) Everyone says that Tom 5) after my dog while I’m away? f) Let’s have some friends 6) out with George’s younger sister. g) Do you think you could look 7) round for dinner on Friday. h) Why don’t we all get 8) on well with her mother-in-law. i) Ellen and Laura were brought 9) up she wants to be an astronaut j) If I have time I’ll drop 10) us up for a few days next week? 5) Match each sentence (a-h) with a sentence (1-8) which helps to explain the meaning of the word in italics: a)We’ve got a new neighbor called Helen 1) I was happy that he’d invited me to his Wills ……5 party. b) This is Sue. She’s a colleague of mine. 2) Even before she married my brother ……… we’d become good friends. 33 c) Andrew is going to be our best man. 3) She always offers to help in the house ……… when she stays with us. d) At the end of the evening I thanked our 4) We both work in the same department host. ……. at the bank. e) I’m sure that Mary will be a wonderful 5) She moved into the house next door bride. ……. yesterday. f) Next week I’m going to stay with my 6) They’re both in their seventies, but grandparents. …….. they live a very full life. g) I’ve always got on well with my sister- 7) When John and I get married, he’ll in-law…….. stand next to John. h) Georgiana is the ideal guest. ……… 8) She’s a dressmaker, and has designed her own wedding dress. 6. Complete each sentence with a word or phrase from the box. Use each word or phrase once only: after against away in on on and off out over a) It would be nice to meet again. I’ll get in touch with you next week. b) I’m afraid Sonia isn’t here. She went ……………………………for the weekend. c) I keep leaving and coming back. I’ve lived here………………….for several years. d) Matthew brought up the children………………………his own after his wife died. e) The baby was called Clare, ………………………………………..its grandmother. f) Peter is…………………………….at the moment but he’ll be back in half an hour. g) Ann decided to get married……………………………….the wishes of her parents. h) After their final quarrel, Carrie told Luke their relationship was…………………… 34 VOCABULARY: GENERAL - PHRASAL VERBS – COME 16 1. Come expressing an idea of movement or change of state: phrasal verb meaning example come along arrive at a place Not many people bought tickets for the concert in advance, but quite a few came along and bought tickets at the door. come apart separate into pieces The antique picture frame just came apart in my hands. come around or become conscious again A nurse was with me when I came around after the operation. come round come out disappear or become Let your shirt soak overnight and less strong (of dirt or the stain will probably come out. colour on clothing / material) come out become public If this story comes out about the knowledge after it has Prime Minister, he’ll have to been kept secret (of the resign. truth) come out come out be given to people (of When do your exam results come results or information) out? leave after a period in a Jane’s coming out of hospital at place (of the weekend. She’s much better hospital/prison) now. Complete these sentences with a particle from the table above: 1. Do you have any glue? The cover of my address book is coming ……………..and I want to stick it together again. 2.I spilt some orange juice on the table cloth. Do you think it will come…………….if I put it in the washing machine? 16 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011. 35 3. The last thing I remember was feeling very dizzy. The next thing I knew, I came ……………….in hospital and a doctor was standing by my bed. 4. The government is going to release a report on traffic congestion. I wonder when it’s coming ………….. 5. We were just chatting at the corner when Jim Gore came ……………… with his girlfriend. 6. I hear Bruce’s operation was successful. When is he coming ………………....of the clinic? 7. Some very shocking facts have come…………… about government corruption, thanks to an investigation by a national newspaper. 2. Come expressing an idea of happen: come off happen successfully or planned as I was planning to arrange a surprise holiday for her birthday, but I’m not sure it’s going to come off. come about happen, especially something I’ve had to organise the school fair which is not planned again this year – I’m not quite sure how that came about. come up to be mentioned or discussed ….only if the subject comes up in conversation. come up happen unexpectedly, usually a …..but then something came up problem or difficult situation and we had to deal with it straightaway. come up become available …..I don’t know if a place on the council is going to come up for a while yet, so perhaps I’ll wait. Use a phrasal verb from the table above to complete these dialogues: 1. Anne: We lost everybody’s e-mail address and had to start all over again. Ken: Really? How did that …………………………………………………………? Anne: Oh, it was some computer virus. 36 2. Rick: David keeps saying he’s going to sail around the world. Ivan: Huh! Do you think it will ever ……………………………………………….? Rick: Probably not. He’s such a dreamer. 3. Brian: We’ll let you know what we decide. We’ll phone you. Fran: When do you think you’ll ……………………………………………………? Brian: Probably at the meeting on Friday. 4. Olga: I thought you were coming to the dinner party last night. Ulla: Yes, I was intending to, but right at the last minute something ……………..? Olga: Oh, I see. Well, you must come next time. 3. Other meanings of come come up against encounter or have to deal I’m doing a research project for my with (a difficult situation) degree on the psychology of ageing, but I’ve come up against a few problems. come across discover (or met) chance come to an almost identical study. make (a decision about I’ve got to come to a decision: do I something) come down to by I came across someone who’s done want to continue with it or not? depend mostly on or be I guess in the end my decision will influenced most by come down to what my professor recommends. Rewrite the underlined words in these horoscopes, using phrasal verbs with come: SCORPIO: You may have to deal with a few problems at work today, but don’t worry, they’re only temporary, and a new job opportunity will arise which could change your life. The name of an old friend is mentioned in conversation, bringing back powerful memories. TAURUS: You will meet someone by pure chance who seems to share the same world view as you, but be careful, they are not what they seem to be. Don’t forget that, in the end, true love is mainly about finding someone you can trust. 37 III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC: THE NEWS – HURRICANES17 Hurricane George, which has been sweeping across the Atlantic for the last few days, struck the coastal areas of Jahar shortly before dawn, with winds of up 170 miles an hour. The battering gales are said to be moving inland, causing widespread damage and devastation. As the hurricane-force winds cut a swath across the country, they are leaving behind a trail of destruction: downed power lines and telephone poles, torn off roofs and uprooted trees. The fishing fleet was totally destroyed as the winds ripped boats from their moorings and tossed them on shore. Huge seas heavily inundated populated areas of the coastal plains, wiping out several settlements. Coastal town residents have sought refuge in stone-built churches and on higher ground. So far, the violent hurricane has left one hundred dead in its wake. The death toll is still climbing as more and more bodies are recovered from under collapsed buildings. Five hundred people are reported missing and are presumed dead, having been swept away by flood waters. The casualty list and the damage statistics are still incomplete and will probably soar as communication links with affected areas are restored. As hardly a house in the area still has a roof, the President has declared a state of emergency. Residents are in desperate need of food and shelter. The authorities ordered the evacuation of people from the capital, although it is hoped that by the time the hurricane reaches the city, it will have downgraded to a tropical storm. If so, the city will survive relatively unscathed. However, what has not already been flattened by the winds is still likely to be severely damaged by mudslides and floods caused by the accompanying torrential rain. Judging by the devastation, Hurricane George is likely to be the deadliest storm on record. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Hurricane George reached the coast of Jahar in the evening. 2. People knew that it was coming. 3. There is no electricity in the affected areas. 17 Barbara & Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 38 4. The fishing fleet was destroyed because the boats were not properly secured. 5. All the devastation was caused by the wind. 6. Churches in Jahar offer better protection than other buildings. 7. The number of victims is as yet unclear. 8. Flood waters have claimed no victims. 9. The President receives regular telephone reports from the coast. 10. Housing is the biggest problem at the moment. 11. People are leaving the capital although it may prove unnecessary. 12. Mudslides are triggered by gale-force winds. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B battering…………………. areas casualty…………………… damage coastal…………………… fleet damage…………………… gales fishing…………………… hurricane flood……………………….. list huge……………………….. rain torrential……………………. seas tropical……………………. statistics violent………………………… storm widespread………………………. waters 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: 100 – OVER- DEADLY- JAHAR – STRIKES – KILLING- GEORGE ……………………………………………………………………………………… 39 4. Phrases to learn: - a provoca pagube şi distrugeri – c…………. d……….. and d…………………… - a rupe liniile de înaltă tensiune – d………… p………….. l………………….. - a mătura (a distruge) o aşezare (grup de case) – w………. o……….. s…………….. - a lăsa distrugerile – l…………….. a t………..of d…………….. - a lăsa în urmă – l…………… i…………….. its w………………… - date incomplete – i………….. s……………… - a reface legăturile de comunicaţie – r…………. c……………… l…………… - a declara stare de calamitate – d………… a s………. of e………………… - a da ordin de evacuare – o…………. e………………… - faţă de suprafaţa afectată, se poate aprecia – j……….…. by the d………….. - a fi înregistrat – be o………….. r…………. 40 a LESSON 4 *Grammar: Indirect Speech * Vocabulary: General – The Body and Clothes * Phrasal Verbs: Get * Vocabulary : Specific - The News – Road Accidents *** I. GRAMMAR: INDIRECT SPEECH18 # ‘Here’ and ‘now’ words: 1. Match the direct and indirect speech expressions: 0. here 5. today A. that day…… F. the next day….. 1. now 6. tonight B. that night…… G. there 0 2. this 7. last week C. that…… H. the week before….. 3. tomorrow 8. next week D. the day before….. I. then……… 4. yesterday E. the next week….. 2. Imagine these sentences were reported in another place a month later. Put in words and expressions from the box: right away that day that evening that morning the the day after the day before the same night the week before there E.g.: ‘I’ll see you tomorrow’. She said she’d see me the day after. 1. ‘My brother’s arriving here today.’ She said her brother was arriving…………… 2. ‘I’ll phone you this evening.’ He said he’d phone ……………………………….. 3. ‘Do you like it here?’ She asked if I liked it ……………………………………… 4. ‘My uncle died last week.’ He told me his uncle had died ……………………….. 5. ‘This meat tastes funny.’ She said……………………………….meat tasted funny. 18 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 41 6. ‘I’m leaving now.’ He told us he was leaving……………………………………… 7. ‘I overslept this morning.’ She told him she’d overslept…………………………… 8. ‘The train leaves at 11.00 tonight.’ I was told the train left at 11.00………………. 9. ‘Pete phoned me yesterday.’ He said Pete had phoned him………………………… #Tenses 3. Complete the table: DIRECT SPEECH INDIRECT SPEECH simple present ……………………… ……………………… past continuous present perfect ………………………. simple past …………………….. ………………………. would…….. 4. Complete the reported sentences with the correct tenses: 1. ‘I’m tired.’ She said she ……………………………………………………….tired. 2. ‘You play very well.’ He told me I……………………………………….very well. 3. ‘Can you help us?’ They asked if I ………………………………………help them. 4. ‘We’re leaving.’ They told us they…………………………………………………. 5. ‘She hasn’t brushed her hair.’ I noticed that she …………………………...her hair. 6. ‘John’s had an accident.’ Pam rang to say that John …………………...an accident. !!!! Tenses DON’T CHANGE #after present or future reporting verbs (there is no important change of time) He says he doesn’t want to play anymore. (‘I don’t want….’) I’ll tell her your idea is great. #after present perfect reporting verbs The government has announced that taxes will be raised. !!!! We often drop that after common reporting verbs: He said (that) he was falling in love with me. 42 I knew (that) he was lying. # ‘Say’ and ‘Tell’ TELL + personal object = we tell somebody something – Karen told us a joke. SAY - (NO) personal object = we say something (to somebody) – We said nothing to anybody 5. Choose the correct answer: 1. I said/told John I wanted to go home. 2. Lucy said/told that she would buy the tickets. 3. I didn’t say/tell anyone that I was leaving. 4. Why did you say/tell you were ill? 5. My father said/told he needed help. #Present situations: He proved that the earth is/was round - a situation that is still present or future when the words are reported DIRECT SPEECH INDIRECT SPEECH The earth is round. He proved that the earth was/is round. ‘How old are you?’ ‘What?” I asked how old you were/are. Where does she work? I’ve often wondered where she worked/works. It will be windy tomorrow. The forecast said it would/will be windy tomorrow. 6. Imagine these sentences were reported soon after they were said: change them to indirect speech in two different ways: E.g.: I’m utterly fed up! (I said) I said I was utterly fed up. I said I’m utterly fed up. 43 1. What day is it? (I asked) ………………………………………………………………………………….. 2. What’s the dark-haired child’s name? (I asked) ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. It’s raining. (I told you) …………………………………………………………………………………. 4. You’ll get your money. (I said) ………………………………………………………………………………… 5. There will be a strike. (This article I was reading said) ………………………………………………………………………………… !!!! We do not keep the original speaker’s tenses if we don’t agree with what he/she said, or if we want to show that the ideas do not come from us. They were certain that the gods lived in the sky. Did you hear that? She said she was fourteen! He announced that profits were higher than forecast. I didn’t know she was ill. # Indirect questions – subject + verb I asked where the trainer and the team were staying. Nobody told me why I had to sign the paper - yes/no questions – if/whether (= formal style) The driver asked if/whether I wanted to go to the town centre. - verb + subject – only informal – He wanted to know when could I start. 7. Turn these into indirect questions, beginning I asked: E.g.: Where are my gloves? I asked where my gloves were. 1. What’s Peter’s address? ……………………………… 2. When’s the new manager coming? ……………………………… 3. How does she know my name? ………………………………. 4. Why are all the windows open? ………………………………. 44 5. How many books does he want? ……………………………….. #Infinitives: He promised to write – future actions – promises, agreements, orders, offers, advice, suggestions, requests ‘I’ll definitely write.’ He promised to write. ‘Ok, I’ll wait until 6 o’clock.’ She agreed to wait until 6 o’clock. ‘Do be careful, Andrew.’ I told Andrew to be careful. ‘Shall I babysit tonight?’ Ann has offered to babysit tonight. ‘You’d better think again.’ The manager advised me to think again. ‘Please don’t be late.’ She asked us not to be late. 8. Change the sentences as shown: E.g.: I won’t tell anybody. (He promised) He promised not to tell anybody. 1. I’ll cook supper. (She offered) ……………………………… 2. Leave early. (He advised me) …………………………….. 3. Please don’t close the door. (She asked me) ……………………………… 4. I’ll stop smoking. (She promised) …………………………….. 5. Why don’t I do the shopping? (He offered) …………………………… #Special cases: He said I’d better go Past tense > Past perfect – only if necessary in order to make the time relations clear DIRECT SPEECH INDIRECT SPEECH I saw Penny a couple of days ago. In his letter, he said he’d seen Penny a couple of days before. Dinosaurs were around for 250 million This guy on TV said that dinosaurs were years. around for 250 million years. 45 9. Change these to indirect speech: 1. I saw him once before in London. (I knew) ……………………………………………………………………………………… 2. Shakespeare didn’t speak French. (The professor said) ……………………………………………………………………………………… 3. He died two years ago. ( When I got there, I found out) ……………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Three thousand years ago there were tigers in England. (It said on this TV program) ………………………………………………………………………………………. 5. Somebody threw a bomb at the Prime Minister. (It said on this morning’s news) ………………………………………………………………………………………. 6. The ancient Romans suffered from lead poisoning. (I read in a magazine) ………………………………………………………………………………………. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL - THE BODY AND CLOTHES19 1. Choose the correct word in each sentence: a) The trousers are the right length, but the stomach/waist is too small. b) I like this watch, but the strap is too small for my palm/wrist. c) The hand has four fingers and a thumb/toe. d) When Robert is nervous he tends to bite his nails/joints. e) This bag has a strap and I can carry it on my neck/shoulder. f) Gina twisted her ankle/elbow and she can’t walk very easily. g) Paul dropped the stone on his foot and broke two toes/fingers. h) When you’re worried lines appear on your eyebrows/forehead. 19 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 46 2. Complete each sentence with a verb from the box. Use each verb once only: disguise dress up fit go with look put on suit wear a) This dress doesn’t fit me. It’s far too big. b) The children decided to …………………………………as astronauts for the party. c) Sue always seems to …………………..trousers. She says they’re more comfortable. d) I like your new haircut. It makes you………………………………………younger. e) It’s a nice pullover, but the color doesn’t ………………………………………you. f) The escaped prisoner managed to ………………………….himself as a policeman. g) I got up late and had only a few minutes to …………………………….my clothes. h) I don’t think that yellow socks………………………………………….a black suit. 3. Match the words from the box with the definitions: blouse cap dress shorts skirt sleeve sock suit a) part of an item of clothing for covering the arm. sleeve b) woman’s or girl’s clothing that covers the body from shoulders to knee or below. …………….. c) jacket together with trousers or skirt made from the same material. ……………… d) a soft covering for the head worn by young people, and in some sports ……………… e) trousers that end above or at the knee …………….. f) item of clothing for women or girls that hangs from the waist and covers all or part of the legs ……………….. g) item of clothing for women or girls covering the upper half of the body ………………. 47 h) soft item of clothing that covers the lower leg and foot inside the shoe ……………… 4. Complete each expression in italics with one of the parts of the body from the box: arms face foot hair heart tongue a) The word is on the tip of my tongue, but I just can’t remember it. b) Crossing the mountains on my own was a ……………………-raising adventure. c) I know this is hard to believe, but you must ……………………………..the truth. d) It is now over thirty years since man first set …………………………..on the moon. e) After his long trip Tom’s parents welcomed him with open………………………. f) Peter knows the songs by ……………………..and doesn’t need to look at a book. 5. Choose the right version: Clothes Choosing clothes can be difficult. Some people want to be (1) of fashion/fashioned/ fashionable/ fashion, but they don’t want to look exactly (2) alike/like/similar/same everybody else. Not all clothes are (3) fitted/suitable/comfort/equal for work or school, perhaps because they’re not (4) formal/strict/uniform/suited enough, or simply not (5) comforting/ comfort/ comforted/ comfortable. It is easy to buy the (6) false/mistake/wrong/error size, and find that your trousers are too (7) straight/close/stiff/tight, especially if you’re a little a bit (8) slim/ overweight/ thin/ enormous. Very (9) loose/lose/loosened/lost clothes make you feel (10) thin/ slim/ narrow/ spare, but when they have (11) lessened/ reduced/ decreased/ shrunk in the washing machine, then you have the same problem! If you buy light (12) of cotton/ in cotton/ cotton/ cottoned clothes, then they might not be (13) warm/ cold/ hot/ cool enough for winter. If your shoes are not (14) tight/enclosed/ firm/ waterproof, and if you aren’t (15) worm/ clothed/ dressed/ fitted for the cold, you might look good, but feel terrible! 48 VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS – GET20 A. Learning phrasal verbs in pairs associated with a context: Phrasal verb Meaning Example get together (+ If two or more people get together; they meet in with) It’s nice to get together with people you get on with. order to do something or spend time together If two or more people get get on (+ with) on, they like each other and are friendly to each other get on (+ with) get behind continue doing something, I must get on with my work. I got especially work behind because I spent too much (+ If you get behind with with) time on the Internet. work or with payments, you have not done as much work or paid as much as you should by a particular time get sth over with get away do and complete Let’s get this meeting over with, something difficult or or else we’ll never get away before unpleasant that must be the rush hour and it will take ages done. to get home. leave a place or person, often when the situation makes it difficult for you to do so can’t/couldn’t get be surprised or shocked I can’t get over how she manages over sth. that something has to get away with doing so little happened or that work. It’s obvious to everyone, but 20 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011. 49 get away sth/doing sth with something is true. the boss never seems to notice. succeed in not being criticised or punished for something wrong that you have done B. More phrasal verbs with get Gerry: How do you manage to survive without a job? Kimberly: Oh, I get by with a bit of help from my parents. [have just enough money to pay for the things I need, but nothing more] Lauren: The problem is that the regulations don’t allow us to use next year’s budget. Juliet: Oh, don’t worry. We’ll get around/round it somehow. [find a way of dealing with or avoiding a problem] Yanis: Have you rung the travel agent’s yet to confirm our bookings? Ronan: Sorry, I haven’t got around/round to it yet, but I’ll do it after lunch, I promise. [do something that you have intended to do for a long time] Polly: I really think you ought to apologise to you-know-who about you-know-what. Ivan: I’m sorry, I don’t know what you’re getting at. Who? What? [If you ask someone what they are getting at, you are asking them what they mean, usually because they have said something indirectly] Ellen: Do you think I can get away with not using any handouts in my lecture? [do something successfully even though it is not the best way of doing it] Lou: Yes, the students just throw them away anyway. 1. Choose the correct particle to complete these sentences: 1. Why don’t you get your homework around/over/by/away with so you can enjoy the rest of the evening? 50 2. As soon as Sue and I met, we knew we were going to get round/at/on/up well. 3. I just can’t come out with you tonight as I’ve got so up/over/away/behind with my work. 4. Why does Rita always get by/away/on/over with arriving late? It doesn’t seem fair. 5. I’m going to have to get round/over/away/behind to filling in my tax form soon. 6. I hope you’ll be able to get away/behind/at/over from work at a reasonable time thought. 7. Your mother couldn’t get up/round/by/over the cost of restaurants in London. 2. Match each question on the left with the most likely response on the right: 1. How do you and Joe get on? I manage somehow, though it isn’t easy. 2. What exactly are you getting at? I just wasn’t organized enough. 3. How do you get by on a student grant? Sure, that would be nice. 4. How did you get so behind? I certainly hope so. 5. When are you going to get round to it? Let me put it another way for you. 6. Shall we get together this evening? We’re great friends. 7. Will you manage to get away soon? Soon, I promise. 3. Rewrite the underlined parts of these sentences, using a phrasal verb (get +….): 1. I’ve been planning to sort out my files but I haven’t found time to do it yet. 2. I can’t believe how much money they spent on their New Year’s party. 3. Don’t try to travel without paying your train fare – an inspector might come on and want to see your ticket. 4. The teachers in the school often meet after work on Fridays in a café near the school. 5. They avoided the problem of offending anyone and just invited all their friends to the wedding. 6. I usually find it quite hard to understand what Professor Mactoft is trying to say in his lectures. 51 7. I hope no-one will mind if I don’t send any Christmas cards this year. 8. Emily has not done nearly as much work on her thesis as she should have done by now. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – THE NEWS – ROAD ACCIDENTS21 1. Fog played its part in a ten-vehicle pile-up on a busy road yesterday, bringing traffic to a halt and causing a five-mile tailback. Four of the cars burst into flames. Rescuers believe that an entire family was wiped out when six people were crushed to death by an articulated lorry that rammed their car. A bus, with school children, skidded off the road and plunged into a ditch. Two of the children died later from their injuries. The driver of the car which started the chain reaction collision suffered only slight bruises. He is believed to have lost control of his car seconds before hitting the crash barriers. The road was closed for hours to traffic while police removed the tangled wreckage. 2. Four people were seriously injured in a head-on crash when a car suddenly changed lanes and collided with an oncoming van. The autopsy revealed that the man who caused the accident had had a heart attack and had died at the wheel. The two cars involved were scarcely recognizable after the collision. The driver of the van was thrown clear and miraculously survived. His three passengers had to be cut free from the wreckage before being rushed to hospital and treated for their sustained injuries. 3. Six people lost their lives on Friday when a car, trying to avoid an unmarked open manhole, skidded and ran over a pedestrian who died instantly. The car then crashed into a stationary coach and the driver and four passengers were killed on the spot. According to the police, excessive speed was partly to blame for the tragedy and the driver was found to be more than four times over the drink limit. The man responsible for road works in that area will appear in court charged with negligence. 4. A camper was killed yesterday when a car hit the hard shoulder and ploughed into his tent ten yards from the road. The car then somersaulted twice before hitting a tree. 21 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 52 The driver and her passenger were rushed to hospital where they died from their injuries soon after being admitted. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Ten vehicles were involved in the collision. 2. Others cars couldn’t get past the site of the crash. 3. The Mini hit the back of an articulated lorry. 4. Two schoolchildren died in the bus which overturned. 5. If it hadn’t been for the bad weather conditions, the accident might not have happened. 6. The van started the collision. 7. The accident could have been prevented. 8. The van driver’s body was found in the wreckage of his vehicle. 9. Five people were involved in this collision. 10. The driver was drunk and was driving too fast. 11. The supervisor of the road works was indirectly responsible for the pedestrian’s death. 12. The camper was killed by a woman driver. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B articulated…………………. barriers busy………………………… bruises crash……………………….. coach entire………………………. family excessive……………………… injuries slight…………………………… lorry stationary…………………….. road sustained…………………….. speed tangled……………………….. wreckage 53 3. Rearrange the words to form the headlines to the stories: 1. IN – CHAIN – 12 – DRIVER – REACTION – CAUSES- CRASH – DEATHS ………………………………………………………………………………………… 2. HEART – FOR – COLLISION – RESPONSIBLE – HEAD-ON – ATTACK ………………………………………………………………………………………… 3. OPEN – DRIVER – KILLS – MANHOLE – AVOIDING – SPEEDING – SIX ………………………………………………………………………………………… 4. BY – CAMPER – DEATH – TO – UNSUSPECTING – CAR – CRASHED – …………………………………………………………………………………………. 4. Phrases to learn: - a juca un rol: -p………. a p……………….. - a fi cuprins de flăcări: -b…………… i……… f……………. - a muri din cauza leziunilor: -d…………. f……… i………….. - a se izbi de o furgonetă care se apropia: - c………….. w………….. an o…………. v…………… - greu identificabil: -s……………. r…………….. - a elibera victimele din automobilele avariate: -c…………. f……….. the v…………. f…………. the t………… w……………… - a deceda pe loc: -d………….. o……………. the s……………. - a învinui viteza excesivă: -b………….. e…………… s……………. - a avea alcolemia de patru ori mai mare decât limita admisă: -be f………. t……… o……………… d…………….. l………….. - a fi internat la spital: - be a…………. to h…………….. 54 the LESSON 5 *Grammar: ‘If’ Clause * Vocabulary: General –Everyday Problems * Phrasal Verbs: Go * Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Broken Marriages *** I. GRAMMAR- IF CLAUSE22 *Ordinary tense use If you didn’t do much maths at school, you’ll find economics difficult. If that was John, why didn’t he say hello? Metals expand if you heat them. - beginning or end of a sentence If you have any problems, telephone 911. Telephone 911 if you have any problems. 1. Complete the sentences with expressions from the box: I never get anything done I’m sure I can’t she was lying we can catch the early train you don’t know what’s going on? say you’re with me you park near the station you want to learn a musical instrument you won’t need to do it again you’re not feeling up to it 1. If anybody asks you what you’re doing, ……………………………………………. 2. How can you make decisions if …………………………………………………….. 3. If you did the test last week, ………………………………………………………... 4. If I don’t get up till nine, ……………………………………………………………. 5. If John couldn’t fix the computer yesterday, ……………………………………….. 6. If she said she didn’t know me, …………………………………………………….. 7. The shops are easy to get to if………………………………………………………. 8. We don’t have to go out if…………………………………………………………... 22 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011 55 9. If you’re ready before eight, ………………………………………………………... 10. You have to practice if …………………………………………………………….. *After if, we normally use a present tense to talk about the future. If I have enough time tomorrow, I’ll come and see you. I’ll give her your love if I see her. If it’s fine tomorrow, I’m going to paint the windows. 2. Put the correct tenses (present or ‘ll…..): 1. If you……………………that again, I…………………………………(say; scream) 2. I ………………….surprised if she……………………to sell that car. (be; manage) 3. If the boys……………….to supper, I………………..chicken breasts. (come; cook) 4. I………………..some money if we………………………….out tonight. (need; go) 5. I………………..you if we…………………………………...to Wales. (miss; move) *If I had a million dollars, ……… If + past tense+ would – things that are not real or not probable now. IF + PAST TENSE WOULD+ INFINITIVE (WITHOUT TO) If I had a million dollars, I would build myself a big house. If you were the boss, what would you do? If she didn’t buy so many she’d have enough money for food. clothes, If I had time, I would/should learn the saxophone. After if, we often use were instead of was. If I were rich, I would spend all my time travelling. We often use the structure If I were you……to give advice. If I were you, I’d get that car serviced. I shouldn’t worry if I were you. 56 3. Put the correct verb forms: 1. The kitchen……………………better if we……………….red curtains. (look; have) 2. Where……………………if you……………………a picture frame? (you go; need) 3. I………………….this if I ……………………………………..to. (not do; not have) 4. If I ………………his address, I……………………round and see him. (know; go) 5. What………………….if you……………………………..the lottery. (you do; win) *If I go and If I went - past + would = less probable, less definite, impossible, imaginary If I become President, I’ll………..(said by a candidate in an election) If I became President, I’d………..(said by a schoolgirl) If I win this race, I’ll………….(said by the fastest runner). If I won this race, I’d………….(said by the slowest runner). Is it all right if I invite John to supper? (direct request) Would it be all right if I invited John to supper? (polite request) 4. Choose the correct verb forms: 1. If she comes/came late again, she’ll lose her job. 2. I’ll let you know if I find/found out what’s happening. 3. If we live/lived in a town, life would be easier. 4. I’m sure he won’t mind if we arrive/arrived early. 5. We’ll/We’d phone you if we have time. 6. If I won the lottery, I will/would give you half the money. 7. It will/would be a pity if she married Fred. 8. If I’m free on Saturday, I will/would go to the mountains. 9. She will/would have a nervous breakdown if she goes on like this. 10. I know I’ll feel better if I stop/stopped smoking. 5. Make these requests less definite, and so more polite: E.g.: It will be nice if you help me a bit with the housework. It would be nice if you helped me a bit with the housework. 57 1. Do you mind if I go first? ………………………………………………………………………………….. 2. If all of us come, will you have room in your car? ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. It will be good if you spend some time with the children. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. Do you mind if I come round about seven o’clock? …………………………………………………………………………….......... 5. Is it all right if I use your phone? …………………………………………………………………………………. *Could = ‘would be able to’: We could go cycling if… If you arrived early, we could talk about the meeting. If Joe came, he could help with the dog. - once as a past tense (something is not real/not probable), once for would be able to. If I could sell my car, I could buy a computer. 6. Complete the sentences with could and expressions from the box: ask her to help get up late go to the cinema more often read the paper go and see him go for a ride have breakfast in the garden watch a film write to Henry E.g.: If Alice was here, we could ask her to help. If I could find my glasses, I could read the paper. 1. If John was at home, we…………………………………………………………… 2. If the TV was working, we………………………………………………………… 3. If we had bikes, ……………………………………………………………………. 4. If tomorrow was Saturday, I………………………………………………………. 5. If it was warmer, we……………………………………………………………….. 6. If I could find my address book, ………………………………………………….. 7. If we lived in a town, ………………………………………………………………. 58 *Unreal past situations: If Jane hadn’t helped me, ………. - how things could have been different - past perfect + would have + past participle IF + PAST PERFECT WOULD HAVE + PAST PARTICIPLE If Mary had felt better, we would have gone swimming. (But she didn’t, so we didn’t.) If you had told me the I would have respected you. (But you didn’t, so I truth, didn’t.) If Jane hadn’t helped me, I would have been in bad trouble. (But she did, so I wasn’t.) If she climbing, hadn’t gone she wouldn’t have fallen and broken her arm. (But she did.) - instead of would have…., we can use could have….( = ‘would have been able to’) If he’d run a bit faster, he could have won. 7. Write the sentences with the correct verb forms: E.g.: If I (know) you were coming, I (invite) some friends in. If I’d known you were coming, I’d have invited some friends in. 1. We (get) better tickets if we (book) earlier. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 2. He (go) to university if his father (not be) ill. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. If you (say) you weren’t hungry, I (not cook) such a big meal. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. The team (win) if Jones (play) better. ………………………………………………………………………………...... 5. If they (not cut) off the electricity, I (finish) my work. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 59 8. Write sentences chains with if to show how things could have been different: He bought a bicycle > went for a ride in the country > fell off > woke up in hospital >met a beautiful nurse > wrote a bestselling novel about her > got rich > married the beautiful nurse and had three charming children > lived happily ever after If he hadn’t bought a bicycle, ………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. Mary’s mother went out that evening>Mary cooked for herself > got interested in cooking > opened a very successful restaurant > had the Prime Minister as a customer > the PM ordered mussels > the mussels poisoned the PM > the PM died > Mary went to prison for life ………………………………………………………………………………………….. .………………………………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………… …………………………………………………………………………………………. *unless – Come tonight unless I phone. - unless = if not/ except if I’ll take the job unless the pay is too low. - unless + affirmative - unless + present tense > to talk about the future 60 9. Change the words in bold: E.g.: Please don’t call the doctor at weekends if it’s not important. – unless it’s important Unless you come with me, I won’t go to New York. - if you don’t come with me 1. You can’t go there if you don’t have a visa. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 2. If you don’t go now, I’ll call the police. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. She always sees me on Wednesdays unless she’s travelling. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. I don’t cook much unless I’ve got visitors. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 5. We usually go sailing at the weekend if Emma hasn’t got a handball match. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 10. Join the beginnings and ends together and write the sentences using unless or if not: BEGINNINGS ENDS 0. I’ll be back tomorrow A. if he doesn’t start working. ….. 1. He’ll get thrown out of school B. if I don’t phone to say I can’t come. ….. 2. You can’t open the door C. if you haven’t heard it before. …. 3. I always watch TV in the evenings D. if I don’t go out 4. I’ll see you at ten E. if it doesn’t rain 5. Let’s have dinner out F. if the children don’t want it. 6. I’ll tell you a good joke G.if there isn’t a change government…. 7. Things will go on getting worse H. if there isn’t a rail strike. 0 8. We’re going to have a picnic I. – if you’re not too tired. ….. 61 of 9. You can have the last sausage J. if you don’t know the code. …… I’ll be back tomorrow unless there’s a rail strike 1………………………………………………………………………………………… 2………………………………………………………………………………………… 3………………………………………………………………………………………… 4………………………………………………………………………………………… 5………………………………………………………………………………………… 6………………………………………………………………………………………… 7………………………………………………………………………………………… 8………………………………………………………………………………………… 9………………………………………………………………………………………… *if only and I wish: tenses – If only I knew…… -If only….! and wish + past tenses – regrets, wishes for unlikely or impossible things - past tenses = talk about the present If only I knew more people! I wish I was better looking. -If only….! and wish + would – things that we would like people or things (not) to do. I wish this damned car would start. If only it would stop raining! 11. Write sentences with If only…..would or I wish….would……. E.g.: Somebody won’t stop talking. I wish/If only he would stop talking! 1. It’s not snowing. …………………………………………………………………….. 2. The phone keeps ringing. …………………………………………………………… 3. The baby won’t stop crying. ………………………………………………………… 4. The kettle won’t boil. ……………………………………………………………….. 62 5. The traffic lights won’t go green. …………………………………………………… *in case: I’m taking my umbrella in case it rains. - precautions I wrote down her address in case I forgot it. + present tense> future I’ve bought a chicken in case your mother stays to lunch. + should = by chance I’ve bought a chicken in case your mother should stay to lunch. =sentences about the past I wrote down her address in case I should forget it. 12. A woman is packing to go on holiday in Austria. Make sentences: SHE’S PACKING: a German phrase book a pack of cards a tennis racket a thick sweater a swimsuit aspirins binoculars her address book some books walking boots IN CASE: she decides to send postcards she meets people who play bridge she wants to go walking the hotel has a heated pool the sun gives her a headache she has time to read the hotel staff don’t speak English the weather is cold there is a tennis court she wants to go bird-watching She’s packing a German phrase book in case the hotel staff don’t speak English. ……………………………………………………………………………………… ……………………………………………………………………………………… ……………………………………………………………………………………… ……………………………………………………………………………………… ……………………………………………………………………………………… ……………………………………………………………………………………… ……………………………………………………………………………………… ……………………………………………………………………………………… 63 * it’s time and I’d rather: tenses – It’s time you had a haircut. - it’s time + infinitive + to It’s time to go out. - would rather ( = would prefer) + infinitive (without to) I’d rather stay in. + subject and verb (past)> present/future meaning It’s time you had a haircut. I’d rather they came tomorrow, not today. 13. Rewrite the second sentence in each conversation, starting with I’d rather we/you etc: E.g.: You’d better phone Judy’. ‘No, you phone her’. I’d rather you phoned her. 1.‘Let’s talk things over’. ‘No, let’s talk tomorrow.’ ………………………………………………………………………………….. 2.’Shall I come at nine?’ ‘Ten would be better.’ ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. ‘I’ll phone Sue.’ ‘No, don’t’. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. ‘Can she work with you?’ ‘Why doesn’t she work with Maggie?’ …………………………………………………………………………………. 5. ‘I’ll cook tomorrow.’ ‘Tonight would be better.’ …………………………………………………………………………………. 64 II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL - EVERYDAY PROBLEMS23 1. Complete each sentence with a verb from the box: blocked collapsed sank trapped crashed exploded flooded injured a) Yesterday a lorry crashed into a bus at the traffic lights. b) The falling roof tiles……………………...several passers-by, though not seriously. c) The old wooden building……………………………………………in a high wind. d) A terrorist bomb……………………………………at the railway station last week. e) The river burst its banks and …………………………….the town during the night. f) Rocks and mud from the mountain………………………..the main road yesterday. g) The storm at sea………………………………………...several small fishing boats. h) The rising water………………………….two families in their homes for six hours. 2. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: ambulance bandage blood patient surgeon ward hospital operation a) A long white bandage was wound around my arm. b) This…………………………was built only two years ago, but is already too small. c) The…………………………..in the bed next to mine was a man with a broken leg. d) The doctor told Jim that he would have to have a/an ……………………………… e) David’s bed is in a small……………………………………………with two others. f) Joanna was operated on by the best………………………………………in the city. g) Some people feel faint when they see………………………………………………. h) Stephen was hurt in an accident and a passer-by called a/an……………………….. 23 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 65 3. Complete each sentence with a compound noun made from two words from the box: air bus park parking strike car centre city failure hour jam pollution power rush shortage stop ticket traffic train water a) The roads were crowded and I was stuck in a traffic jam for hours. b) The ……………….. …………… is bad in this city. It’s getting hard to breathe! c) All the lights went out because there was a …………… ……………….. d) I left my car in the wrong place and the police gave me a ……………. ………….. e) I couldn’t use the railway yesterday because there was a ……………. …………… f) I had to pay a fortune to leave my car in a multi-storey………… g) I waited at the …………. …..………….. ……………….for hours but all the buses were full. h) There is always a lot of traffic during the ……………… ……………….. i) It doesn’t rain a lot here, and at the moment there is a …………… j) The Government has decided to ban all cars from the………… ……………. ……………… 4. Match the beginnings of the sentences (a-j) with the endings (110): a) Fire-fighters managed to put 6 1. fire accidentally. b) After a few minutes a fire ……. 2. fire to the house deliberately c) It was believed that someone set….. 3. spark from a passing train d) Luckily Paul carried a fire……. 4. into flames e) The fire was started by a …… 5. heat inside the burning car f) Metal melted from the intense …… 6. out the fire after two hours g) I could hardly breathe because of the …… 7. thick cloud of smoke h) The old theatre caught………. 8. -extinguisher in his car i) The wooden hut was burnt to…… 9. a heap of ashes j) In seconds the building burst…….. 10. engine arrived at the blaze 66 VOCABULARY: GENERAL - PHRASAL VERBS: GO24 Amelia’s story: Amelia has been going through a difficult time at work, so she decided to cheer herself up by going in for a competition. The prize was a luxury holiday in the Caribbean. Amelia has had to go without a holiday for several years now, so she really wanted to win. The competition was to write a story beginning ‘Suddenly the lights went out...’ The problem was that Amelia could not think of an idea for her story. ‘How can I go about getting a good idea?’, she asked me. ‘It must be something special so that the judges go for my story over all the others.’ I suggested she went to the library to go through some books of short stories – she might get some ideas there. So she went off to see what she could find. She soon found some great stories. She read one and then another and she went on reading all afternoon. Then she noticed a strange smell and suddenly the lights went out. She looked up and saw that the library was on fire. Of course, that gave her the idea for her story. I hope she wins. Complete the text below using the correct particles from the phrasal verbs above: I was going..............................(1) some old letters the other day when I found one from my friend Nancy. After high school she had gone............................(2) to train as a doctor and ended up in Africa. She had to go .............................(3) years of very hard study before she qualified. Life in Africa was not as comfortable as it was in our hometown, and there were many things she had to go ............................(4) which the rest of us think of as necessities in our daily lives. But despite all the hardships, she went ..........................(5) working and helping people less fortunate than herself. I admire her so much. I wondered how I might go .............................(6) making contact with her again, as I have no idea where she is living now. 24 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011. 67 Some more phrasal verbs with “go” Phrasal verb Meaning Example go along with support an idea, or agree Whatever you say, Maggie will go sth/sb with someone’s opinion along with you. go on continue to exist or It went on raining all day. happen go on happen There’s a police car outside the shop. Do you know what’s going on? go through do something unpleasant I don’t want to do the exam now but with or difficult which you I’d better go through with it. planned or promised to do go together if two types of things or A bad cough and a sore throat often people go together, they go together. are usually found with each other Rewrite the sentences using phrasal verbs with go so that they keep the same meaning: 1. I’m thinking of competing in the New York Marathon next year. 2. There were some difficult times in my father’s life. 3. Unemployment and high crime levels often exist side by side. 4. He decided to undergo the operation even though there were risks. 5. I refused to support their decision to close the youth club. 6. I didn’t realise how late it was and I didn’t stop studying till after midnight. 7. We had to survive with no hot water for 24 hours while they were repairing the pipes. 8. Do you think I should try the advanced level exam? It might be too difficult. 9. She just left without saying goodbye. I wonder if I offended her? 10. What was happening in the staffroom at lunchtime? I heard someone shouting. 68 In these sentences, some of the phrasal verbs from the opposite page are used with new meanings. Choose the correct paraphrase: 1. We had to throw the fish away as it had gone off. a) Someone had switched off the oven. b) The fish had become bad because we kept it too long. c) The fish had fallen off the table on to the floor. 2. I wish you wouldn’t go on about your problems all the time! I have problems too, you know! a) I wish you wouldn’t think obsessively. b) I wish you wouldn’t be very secretive. c) I wish you wouldn’t talk constantly. 3. She’s been going about telling everyone I want to marry her. a) She’s been thinking of telling everyone. b) She’s on the point of telling everyone. c) She has told everyone. 4. Ask her to dance with you. Go on! a) Continue doing what you’re doing. b) Step on the dance floor. c) Do it now, don’t hesitate. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – THE NEWS – BROKEN MARRIAGES25 The steady rise in the incidence of marital breakdown may soon make the institution of marriage obsolete. Single-parenthood, once uncommon, is now almost the rule in certain communities. It is usually the father who is absent – often defaulting on his financial responsibilities and failing to meet his moral and legal 25 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 69 obligations to support his family. Only a quarter of such husbands are found to contribute the awarded alimony and child support payments, and this leads to increased poverty among divorced mothers. In rare cases, however, courts grant custody of children to the father, stripping the mother of parental rights. She is given limited access to her children and, in extreme cases, visits may take place only under supervision. One in every three marriages now ends in divorce, with teenage marriages three times more likely to break up. These facts are partly due to changing morals. Some blame sexual permissiveness for the alarming statistics on divorce, and for the number of children born out of wedlock. According to statistics, ninety percent of fathers are too immature to take responsibility for their babies. The remaining ten per cent are forced into teenage marriages, but these are filled with frustration, tension and strife, and usually end in divorce. Unwed mothers, burdened by their illegitimate offspring, feel trapped. They can only turn to welfare for support, from that time on leading a life of social dependency. A survey was recently conducted among divorced couples. It reveals that a surprising number of divorced partners would like to reconcile and get together again. Over fifty per cent of the men surveyed are willing to remarry their ex-spouses, as are 28% of the women. It is now being argued that divorce gives neither partner enough time to rethink and, after careful consideration, some couples regret splitting. An attempt to start anew should be made for the sake of the children, whom divorce often leaves distraught and mentally scarred. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Divorce is on the increase. 2. Many people bring up their children without the support of their spouses. 3. About half of absent fathers support their families. 4. Many divorced mothers cannot cope financially. 5. Custody of the child is always granted to the mother. 6. The court rules on the visitation rights of divorced parents. 7. Teenage marriages offer better prospects for solid family life. 8. Teenagers start their sexual lives too early. 70 9. Ten per cent of young fathers are happy to start families. 10. Unwed mothers are supported by taxpayers’ money. 11. More women than men would like to return to their ex-spouses. 12. It is important to give people more time to make up their minds before granting them a divorce. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B awarded………………….. access divorced………………….. alimony financial…………………… breakdown illegitimate………………… dependency legal………………………. mothers limited……………………… obligations marital……………………… offspring parental……………………. permissiveness sexual…………………….. responsibilities social…………………….. rights 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline of the story: BEFORE – SHOULD – TIME – BE – MORE – COUPLES – TO – DIVORCE – GIVEN – RECONCILE ………………………………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: - a-şi îndeplini datoria morală: - m…………. m……………….. o…………… - a acorda custodia: - g……………. c……………….. - a lipsi de drepturi părinteşti: -s……….. o……….. p………….. r…………… - acces limitat: - l……………. a………………… 71 - sub supravegherea: - u…………….. s…………………. - copii născuţi în afara căsătoriei: c………… b………….. o…………. of w…………… - a-şi asuma răspunderea pentru: - t………….. r………….. f………………… - a apela la asistenţa socială pentru ajutor: -t………….. t…………… w………….. f………….. s…………….. - a desfăşura o anchetă: c……………. a s……………….. - în interesul copiilor: f…………. the s………… o…… c……………. - a o lua de la început: s…………… a……………. 72 LESSON 6 *Grammar: Wishes – “Wish” and “If only”; Passives * Vocabulary: General – Interests and Free Time * Phrasal Verbs – Look * Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Forest Fires *** I. GRAMMAR – WISHES – “WISH” AND “IF ONLY”26 *Wishes about the present: I wish + past tense simple/ would I wish I owned a helicopter. If I owned a helicopter, I would be happy. I wish I didn’t have to go to school! I wish I could fly! If only I owned a helicopter. (emphasis) - the past simple DOES NOT REFER TO past time – a wish for things to be different - wish + could (not “wish” + would) – I wish I could sing (but I can’t). * Wishes about the past: I wish + past perfect I wish I had lived in the 18th century! If I had lived in the 18th century, I would have been happy. I wish I hadn’t eaten so much! I feel awful! If I hadn’t eaten so much, it would have been better for me! If only I hadn’t eaten so much! (emphasis) *Hope - + present/ will I hope you have a good time at the party. I hope the weather will be fine tomorrow. 26 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003; Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 73 1. Choose the correct word or phrase in each sentence: a) I’m sunburnt. I wish I hadn’t sunbathed/ didn’t sunbathe for so long. b) I don’t feel well. I wish I could stay/stayed at home tomorrow. c) I’m not a good swimmer, but I wish I could swim/would swim well. d) I wish I had/have a puppy or a kitten! e) I wish I could see/saw you tomorrow, but it’s impossible. f) I wish Jim didn’t sit/doesn’t sit next to me. He’s so annoying! g) If only we had/would have some money, we could take the bus. h) I hope you enjoyed/enjoy yourselves at the dance tomorrow. i) I wish I can/could speak English better! j) I hope I’ll/I’d win the lottery! 2. Choose the correct situation for each sentence: a) I’ve got lots of work to do, and I’m tired, but I can’t stop. 1. I wish I had taken a rest. 2. I wish I could take a rest. b) I wasn’t paying attention in class, and now I can’t do my homework. 1. I wish I listened to my teacher. 2. I wish I’d listened to my teacher. c) Sarah painted her room green, but she doesn’t like it. 1. She wishes she’d painted it blue. 2. She wishes she painted it blue. d) This is a very puzzling problem! 1. I wish I’d known the answer. 2. I wish I knew the answer. e) It’s really cold and miserable here in the winter. 1. I wish we lived in a warm place. 2. I hope we live in a warm place. f) I can’t repair my bike because I haven’t got any tools. 1. If only I would have a screwdriver. 2. If only I had a screwdriver. g) I’m worried about my basketball team. Perhaps they won’t win! 1. I wish they play well. 2. I hope they play well. h) You promised not to tell anyone my secrets but you did! 1. I wish I hadn’t told you. 2. I wish I didn’t tell you. i) I’ve been feeling ill all week. 1. I hope I feel better soon. 2. I hope I’d feel better soon. 74 j) I want to see my sister. I haven’t seen her for ages. 1. I wish I could speak to her. 2. I wish I spoke to her. 3. Complete each sentence with a suitable form of the verb in brackets: a) I’m soaked to the skin! If only I (bring) had brought an umbrella! b) This pullover was cheap. I wish I (buy)………………………………..two of them! c) I like your school. I wish I (go)…………………………………………….there too. d) I must get in touch with Sue. If only I (know)…………………...her phone number! e) This bus is really slow! I wish we (take)……………………………………the train. f) I’m disappointed in this camera. I wish I (not buy)………………………………...it. g) I answered three questions well. If only I (finish)……………………the whole test! h) I can’t understand Marie! I wish I (speak)…………………………………...French. 8. Complete the sentences. Use these words: accepted, caught, found, played, saved, stayed: Ex: I spent all my money. I wish now that I had saved it. 1. I missed the train. I really wish……………………………………………………… 2. Rita left the party early. Nick wishes………………………………………………... 3. Emma refused the offer. But her parents wish …………………………………….. 4. I looked everywhere for the keys. I wish ………………………………………….. 5. The injured player could only watch. He wishes…………………………………… GRAMMAR – PASSIVES27 *Active and passive ACTIVE PASSIVE My sister makes these toys. These toys are made by my sister. Two boys stole my car. My car was stolen by two boys. 27 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011 75 They sent him to America. He was sent to America. The government will open three new Three new prisons will be opened next prisons next year. year. #The subject of a passive verb corresponds to the object of an active verb. SUBJECT SUBJECT Passive: This house was built in 1846. German is spoken in Austria. Active: They built this house in 1846. Austrians speak German. OBJECT OBJECT #Sometimes we make passives with get instead of be, especially in spoken English. I get paid on Fridays. My window got broken by the wind. 1. Put the expressions from the box in the right places: is made was made has been made had been made was being made will be made is being made ACTIVE PASSIVE SIMPLE PRESENT makes is made PRESENT CONTINUOUS is making …………….. FUTURE will make …………….. SIMPLE PAST made …………….. PAST CONTINUOUS was making ……………… PRESENT PERFECT has made ……………… PAST PERFECT had made …………….. 76 2. Make passive sentences: E.g.: A Roman pavement has just been found under Oxford Street. (just find: present perfect) 1. Chinese………………………………………in Singapore. (speak: simple present) 2. The Taj Mahal……………………………………around 1640. (build: simple past) 3. The new hospital…………………………………………..next year. (open: future) 4. She……………………………………………now. (interview: present continuous) 5. I realised I …………………………………………………(watch: past continuous) 6. Who …………………………………….to Andy’s party? (invite: present perfect) 7. He found that all his money…………………………………….(steal: past perfect). 8. Passengers…………………………not to speak to the driver. (ask: simple present) 9. The village church…………………………in a fire last year. (destroy: simple past) 10. You ………………………………………………by Dr. Chapel. (examine: future) #With a passive, we only use by + noun if we need to say who does the action. This house was built in 1846 by Sir John Latton. My computer was made in China. (NOT…..by Chinese people) 3. Cross out the expression in italics if you feel it gives no useful information: E.g.: A 54-year-old accountant was arrested for drunk driving last night by the police. 1. ‘Romeo and Juliet’ was written by Shakespeare. 2. All of these birds have been seen in Britain by people who watch birds. 3. Everest was first climbed in 1953 by mountain climbers. 4. This house was built by Franck Lloyd Wright. 5. My sister’s books have been translated into thirty languages by translators. 6. Sugar is made from sugar cane and sugar beet by sugar companies. 7. This letter wasn’t written by an English person. 77 * Passive infinitives and –ing forms: to be seen; being seen PASSIVE INFINITIVES: (to) be watched, seen, made…. PASSIVE –ING FORMS: being watched, seen, made…. I want to be told the truth. Those people mustn’t be forgotten. I don’t like being ignored. She loves being photographed. Note the position of prepositions in these structures. I want to be listened to. I don’t like being talked about behind my back. Modal verbs can be followed by passive infinitives (without to). This mustn’t be washed in hot water. The papers can be sent to my office. 4. Write sentences using want with passive infinitives: E.g.: ‘Invite me!’ He wants to be invited. 1. ‘Remember me!’ He………………………………………………………………… 2. ‘Respect me!’ She…………………………………………………………………… 3. ‘Elect us!’ They……………………………………………………………………... 4. ‘I hope you’ll listen to me’. She…………………………………………………….. 5. ‘Please look at me!’ He……………………………………………………………… 5. Write sentences beginning I like/ I don’t mind/ don’t like/ hate, with some of the verbs in the box. Use passive –ing forms: admire ask for money correct criticise forget ignore interrupt invite to parties kiss laugh at listen to look at photograph shout at talk about talk to (by strangers) undervalue wake up I don’t like being criticised. I don’t mind being photographed. ………………………………………………………………………………………… 78 ………………………………………………………………………………………… …………………………………………………………………………………………. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. *Passives: verbs with two objects: Susan was given a prize ACTIVE PASSIVE They gave Susan a prize. Susan was given a prize. They gave a prize to Susan. A prize was given to Susan. #The structure with the person as subject – very common 6. Change the structure: E.g.: Nothing was sent to me. I was sent nothing. 1. Papers were brought to us to sign. …………………….. 2. A clock was given to Henry when he retired. …………………….. 3. Stories were read to the children. ……………………. 4. $ 5,000 is owed to me. ……………………. 5. A new job has been offered to me. ……………………. 7. Make passive sentences. Use the words in italics as subjects and verbs: E.g.: Somebody sent application forms to all the students. (send) All the students were sent application forms. Somebody sent application forms to all the students. (send) Application forms were sent to all the students. 1. All the passengers received meal tickets. (give) ………………………………………………………………………………...... 2. All the passengers received meal tickets. (give) ………………………………………………………………………………….. 79 3. Ellen has seen the plans for the new building. (show) ………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. Ellen has seen the plans for the new building. (show) ………………………………………………………………………………………… 5. Someone has promised all the office workers a week’s holiday. (promise) ………………………………………………………………………………………….. 6. Someone has promised all the office workers a week’s holiday. (promise) ……………………………………………………………………………………….. *Prepositions with passives: Ted likes being read to -verb + preposition = stay together ACTIVE: The doctors operated on her yesterday morning. PASSIVE: She was operated on yesterday morning. 8. Take words from each box to complete the sentences. More than one answer may be possible: heard looked operated slept spoken talked about at at for paid played in of read sat on on shouted to to with E.g.: She was taken into hospital today, and she’s going to be operated on tomorrow. 1. The children like to be ………………………………...when they’re going to sleep. 2. I don’t like being………………………………………………… behind my back. 3. The new secretary’s working very badly. He’ll have to be………………………… 4. I don’t think he came home last night. His bed hasn’t been……………………….. 5. That antique chair’s not really meant to be ………………………………………… 6. It’s not really our house yet. It hasn’t been…………………………………………. 7. He left for America in 1980, and he hasn’t been………………………………since. 8. The cat loves being………………………………………………………………….. 9. He’s so shy: it even upsets him to be ………………………………………………. 10. Please talk calmly. I don’t like being………………………………………………. 80 #To ask who did something in passive questions, we usually prefer Who…..by?, especially in spoken English. Who was this cathedral built by? Who were you invited by? By whom…..? is also possible, especially in writing. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – INTERESTS AND FREE TIME28 1. Choose the most suitable word in each sentence: a) United managed to beat/win City in the last minute of the match. b) At the end of the play, everyone in the theatre exploded/applauded. c) If you want to enter for/sign on the competition, you’ll need a form. d) The cycling club is doing/holding a meeting next Thursday. e) The youth orchestra has acted/performed all over Europe. f) I’m doing/going fishing next week. Do you want to come? g) The final score was 2-2, so Rovers drew/equalled the game. h) David passes/spends an hour every day playing computer games. i) Did you enjoy/please yourself at the folk festival? j) We were late and so we lost/missed the beginning of the film. 2. Match each word from the box with one of the explanations: athletes audience cast spectators team viewers competitors fans group members a) People who watch a sporting performance. Spectators b) People who exercise and take part in games of speed and strength. …………………. c) People who support a sport, or a famous person. ………………… 28 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003 81 d) People who together take part in a sport. …………………. e) People who all belong to the same club. ………………….. f) People who play rock music together. …………………. g) People who listen to or watch a play or performance. ………………… h) People who watch television. …………………. i) People who act together in a play. ………………….. j) People who are all trying to win the same prize. ………………….. 3. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: exhibition line medal prize screen ticket tyre whistle queue rod a) Helen won first prize in the competition. b) When Steve won the race, he was given a gold …………………………………….. c) We had to wait in a …………………………...before we could get into the cinema. d) Rachel had to push her bike after she got a flat …………………………………….. e) There was so much shouting that no one heard the referee’s ………………………. f) I’ve got a spare…………………….for tomorrow’s concert. Do you want to come? g) Have you seen the new………………………..of paintings at the National Gallery? h) I’m going fishing tomorrow. I’ve just bought a new ………………………………. i) Kate was the first runner to cross the finishing …………………………………….. j) We didn’t enjoy the film because we were too close to the ………………………... 82 4. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: drop go join knock live make stand turn a) Lenny ‘The Fist’ Smith, the boxer, said he would knock out his opponent. b) Carol won the match because the other player failed to ……………………………….up. c) The singer asked the audience to……………………………………in and all sing together. d) It was a reasonable film, but it didn’t really…………………………up to my expectations. e) Tom and Sue used to ………………………………………………………..out together. f) From my seat, I couldn’t…………………………out what was happening on the stage. g) The referee made it clear that he would not …………………………for bad behaviour. h) Peter had to……………………………………..out of the race after his car broke down. 5. Match each activity (a-h) with a place (1-8): a) Sunbathing and wearing swimming costumes 8 1. a stage b) Watching elephants dancing. ………. 2. a running track c) Doing keep fit exercises. 3. a party ………….. d) Crossing the finishing line. ……….. 4. a funfair e) Taking a dog for a walk. 5. a circus …………. f) Celebrating someone’s birthday. ………. 6. a park g) Riding a ghost train or a big wheel. ……… 7. a gym h) Speaking clearly so the audience can hear. …… 8. a beach VOCABULARY: GENERAL: PHRASAL VERBS - LOOK29 Phrasal verbs where look keeps aspects of its basic meaning: The idea of seeing, observing or noticing something is included in many phrasal verbs with look. Tim: Did you manage to read the report? Iris: Well, I looked at it, but I haven’t read it properly. [read it quickly and not very carefully]. 29 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011. 83 Tim: I’d like you to read it if you could. We need to look at the conclusions and make some decisions. [examine or consider something carefully in order to make a decision about it]. Rita: How do I get to your village coming from the city? Bob: When you’re on the motorway, look out for a sign saying ‘Willowsdean’. That’s where you turn off. [carefully watch the things around you so that you will notice a particular thing.] The bank robbers had a lookout standing at the street corner to warn them if the police came. [noun: a person who is watching for danger] I wasn’t in the demonstration. I was just an onlooker. [noun: someone who watches an activity or event without becoming involved in it; from the phrasal verb with the same meaning look on] Phrasal verbs where look has more abstract meanings: If you…. then you…. look up to sb respect and admire them look down on sb/sth think that someone or something is less important than you, or that something is not good enough quality for you to use. look after sb/sth take care of someone or something by doing what is needed to keep someone or something well or in good condition look ahead think about what will happen in the future and plan for those events look around/round try to find something you want (e.g. a job) by asking different people or by looking in different places look forward to feel pleased and excited about something that is going to sth/doing sth happen 84 1. Choose the correct answer: 1. If you are looking around for a new job, you are… a) applying for a new job b) trying to find a new job c) worried about your new job 2. If you look out for someone who is picking you up in their car, you…. a) carefully avoid getting hit by their car b) watch the road and warn them of danger c) watch for their car so you will see them when they arrive 3. If you look down on cheap restaurants, you… a) consider them not good enough for you b) see them from the top windows of your house or flat c) always consider them before going to a dearer one 4. If you look after someone’s cat while they are away, you… a) follow the cat everywhere b) search for it because it is lost c) care for it and give it what it needs 5. If you look up to your English teacher, you….. a) stand up when you speak to him or her b) admire and respect him or her c) raise your head because he or she is taller than you 2. Complete these sentences with a suitable particle. 1. I’m really looking……………………..to seeing my cousins again next week. 2. She’s looking …………………….for a new English course. She’s not very satisfied with the one she’s following at the moment. 3. She loves looking …………………..children, so she has decided to train as a nanny. 4. We have to look…………………to the time when our child will be old enough to go to university. 5. Lord Muck is a terrible snob. He looks……………………on most other people. 6. I didn’t have time to read the newspaper yesterday. I only looked …………………. it very quickly. 85 3. Here are some more phrasal verbs based on look. Read each sentence and try to guess the meaning of the phrasal verb. 1. You could look up the new words in a dictionary. 2. When I was in Boston on business last week I looked up an old friend. 3. After a long recession the economic situation is looking up. 4. I looked over the report on the way to the meeting. 5. I looked through the report and scribbled down a few notes. 6. Detectives are looking into the murder. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – THE NEWS - FOREST FIRES30 More than 1 million acres of forests have gone up in flame this year. This represents the worst loss of timber in Norwood this century. Millions of dollars-worth of damage has been caused, with beautiful woodland areas and natural reserves being reduced to ashes. Following a severe drought for the third year in succession, a series of lightning storms ignited a wave of fires which were almost impossible to contain. In just one National Park, the inferno got out of control and seared 700,000 acres in 5 months. When one raging fire is put out, firemen move on to another outbreak, often caused by airborne embers. “Fire spreads so quickly”, said one firefighter, his eyes swollen, his face covered with grime, “that you can easily be cut off by the flames”. Indeed, 20 firefighters have died battling this year’s forest fires: some were overcome by smoke and flames before they could reach the safety of fire-resistant shelters, while several were taken to hospital with burns and injuries from falling trees. One was killed when a water bombing aircraft accidentally emptied its 1,000 gallon load over him. At the scene, it is impossible to endure the heat; in some areas the fire reaches 2,000 degrees Fahrenheit – hot enough to melt metal traffic signs and vaporize small streams. Dense smoke cuts visibility by half. The ashes at each smouldering spot have to be checked to make reignition impossible. In an effort to prevent the fire from spreading further, helicopters and planes dump fire retardants. At night, an eerie 30 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. Print. 86 orange glow can be seen in the sky from many miles away and the conflagration was detected by weather satellites. Forests, with the exception of some very old and large trees, will regenerate quickly – although it could take 300 years before the worst-burnt areas return to their full majesty. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. This year’s forest fires have brought several million dollars-worth of losses. 2. For the last three years, there has been little rain. 3. No rains accompanied the storms which started the fires. 4. Fire can spread faster than one can imagine. 5. Some firefighters died because of smoke inhalation. 6. The water-bombing aircraft dropped its load on the man by mistake. 7. If one fire is put out, it no longer represents a danger. 8. Helicopters and planes are only used to spot new out-breaks of fire. 9. The fact that the conflagration is seen from space speaks of the scale of the disaster. 10. After the fire, the forests will soon look the same. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B cause…………………… damage dense…………………… eyes eerie……………………. fire fire…………………….. glow lightning………………… reserves natural………………….. retardants raging…………………. satellites smouldering………………… smoke swollen……………………. spot weather……………………… storms 87 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline of the story: IN – FORESTS – DESTROYED – MORE – BLAZES- UNCONTROLLABLE …………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. Phrases to learn: -a arde, a se mistui: – g................... u.................. i……………….. f……………………. - a constitui o pierdere: – r…………….. a l………………….. - a da foc, a aprinde focul: – i..................... f...................... - imposibil de a fi stăpânit: – i..................... to c.............................. - a stinge incendiul: – p.................. o.................... a f........................ - a suporta căldura: – e..................... the h........................ - topit şi vaporizat: – m....................... and v.......................... - a limita vizibilitatea la jumătate: – c...................... v....................... by h.................... - a preveni extinderea focului: – p........................ the f................... f……………….. s……………… - a verifica locurile fumegânde: – c……………. s……………… s……………….. 88 LESSON 7 *Grammar: Modal Verbs (1) * Vocabulary: General – Places * Phrasal Verbs: Make * Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Drought *** I. GRAMMAR – MODAL VERBS31 (1) *can, could may, might shall, should will, would must ought to *before other verbs, in tags and short answers You can speak Japanese, can’t you? Yes, I can. You shouldn’t be here, should you? No, I shouldn’t. 1.Compare the modal verbs and the ordinary verbs in the examples, and answer the questions: MODAL VERBS ORDINARY VERBS I may see him. I hope to see him. He must be happy. He seems to be happy. Shall we stop? Do you want to stop? I can’t sing. She doesn’t like to sing. He ought to tell her. He plans to tell her. a. Which sort of infinitive is used after modal verbs? ………………………………. b. Which is the exception? …………………………………………………………… c. What is special about the third person present (he/she/it…….) of modals? …………………………………………………………………………………. d. What is special about the question and negative forms of modals? …………………………………………………………………………………. 31 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011 89 2. Use some of the infinitives from the box to complete the sentences: be to be do make to make play to do get to get move to move go to go pass to pass leave to leave phone to phone to play 1. Can you………………the piano? 6. She hopes……………...a new car. 2. She seems…………better today. 7. Must you…………so much noise? 3. I want…………...some shopping. 8. Could you……………….the salt? 4. We may………….to France soon. 9. We ought………………….Angela. 5. When will you…………...school? 10. I’d like………….to another house. # no infinitives or participles; instead - be able to, have to, be allowed to He’d like to be able to travel abroad more. I’ve never been able to understand maths. I’m sorry to have to tell you this….. We’ve had to get new shoes for both the kids. She has always been allowed to go out alone. 3. Choose the best word (s): 1. …………………………………………………………you swim? (may, can, shall) 2. I really ………………………………………………...go now. (shall, would, must). 3. We………………………………………..see Ann tomorrow. (might, ought, would) 4. You…………………………………………to see the doctor. (should, could, ought) 5. I ……………………………………….understand him. (couldn’t, mustn’t, be able) 6. You……………………..be here at exactly 10.00. Don’t be late. (must, may, might) 7. …………………………………………………..I carry your bag? (might, will, can) 8. It………………………………………………....rain tomorrow. (may, would, shall) 9. It……………………………..be 10 o’clock already! (might not, can’t, oughtn’t to) 10. You …………………………..be very tired after your journey. (would, must, can) 90 *must, should and ought to - must = orders, strong suggestions, advice and opinions You must stop smoking or you’ll die. You must not park here. People must realise that the world is in trouble. - should = less strong suggestions, advice and opinions I really think you should stop smoking. You shouldn’t park here; somebody will steal your car. People should do more to help others. - in questions – we’re wondering what to do Should I change my job or stay where I am? - ought to = should – People ought to do more to help others. 4. Put in the best word: must or should: 1. You know, I think you………………………………………………..take a holiday. 2. Tell Mark he…………………………………………………..tidy his room at once. 3. Visitors are reminded that they ………………………….keep their bags with them. 4. I’m sorry, but you……………………………………...go. We don’t want you here. 5. I really………………………………………………….go on a diet. I’ll start today! 6. I suppose I………………………………….write to Aunt Rachel one of these days. 7. You absolutely…………………..check the tyres before you take the car out today. 8. All officers ………………………….report to the Commanding Officer by midday. 9. You ………………………………………...have your hair cut at least once a week. 10. I think everybody……………………………………know two or more languages. *have to and must - have (got) to = must I have to/must finish this report before tomorrow. Do you have to / Must you make all that noise? We’ve got to/must check in before six o’clock. - must – the feelings and wishes of the speaker/hearer. I must stop smoking. (I want to) Must you wear those dirty jeans? (Is that what you want?) 91 - have (got) to – obligations that come from somewhere else. I’ve got to stop smoking – doctor’s orders. Do you have to wear a tie at work? (Is there a rule?) You have to drive on the left in England. (sounds more natural) 5. Complete the sentences with expressions from the box and must or have/ has (got) to: do military service do some shopping get a haircut give my love hold a general election pay phone him take more exercise try to get pay income tax work E.g.: In some countries, men have (got) to do military service. 1. I’m getting very unfit. I …………………………………………………………….. 2. I haven’t heard anything from James for a long time. I…………………………….. 3. Nearly everybody…………………………………………………………………… 4. In Britain, we ………………………………………………every five years or less. 5. You……………………………………………………to Gareth when you see him. 6. Jack’s really upset. He ………………………………………...all of next weekend. 7. There’s nothing to eat in the house. We really……………………………………… 8. You………………………………………... You’re beginning to look very strange. 9. Children can get into the museum free, but adults…………………………………. 10. I’m getting very tired. I…………………………………………………more sleep. *must not; do not have to; do not need to/ needn’t - must not = prohibition Students must not leave bicycles in front of the library. Passengers must not speak to the driver. - do not have to; do not need to/ needn’t = unnecessary Friday’s holiday – I don’t have to work. You needn’t pay now – tomorrow’s OK. 92 6. Complete the sentences, using must not/ mustn’t or do not/ don’t have to: 1. Campers…………………………………………………………....play music after 10 p.m. 2. Students ………………………………………ask permission to stay out after midnight. 3. Bicycles ……………………………………………….be parked in the front courtyard. 4. Residents …………………………………………….hang washing out of the window. 5. British subjects…………………………………………….get visas to travel to Europe. 6. Passengers ……………………………………………………..lean out of the window. 7. You …………………………………………………………..pay for your tickets now. 8. It’s rained a lot, so we ……………………………………………….water the garden. 9. You ……………………………………………disturb your sister while she’s working. *had better – You’d better take your umbrella = This is a good thing to do now. = strong advice to people (including ourselves) You’d better stop that, young lady. I’ d better not stay any longer; I’ve got work to do. - had better and should – both say “This is a good thing to do now” - only should - “This is a good thing to do in general” We’re late (now). We’d better/should phone Mum. You should always drive very carefully near schools. = quite direct – NOT in polite requests Could you help me if you’ve got time? You’d better help me or there’ll be trouble. 93 7. Put the beginnings and ends together. Use ‘d better with the verbs in the box: do not drink remember see give go not sit stop invite phone phone 0 My husband worries if I’m late. B A. I………………………………....it. 1. This milk smells bad. ….. B. I’d better phone him. 0 2. That chair looks very dirty. ….. C. We ……………………..the doctor. 3. The baby’s temperature is 40°. ….. D. We …………………and get some. 4. You have to get up early tomorrow. …. E. You ………………………..to bed. 5. There’s almost no petrol in the car. ….. F. You………………………….on it. 6. Sheila forgot my birthday last year. ….. G. We …………………….him round. 7. There’s somebody at the door. ….. H. I …………………...some washing. 8. Helen needs her camera. ….. I. You………………….it back to her. 9. We haven’t got anything to wear. …. J. I…………………………..who it is. 10. We haven’t seen John for ages. …. K. She ……………………it this time. *supposed to – You’re supposed to start work at 8.30. = talk about rules You’re not supposed to park on double yellow lines. = what people believe or expect This stuff is supposed to kill flies. He’s supposed to be rich. She was supposed to be here an hour ago. Where is she? That’s a strange picture. What’s it supposed to be? 94 8. Complete the sentences with (be) supposed to and the expressions in the box: be have be come pay for cure headaches phone do go go to church smoke E.g.: Is this supposed to be coffee? It tastes like dishwater. 1. Aspirins …………………………………………………………………………….. 2. Catholics ………………………………………………………………..on Sundays. 3. Wasn’t Jack ……………………………………………………………….us today? 4. The computer …………………………an instruction manual, but I couldn’t find it. 5. What am I ………………………………………………with all this chicken salad? 6. You …………………………………………………………..and see me yesterday. 7. You’re not …………………………………………..into the shower with shoes on. 8. You ……………………………………good at geography – where the hell are we? 9. You ……………………………………everything at the cash desk on the way out. 10. You’re not …………………………………………………………...in food shops. *must/can’t: certainty – She must be in. He can’t be hungry. - must = something seems sure/ certain Anna’s gone to bed. She must be tired. (= I am certain that she is tired) Look at her clothes. She must have plenty of money. (= I feel sure that she has plenty of money.) If A is bigger than B, and B is bigger than C, then A must be bigger than C. - can’t – negative of must – for certainty It can’t be true. (= It’s certainly not true) ‘There’s the doorbell. It must be Roger.’ ‘No, it can’t be Roger – it’s too early.’ She always wears old clothes. She can’t have much money. 95 9. Rewrite the sentence in italics with must: E.g.: Her light’s on. She’s certainly in. She must be in. 1. John’s coming to see me. I’m sure he wants something. He………………………. 2. Listen to her accent. I feel sure she’s French. ………………………….. 3. Look at all those books. He certainly reads a lot. ………………………….. 4. So you’re studying politics. I’m sure that’s interesting. ………………………….. 5. Are those his shoes? He certainly has very big feet. ………………………….. 10. Rewrite the sentence in italics with can’t: E.g.: Her light’s out. I’m sure she’s not at home. She can’t be at home. 1. Listen to his accent. He is certainly not American. ………………………. 2. He has a very expensive car. I’m sure he’s not a teacher. …...………………….. 3. She’s very bad-tempered. I feel sure she doesn’t have many friends. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. I filled up the car yesterday. I’m sure we don’t need petrol. ……………………….. 5. He had lunch an hour ago. He’s not hungry: it’s impossible. …………………… II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PLACES32 1. Choose the most suitable word in each sentence: a) We arranged to meet in the centre of town in the main place/ square. b) Their cottage is in the heart of some beautiful country/countryside. c) The children spent all day playing on the sandy beach/seaside. d) I dropped my ice-cream on the earth/ground, so I couldn’t eat it. e) This footpath/pavement leads across the fields to the village. 32 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003 96 f) There was a wonderful scenery/view from my hotel room. g) You can’t stop here. Car-park/Parking is not allowed in this street. h) Helen decided to leave the country/land and work abroad. 2. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: block centre crossing hall place station traffic zone junction part a) The police officer asked me to come with him to the police station. b) When you reach the road………………………………………………….turn right. c) The mayor’s office is in the town…………………………………………………… d) Margaret lives on the top floor of a …………………………………………of flats. e) Cars have to stop for you if you use a pedestrian…………………………………… f) Which ………………………………………………………of town do you live in? g) You can buy fresh fish in the market………………………………….every Friday. h) Take the first turning on the left after the next set of…………………………lights. i) The centre of town is now a traffic-free………………………..and cars are banned. j) A new shopping………………………….has been opened on the edge of the town. 3. Replace the words in italics with one of the words from the box: capital crowded neighboring rural international isolated urban a) It’s much healthier to live in a country area, far away from the city. rural b) Sue has just moved to a nearby town. ……………………. c) We lived in the middle of nowhere in an out of the way cottage. …………………….. d) Paris is the most important city of France. …………………… 97 local e) There is not a lot of world news in this newspaper. …………………… f) I do my shopping at the neighborhood shops, not in the town centre. …………………… g) At weekends the town centre is always full of people. …………………… h) There is far too much pollution nowadays in city areas. …………………… 4. Complete each compound noun with a word from the box: about bridge side skirts ground path park roads a) Our children spend a lot of time having fun at the local playground. b) When you reach the cross…………………………………………., take the road to Linton. c) You have to turn left when you reach the next round………………………………….. d) We can’t leave the car here. We’ll have to look for a car………………………………. e) Follow this foot……………………………………………until you reach the main road. f) There was an old woman selling fruit at the road……………………………………….. g) Paula lives on the out……………………….of the town, where the countryside begins. h) You can cross the railway line by walking over a foot………………………………….. 5. Match the words from the box with the explanations: bridge bungalow semi-detached house caravan castle terraced house tower a) A strong building made in the past to defend people against enemies. castle b) A small house on wheels which is pulled by a car. ……………………. c) A house which is one of a pair of houses joined together. ………………….. d) A house with only one floor. …………………… 98 cottage e) This carries a road or railway over a river. ……………………… f) A house which is part of a row of houses all joined together. ………………………. g) A small house in the country. ……………………… h) A tall building standing alone, or as part of a castle or church. ……………………… VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS - MAKE33 A. Make + the particles for, out and up make up something = form the whole of something make up something (or make something up) = invent something, e.g. a story or a game make up something (or make something up) = say or write something that is not true in order to deceive make for somewhere = go in the direction of make out something/ someone = be able to see or hear something or someone with difficulty make out someone (or make someone out) = understand why someone behaves as they do make out something (make something out) = understand something, especially why something has happened Examples: Can you make out the words of this song? When we got to the park, the children made for the swings while I set on a bench. Sally didn’t want to go to the concert, so she made up an excuse about being ill. The children loved Uncle Bob because he was so good at making up new games. 33 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011. 99 Over 30% of the university population is made up of overseas students. Notice how make out with the following three meanings is usually used with can or could in a negative sentence and is not usually used in the passive. I couldn’t make out a word he was saying. Jack is behaving very strangely at the moment. I just can’t make him out. I can’t make out why my computer won’t let me save this document. You probably already know that the noun make-up can mean cosmetics, e.g. My sister never goes out without any make-up on, but I only wear it for special occasions. However, make-up, from the verb make up, can also mean the combination of things which form something, e.g. The class has an interesting make-up, with students from three continents and twelve different countries. B. Make + two particles phrasal verb meaning example make up for sth provide something good in The wonderful food in the order to make a bad situation restaurant made up for the better make it up to sb do something rather uncomfortable seats. good for I forgot Teresa’s birthday someone who you have done yesterday so I’ll have to take something bad to in the past, her somewhere nice to make it or to someone who has done up to her. something good for you. 1. Read these comments by different people and then answer the questions below by writing the correct name in the box. Drew: I can’t make out what she’s saying, can you? Melanie: I just can’t make him out at all, can you? 100 Lars: I treated her a bit insensitively at the party so I gave her a present to make up for it. Pete: I made up a story about losing my wallet, so he paid the drinks bill for me. Jane: I loved the trip. The beautiful scenery made up for the awful roads. 1. Who invented something that was not true? …………………. 2. Who said something good had made a bad experience less bad? ………………… 3. Who has difficulty hearing something? ………………… 4. Who wanted to restore a damaged relationship? ………………… 5. Who can’t understand someone’s behavior? …………………. 2. Correct the mistakes with the phrasal verbs in these sentences. 1. As soon as we had checked in at the hotel, we made straight at the beach. 2. She made out some story about the bus being late, but I’m sure she just overslept. 3. Why the camera was not working properly could not be made out by anybody. 4. Harry is very good at making over stories for the children; they love his tales. 5. Can you make what that white thing on the horizon is out? 6. The report is made of three sections up. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS - DROUGHT34 A conference was held today in Agunda’s capital, Barnaros, to discuss possible measures for averting the major food crisis caused by this year’s drought. Reports show that the autumn grain stockpiles will fall to little more than a month’s supply. Several factors combined to contribute to the disaster. First, the rainless summer and scorching sun parched the land damaging wheat, corn, and peanut crops, and killing millions of chickens and turkeys. Second, last winter, the driest in nearly a century, left areas bare of their normal snow cover and vulnerable to high winds. Subsoil moisture was depleted and the insufficient winter rain and snow failed to restore it. Fertile topsoil has thus eroded faster than it has been renewed. It cannot be 34 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 101 improved even with the heavy use of chemical fertilizers. These two facts have resulted in the drastically diminished yield of crops. Drought has brought other problems, too. Water shortages in many areas limit the amount of land that can be converted to agriculture by irrigation methods. Also, getting rid of weeds, which suck up the remaining water, poses yet another problem; turning up the soil causes it to lose even more moisture. To add to the drought damage, uncontrollable fires swept through coffee plantation bringing massive devastation. Drought has also seriously cut the country’s hydroelectric potential bringing about cuts in electricity. It has virtually emptied the smaller reservoirs and produced water emergencies. Formerly roaring rivers have been turned into trickles. Water restrictions have been imposed and city residents have been banned from using hosepipes for domestic purposes. In some areas, low river levels concentrate chemical pollutants to such an extent that the water is unsafe to drink. According to weather forecasts, there is little prospect of a steady rainfall in the foreseeable future. As last year’s rain was also sparse, it looks as if the climatic pattern is changing for the worse. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. The conference was devoted to analyzing the cause of this year’s drought. 2. There will be no grain left for the winter. 3. Farm animals were also affected by the drought. 4. Last winter did not differ from the former ones. 5. The problem was that last winter the soil was exposed to bad weather. 6. Chemical fertilizers will repair the damage done to the topsoil. 7. Irrigation is one of the means of gaining extra land for growing crops. 8. Turning up soil is one of the methods of getting rid of weeds. 9. From the text, we learn that Agunda relies heavily on electricity generated by water-power. 10. Now it is illegal to wash cars and to water gardens. 11. To make water safe for consumption it must first be boiled. 12. Calamitous weather abnormalities are now taking place more often than before. 102 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B chemical………………. crisis climatic……………….. devastation fertile…………………. fertilizers foreseeable…………….. future grain…………………… pattern insufficient……………….. rain major……………………. rainfall massive………………….. rivers rainless………………….. shortages roaring……………………. stockpiles scorching…………………… summer steady…………………….. sun water………………………. topsoil 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline of the story: WATER – DROUGHT – REDUCED – SEVERE – RESERVES – DRAMATICALLY – BY ………………………………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: - a preîntâmpina criza: -a……………… a c………………… -factori care contribuie la catastrofă: -f................. c.................. to the d..................... - ploi insuficiente: -i...................... r……………….. -a recâştiga pământul pentru agricultură: -c........................ the l................. to a............... 103 - a provoca distrugeri însemnate: -b.................... m...................... d.......................... -a diminua puterea hidrocentralelor: -c.................... h........................... p..................... - a impune restricţii: -i..................... r.......................... - într-o asemenea măsură: -t....................... s.............. an e.................... that - o şansă redusă de: -l.................. p................. of - schimbare în rău: -c.................. f……………. the w…………….. 104 LESSON 8 *Grammar: Modal Verbs (2) * Vocabulary: General – Food and Drink * Phrasal Verbs: Put* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Famine *** I. GRAMMAR – MODAL VERBS35 (2) - may and might – It may rain. It might even snow = things are possible = perhaps they are true, or perhaps they will happen ‘Who’s that?’ ‘I’m not sure. It may be Celia.’ I might go and see Dad at the weekend. The company might lose money this year. = perhaps things are not true – may/might not I may/might not get that new job after all. - might – sometimes – smaller possibility She may be at home. (50% chance) Tina might be there too. (smaller chance) According to the radio, it may rain today. It might even snow. - difference – may/might not and can’t The game may/might not finish before ten. (Perhaps it won’t) The game can’t finish before ten – it only started at 9.30. (It’s not possible) - sometimes – could = might The company could lose money this year. It could rain today. 1. Put in may/may not or can’t: 1. I’ll go to the supermarket, but it……………………………………………..be open. 2. Their car’s not outside. They………………………………be at home; I’m not sure. 35 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011 105 3. ‘Can I see you tomorrow?’ ‘Perhaps, I…………………………have time – I’ll see.’ 4. ‘You’ve won first prize in the lottery.’ ‘No, it………………………………be true!’ 5. ‘They’ve found giraffes in Scotland.’ ‘That………………………………..be right’. 6. We can try to see that play, but they …………………………have any tickets left. 7. He’s got a strong French accent. He……………………………………..be English. 8. I ………………………………………...pass the exam, but I’m hoping for the best. 9.I’m going to see my old primary school teacher tomorrow, but she ………………………………………………………………………..remember me. 10. You………………………..want more to eat – you’ve just had an enormous meal. -can, could, may = permission, requests - can, could = more formal, polite - may = very formal, less common Can I ask you a question? Could I look at your newspaper? May I sit here? - can, may = offer to do things for people Can I get you a drink? May I help you, sir? -can’t/cannot, may not = give or refuse permission You can use my car if you want to. I’m sorry, you can’t come in here. Visitors may park in Elm Road. Visitors may not park in front of the hospital. 2. Give or refuse permission, using the words in the box: come into have make park ride use E.g.: you/here (can) You can park here. 1. students / this lift (may not) ...…………………. 2. you / these tickets (may) ……………………. 3. nobody/ my horse (can) …………………… 106 4. you/ my room (can’t) …………………… 5. employees/ personal phone calls (may not) ..………………….. - can, could = ask people to do things Can you put the children to bed? Could you help me for a few minutes? - could you possibly….? and I wonder if you could….are very polite. Could you possibly help me? I wonder if you could give me some advice. 3. Make sentences, using the words in the box: luggage supper the dogs the TV this letter time to go Ex: could/ tonight/ you/ cook/? Could you cook supper tonight? 1. translate/ can/ for me/ you/? ……………………………… 2. you/ feed/ could/? ……………………………… 3. can/ it’s/ you/ tell me/ when/? ……………………………… 4. watch/ you/ for a minute/ could/ my/? ………………………………. 5. switch on/ you/ can/ ? ……………………………….. -shall in questions – What shall we do? - make offers, suggestions, ask for instructions, decisions Shall I carry your bag? What on earth shall we do? Shall we go out for a meal? What time shall we come and see you? - we DON”T use “shall” in the answers! Shall we go home now? 107 Yes, good idea. 4. Make sentences with “Shall I…?”: E.g.: put/ the car/ in the garage? Shall I put the car in the garage? what/ tell/ Sandra? What shall I tell Sandra? 1. where/ put the coats? ….……………………………… 2. when / pay you? …………………………………. 3. lock/ the door? ….……………………………… 4. what time/ come tomorrow? …………………………………. 5. go/ now? …………………………………. 5. Can you complete these sentences? (They are from a discussion about holiday plans.) Use shall we: E.g.: where? where shall we go? 1. France or Scotland? ..…………………. 2. seaside or mountains? .………………….. 3. when? …………………… 4. how long for? …………………… 5. fly? train? drive? …………………… - can, could = ability – past and future - future = can – we are deciding now what to do in the future - in other cases – will be able to I can see you tomorrow morning for half an hour. One day we will be able to live without wars. 6. Put in can or can’t if possible; if not, use will/won’t be able to: E.g.: I can pick it up tonight, if that’s convenient. I think I will be able to speak English quite well in a few months. 1. ‘We need some more oil.’ ‘Ok, I……………………..let you have some this week.’ 2. ‘Dr Parker…………………………….see you at twelve on Tuesday.’ ‘Thank you.’ 108 3. She………………………………………………………walk again in a few weeks. 4. Do you think one day people……………………………………..travel to the stars? 5. In a few years, computers…………………………………..think better than we do. 6. I’m free at the weekend, so the kids……................................................come round. -can, could - past = NOT – could; YES – managed to, succeeded in ….ing (we managed to do something on one occasion) I managed to get up early today. (NOT I could…….) After six hours, we succeeded in getting to the top of the mountain. (NOT could….) BUT: She could read when she was four. (Not one occasion). He couldn’t find the ticket office. (He didn’t manage it). 7. Complete the sentences with could, couldn’t, managed to: E.g.: 200 years ago, most people could ride a horse. At her third try, she managed to pass the driving test. I think I had the wrong key, because I couldn’t open the door. 1. I……………………………………..speak French really well when I lived in Paris. 2. He ……………………………………….repair the car, but it took him a long time. 3. At last I……………………………………….make her understand what I wanted. 4. We wanted to go to the opera, but we……………………………………get tickets. 5. I ………………………….swim across the river, but it was harder than I expected. 6. All three children…………………..ride as well as they………………………walk. 7. He……………………………………….already walk when he was ten months old. - used to = I used to play; Did you use to play?; She did not use to play. = not really a modal – we usually make questions and negatives with did 109 = used to + infinitive (finished habits and situations) = things that were true, but are not now She used to live in Liverpool. I didn’t use to like her. Did you use to play football? I use not to like her. (more formal) = only past – for present habits = simple present tense My sister plays tennis occasionally. (NOT uses to play) 8. Make sentences about the past and present habits and situations: E.g. Penny/ play badminton/ golf Penny used to play badminton. Now she plays golf. 1. Anna/ have lots of boyfriends/ be married …………………………………. 2. John/ study mathematics/ physics ………………………………… 3. Mary/ climb mountains/ cycle ………………………………… 4. Joe/ be a builder/ driver ………………………………… 5. Gary/ work in Germany/ England …………………………………. 9. Make sentences with used to and didn’t use to about how people lived hundreds of years ago: E.g.: read or write Most people didn’t use to read or write. 1. travel/ by horse ………………………………………….. 2. cook/ on wood fires ………………………………………….. 3. live so long …………………………………………. 4. fight/ spears …………………………………………. 5. hunt/ bows and arrows …………………………………………. - will, would = She will talk to herself - will = habits, typical behaviour 110 She’ll sit talking to herself for hours. If something breaks down and you kick it, it will often start working again. - if we stress will = critical She WILL fall in love with the wrong people. - would = past On Saturdays, when I was a child, we would all get up early and go fishing. He was a nice boy, but he WOULD talk about himself all the time. 10. Complete the sentences with will+ verbs from the box: be drive fall keep listen play ring talk tell 1. ‘Dad, I’ve broken my watch’. ‘Well, you…………………………playing with it’. 2. That child’s no trouble – he………………………………….by himself for hours. 3. She’s nice, but she ……………………………….about people behind their backs. 4. People …………………………………………………to you if you listen to them. 5. If you drop toast, it …………………………………..butter side down every time. 6. If you’re having a bath, the phone ………………. And if you answer it, it………………………………………………………………...a wrong number. 7. He ………………you one thing one minute and the opposite the next – he’s crazy. 8. I’m not surprised you had an accident – you ……………………………….too fast. 11. Complete the text with would + verbs from the box: come exchange find go go make swim skate take When I was a child we lived by a lake. It was a beautiful place. On summer evenings we (1) …………………….in the lake, or take a canoe out, and in winter we (2)…………………across to the other side. School was boring, but weekends were fun, especially when Dad was home. Sometimes he (3) ………………us fishing; or we (4) ………………….exploring in the woods. We always got lost, but we 111 (5)……………………our way home again somehow. On Sundays Mum (6)……………………us pancakes for breakfast, and then we (7)………………….to the little village church for the Sunday service. We had a lot of relations living in the same part of the country, and we saw a lot of them. At Christmas everybody (8)……………………to our house for dinner, and then we (9)………………………..presents. It was a good time. 12. Here are some laws of nature. Join the beginnings and the ends: 0 After you have bought something, G A. it will. 1. If anything can go wrong, ….. B. somebody will. 2. If there are two good TV shows, ….. C. they will both be on at the same time. 3. If you explain so clearly that nobody D. will always move faster. can misunderstand, …. 4. If you throw something away,….. E. you’ll never do enough. 5. No matter how much you do, ….. F. will fall asleep first. 6. The one who snores…… G.you will find it somewhere else cheaper 7. The other queue……… H. you’ll need it the next day. - should have = I should have gone; Should you have gone?; he/she/it should not have gone = if somebody didn’t do something that was important Julia should have gone to the doctor, but she forgot. I should have studied harder at school. = if somebody did something wrong, we can say he/she shouldn’t have done it You shouldn’t have told the policeman that he was stupid. - may have, must have = may have happened = perhaps it (has) happened Suzy isn’t answering the phone. She may have gone out (= Perhaps she’s gone out). 112 = must have happened = we feel sure that it (has) happened. # can’t have She’s late. She must have missed the train. He can’t have gone away. His car’s still outside. = note the difference Joe must have gone home. (= It seems certain that he has gone home) Joe had to go home (= It was necessary for him to go home) 13. Rewrite these sentences using may have: E.g. Perhaps Shakespeare travelled in Italy. Shakespeare may have travelled in Italy. 1. Perhaps she’s broken her leg. ………………………………………. 2. Perhaps I’ve lost my keys. ………………………………………. 3. Perhaps Alice has gone back home. ………………………………………. 4. Perhaps my great-grandfather was a soldier. ………………………………………. 5. Perhaps I’ve found a new job. ………………………………………. 14. Rewrite these sentences in italics with must have or can’t have: E.g. The exam was easy. I’m sure I’ve passed. I must have passed. 1. Her office is locked. I’m sure she’s gone home. ……………………… 2. I can’t find my umbrella. I feel sure I left it on the bus. ……………………… 3.The fridge is empty. Peter has certainly not been shopping. …………………………...................................................................................... 4. Helen hasn’t come. I’m sure she’s forgotten. ……………………… 5. The flowers are dead. Obviously you didn’t water them. ……………………… 113 15. Choose the best expression: 1. Castles in the Middle Ages must have been/had to be cold places. 2. When I was a child, we must have got/ had to get water from the village pump. 3. At my secondary school I must have learnt/had to learn Latin. 4. So you broke your leg skiing. That must have been/ had to be terrible. 5. The kitchen window’s broken. Those kids next door had to do it/ must have done it. - could have, needn’t have = could have done it = somebody didn’t do something that was possible I could have gone to university, but I didn’t want to. = needn’t have done something = we did it, but it was unnecessary I needn’t have cooked all that food. Nobody was hungry. = note the difference We needn’t have hurried – we got there much too early. (It was unnecessary to hurry, but we did) We didn’t need to hurry; we had lots of time. (It was unnecessary to hurry, so we probably didn’t). 16. Complete the text with could have, using words from the box: be be get go hit lend marry phone study win 1. Amy……………………………..Ethan or Peter, but she didn’t love either of them. 2. Why didn’t you ask me for money? I……………………………………..you some. 3. I………………………………...mathematics, but I decided to do language instead. 4. Our team……………………………….the match, but they didn’t try hard enough. 5. The holiday was OK, but it……………………………………………………better. 6. When she said that, I…………………………………………………………….her. 7. Things were bad, but they……………………………………………...much worse. 8. We…………...to Paris last weekend, but we thought this weekend would be easier. 114 9. He ………………………………….the police, but he didn’t want to cause trouble. 10. I……………………………..a job in a bank, but I’m not very interested in money. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – FOOD AND DRINK36 1. Choose the correct word in each sentence: a) Would you like a bread/roll with your soup? b) The first course/plate consisted of cold fish and salad. c) That was a really lovely food/meal. Please let me pay for you. d) I felt so thirsty that I drank two cans/tins of Corky Cola. e) Nowadays many people buy frozen/iced food instead of fresh food. f) Could you give me the receipt/recipe for this cake? It’s delicious. g) This pie is fantastic! It’s really tasteful/tasty. h) Helen is a really good cook/cooker. i) Can I have a fork/spoon so I can stir my coffee? 2. Complete each sentence with a suitable verb from the box: add bake boil chop fry grate mix peel roast squeeze a) John decided to roast the beef in the oven for two hours. b) Put all the ingredients in a bowl and ……………………………them together well. c) First…………………………………………………….the onions into small pieces. d) I wanted to ……………………….some cakes this morning, but I didn’t have time. e) Taste the soup, and ……………………………………salt and pepper if necessary. f) …………………………………...the potatoes, and then cut them into large pieces. g) These vegetables taste great if you ……………………them for a minute in hot oil. h) …………………………………………some cheese, and sprinkle it over the pasta. i) ……………………………………….a lemon and sprinkle the juice over the salad. j) ……………………………………………...the rice in salted water for ten minutes. 36 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 115 3. Complete each phrase with a suitable word from the box: bacon biscuits saucer vinegar butter chips fork a) pepper and salt e) fish and …………….. b) knife and ………. f) oil and ……………….. g) egg and ……….. g) cup and ……………… h) bread and ………… h) tea and ………………… salt 4. Complete the phrase with a suitable word from the box: bar carton cup glass jar loaf pinch slice a) a slice of bread or cake e) a ……………….of bread b) a …………….of chocolate f) a………………...of water c) a ………..................of jam g) a ………………….of salt d) a …………………..of tea h) a ………………….of milk 5. Complete the phrase with a suitable word from the box: bill book dessert menu takeaway tip a) We weren’t sure what to have, so we asked for the menu. b) Tony finished his meal, paid the …………………………..., and left the restaurant. c) After two courses we felt full, so we didn’t have any ……………………………… d) We had a very tasty Indian …………………………………….for the main course. e) This is a popular restaurant and you have to ………………………………..a table. f) The service was excellent so we left a large …………………………...on the table. 116 VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS – PUT37 A. Put verbs related to physical actions: With all these phrasal verbs the particle can come either before or after the object, e.g. to put on a CD or to put a CD on. We spent yesterday putting in a new washing machine. [fixing new equipment or a new system in the correct place.] Could you put the air conditioning on, please? It’s too hot in here. [make a device work by pressing a switch.] I don’t think you’ve heard this CD. I’ll put it on. [ put something that sounds or pictures are recorded onto into a machine so that you can hear or see the recording.] Would you mind putting that light out? It’s shining directly onto my computer screen. [making a light stop shining by pressing a switch] I see they’re putting up a new block of flats near the park. [building a structure] It poured with rain while we tried to put our tent up. [open something that is folded or rolled up so that it is ready to use] B. Put verbs and time Dave: Jim, I’m sorry to have to put you off again, but I’m just too busy to see you today. [tell someone you can’t see them or do something for them till a later time]. Could we put our meeting back till next week? [change the date or time of an event so that it happens later than planned] Jim: Sure. We can put it off until next Monday. [decide or arrange to do something at a later time] Pilot: Ladies and gentlemen, we’re now coming in to land at Mexico City. You may want to put your watches forward; the local time is 8.35 a.m. [make a watch or clock show an earlier time] 37 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011. 117 In Britain, around the last weekend in October, all clocks are put back one hour. [make a watch or clock show an earlier time] C. Put verbs and relations with other people If you…. then….. are put out you are annoyed, often because of something that someone has done or said to you put up with sb/sth you accept unpleasant behavior or an unpleasant situation, even though you do not like it put sb on to/onto you tell them about something or someone that could help sth/sb them, often something or someone they did not know about before 1. Correct any mistakes in these sentences. If there are no mistakes, write correct at the end of the sentence. 1. I like sleeping in tents but I don’t like putting up them. 2. Put that CD on that you bought yesterday. I’d like to hear it. 3. We put last week in a new dishwasher. It’s wonderful. 4. Will you put on the TV? I want to watch the tennis. 5. That light is too strong. Shall we put out it? 2. Complete the text using particles from the examples above: ‘I don’t know how Harry puts ……………(1) with his boss. He works so hard but his boss even gets him to put the lights ……………..(2) for him when it starts to get dark, and it’s always Harry who has to put…………….(3) new computer equipment. His boss never thinks twice about putting him …………….(4) when they’ve arranged a meeting. I know Harry feels put ……………(5), but he never complains. We should really do what we can to put him …………….(6) some better jobs. 118 3. Rewrite these sentences so that the actions are the opposite of the ones underlined. Use phrasal verbs and make any other necessary changes so that the sentences make sense: Example: Please turn the radio off now. I’m trying to sleep. Please put the radio on now. There’s a programme I’d like to listen to. 1. Could you switch the light on please. I can’t see to read. 2. They’re pulling down those old buildings near the railway station. 3. The Boy Scouts took their tent down very quickly and loaded it into their bus. 4. Could we possibly bring our meeting forward to 10 o’clock? 5. When we moved into our new house we decided to remove an old, rather ugly fireplace. 6. Can you turn that CD off, please. I can’t concentrate on my work. 4. Here are some more phrasal verbs based on put. Match the phrasal verbs in the sentences 1-5 with the definitions a-e: 1.Josie is very good at putting her ideas a)stick or fasten a piece of paper to something, e.g. a wall, so that it can be across. seen 2.Anyone who is smoking must put b) express in such a way that others can their cigarettes out immediately. understand easily 3.I’m not putting that on. I’d look c) land ridiculous in it! 4.The secretary’s put up some d) put a piece of clothing on your body information about excursions. Have you seen it? 5.The plane was due to put down in e) extinguish or stop something burning Los Angeles at 3.50 a.m., but was diverted to San Francisco at the last minute. 119 III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS - FAMINE38 Fears are growing of another famine in Agunda which could prove to be much worse than that of 1981 when more than a million people starved to death. Relief agencies are talking in terms of ten million at risk in the affected area. They are calling on the world community to act now to avert a major tragedy as the situation is worsening rapidly. Reporters speak of a pitiful picture of human suffering caused by drought and disease. The infant mortality rate is steadily climbing, and for many of the children who survive, there is only a prospect of stunted growth and irreversible brain damage from chronic malnutrition. Hundreds of thousands of emaciated people are said to be undernourished, dehydrated and on the move, searching for food. Looting by hordes of famished peasants are daily occurrences. Villages are deserted and towns overpopulated. According to estimates, two million tons of food are needed immediately. One ton feeds five people at an “absolute minimum” subsistence level for a year. The current emergency has arisen because there has been no rain for the second year running. The relentless drought has withered crops and turned grazing land into deserts. Consequently, livestocks has been decimated. Before the dry spell, there were two successive years of poor harvests which complicated the country’s economic plight. Annual targets for grain production have not been met and the acreage of land used for agriculture has shrunk dramatically. Among other necessities, fertilizers and high quality grain are needed to boost production. Besides food, funds are being sought for medical aid and fuel for the fleet of trucks laden with supplies. A major airlift of stockpiled flour has been improvised to reach the worst-hit areas that are inaccessible to convoys and to distribute basic rations to the starving. Despite a raging civil war, humanitarian aid at the faminestricken areas will continue. 38 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 120 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Ten million people died of starvation in Agunda in 1981. 2. Action by the world community is desperately needed. 3. The current famine is the result of a prolonged drought. 4. Small children have no chance of survival. 5. Malnutrition can affect a child’s mental development. 6. Lack of drinking water is another life-threatening problem. 7. Cases of looting are sporadic. 8. People move to live in the country because it is easier to find food there. 9. Farm animals have died because they had nothing to eat. 10. Now there is more land than can be used for growing crops. 11. Food supplies will be distributed by air and by land. 12. Civil war will prevent relief agencies from delivering their supplies. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B affected……………….. agencies basic…………………… aid chronic………………… area daily…………………… damage famished………………… drought grazing………………….. land human…………………. malnutrition humanitarian………………. mortality infant…………………….. occurrences irreversible…………………… peasants major………………………… picture pitiful………………………. rations relentless……………………… suffering 121 relief…………………………. tragedy 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline of the story: FOR – MILLIONS – INTERNATIONAL – STARVATION – AS- FOOD – AGUNDA – FACE- RELIEF ………………………………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: - a se dovedi mult mai rău: -p…………… m…………….. w……………… - zonă ameninţată: -a………….. a…………………. - a preîntâmpina o tragedie: -a................ a t.................. - situaţia se înrăutăţeşte rapid: -the s................. is w................. r.................... -rata mortalităţii creşte constant: -m.................. r................. is s.................... c.................... - leziuni ireversibile ale creierului: -i................... b.................. d.................... - eveniment zilnic: -d..................... o...................... -a îndeplini obiectivele planificate anual: -m……………. a…………….. t………………... - a căuta fonduri: -s……………… f……………… - a împărţi raţiile minime de alimente: -d................ b.............. r............... - război civil care face ravagii: -r............... c................ w................ 122 LESSON 9 *Grammar: Revision – Reported Speech, Conditionals, Wishes, Passives, Modals * Vocabulary: General – Work and Study * Phrasal Verbs: Take* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Floods *** I. GRAMMAR – REVISION – REPORTED SPEECH, CONDITIONALS, WISHES, PASSIVES, MODALS39 1. Choose the correct word or phrase in each sentence: a) Jim asked/told the teacher if the book was his. b) I have had/had two teeth taken out last week. c) I can’t do these sums. I wish I have/had a calculator with me. d) Anne refused/ said she didn’t want me to borrow her bike. e) Helen can’t have stolen/ must have stolen the money from the office. She didn’t come in to the office on the day it was stolen. f) If I have/had more money, I’d pay for you too. g) It’s getting very late, so I think you’d better/ you could leave. h) Tracey phoned earlier and said that she had been/ would be late. i) The next two lessons were been/have been cancelled. j) If we’d remembered/we remembered to bring the map, we wouldn’t have got lost. 2. Look carefully at each line. Some lines are correct but some have a word which should not be there. Tick (v) each correct line. If a line has a word which should not be there, write the word in the space: Do-It-Yourself Last week my brother and I decided to paint our 39 1. V Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 123 bedrooms if while our parents were out for the 2. if day. Our parents usually they have the painting done 3……… by a local firm, but we thought we could to save some 4. ……… money if we did paint it ourselves. We had watched the 5. ……… painters the last time the house had to been painted, 6. ……. so we thought we would be able to do the job. 7. ……… ‘First all the surfaces must have to be washed’, my 8. ……….. brother said. ‘That can’t have be very difficult,’ I 9. ……… replied. ‘We’d better if put some newspapers on 10………. the carpet. If we can make a mess, we’ll get into 11 ………. trouble’. After that had been have done, we looked 12. ……… for some paint in the garden shed. ‘We could use 13. ………. this red paint,’ I was suggested. My brother said that 14. ………. he preferred green paint. Just as if we were going to 15. ………. start, our parents arrived home. ‘You should have been 16. ……….. asked us first,’ my mother said us. ‘You can paint the 17. ……….. rest of the house too!” 18. ………. 3. Complete each sentence with one of the words or phrases from the box: could don’t have to might have should had to have to must mustn’t a) We don’t have to wear a uniform at my school. b) You ………………………………………..play with matches! It’s very dangerous. c) I’m not sure, but I think I ……………………………….left my wallet in the bank. d) I’m getting up early, because I …………………………..go running before school. e) Sorry I can’t stay any longer, but I really …………………………………go home. f) If you want to, we …………………………………….go swimming this afternoon. g) Sorry I’m late, but I ……………………………………….take my dog to the vet’s. h) I think you………………………………go to bed earlier, and stop drinking coffee. 124 4. Complete the second sentence so that it has a similar meaning to the first sentence: a) I don’t know the answer, so I can’t help you. If I knew the answer, I would help you. b) Don’t run fast, or you’ll feel tired. If ……………………………………………………………………………… c) An off-duty policewoman arrested the robber. The robber ……………………………………………………………………. d) We didn’t leave early, so we missed the train. If we …………………………………………………………………………. e) I ate all the ice-cream, and now I regret it. I wish…………………………………………………………………………. f) Where is the bus station? Could you……………………………………………………………………. g) The local council is building a new sports centre. A new sports centre………………………………………………………….. h) I think you should go to the doctor’s. If I……………………………………………………………………………. i) Someone used a hammer to break the window. The window…………………………………………………………………. j) ‘Don’t forget to buy some milk, Amy,’ I said. I reminded…………………………………………………………………… 5. For each question, complete the second sentence so that it means the same as the first, using no more than three words: a) It wasn’t necessary for me to go to work yesterday. I didn’t have to go to work yesterday. b) I’d like to be rich! I wish……………………………………………………………………….rich! 125 c) I’m going to the hairdresser’s tomorrow. I’m having……………………………………………………………tomorrow. d) Perhaps Mark missed the bus. Mark might……………………………………………………………...the bus. e) Marconi was the inventor of radio. Radio ………………………………………………………………by Marconi. f) I think you were wrong to forget the keys! You shouldn’t ………………………………………………………..the keys! g) It would be a good idea for us to take an umbrella. We……………………………………………………...better take an umbrella. h) I’m sure that Maria worked very hard. Maria ………………………………………………………………..very hard. i) Helen gave a camera to Richard. Richard ……………………………………………………..a camera by Helen. j) It was unnecessary for us to buy so much food. We ……………………………………………………….bought so much food. 6. Mixed structures. Write It must be true, It may be true or It can’t be true: 0.There are people on other planets. It may be true. 1.There are plants on the moon. ……………… 2. Shakespeare interviewed Julius Caesar. ……………… 3. Some members of the government take drugs. ……………… 4. All English children can read. ………………. 5. It is raining somewhere in Africa at this moment. ……………… 126 7. Use the words in the box in requests beginning Can you….or Can I…..: bill catalogue contract menu price list receipt credit card estimate 1. (You have just paid a taxi driver). …………………give me a ……………………? 2. (You have just sat down in a restaurant). ………………bring me the…………….? 3. (You are talking to a builder)…………………give me an………………………...? 4. (You are in a car showroom and you want to know how much the cars cost.) …………..give me your ………………………………………………...........? 5. (You have finished a meal in a restaurant). …………….bring me the……………? 6. (You want to buy some things in a small shop) ……………pay by ……………………………………………………………………………........? 7. (You are renting a car) ………………….. explain this paragraph in the …………………………………………………………………………………? 8. (You are telephoning a clothing company) ………………send me your …………………………………………………………………………………? 8. Grammar in a text. Complete the text with words from the box, using used to….: buy go play stand have keep look after look at live take Recently we took our 15-year-old son Joe to the place in Paris where we (1) ………………… when he was a baby. We showed him the house, with the balcony where he (2)………………… and make speeches to imaginary crowds. Then we went inside, and believe it or not, there was Mme Duchène, who (3)……………………Joe when we were working. She didn’t look a day older. We couldn’t get into the flat, but we saw the garden where Joe (4)………………Then we visited the park where we (5) ……………………him for walks, the zoo where he (6)…………………..the lions and tigers, and the lake where we (7)……………………boating. Not much had 127 changed in the area: most of the shops were still there, including the wonderful old grocer’s where we (8)…………………… delicacies like cherries in brandy. But the friendly butcher who (9)………………….the best pieces of meat for us was gone, and so was the restaurant with the bad-tempered old waitress where we (10)……………….. Sunday lunch. I found it strange to go back: it made me feel happy and sad at the same time. But Joe was delighted with the trip. 9. Perfect modals. Complete the sentences with should have…., could have,….may have….., or can’t have. More than one answer may be possible: He should have paid me last week. (pay) 1. James …………………………………….to America. I saw him this morning. (go) 2. You……………………………………………….somebody, driving like that. (kill) 3. ‘Where’s Phil?’ ‘I don’t know. He ……………………………………..home.’ (go) 4. ‘We went to Dublin for the weekend.’ ‘That …………………..a nice change.’ (be) 5. If my parents hadn’t been so poor, I ……………………………..to university. (go) 10. Choose the best form: 1. We may/ might/ both win, but I don’t think there’s much chance. 2. I may/ can/ both ask you to help me later. 3. That may not/ can’t/ both be her daughter – they’re nearly the same age. 4. We can/ may/ both decide to go camping again at Easter. 5. There may not/ can’t/ both be enough room for everybody on the bus – we’ll have to wait and see. 6. You may not/ can’t/ both get in without a ticket – not a chance. 7. You absolutely should/ must/ both go and see Liz. 128 II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL - WORK AND STUDY40 1. Choose the correct word in each sentence: a) Penny took three exams and managed to pass/succeed them all. b) Most people would prefer a job/work which was near home. c) Tim had to learn/teach fifty children how to swim. d) I can’t come to the cinema tonight. I’m reading/studying for a test. e) It’s hard reading aloud/loudly when you don’t understand the words. f) The manager told David to make an application/invitation for the job. g) Ann works in advertising and earns/wins a very high salary. h) Would you like to come into my bureau/office? We can talk there. 2. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: business date heart phone practice rules time work a) Before her history exam, Laura learnt a list of dates by heart. b) The manager will be with you in a moment. He’s on the …………………………... c) I haven’t spoken Spanish for ages and I’m a bit out of …………………………….. d) Ever since Tim lost his job he’s been out of ……………………………………….. e) Bringing your mobile phone to the class is against the …………………………….! f) This factory isn’t very modern. Most of the machines are out of…………………… g) Our maths teacher is always late. He’s never on……………………………………. h) Mrs Smith isn’t here at the moment. She’s away on ……………………………….. 3. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: get hand keep look pick stand take write a) If you don’t know the answer, look it up in the back of the book. b) My boss wouldn’t let me ………………………time off to go to a football match. 40 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 129 c) Stop talking, and ……………………………………………….on with your work! d) George finds it hard to ………………………….up with the rest of the maths class. e) Carol stayed in France and managed to…………………………….up the language. f) If you speak so fast I can’t ………………………………down what you’re saying. g) Don’t forget to check over your work before you………………………………it in. h) Mrs Wood is going to …………………………in for your teacher while he’s away. 4. Match each sentence (a-j) with a sentence (1-10) which has a similar meaning: a) She was given the sack. 7 1. She was given a better job. b) She got a rise. …… 2. She answered an advertisement. c) She got a promotion. ….. 3 She decided to leave. d) She retired. …… 4. She did the job carefully. e) She did it for a living. …… 5. She didn’t have a job. f) She resigned. …… 6. She earned her money that way. g) She was unemployed. ….. 7. She was dismissed. h) She applied for the job. ….. 8. She wanted a better job. i) She was ambitious. …… 9. She was old and stopped work. j) She was conscientious. ….. 10. She was given more money. 5. Complete each sentence with a word formed from the word in bold: a) Nowadays it’s very important to get a good education. educate b) Our company helps ………………………………………...people to find new jobs. employ c) Paul has good ideas, but writes very ……………………………………………….. care d) Helen has become a ………………………………………………..businesswoman. succeed 130 e) I hope to leave school with some useful……………………………………………. qualify f) Mr Dale was my ……………………………………for ten years, and paid me well. employ g) According to the ……………………………………, the French lesson starts at ten. time VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS - TAKE41 A. Take in a physical sense If you take apart something or take something apart you separate it into its different parts. Rod loves taking clocks apart, but he never manages to put them together again. If you take back something or take something back, you return it to the person or organization that you bought or borrowed it from. When you go into town to take back your library books, could you also take these trousers back to the shop for me – they’re too small. If you take aside somebody or take somebody aside, you separate someone from a group of people so that you can speak to them privately. My boss took me aside at the Christmas party and told me he was going to give me a promotion in the New Year. If you take off, you suddenly leave a place, without telling anyone where you are going. Most people stayed at the party until quite late, but Rose took off early for some reason. 41 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011. 131 B. Take in an abstract sense: phrasal verb meaning example take up sth or take start doing a particular job My son has recently taken up sth up or activity stamp collecting as a hobby. take off sth or take subtract a particular amount the shop assistant took off ten sth off (sth) per cent because the item was from a total damaged. take away sth or subtract a first number from If you take 11 away from 33, take sth away a second number you’re left with 22. take back sth or admit that something you I shouldn’t have called you take sth back said was wrong lazy – I take it back. take in sth or take look at something carefully He showed us a photo of his sth in noticing all the details house, but I was so tired that I didn’t really take it in. C. Other senses of take Lucy has started swimming regularly. She has taken out [subscribed to or registered for something officially] a year’s membership at a year’s sports club and has taken to [started to do something often] going to the swimming pool every lunch hour. She is so taken up with [very busy doing something] her swimming that she wouldn’t even take me up on [accept] my offer to buy her lunch in the best restaurant in town. The exercise certainly takes it out of [makes her feel very tired] her – she is too exhausted to go anywhere in the evenings. 132 1. Each line of this text contains a phrasal verb with take, but some of them are used incorrectly. If a line has a correct phrasal verb, tick the box. If the line is incorrect, cross out the incorrect word and write the correct word in the box: The watch was broken so I took it off to the shop. back I bought a new jacket but it had a mark on it so I took it back. …….. The shop assistant took me offside and told me that ……. if I was prepared to keep the jacket she would take away ……. ten per cent. I didn’t really take in what she was saying at ……. first, but once I understood, I decided to take her over on the offer ……. 2. Use a phrasal verb from the examples above to complete these dialogues: 1. Roy: I find it very offensive that you called Ciaran an idiot. Kim: OK, OK. Sorry, I shouldn’t have said it. I…………………………………….. 2. Matt: Fiona seems really keen on her tennis these days. Clare: Yes, she’s really………………………it. She’s so…………………….with it that she’s stopped going to the swimming pool. 3. Jim: I tried to clean the inside of my computer and I’ve put all the bits back but I have two bits left over. Len: Well, I’m not surprised! I warned you not to ………………in the first place. 4. Brian: I get so bored since I retired from my job. Miriam: Well, why don’t you………………………………………………….golf? 5. Ali: What’s this figure here, $ 30? Paul: It’s what you get when you …………………$15 ……………….. from $45. 6. Anoma: You look exhausted these days. Terry: Yes, teaching 28 hours a week really …………………………………..me. 7. Hilary: Geoff left very suddenly, didn’t he? Kersty: Yes, he just………………………………..without even saying goodbye. 133 III. VOCABULARY : SPECIFIC – NEWS - FLOODS42 According to the latest reports from Anturia, a country bedevilled by natural disasters, 100 people are confirmed dead and up to 300 are feared drowned after the rivers burst their banks on Friday and inundated large parts of the country. Five days of heavy monsoon rains raised the number of dead to 1,200 in this year’s unusually heavy storms and widespread flooding. Reportedly, a boat carrying more than 50 passengers capsized in one river killing at least 35 people, while another boat sank in crocodile-infested waters, causing the tragic death of fourteen people. However, according to health officials, a third of all deaths have been caused by diarrhoea and other stomach ailments after villagers drank polluted floodwater. Other victims were killed by venomous water snakes or were drowned. Among the homeless are thousands of displaced families huddled on embankments, waiting for evacuation, while others are marooned on the roofs of their houses. Many villages are isolated, as bridges have been damaged and hundreds of miles of roads are under water. Railroad services have been suspended and flooded airports have forced the cancellation of flights. The disaster has been described as unprecedented, causing severe shortages of food and fuel due to submerged storage buildings. Amid growing fears of the flood worsening, irrigation experts are urging more protection work against other rain-swollen rivers threatening residential areas along their banks. People have been warned that flood-related crime will be severely punished, even to having offenders shot on the spot. About 100 cases of looting of abandoned properties have been reported, as well as several cases of sabotage. Boat patrols have been set up to locate looting gangs and to guard the dykes against subversives. The President will report to Parliament today on new measures to be taken to counter the flood. However, a clear picture of the damage will only emerge after the waters recede. 42 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 134 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. The inhabitants of Anturia have suffered from many calamities in the past. 2. The reported flooding is the first one this year. 3. Not all the deaths were caused by drowning. 4. Diarrhoea can be a cause of death. 5. We understand that, geographically, Anturia is situated in a temperate zone. 6. Thousands of people had no time to leave the affected area. 7. The only way to reach isolated regions is by train. 8. There is not enough food because supplies are under water. 9. Fortunately, there is no danger of other flood barriers being washed away. 10. Looters will be killed if caught red-handed. 11.There are people who want to turn this tragedy to their own, possibly political, advantage. 12. The President will present the Parliament with a detailed report of the losses. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B abandoned………………….. ailments displaced……………………. areas health………………………. buildings heavy…………………………. disaster irrigation………………………. experts looting……………………….. families polluted……………………….. flooding residential………………………. floodwater stomach……………………….. gangs storage………………………… officials unprecedented…………………. properties venomous…………………….. rains widespread…………………….. snakes 135 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: WIDESPREAD – MONSOON – ANTURIA – AFTER – PARALYSED – BY – FLOODING – HITS ………………………………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: - potrivit relatărilor: – a............. t.............. the r...................... -şalupa s-a răsturnat şi oamenii s-au înecat: – b................... s................ c.................. and p................. were d.................... - familiile sunt lipsite de adăpost: – f.................. are d.................... - a suspenda transporturile feroviare: – s............... - a provoca lipsuri serioase: – c................. r................. s..................... s.................... s............................ - a împuşca pe loc: – s................. o.................. the s...................... - a păzi împotriva: – g..................... - a întreprinde acţiuni: – t.................. a....................... m.................... - imagine clară a distrugerilor: – c................. 136 p................ of the d...................... LESSON 10 *Grammar: Purpose; Reason and Result * Vocabulary: General – The Natural Environment * Phrasal Verbs: UP* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Earthquake *** I. GRAMMAR – PURPOSE43 Purpose: to and for * We use the to infinitive to describe purpose, to say why we do things. This is called ‘the infinitive of purpose’. Alistair went to the station to meet his parents. NOT for to meet * In formal speech and writing we can use in order to. This is not as common as the infinitive of purpose. The President made a speech in order to explain the policy. * We can use for followed by a noun to say why we do something. This is especially common following verbs of motion. I went to the shops for some milk. Purpose: so that * We can use so (that) to express purpose. After so (that), we use subject + verb. * For a habitual purpose we use can OR the present simple. I leave the window open so (that) the cat can get in and out. Bill wears thick socks in bed so (that) his feet don’t get cold. * For a future purpose we use can, will OR the present simple. Dora is going to leave class early, so (that) she can go to the dentist. We’ll take an umbrella so (that) we don’t get wet. 43 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 137 * For a past purpose we use could, would, OR the past simple. Dora left class early so (that) she could go to the dentist. We took an umbrella so (that) we wouldn’t get wet. * If the subject of the first part of the sentence and the subject of the purpose close are different, we CAN’T use the infinitive of purpose to. We HAVE TO use so (that). Helen played the piano to entertain her friends. Helen played the piano so (that) everyone else could dance. 1. Put one suitable word in each space. Contractions count as one word: a) I wrote the date in my diary so that I wouldn’t forget it. b) Most tourists come here …………………………………visit the ancient temples. c) Mary called a meeting ……… …………. …………………. announce the team. d) The thief………………….in black so that nobody………………………..see him. e) Jack came to me……………………………………………………………..advice. f) Our teacher made us sit far apart so that we ………………………………...cheat! g) I’ll leave the box open so that you……………………………………help yourself. h) Lisa got up early so that she ……………………………….....finish her homework. 2. Rewrite each sentence so that it contains the word in bold: a) I went to the shops to get some eggs. for I went to the shops for some eggs. b) Nicola came here for a meeting with the director. to …………………………………………………………………………………… c) We went on holiday to have a rest. for …………………………………………………………………………………… 138 d) Mike plays chess for relaxation. to …………………………………………………………………………………… e) I opened the window to let in some air. for ……………………………………………………………………………………. f) Cristina went shopping to buy some new clothes. for ……………………………………………………………………………………. g) I went to a private school for English lessons. to …………………………………………………………………………………… h) Sam went to a specialist to get treatment. for …………………………………………………………………………………… 3. Complete the second sentence so that it has a similar meaning to the first sentence: a) Paul had to go to the doctor’s, and left work early. Paul left work early so that he could go to the doctor’s. b) The school was rebuilt because it wasn’t large enough. The school ……………………… in order to …………………………...larger. c) Sophia wanted Jack to call her, and gave him her phone number. Sophia ……………………………so that………………………………….her. d) I might get sunburnt, so I’ll put on some suntan oil. I’ll ………………………………..so that…………………………….sunburnt. e) Cathy hid the presents and nobody saw them. Cathy ………………….. ………..so that………………………………...them. f) We wanted people to dance, so we had the party in a large hall. We ……………………………….so that……………………………….dance. g) Dick wanted to get a good seat, so he arrived early. Dick ……………………………...so that…………………………a good seat. 139 h) I couldn’t see well in the cinema, and changed seats. I ………………………………….so that……………………………….better. i) We didn’t want to feel hungry, so we took some sandwiches. We took ………………………….so that we………………………….hungry. j) Harry wanted his friends to notice him so he wore a funny hat. Harry …………………………….so that…………………………………him. GRAMMAR - REASON AND RESULT44 *We use because, as and since when we want to explain the reason for something. As and since are more common in formal speech and writing. Tim didn’t feel well, because he had eaten fifteen ice-creams. As/since Tim had eaten fifteen ice-creams, he didn’t feel very well. Tim didn’t feel well, as/since he had eaten fifteen ice-creams. *As and since can come at the beginning of the sentence. Normally we do NOT begin sentences with because, but this is possible in informal speech. Because Tim had eaten fifteen ice-creams, he didn’t feel very well. *We use so to express a result. Note the relation between because and so. Tim had eaten fifteen ice-creams, so he didn’t feel very well. So and Such for emphasis *We use so many/much (that) and so few/little (that) with nouns, for emphasis. That is usually left out in informal speech and writing. Note the rules: Countable nouns: I bought so many books (that) I couldn’t carry them all. There were so few people in the theatre (that) the actors didn’t perform well. Uncountable nouns: There is so much rain at the moment (that) we hardly ever go out. We have so little free time (that) we don’t watch television. 44 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 140 *We use so + adjective + that with adjectives by themselves. Last night was so hot (that) I couldn’t sleep. The trainers were so cheap (that) I bought two pairs. *If we have an adjective followed by a noun, we use such a. It was such a lovely day (that) we went for a walk in the town. It was such a good film (that) I saw it twice. Too and not enough for a difficulty *Too + adjective means ‘more than is necessary or good’. It suggests a difficulty, and that something cannot be done. It was too far. (so I didn’t go) It was too difficult. (so I didn’t do it) *If we say what the action is we use to + infinitive. It was too far to walk so we took a taxi. The mountain was too difficult (for us) to climb. *Not + adjective+ enough means ‘less than is necessary or good.’ Compare the use of too and not enough. Little Gerry is too young to walk to school. Little Gerry is not old enough to walk to school. *With nouns we can use too many/much, too few/little and not enough. Countable nouns: There are too many things to do. There are too few books. We haven’t got enough books. Uncountable nouns: There’s too much time. There’s too little time. We haven’t got enough time. * Notice from the above examples that enough comes after adjectives (‘old’) but before nouns (‘books’/ ‘time’) 141 So and too *It is a common mistake to confuse so and too. So is like very, and is used for emphasis. The speaker’s opinion can be positive or negative. Too means ‘more than enough’. It suggests a difficulty, that something cannot be done or will not happen. It’s very expensive. (a fact) It’s so expensive. (I’m surprised, but I still might buy it) It’s too expensive. (so I won’t buy it). Result phrases: as a result, in the end, eventually We can also express result with a linking phrase like as a result, or a time expression like in the end or eventually. These are more common in formal speech and writing. Two metres of snow fell during the night. As a result, several main roads were blocked. (in speech we would just use so here) It started raining while we were having our picnic, and eventually we decided to go home. Kate and Tim waited for the bus for a long time, and in the end they took a taxi. Linking words: Words like because and so are called ‘linking words’. 4. Choose the correct word or phrase in each sentence: a) It was such/so a delicious drink, that I had to have another glass. b) Andrew ate so much/so many cakes that he could hardly walk! c) Kate’s offer sounded so/too good to be true! d) There are so few/so little good programmes on TV that I rarely watch it. e) I felt so/too weak that I couldn’t stand up. f) We had so much/so many free time, that we got bored. g) I waited for Elaine for ages, and as a result/in the end I gave up. h) There was so much/so many rain last night, that the roads were flooded. 142 i) David was too tall/tall enough/enough tall/very tall to reach the shelf. j) I had so few/so little knowledge of the subject that I got zero in the test. 5. Complete the sentences with one of these words: too, enough, so, such, much, many, little, few: a) It’s so late and there are still lots of people in the club. b) It’s …………………………………late to catch a bus. I’ll have to get a taxi home. c) I have so…………………………………………………………………work to do! d) I have so………………………………………………………………….jobs to do! e) I don’t have ………………………………………money to go on holiday this year. f) I have too………………………………………….money to go on holiday this year. g) I have too……………………euros in my bank account to go on holiday this year. h) It was………………………………………………………………an exciting film! i) The film was…………………………………………………………………exciting. j) It’s ……………………hot on the beach. I don’t like it. I’m going back to the hotel. k) It’s …………………………………..hot on the beach! I love it. I’m really relaxed. 6. Put one suitable word in each space: a) My tea is too hot to drink at the moment. b) I had to stand at the back, …………………………….there weren’t any seats left. c) Thomas had………………………………...homework, that he had to stay up late. d) There were…………..………………….people in front of us that we couldn’t see. e) Helen missed the bus, ………………………………………………she took a taxi. f) There were ……….. ………………………..customers that the shop closed down. g) The room wasn’t large………………………………………….for so many guests. h) Hannah was…………………………………..tired that she fall asleep on the train. i) We had………………………………….money that we couldn’t even buy a drink. j) ………………………….................it was raining, the school picnic was postponed. 143 7. Rewrite each sentence so that it has a similar meaning and contains the word in bold: a) I felt really tired, so I stayed at home and had a rest. because I stayed at home and had a rest because I felt really tired. b) I didn’t use that piece of string, because it was too short. enough ………………………………………………………………………………….. c) The question was so difficult that I had to ask for help. such ………………………………………………………………………………….. d) There weren’t enough seats for all the guests. few ………………………………………………………………………………….. e) There weren’t enough seats for all the guests. many ………………………………………………………………………………… f) We can’t put that box in the car as there isn’t much space. little ………………………………………………………………………………… g) I haven’t got enough time to do all my work. too ………………………………………………………………………………. h) I’ve got such a lot of work that I can’t go out. so ………………………………………………………………………………. i) She had lots of children and didn’t know what to do. many ………………………………………………………………………………. j) It was such a good play that the audience cheered. so ……………………………………………………………………………… 144 8. Underline the errors in these sentences. Rewrite each sentence: a) Sorry, but I haven’t got little time. Sorry, but I haven’t got enough time. b) Erica is not enough old to drive a car. …………………………………………………………………………………. c) Paul has so much friends that he’s always busy. …………………………………………………………………………………. d) We have too few time to go sight-seeing. …………………………………………………………………………………. e) It’s too hot that I can’t think! ………………………………………………………………………………… f) There was too much snow that we couldn’t travel. ………………………………………………………………………………… g) It was so a long way that we decided to drive there. ………………………………………………………………………………… h) So that I had run a long way, I felt exhausted. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 9. Complete the second sentence so that it has a similar meaning to the first sentence: a) I’m afraid you’re not fast enough to be in the running team. I’m afraid you’re too slow to be in the running team. b) It’s not very far to the house, so we can walk. We can walk……………………………………………………………………. c) The film was so long that we missed our last bus. It was…………………………………………………………………………… d) Tina felt unhappy and she cried. Tina felt so……………………………………………………………………… e) Tom has lots of money, and doesn’t know what to do with it. Tom has so……………………………………………………………………… 145 f) Jim is too young to get married. Jim isn’t………………………………………………………………………… g) I can’t afford to buy this bike. I haven’t got……………………………………………………………………. h) There are too few plates I’m afraid. There aren’t……………………………………………………………………... II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – THE NATURAL ENVIRONMENT45 1. Choose the correct word in each sentence: a) Before we set off, we listened to the climate/weather forecast. b) Paula saw a flash of lightning/thunder and then heard a deep boom. c) The traffic had to slow down because of the thick fog/vapor. d) There won’t be much rain. It’s only a short shower/stream. e) Spring is my favorite season/term of the year. f) Last summer was very hot, and there was a real heatwave/temperature. g) Look at those clouds! There’s going to be a blast/storm. h) On a hot day in summer, I look forward to the chilly/cool evening. i) We were caught in the rain and got damp/soaked to the skin. j) In the morning there was half a metre of ice/snow blocking the road. 2. Choose the word which best matches the description: a) Large white water bird with a long neck. duck/swan b) Four legged animal with horns, good at climbing. goat/sheep c) Sea animal with a shell and five pairs of legs. crab/frog d) Insect with large beautifully colored wings. bee/butterfly e) Small reptile with four legs and a long tail. lizard/snake 45 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 146 f) Small flying insect which drinks blood from the skin. fly/mosquito g) Small long-eared animal that lives in a hole. mouse/rabbit h) Animal with long legs and neck and orangey skin. camel/giraffe i) Eight-legged creature which catches insects. bat/spider j) Young animal which barks, often a pet. kitten/ puppy 3. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: bark berry blossom branch leaf root thorn trunk a) Sue managed to reach the branch of a tree and climb up to the window. b) I felt ill after I ate a red …………………………………..from a bush in the woods. c) The wall was cracked by the ………………………of a tree growing underneath it. d) In the autumn, every…………………….on the tree turns yellow and then falls off. e) Lis hurt herself on a …………………………….while she was picking some roses. f) The ……………………….of this tree can be removed and used as a kind of paper. g) In spring all the apple trees are covered in white…………………………………… h) An oak tree has a very broad…………………………, sometimes two metres thick. 4. Choose the best ending (1-8) for each sentence (a-h): a) In cities the air is hard to breathe because of car 6 1. waste b) The earth’s climate is changing because of ………. 2. pollution c) Not having enough of something is called a ………. 3. recycling d) Air, sea and land can suffer from …….. 4. global warming. e) Throwing things away unnecessarily is called……… 5. rubbish f) A mixture of smoke and fog is called………. 6. exhaust fumes g) Things which we throw away are called…… 7. shortage h) To avoid wasting things we can use ……….. 8. smog 147 5. Complete each sentence with a pair of verbs from the box with opposite meanings: clean up cut down destroy let plant pollute prevent protect recycle throw away a) People should be encouraged to protect the environment, rather than destroy it. b) We should try to ……………disasters happening, not just …………..them happen. c) Everyone should try to…………………beaches, and not…………………….them. d) It would be a good idea to …………………more trees, not to……………….trees. e) We can use things again if we…………………rather than …………….them away. 6. Complete each sentence with the pairs of words from the box: country/city farm/cottage fence/hedge hills/mountains paths/tracks stream/river town/village crops/weeds a) Elderly people often move away from the city to live in the country. b) I’ve often walked over the ………………, but I don’t like climbing …………….. c) A boat can sail up a …………………, but a …………………………..is too small. d) If you go for a walk, stay on the …………………… If you follow any of the animal……………………………………………………………you might get lost. e) Farmers try to get rid of all the ………………….and increase the quantity of …………………………………………………………………………...they grow. f) I come from a little…………………The nearest big …………………...is Bedford. g) One field has a wooden……………., the other has a ……………..made of bushes. h) In the middle of the …………………..was a lovely old……………..with a garden. 148 VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS - UP46 A. Read the text about someone complaining about having to do housework. Notice how the particle up sometimes expresses the idea of completing or totally finishing something. I spent all morning yesterday clearing up [making a place tidy and clean, especially by putting things where they usually belong] my study. There were books and papers everywhere. Then I had to sweep up [remove rubbish or dirt, usually from the floor, using a brush] the rubbish and dead leaves on the terrace. After that I tried to tidy up [make a room or a group of things tidy by putting things in the correct place] my bedroom. There were dirty clothes all jumbled up [mixed together in an untidy way] in a pile on the floor. I had to hang up [hang something, especially clothes, on a hook] four jackets and several pairs of trousers I’d left lying on chairs. That took me an hour. Then I discovered the washbasin was clogged up [blocked] in the bathroom, so I had to clear that. By that time I’d used up [finished a supply of something] all my energy and I was too tired to do anything, so I just fell asleep on the sofa. Note how the particle up can be used for emphasis. Eat up your vegetables, children! Drink up your juice! Paul’s used up all the milk. These three sentences could be written without up, but using up emphasizes the meaning of ‘finish it all or completely’. B. Read this live Internet chat between Robert and Gemma. G: Hi, Rob, are you there? R: Hi Gemma, what’s new? G: My sister Val showed up at last. She’s been promising to come for weeks. R: Great:) G: Yeah, turned up yesterday evening. 46 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011. 149 R: What’s she doing these days? G: She’s just opened up a restaurant serving exotic food from different countries. It’s in that shopping mall in Dunston, you know. R: Wow! That’s original. It’ll certainly liven Dunston up a bit, it’s such a boring place. How did she think of that? G: Oh, she’s always full of new ideas. R: So, what’s the set up? Is she the only person involved? G: No, she has a business partner and they divide up the work – and the profits! R: Sounds like fun:-) G: Yeah, but she says it’s hard work. She spends half the day chopping up food and cleaning the kitchen. R: Mm. Maybe we’re better off working in office jobs…. 1. Choose the best form from the chat above to fill the gaps in this email. Use a different verb in each gap and write it in the correct form. Hi, Gina! How are things with you? Hope all’s well. Has your cousin…………………..(1) up yet? We certainly need him around to ………………….(2) this place up a bit! Besides which, I need his help in the garden. An old tree blew down last week and I need to ………………….(3) up the branches. When he eventually ……………………(4) up, let’s try out that new club that’s …………………..(5) up in Market Street. Love, Tanya. 2. Choose the correct word to complete these sentences. Sometimes there is more than one possible answer. 1. Sam clogged/used/divided/showed up too much time on the first exam question and didn’t finish the paper. 2. Guess who showed/livened/hung/turned up at midnight last night? 3. Please could you divide/turn/chop/clog up these onions for me? 150 4. Jill spent ages clearing/tidying/hanging/turning up the lounge. 5. A new supermarket is turning/showing/opening/hanging up near us next month. 6. The bath is jumbled/swept/chopped/clogged up with hair. It’s disgusting! 7. Could you hang/clear/use/sweep up the leaves on the front steps, please? 8. When the old man died, his things were chopped/divided/cleared/used up among his children. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS - EARTHQUAKE47 At least 5,000 people are estimated to have died and thousands of others to have been injured in a destructive earthquake which devastated large areas of Ishmad. This small mountainous country is prone to seismic disturbances as it lies on a seismological fault. This tragedy proved particularly calamitous and the still incomplete statistics speak of unprecedented damage. The high magnitude quake measured 7.7 on the Richter scale and was the strongest this area has experienced in more than a century. It followed a fortnight of tremors and its epicentre was some 150 miles southwest of Zento, the Ishmadic capital. Three small villages, close to the epicentre, are said to have been completely wiped out. The quake also triggered devastating landslides which destroyed a power station, depriving one-third of the country of electricity. No aftershocks were reported. At two in the morning, two strong quakes, thirty minutes apart, rocked the capital, catching the inhabitants in their sleep and leaving homes badly damaged. Those who did not immediately leave the affected area paid for it with their lives. Hundreds of bodies lie buried under the ruins and the death toll mounts as rescue workers dig into the mounds of debris to find those entombed. With half the city reduced to rubble, most of its surviving inhabitants have been left homeless. Hardest hit were the badly-constructed high-rise apartment blocks, built of precast concrete slabs, which have sprung up in recent years. They were the first to collapse on their occupants and they are now being blamed for the high death toll as there are few which withstood the tremors. Many schools and hospitals disintegrated as the earth heaved. Other buildings were gutted by fire from ruptured gas pipes and a pall of smoke still hangs over the town. All the structurally-damaged 47 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 151 buildings will have to be razed. It is now predicted that, even after years of reconstructive work, Zento will never look the same again. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. We know exactly what the number of casualties is. 2. It is not the first or the last earthquake in Ishmad. 3. 7.7 on the Richter scale is not regarded as particularly strong. 4. There had been no previous indication that a quake might be coming. 5. The quake is indirectly responsible for the lack of energy in some parts of the country. 6. Thirty quakes were felt in the space of two hours. 7. Most of the victims were killed by collapsing buildings. 8. Those who survived still have a place to live. 9. Buildings built of concrete were strong enough not to collapse. 10. Fires were started by gas explosions. 11. Structurally damaged buildings will be reconstructed. 12. The report tells us that the capital of the country will be moved from Zento after reconstructive work. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B affected……………….. area calamitous……………… country concrete………………… damage destructive………………. earthquake devastating………………. inhabitants high magnitude……………… landslides homeless…………………….. quake incomplete…………………… slabs mountainous………………… statistics 152 rescue……………………… tragedy unprecedented…………………. workers 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline of the story: 5,000 – MAGNITUDE – STRIKES – AS- QUAKE – KILLED – HIGH – ISHMAD ………………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: - a devasta ţara: – d............... the c..................... - a fi expus cutremurelor: – be p................. t................. q................... - a găsi pe cineva în timpul somnului: – c................ somebody i....... his s............. - a se afla sub dărâmături: – l................ b................ u............... the r.................. - numărul morţilor creşte mereu:– d................ t............ m..................... - a-i lăsa pe locuitori fără acoperiş deasupra capului – l................. the i............ h................... - a suporta undele seismice: – w................ the t..................... - mistuit de foc: – g................ b............. f................... 153 LESSON 11 *Grammar: Contrast * Vocabulary: General – Tools and Technology * Phrasal Verbs: OUT* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Avalanches *** I. GRAMMAR - CONTRAST48 *But, yet, although, though, even though: but – more informal speech Maria felt ill, but she went to school. although – careful or formal speech or writing Maria went to school although she was ill. - can come at the beginning Although she was ill, Maria went to school. We can emphasize but and although with still and anyway: Maria felt ill, but she went to school anyway. Maria felt ill, but she still went to school. Although she was ill, Maria went to school anyway. We can use yet instead of but in writing Maria felt ill, yet she went to school. *Although often becomes though in speech. Though can come at the end of a sentence, although cannot. Although I asked her, she didn’t come. (speech and writing) Though I asked her, she didn’t come. (speech) I asked her, (but) she didn’t come, though. (speech) Even though gives a stronger contrast than although: Even though I asked her, she didn’t come. (which was really surprising) 48 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 154 *While, whereas: While and whereas are used in formal speech and writing. They compare two facts and emphasize the difference between them. While United were fast and accurate, City was slow and careless. *However, nevertheless, on the other hand: However is a way of expressing contrast in formal speech or writing. It can go at the beginning, middle or end of the sentence, and is separated by a comma (or a pause in speech): Normally we don’t refund money without a receipt. However, on this occasion I’ll do it. Normally we don’t refund money without a receipt. On this occasion, however, I’ll do it. Normally we don’t refund money without a receipt. On this occasion, I’ll do it, however. Nevertheless is a very formal way of expressing however. I’m not happy with your work. Nevertheless, I’m going to give you one last chance. on the other hand – introduces a contrasting opinion; more common in formal speech and writing Television has many advantages. It keeps us informed about the latest news, and also provides entertainment in the home. On the other hand, television has been blamed for the violent behaviour of some young people, and for encouraging children to sit indoors, instead of taking exercise. *Despite and in spite of: They are followed by a noun (including the –ing form used as a noun). In spite of the rain, we went out. (Although it was raining, we went out). Despite losing, we celebrated. (Although we lost, we celebrated) Despite her illness, Maria went to school. Despite being ill, Maria went to school. In spite of her illness, Maria went to school. In spite of being ill, Maria went to school. 155 1. Choose the correct word or phrase in each sentence: a) I read the book you suggested. I didn’t enjoy it, although/however. b) In spite of/Although we warned him, Harry still got lost. c) Although/ However I like it here, I won’t stay here long. d) Cars are convenient. On the other hand/Whereas, they cause pollution. e) I didn’t have much time, but/however I managed to visit lots of places. f) Catherine won the race, although/despite falling over. g) Although/ In spite of the delay, the train arrived on time. h) I didn’t manage to jump over the wall, although/yet I tried twice. 2. Complete each sentence with one suitable word: a) Although Tim felt tired, he stayed up to finish his homework. b) Sam didn’t like skating, ……………………he went with his friends all the same. c) I found French hard at first. ……………………………, I soon started to enjoy it. d) Jane kept running, ……………………………..though she knew she couldn’t win. e) Mike was lost, but he …………………………………...refused to look at the map. f) Carol went to see the film, …………………………………..she had seen it before. g) ……………………………………..the rain, the school sports were a great success. h) Helen won the swimming competition, in ………………………………of her cold. 3. Rewrite each sentence beginning as shown. Do not change the meaning: a) Although it was snowing, we went out for a walk. Despite the snow, we went out for a walk. b) Some experts think prices will fall, but others disagree. While ………………………………………………………………………….. c) Even though they were losing at half-time, City won in the end. Despite ………………………………………………………………………… d) Despite the heat, Diana wore her winter clothes. Although ………………………………………………………………………. 156 e) Whereas last summer was good, this summer it’s rained all the time. Last summer was good ………………………………………………………… f) James had a headache, but he still read until late. In spite of ………………………………………………………………………. g) Although Jon hadn’t studied, he did well in the test. Jon hadn’t studied……………………………………………………………… 4. Complete each sentence with one suitable word: a) I couldn’t run fast enough to catch the shoplifter. b) They were…………............................good roads that we could drive at high speed. c) It was……………………………………………….dark that I couldn’t see a thing. d) The trousers were…………………………………………...long enough to fit Jean. e) We had……......................................a good time that we decided to go there again. f) It was…………………………………………late that we couldn’t get a bus home. g) I took a taxi as it was…………………………………………………….far to walk. h) The ladder wasn’t tall………………………………………….to reach the window. i) There are…………………………...lovely fish that you don’t feel like eating meat. j) There were……………………..…..many dishes that I couldn’t make up my mind. 5. Rewrite each sentence, beginning as shown. Do not change the meaning. Two sentences should be rewritten as one: a) Despite the cold weather, we all went for a walk. Although it was cold, we all went for a walk. b) John has done well in French, but not so well in Maths. While………………………………………………………………………….. c) I tried to persuade her. I didn’t succeed, however. Although……………………………………………………………………… d)It was raining, but I went swimming anyway. In spite of……………………………………………………………………… e) Ann felt ill, but insisted on going to work. Despite………………………………………………………………………… 157 f) In spite of his early lead, Hudson lost his race. Although……………………………………………………………………… g) I’m not going to pay, although I know that I should. While…………………………………………………………………………. h) We expected Larry to accept the job, but he didn’t. Even though Larry……………………………………………………………. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – TOOLS AND TECHNOLOGY49 1. Choose the correct word in each sentence: a) In the UK it’s ‘mobile phone’, but in the US it’s a cell phone/ pocket phone. b) In Britain most private cars run on gas/petrol or diesel. c) Ann’s friends bought her an electric/electrical mixer for her birthday. d) Peter had to push his bike when he got a flat tyre/wheel. e) This car has got a really powerful engine/machine. f) When the machine is on, a little red light/torch comes on. g) The noise of the workmen banging in nails/screws was disturbing. h) The radiators will have to be fitted by a heater/plumber. 2. Match the words from the box with the explanations: answering machine camera dishwasher mobile phone sewing machine a) Use this if you can’t stay in to take your calls. photocopier vacuum cleaner answering machine b) Use this to make calls when you’re out and about. ………………….. c) Use this to do your own dressmaking. ………………….. d) Use this to get rid of dust and dirt. ………………….. e) Use this to take a snapshot for your album. ………………….. f) Use this to deal with dirty cutlery and crockery. ………………….. 49 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 158 g) Use this if you need several pages all the same. ………………….. 3. Complete each phrase in italics with a verb from the box: blow break cut go plug ring run turn warm wear a) I’m sorry I can’t talk now, but I’ll ring back in half an hour. b) The police think that a car bomb was used to ……………………up the building. c) These tyres are strong, and won’t ……………………………………...out for ages. d) Jane’s old car used to …………………………………………….down all the time. e) You can ……………………………..in the computer to the socket by the window. f) If you don’t pay the electricity bill they will ……………………………….you off. g) I think it’s time to ………………………………….off the television and go to bed. h) Whenever there is a thunder storm, all the lights ……………………………….out. i) It’s not necessary to……………………….up the engine first, although it’s so cold. j) If you leave the radio on all night the battery will……………………………….out. 4. Complete the sentences about computers with a word from the box: button cursor hard disk highlight print out memory modem website icon a) The computer stores large amount of information on its hard disk. b) When a program is running, it is using the computer’s …………………………….. c) A small picture that represents a program is called an ……………………………... d) The flashing symbol that shows where text will appear in the ……………………... e) When you’ve finished writing text you often want to ……………………………… f) You can click the left or right mouse………………………………………………... g) Organizations use the internet to provide information about themselves- they put the information on their……………………………………………………………... h) You connect the computer to the internet via a …………………………………….. 159 i) Hold down the left mouse button and drag the cursor across any text that you want to ……………………………………………………………………………………. 5. Replace the group word in italics in each sentence with an example word from the box: car ladder cello electric toothbrush oven frying pan gun saw a) The police discovered the vehicle more than twenty miles away. – car b) My sister bought me this gadget to clean my teeth as a present - …………………... c) The builders left their equipment outside the house. - ……………………………… d) The cost of the kitchen includes an electrical appliance. - …………………………. e) This kitchen utensil is lightweight and non-stick. - …………………………………. f) I had to use a tool to cut the floorboards in half. - ………………………………….. g) One of the robbers was carrying a weapon. - ……………………………………….. h) This instrument is rather heavy to carry. - ………………………………………….. 6. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: battery handle key lock plug socket switch wire a) Lisa turned the door handle, opened the door and entered the room. b) My watch stopped working because the ………………………………..had run out. c) The television won’t work in this room, as there isn’t an electric…………………... d) Bill pressed the light ………………………..., but none of the lights were working. e) To wind up this old clock you need a special kind of………………………………. f) Mary put the key in the ………………………………………., but it wouldn’t turn. g) I’ve bought an electric kettle, but the lead hasn’t got a ………………………..on it. h) The electric bell didn’t work because the……………………………...had been cut. 160 7. Match each sentence with the necessary object from the box: binoculars compass hairdrier iron lawnmower pump razor scissors thermometer tin-opener a) There is no air in either of these tyres. – pump b) Do you fancy some tinned beans for lunch? - ……………………………………… c) The grass in the back garden is awfully long. - …………………………………….. d) Sam has been letting his beard grow but now he’s going to shave - ……………….. e) When it’s long like this you need more than a towel. - …………………………….. f) I’ve got to cut the ends off the legs of my new jeans. - ……………………………. g) Do you think I’ve got a temperature? - ……………………………………………... h) It’s difficult to see wild animals when they’re so far away. - ………………………. i) Jean was completely lost, and needed to know where north was. -…………………. j) You can’t go out with all those creases in your shirt. - …………………………….. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS - OUT50 A. Out meaning ‘not in’: Many phrasal verbs with out have an association with the basic meaning of out, i.e. ‘not in’: phrasal verb meaning example leave out sth or not include something or For homework do exercise 8 leave sth out someone cut out sth or cut remove by cutting, usually She sth out from paper or cloth but leave out number 10. cut some interesting articles out of the newspaper for us. show out sb or lead a visitor who is leaving Let me show you out – it’s show sb out to the door of a room or quite hard to find the exit from building 50 here. Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011. 161 see out sb or see sb go with someone to the door Don’t worry, I can see myself out of a room or building when out. they are leaving let out sb/sth or let allow a person or animal to The door will be locked but the sb/sth out leave, usually by opening a receptionist will let you out. locked or closed door lock out sb or lock prevent someone sb out entering a from I forgot my keys and was building by locked out of my own house! locking the door lock yourself out accidentally prevent I’ve locked myself out so often yourself from getting into a that I’ve hidden a spare key in building by leaving the keys the garden now. inside when you shut the door B. Out meaning ‘to the end’ or ‘completely’: Sometimes out in phrasal verbs gives an idea of completing or doing something to the end. I sorted out my room on Sunday. [arranged things that were untidy] I cleared out [made tidy by removing unwanted things] all my wardrobes and threw away my worn out shoes [used so much that they had become damaged] Unfortunately, I’d run out of furniture polish, so I couldn’t do any polishing, but I’ll do that next weekend. [there was none left because it had all been used] C. Other uses of out He spread out the photos on the table so everyone could see them. [arranged on a flat surface] The band has a new album coming out next month. [available for people to buy] Madam, would you like to try out the bike before deciding whether to buy it? [test to find out if it works or decide whether you like it] 162 My husband’s business is so busy at the moment that I’m helping out in the office. [helping especially by doing work or giving money] I always feel I lost out because I never learnt a musical instrument as a child. [did not have an advantage that others had] 1. Rewrite these sentences using phrasal verbs: 1. I’ll take you down to the exit, if you like. 2. For some reason my name was omitted from the guest list. 3. My keys are inside the car and I can’t get into it. 4. He can find his own way to the exit – there’s no need to take him there. 5. She collected pictures of her pop idol from the music magazines. 6. The security guard opened the gate so we could leave the building site. 2. Complete these sentences using phrasal verbs. Write the verbs in the correct form. 1. I……………………….out by not learning a foreign language at school. I meet so many people I just can’t communicate with. 2. Would you like to ……………………out my tennis racket? It’s a new model. 3. Our business at the shop is growing so fast we need someone to ………………..out at weekends. 4. I got…………………… out yesterday. I left home without my keys and my flatmate had gone away for the day. 5. I…………………..out a job advertisement from the paper last night and now I don’t know where I put it. 6. Rana: Right, Miles, I’m leaving now. Miles: I’ll come with you and ………………..you out. Our new office building is a bit complicated. Rana: Oh, it’s OK, I can …………………myself out. Miles: Well, actually you can’t. They lock the street door at 6 p.m. so I’ll have to come and ………………..you out. 163 3. Choose which sentence from a-e below best fits the gaps 1-5 in the text. I wanted to find out more about the history of my town for a college project. (1) So I decided to go to the local library. I got out some books, newspapers and some old maps which they had. (2) I decided to make a pile of things to photocopy. (3) There was a huge amount of material, too much in fact. (4) So I hurried and just chose the most important things to copy in the time I had left. (5) I will go back and do them some other time. a) So I sorted out the most important items. b) Unfortunately, I had to leave out the very big maps. c) I’d cut out some articles from the local paper but I needed more information. d) Time was running out; the library closed at 4 p.m. e) I spread them all out on a big table. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – THE NEWS - AVALANCHES51 Eight climbers, two of them girls, were swept to their deaths yesterday when an avalanche of ice and snow thundered down Mount Bloor. It hit the party of two guides and six teenagers shortly after they had made a dawn start to assault the peak, despite both adverse weather conditions and official warnings. They were swept down the slopes from a mist-covered mountain ledge, and buried under thousands of tons of debris. It is not yet known what triggered this avalanche. Severe frost has delayed the rescue operation and the teams are finding it increasingly hard to reach the disaster site. A rescue worker is quoted as saying that there is no chance of finding any survivors. He even doubted whether they would be able to find the bodies as three feet of snow fell during the night. If the bad weather persists, the search for the missing climbers will have to be abandoned until early spring when the snows begin to melt. 51 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 164 Meanwhile, the authorities have requested extra snowploughs to clear the tracks and free scores of tourists stranded in mountain villages. Just two days ago, rescue teams at a nearby resort were alerted when a skier strayed off the piste. When he was unable to avoid the surging wall of snow, he was buried in the cascade. Sniffer dogs were brought in and his body, thrown 1,200 feet by the impact, was found under a heap in a ravine. It was dug out, although near-zero visibility made the rescue operation extremely difficult. Following this tragedy, a warning has been issued to skiers to keep to established runs and, by no means, to venture onto steep, unmarked slopes. In January alone, avalanches caused fourteen deaths. The increase in the number of avalanches is believed to be the result of the widespread deforestation of the mountain slopes to make way for ski resorts. The resulting serious erosion of topsoil has substantially multiplied the incidence of avalanches and endangered skiers’ lives. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. There were six men in the group of climbers. 2. The group had left for the peak early in the morning. 3. When they were setting out the weather was fine. 4. The avalanche is believed to have been started by the climbers. 5. It is possible that some of the climbers are still alive. 6. The search will continue provided the weather does not get worse. 7. Sometimes bodies of the victims are found months later, in spring. 8. Some mountain villages have been cut off by recent snowfalls. 9. It wasn’t the skier’s fault that he was killed. 10. The rescue operation was difficult because it was very cold. 11. Death by avalanche is not rare in that region. 12. If there were more trees on the slopes, there would be fewer avalanches. 165 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B adverse .......................... conditions bad deforestations ............................ dawn .............................. dogs disaster ............................... frost mountain ............................ ledge rescue ............................ site severe ........................... operation sniffer ............................ slopes steep ............................... start widespread ............................ weather 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: ON – AVALANCHE – SLOPES – REPORTED – MORE – THE – DEATHS …………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. Phrases to learn: -a fi strivit de avalanşă: b.............. s................. b.............. an a........................... -condiţii meteorologice proaste: a................... w......................... c........................ -îngropat sub zăpadă: b.................... u................. the s.................. -acţiune de salvare: r................. o....................... -locul tragediei: d................. s......................... -căutarea celor care au supravieţuit: s................. f............... s..................... -a opri căutările: a................... the s...................... -a avertiza, a da un semnal de alarmă: i................. a w...................... -în nici un caz: b................ n................... m................... -a multiplica numărul cazurilor: m........................ the i.......................... -a ameninţa viaţa – e................... one’s l.............. 166 LESSON 12 *Grammar: Relatives – who, whom, which, that, what, whose * Vocabulary: General – Everyday Objects * Phrasal Verbs: Off* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Volcanic Eruptions *** I. GRAMMAR - RELATIVES – who, whom, which, that, what, whose52 *who(m), which, that - join sentences to nouns – who (for people), and which (for things) I’ve got a friend. He collects stamps > I’ve got a friend who collects stamps. There’s a problem. It worries me. > There’s a problem which worries me. Holly’s lost the watch. I bought it for her.> Holly’s lost the watch which I bought for her. - who, which instead of he, him, she, it. Don’t use both! The man who lives opposite has been ill. (not “who he lives”) This is the report which you wanted. (not “which you wanted it”) - that – instead of “which”, “who” – in informal style There’s a problem that you don’t understand. I know some people that could help you. - we normally use that, not which, after all, everything, nothing, the only ….and superlatives I told you everything that I know. The only thing that matters to me is your happiness. - whom – object for people; formal What is the name of that nurse whom we met last week? (formal) 52 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 167 What’s the name of that nurse who/that we met last week? (informal) - always used after prepositions the woman with whom I travelled *when, where – after words for time and place I’ll never forget the day when I first met you. (= ‘…the day on which…’) Do you know a shop where I can find sandals? (= ‘…a shop at which…’) 1. Join the sentences in the places marked*. Change he, it etc. to who or which: E.g.: I know a shop*. It sells good coffee. I know a shop which sells good coffee. Most of the people* work in London. They live in our village. Most of the people who live in our village work in London. 1. The tomatoes* were mostly bad. You bought them. ……………………………………………………………………………….. 2. The flowers* are doing well. I planted them. ………………………………………………………………………………. 3. A lot of people* want a change of government. I know them. ……………………………………………………………………………….. 4. Three of the prisoners* are still on the run. They escaped last night. ………………………………………………………………………………. 5. There’s some cheese in the fridge*. It needs to be eaten. ………………………………………………………………………………. 6. I want some plates*. They can go in the microwave. ………………………………………………………………………………. 7. They haven’t got the shirt* in your size. You wanted it. ……………………………………………………………………………… 8. The boy* has asked my sister out. He lives next door. ……………………………………………………………………………… 168 2. Make these sentences more formal: 1. He’s one of those people that everybody likes. ……………………………………………………………………………… 2. There were three boys at my school that I’ll never forget. ………………………………………………………………………………. 3. The woman that I didn’t recognise was my old dentist. ………………………………………………………………………………. 4. The man who the police arrested said that he’d never met the woman. ……………………………………………………………………………….. *leaving out relative pronouns - we can leave out object pronouns who(m), which, that, but not usually subject pronouns. Where’s that letter that I saw this morning? > Where’s that letter I saw this morning? BUT NOT Where’s that letter that was on the table? > Where’s that letter was on the table? 3. Is the relative pronoun the subject or object in these clauses? E.g.: That’s the woman who lives next door. – S Our doctor is a person whom I really respect. – O 1. He had a simple idea which changed the world. ……….. 2. I’ve lost that nice ring which Bill gave me. ……….. 3. It’s a book that everybody talks about and nobody reads. ….. 4. Once there were three rabbits that lived near a river. ……… 5. That’s the man who I wanted to see. ….. 6. An orphan is a child who hasn’t got any parents. …… 7. He keeps telling you things which you already know. …… 8. They never thanked me for the money that I sent them. …… 169 4. In which three of sentences 1-6 can the relative pronouns be left out? E.g.: The strawberries which I bought weren’t very good. – NO which 1. The job that he got wasn’t very interesting. 2. A woman who(m) my sister knows has just bought the house next door. 3. The doctor who treated me didn’t know what he was doing. 4. I’m sorry for people who haven’t got a sense of humour. 5. Have you got anything that will clean this carpet? 6. Have you got a typewriter that I can use? 5. Join the sentences in the places marked* without using who(m), which or that: E.g.: You asked me to get you a paper. Here’s the paper*. Here’s the paper you asked me to get you. 1. You recommended a film. We went to see the film*, but we didn’t think much of it. ……………………………………………………………………………… 2. My sister bought a new car last month. The car* has broken down four times already. …………………………………………………………………………….. 3. You didn’t recognise an actor on television last night. The actor*was Jake McLean. ……………………………………………………………………………… *what = the thing(s) that’: Take what you like What she said made me angry. Help yourself. Take what you like. I gave him what he needed. 170 - + singular verb What I learnt at school was mostly useless. - that – after anything, something, nothing, everything, all, the only thing I’ll give you anything that you need. (NOT what you need) Music is the only thing that interests her. All that I could do was listen to her. They had nothing that was useful. 6. Rewrite the words in italics, using what: E.g.: The things that she did that morning weren’t helpful. what she did; wasn’t 1. The things that he said made everybody angry. ………………………………….. 2.The date – that’s the thing that I forgot to tell them! ……………………………….. 3. I’ll do anything that I like. ……………………………………………………..…… 4. The things that it said in the paper were worrying. ………………………………… 5.Schoolchildren should read anything that interests them.…………………………… 7. Complete the definitions using what and the words in the box: advertising cheese grass gravity happiness imagination money petrol philosophy power honey E.g.: Cheese is what people make from milk. 1. ……………………………………………………………………………bees make. 2. ……………………………...........................................................................cows eat. 3. ……………………..........................................................................everybody wants. 4. …………………………………………………………………...philosophers study. 5. ………………………………………………………………………politicians want. 6. ……………………………………………………………...economists know about. 7. ………………………………………………………………....................poets need. 8. …………………………………………...makes people buy things they don’t want. 9. ………………………………………………………………………..makes cars go. 171 10. ……………………………………………………………………makes things fall. 8. Put in that or what: 1. I don’t believe anything ……………………………………………………she says. 2. …………………………………………………………………..he did shocked me. 3. The only thing ……………………………………………………I forgot was soap. 4. I don’t have time to read everything………………………………………I want to. 5. They told us…………………………………………………….we needed to know. *whose: a girl whose beauty………. -formal I saw a girl. Her beauty took my breath away. > I saw a girl whose beauty took my breath away. He went to a meeting. He didn’t understand its purpose.> He went to a meeting whose purpose he didn’t understand. + noun 9. Complete the sentences with whose. The words in the box will help: books children students tourists are happy are read learn is enjoyed food houses patients plants die fall down get lost grow E.g.: A good builder is one whose houses don’t fall down. 1. A good parent is one ……………………………………………………………… 2. A good gardener ………………………………………………………………….. 3. A good doctor …………………………………………………………………….. 4. A good writer ……………………………………………………………………... 5. A good teacher ……………………………………………………………………. 6. A good tourist guide ……………………………………………………………… 7. A good cook ……………………………………………………………………… 172 *Prepositions in relative clauses: the girl I was talking about - who/whom/which/that + verb + preposition OBJECT VERB + PREPOSITION something (that) you can write with the girl (whom) I was talking about the music (which) we listened to - before their objects – very formal something with which you can write the girl about whom I was talking 10. Complete the sentences with expressions from the box: a cup a picture a tap a toy a vase a window 1. …………………………………………………is something that a child plays with. 2. …………………………………………………….is something water comes out of. 3. ……………………………………………………is something that you can look at. 4. …………………………………………………..is something you can look through. 5. …………………………………………………...is something that you drink out of. 6. ………………………………………………...…...is something you put flowers in. 11. Put the words in the correct order. Which description goes with which word in the box? teeth coat-hanger toothbrush table bed safe detergent match E.g.: bite you with things that things that you bite with – teeth 1. in something you sleep that ………………………………… 2. on you that something put things. ………………………………… 173 3. valuables in you that put something ………………………………… 4. teeth with you that thing a your clean ………………………………… 5. on a thing hang that clothes you ………………………………… 6. with liquid dishes you wash that ………………………………… 7. can a fire start with you that something ………………………………… *reduced relative clauses: luggage left unattended - leave out who/which/that + is/are/was/were before participles (-ing and –ed forms) Do you know that man standing near the door? (= ‘….who is standing….’) The man accused of the killing said that he was at the cinema at the time (= the man who was accused……’) Letters posted before twelve noon will usually be delivered by the next day. 12. Change the words in italics as shown in the example: E.g.: Paper that is made from rice is sometimes used for stationery. Paper made from rice 1. Who’s that good-looking man who is talking to Alison? ………………………………………………………………………………...... 2. Luggage that is left unattended will be taken away by police. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. The driver who was sent to collect me at the airport went to the wrong terminal. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. The nurse who is looking after my aunt is very kind to her. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 5. All the rubbish that is floating in the sea is a real danger to health. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 174 13. Join the sentences without using who/which/that: E.g.: There was a man. The man was seen running from the burning building. There was a man seen running from the burning building. 1. I keep dreaming about a woman. The woman is standing with her back to me. …………………………………………………………………………………. 2. James says he heard a shot. The shot was fired in the street. …………………………………………………………………………………. 3. Are those your trousers? The trousers are hanging over the balcony. …………………………………………………………………………………. 4. They live in a beautiful old house. The house was built 300 years ago. ………………………………………………………………………………...... 5.The Navajo create beautiful jewellery. The jewellery is made of silver and turquoise. ………………………………………………………………………………….. *non-identifying relative clauses: Kelly, who does my hair, ….. - some relative clauses identify – they say who or what we are talking about. - others do not identify, because it is already clear who or what we are talking about. -the use of which to refer to a whole clause. He took out the teeth which/that were causing the trouble. (which/that = ‘the teeth’) He took out two teeth, which was a real pity. (which = the clause ‘He took out two teeth’) - what cannot be used in this way He got the job, which surprised us all. (NOT – what surprised) 14. Which relative clauses identify? Circle A or B: E.g.: A. The woman who/that does my hair has just had a baby. B. Kelly, who does my hair, has just had a baby. 175 1. A. She married a man (that/who/whom) she met on a bus. B. She married a nice architect from Belfast, whom she met on a bus. 2. A. Have you got a book that’s really easy to read? B. I lent him “The Old Man and the Sea”, which is really easy to read. 3. A. What did you think of the wine (that) we had last night? B. I poured him a glass of wine, which he drank at once. 15. Change who/whom/which to that, or leave it out, if possible: E.g: This is Peter Taylor, who works with my sister. no change People who don’t answer letters annoy me. that 1. What happened to the oranges which I bought yesterday? …………….. 2.This room, which isn’t used any more, belonged to our eldest son. …………….. 3.My Uncle Sebastian, who travels a lot, has just gone off to Thailand. …………..... 4.We live in a village called Netherworld, which has 150 inhabitants. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 5. I like a film which has a beginning, a middle and an end – in that order. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 6. I’ve had a card from Sally, who used to live next door. ………………….. 7. Do you remember those awful people who we met in Corfu? ………………….. 8.We had good advice from James, whom we consulted about investments. …………………………………………………………………………………. 16. Put in which or what: 1. She cycles to work every day, …………………………………..keeps her healthy. 2. I very much liked………………………………………….you said at the meeting. 3. They gave me ………………………………………………………….I asked for. 4. The lights suddenly went out, …………………………frightened Granny terribly. 5. This is ………………………………………………………………………..I need. 176 II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – EVERYDAY OBJECTS53 1. Choose the correct word in each sentence: a) I have to do some sewing. Do you have a pin/needle? b) You need special glue/sticker when you make model aeroplanes. c) I always carry a carving knife/penknife in my pocket. d) Paul keeps his papers together with a rubber band/rubber ring. e) Sheets of paper can be fastened together with a paper clip/zipper. f) I wrapped up the parcel using brown paper and rope/string. g) Helen took the cutters/scissors and started trimming Mary’s hair. h) Oh bother! One of my shirt bottoms/buttons has fallen off. i) As David was tying his shoelace/shoestring, it broke. j) Little Susie usually ties up her hair with a red ribbon/strip. 2. Match each sentence with the necessary object from the box: diary dictionary envelope correction fluid notice ruler sharpener stamp file notepad a) It’s important to let everyone know what time the meeting starts. - notice b) Hang on a minute, I’ll just write down those details. - ……………………………... c) Oh dear, I’ve written my name in the wrong place. - ………………………………. d) Write down the date of the next match so you don’t forget. - …………………….. e) I’ve written my letter but I’ve got nothing to put it in. - ……………………… …… f) I keep losing the sheets I wrote my homework on. - ……………………………….. g) How long is this piece of paper exactly? - …………………………………………. h) What a nuisance! My pencil has broken. - ………………………………………… i) My letter’s ready for the post. How much will it cost? - …………………………... j) I’m not really sure what this word means. - ………………………………………... 53 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 177 3. The words in italics are in the wrong sentence. Find the correct sentence for each one: a) You can hang your coat on the fireplace behind the door. - hook b) It’s time for lunch. Can you put the doormat on the table? - ……………………….. c) I’ve bought a beautiful hook with long leaves for your room. - …………………….. d) Don’t forget to pull all the rubbish from the kitchen into the broom. - …………….. e) Cathy pulled back the plant and looked out at the street. - …………………………. f) You can sweep the floor with the curtains in the cupboard. - ………………………. g) My mother insists that we all wipe our feet on the tablecloth. - ……………………. h) Some logs were blazing and crackling in the dustbin. - …………………………….. 4. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: alarm comb gown hanger slippers table toothpaste towel mirror pillow a) My hair is an awful mess. Have you got a comb? b) When I get up I put on my dressing……………………………...and go downstairs. c) It’s sometimes a shock to see your face in the ……………………………………… d) Helen always sits at her dressing ……………………………...and brushes her hair. e) When I’m in the house I take off my shoes and put on my ………………………… f) I want to clean my teeth but I can’t find any ………………………………………. g) Every morning at 6.30 the …………………………...clock goes off and I wake up. h) You can wash your hands here, and there’s a ……………………..behind the door. i) I can’t get to sleep unless I have a really comfortable……………………………… j) You can put your coat in the wardrobe on a coat ………………………………….. 178 5. Match the words from the box with the explanations: street sign hedge pedestrian crossing kerb lamp post gate subway pavement a) This is a safe place to go from one side of the street to the other. - pedestrian crossing b) This has a light at the top in the street. - ……………………………………………. c) This is where people walk in the street. - …………………………………………… d) This is a kind of wall made of a living plant. - ……………………………………... e) This closes the opening in an outside wall. - ……………………………………….. f) This is a line of stones between the footpath and the road. - ………………………. g) This helps you know where you want to go. - ……………………………………… h) This is a way of crossing under the road. - …………………………………………. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS - OFF54 A. Leaving places: Off sometimes combines with verbs to express the idea of something or someone leaving a place. example meaning The space shuttle will lift off at 9.00 leave the ground (of a spacecraft or aircraft) hours. We should head off at about six start a journey or leave a place tomorrow. I’ve sent off that letter you wrote to the send a letter, document, or parcel by post newspaper. Let’s try and slip off before the meeting leave a place quietly so that other people do finishes and go for a drink. 54 not notice you going. Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 179 Why did he just clear off without saying leave a place quickly (informal) goodbye? Clear off! This is private property. B. Ending or changing state Off sometimes expresses the idea of moving towards an ending or a change of state. I’ll come and see you off at the airport tomorrow. [go to the airport in order to say goodbye] My cousin has sold off his share of the Internet company he started with a friend. [sold part of a business] After lunch Grandpa dozed off on the sofa. [gradually started to sleep, especially during the day] Mr. Prosser suddenly look very pale and broke off in the middle of his lecture. [suddenly stopped speaking] She’s so clever. She can run off a 1,000-word essay in an hour. It takes me all day! [quickly and easily write something that is usually difficult to write] C. Other expressions with off What he said has put me off the idea of going to Blandville for a holiday altogether! [made me not like something] His description of the hotel was very off-putting. [made something sound unattractive or unpleasant] Maybe we should hold off and go to Paris or somewhere in the spring? [delay doing something] I think I’ve managed to turn him off the idea of building a model railway track in the back garden. [make someone decide that they are not interested in something] She didn’t get offended by the comments; she just laughed it off. [laughed about something unpleasant in order to make it seem less important or serious] 180 1. Complete these sentences. Write the verbs in the correct form. 1. The company is not doing very well – isn’t it time you ……………….off your shares in it? 2. We were talking to Janice when she suddenly………………of in the middle of a sentence and ran out of the room. 3. I thought it was very rude of him just to ………………off like that without saying goodbye. 4. Would you like me to come and …………………you off at the station? 5. I thought I’d ………………..off fairly soon – I’ve got to get up early tomorrow, but thank you for a lovely party. 6. I was so tired that I just …………………off in front of the television. 7. You mustn’t forget to …………………off that birthday card this afternoon. 8. A large crowd gathered to watch the rocket………………….off. 2. Replace the underlined words in these sentences with phrasal verbs: 1. It won’t take her long to do the letters you asked her to do. 2. I often fall asleep in boring lectures. 3. Let’s try and leave quietly before the others wake up. 4. In the middle of a long speech the actor suddenly stopped and ran off the stage. 5. I’ve put all the students’ exam results in the post. 6. The school disco has given her quite negative feelings about discos in general. 7. Tell that boy in our front garden to leave at once – he’s annoying the dog. 8. Fortunately, he didn’t take the criticism of his acting seriously. 3. Answer these questions using full sentences: 1. If someone criticized your hairstyle would you laugh it off or get very upset? 2. What kind of programmes are most likely to make you doze off in front of the television? 3. If you go on a journey on your own, who usually sees you off? 181 4. Can you run off an English essay quickly or does it take you a long time to do? 5. Why might a lecturer break off in the middle of a talk? 6. If you plan to slip off during a party, how are you intending to go? 7. If someone tells some children to ‘clear off’, how do you think that person probably feels about the children? 8. Name something that might put you off eating your dinner. 4. Rewrite these sentences using a phrasal verb that means the opposite of the underlined verb. Many any other necessary changes so that the sentences make sense. 1. I’m going to meet James at the airport tomorrow. 2. I’ve just received a letter from Pauline. 3. The rocket is due to land tomorrow at noon. 4. I hope I’ve managed to interest him in the idea of redecorating the house. 5. I woke up when all the others went off to play tennis. 6. We’re planning to arrive in the early evening. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS - VOLCANIC ERUPTIONS55 There is increased danger of fresh mudflows from Mount Araramo, according to the latest reports from Anturia. Eruptions reached a height of 2.5 miles yesterday as the volcano entered its eleventh week of violent activity, despite vulcanologists’ predictions that it was subsiding. Mt. Araramo, dormant for three centuries, erupted for the first time this year on June 9th with the strength of a 20-megaton hydrogen bomb. That upheaval sent rocks and plumes of hot ash twelve miles into the air. Large amounts of lava have already been released and molten rock is continually oozing out of cracks in the ground. Large pieces of floating pumice were found on the surface of 55 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 182 the ocean 150 miles south of Mt. Araramo indicating a simultaneous underwater explosion. Thousands of trees snapped like twigs seconds after the initial blast. Superheated gases melted ice and snow on the upper parts of the mountain which resulted in an avalanche of boiling water and mud. Dust reached as far as 4,000 miles, lengthening the glow of sunsets by almost two hours. Massive amounts of CO2 released into the atmosphere are believed to be adding substantially to the greenhouse effect already threatening our planet. One hundred people are said to have perished in various volcano-related incidents. Some were killed by poisonous gases, others were buried alive by twelve feet of volcanic ash, or hit by falling rocks. Forty thousand villagers have already fled the area as heavy rains threaten to send more mud and debris further down the mountain slopes. Several hundred cattle were killed and 100,000 acres of crops destroyed. The damage is estimated to be in excess of two hundred million Anturian dollars. The world experiences an average of thirty major eruptions each year from more than six hundred active volcanoes. Others, though believed to be extinct because of centuries of dormancy, may be only waiting to thunder back to life. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Mount Araramo, in Anturia, is still active. 2. Vulcanologists had expected the volcano to continue to erupt for a much longer period. 3. The last time it erupted was three hundred years ago. 4. The pumice found floating on the ocean’s surface came from Mt. Araramo. 5. Mt. Araramo is wooded and was covered by snow at the time of the eruption. 6. The effects of the eruption could be seen thousands of miles away. 7. Volcanic eruptions are responsible for the greenhouse effect. 8. One hundred people were killed by falling rocks. 9. What the villagers fear are mudflows rather than other eruption-related dangers. 10. An active volcano is one that has major eruptions. 11. If a volcano is extinct, it means that it will never erupt again. 183 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B active......... activity boiling......... amounts floating......... ash heavy......... blast hot........... explosion initial.......... gases large.......... pumice molten........ rains superheated......... rock underwater............ volcanoes violent............. water 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: TO – MT. ARARAMO – MORE – ACTIVITY – BRING – FROM – VOLCANIC – DESTRUCTION – STILL ………………………………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: -potrivit relatărilor recente: -a.................. t................. l.................... r....................... -a atinge înălţimea: -r.................... a h...................... -activitate vulcanică violentă: -v..................... v.................... a...................... -a exploda cu forţa unei bombe: -e................... w................... a s........................ o....................... a b............................ -a contribui în mod considerabil: -a......................... s........................... -îngropat de viu: -b..................... a........................... -a părăsi în grabă zona: -f................... the a.......................... 184 -pagube care depăşesc valoarea x: -d.................. is i..................... e...................... of x -secole de inactivitate: -c.................... o.............. d...................... 185 LESSON 13 *Grammar: Questions (1)* Vocabulary: General – Travel and Holidays* Phrasal Verbs: On and In* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Gas Poisoning *** I. GRAMMAR - QUESTIONS56 - in questions, we normally put an auxiliary verb before the subject. Have you seen Isabel? Why are those men laughing? When can I pay? - if there is no auxiliary verb, we use do. What does ‘gaunt’ mean? - we do not use do with other auxiliaries or with be. Can you tell me the time? - after do, we use the infinitive without to. What does she want? Did you go out last night? 1. Correct the mistakes: E.g.: How you pronounce ‘write’? do you 1. She is happy? ........................... 2. What he thinks? ………………... 3. Did you saw Max? ………………... 4. Where can I to sit down? ………………... 5. When the bus leaves? ………………... 6. Do you can speak Arabic? ………………… 7. What means ‘vast’? ………………… 56 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011 186 8. Where you went? ………………… 9. Why she is crying? ………………… 10. What I must to do now? ………………… - we only put an auxiliary verb before the subject, not the whole verb. Is your father coming tonight? Where are the President and his family staying? 2. Make questions: E.g.: The 7.30 train for London leaves from platform 2. Does the 7.30 train for London leave from platform 2? 1. Jane and her mother will be staying in Ireland. Will……………………………………………………………………………... 2. John and Susan want to play golf on Saturday. Do………………………………………………………………………………. 3. The Sunday newspapers have arrived. Have……………………………………………………………………………. 4. The secretary from the accounts office has telephoned. Has……………………………………………………………………………… 5. The big man with the grey beard said something. What…………………………………………………………………………… - note that do may come twice in questions: as an auxiliary verb and as a main verb. What does your father do? What did you do at university? - common question expressions before nouns: what colour, what size, what make of, what sort/kind/type of What colour eyes has she got? = What colour are her eyes? What size shoes do you wear? What make of car did you buy? 187 What sort of music do you like? What time does the train get in – NOT at what time 3. Complete the questions with a suitable expression: E.g.: What colour curtains shall we have in the kitchen? 1. …………………………………………………………………...jeans do you wear? 2. ………………………………………………………………..hair has the baby got? 3. …………………………………………………………………..books do you read? 4. ………………………………………………….mountain bike do you recommend? 5. …………………………………………………………………….food do you like? - note the difference between how? and what….like? #we use how? mostly to ask about things that change – moods, health, work #we use what….like? mostly to ask about things that don’t change – people’s character and appearance ‘How’s Joe?’ ‘He’s very well.’ ‘What’s Joe like?’ ‘Tall, good-looking, a bit shy’. ‘How does she seem today?’ ‘Much happier’. ‘What does your sister look like?’ ‘Short, dark and cheerfullooking.’ 4. Make questions with how? or what….like?: E.g.: (your flat) What’s your flat like? ‘Small and comfortable’. 1. (the new teacher)…………………………………………………..‘Not much good.’ 2. (your mother?) ………………………………………………………..‘Fine, thanks.’ 3. (work going?) ……………………………………….‘Not very well at the moment.’ 4. (business?) ………………………………………………………………...‘Terrible.’ 5. (Anne’s boyfriend?)………………………………………………….‘Not very nice.’ 188 6. (school?)……………………………………………...………….‘Much better now.’ 7. (Manchester?) ………………………………………….. ‘An interesting place.’ 8. (things at home?) …………………………….................................‘Ok, I suppose.’ 9. (your village) ……………………………………………………..‘Very quiet.’ 10. (the neighbours) ……………………………………………….…‘A bit strange.’ - Yes/no questions -asking for information Are you ready? – Yes, nearly. / No, not quite. Has anyone seen my bag? – Yes, it’s on the chair./ No, I don’t think so. - other uses Shall we eat out tonight? – making a suggestion Can/Could you write the address down for me, please? – requesting Can I carry something for you? – No, it’s OK, thanks – offering Would you like to come to a party? – Yes, I’d love to. – inviting May I use your phone? – Yes, of course. – asking permission 5. Write down the use of each question. Choose from these uses: asking for information (x3), asking permission, inviting, making a suggestion, offering, requesting (x2) E.g.: Could you post this letter for me? requesting Can we get a number 35 bus from this stop? asking for information 1. Can I help you with those bags? ……………………….. 2. Shall we stop for a rest? ……………………….. 3. Is it Tuesday today? ……………………….. 4. Could you wait a moment, please? ……………………….. 5. Would you like to have tea with us? ……………………….. 189 6. Will your friend be here next weekend? ……………………….. 7. May I sit down? ……………………….. 6. What would you say in these situations? E.g.: You want to know if Mark has been to Los Angeles. Ask Sarah. Has Mark been to Los Angeles? 1. You aren’t sure if Rachel and Vicky are going to America. Ask them. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 2. You want to know if Laura plays tennis. Ask Trevor. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. You are wondering if Claire enjoyed her holiday. Ask her. …………………………………………………………………………………. 4. You want to suggest to Rachel that you both go for a walk. …………………………………………………………………………………. 5. You need to know if David will be at the club tonight. Ask him. …………………………………………………………………………………. - short answers – Yes, it is./ No, it isn’t. QUESTION SHORT ANSWER Auxiliary Pronoun Auxiliary Are you working tomorrow? Yes, I am Has Emma got a computer? Yes, she has Will I need my passport? Yes, you will Did they repair your phone? Yes, they did QUESTION SHORT ANSWER Auxiliary Pronoun Auxiliary the photocopier working now? No, it isn’t Have the children gone to sleep? No, they haven’t Will there be food at the party? No, there won’t. Is 190 Does this train stop at Derby? No, it doesn’t - to answer a request, suggestion, etc, we normally use a phrase like ‘Yes, of course’ or ‘Yes, please’ rather than a short answer. If we answer in the negative, we have to give some explanation Request: Could you help me move these chairs, please? Yes, of course. I’m afraid I’m rather busy. Suggestion: Shall we have a coffee? Yes, OK. Sorry, I can’t. I have to go. Offer: Can I give you a hand? Yes, please. That’s very kind of you. It’s OK, thanks. I can manage. Invitation: Would you like to come to the barbecue? Yes, please. I’d love to. I’d love to, but I’ll be away. 7. Which would normally be the best answer? E.g.: Are you busy today? a) Yes, busy./ b) Yes, I am. 1. Is it too hot in here for you? a) No, it isn’t./ b) No, I’m fine, thanks. 2. Do you know Emma? a) Yes./ b) Yes, we live in the same building. 3. Tell me, did you steal my money? a) No./ b) No, I didn’t steal your money. 4. Do you live on the campus? a) Yes, I do./ b) Yes, I live on it. 5. Would you like to come out with us for the day? a) Yes, I would like./ b)Yes, please. 6. Is it the eighteenth today? a) Yes, it is./ b) Yes, it is the eighteenth of November today. 7. Did you bring my CD? a) No./ b) No, sorry. I forgot it. 8. Can I carry your bags? a) No, you can’t./ b) It’s all right, thanks. 191 II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – TRAVEL AND HOLIDAYS57 1. Decide which answer best fits each space: Holidays Most people enjoy going (1) out/forward/abroad/foreign for their holidays, and having the opportunity to (2) remain/pass/spend/stay in an interesting city or a seaside (3) resort/post/too/one. If you speak (4) strange/stranger/foreigner/foreign languages, you can make new friends, and (5) fetch/take/go/get home some interesting (6) memories/souvenirs/memoirs/recollections as presents. But before you can do that, you have to (7) reach/arrive/go/travel your destination, and that is often a problem! If you fly, then you may find that your flight has been (8) waited/reversed/ delayed/booked. (9) Journeys/Travels/Voyages/Passes by train can also be difficult, since trains are often (10) filling/occupied/overdone/crowded in the summer, and you might have to reserve a (11) post/chair/seat/position in advance. Whichever way you (12) voyage/travel/trip/tour, you can have problems with your (13) baggages/luggage/goods/sacks, and it is often difficult to find good (14) staying/homes/lodges/accommodation. Apart from this, you might not be able to afford the (15) fare/fair/far/fur. 2. Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: after down for off in out up a) The car broke down in the mountains, and we couldn’t find a garage. b) James had to set…………………………………….at dawn to catch the early train. c) Sue’s bike passed me, and I had to ride fast to catch………………………with her. d) I arrived at the airport, checked ……………………….., and then had some coffee. e) We were heading …………………....Paris, but we were not in a hurry to get there. f) Jill ran ………………………………..of money after a week, and had to go home. g) Our next-door neighbours looked …………………...our dog while we were away. 57 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 192 3. Complete each sentence with a word formed from the word in bold: a) They told me to ask at the information desk. inform b) The plane gathered speed as it roared along the …………… run c) The ……………………of our plane has been delayed. depart d) The plane made a bumpy ………………….and I felt ill. land e) The clerk asked me if I had made a …………………. reserve f) I got a seat because of another passenger’s ………………… cancel g) We arrived late at the ………………, and missed the plane. air h) We fastened our seatbelts and prepared for ……………….. take 4. Complete each part sentence (a-j) with one of the endings (1-10) and make a compound word: a) I sent my friend a post …… 1. suit with you to the beach. 7 b) I fastened my seat…………. 2. table turned out to be wrong. c) We stayed on a small camp ……….. 3. belt, and waited for takeoff. d) I always forget my guide………….. 4. port, you must tell the police. e)Don’t forget to take your swim 5. hiking can be dangerous. …………. f) If you lose your pass………. 6. side when I was little g) We stayed in a quiet guest………. 7. card of the town where I stayed. h) The train time………….. 8. book when I visit old cities. i) I used to like going to the sea………. 9. house down the river. j)Nowadays I’m afraid that hitch……… 10. site just outside the town. 5. Choose the correct word in each sentence: a) In Greece we visited several ancient/antique temples. b) Whenever Lucy travels by boat she feels seasick/dizzy. c) Holidays in the mountains are always more relaxed/relaxing. 193 d) We always eat the local/topical food when we’re abroad. e) On my summer holidays I like getting suntanned/sunburnt. f) It may not be easy to find accommodation at reasonable/logical prices. g) After cycling all day, Bill was completely exhausted/tired. h) The owner of the hotel gave us a hospitable/warm welcome. i) Jack likes spending most of his holiday in the open/plain air. 6. The words in italics are in the wrong sentences. Find the correct sentence for each one: a) We spent two weeks in a lovely seaside station. resort b) Jim stayed the night in a small bed and hostel. …………… c) Karen was exhausted after her fifteen-mile holiday. …………… d) Martin and Carol had a great time on their camping cards. …………… e) As it was cheaper, I bought a return stop. ………….... f) We managed to find some petrol at a remote filling village. …………… g) The bus made an overnight breakfast in a town near the border. …………… h) The family rented a cottage in a country walk for the summer. …………… i) If you’re a student, you can save money by staying in a youth ticket. …………… j)David never carried cash on holiday. He always takes credit resort .………………………………………………………………………………............ VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS – ON AND IN58 A. ON *On in phrasal verbs sometimes has a clear link with the basic physical meaning of on. Never buy shoes without trying them on! [putting a piece of clothing to see whether it fits and whether you like it] 58 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 194 Ray: Do you think Dan’s really feeling better or is he just putting on a brave face? [pretending to have a particular feeling or behave in a way that is not real or natural for you] Joe: No, I think he’s fine now. I don’t think his cheerfulness is put-on. [pretend or not genuine] Sam: I’ve got something weighing on my mind at the moment. Could you give me some advice? [worrying, upsetting] Deb: No problem. Tell me all about it and I’ll do what I can. *On is also used with verbs where there is an idea of dependence. You can always rely/depend/count on Jim! [be confident that someone will help you] *On in phrasal verbs also often contains an idea of further. Just because you’ve failed one driving test, you mustn’t stop having lessons. You must keep on trying. [continue to do something] When you’ve finished with the magazine, just pass it on to someone else [give] B. IN phrasal verb meaning example call in visit a place or person for a Please call in and see us when short time, usually when you you are next in town. are going somewhere else take sth in or make a piece of clothing This skirt is too big for me now – take in sth narrower I’ll have to take it in rub sth in or put a substance on the surface Rub the cream in gently with the rub in sth of something and rub it so that tips of your fingers. it goes into the surface lock sb in or prevent someone from leaving Make sure you leave the office 195 lock in sb a room or building by locking by 6.30 p.m. or you’ll be locked the doors in. push in rudely join a line of people It’s so annoying when people (informal) who are waiting by going in push in at the bus stop. front of some of the people who are already there start to be believed (used about Be patient with Jenny – it’ll take sink in something unpleasant or a long time for the terrible news surprising, which usually has to sink in. implications) 1. Rewrite the underlined parts of these sentences using phrasal verbs: 1. I read the gardening article you gave me then gave it to a friend who’s also interested in plants. 2. Do you think she’s really angry, or do you think she’s just pretending? 3. He looks very pale and tired. Something is clearly worrying him. 4. It’s a lovely jacket. See if it fits you and how it looks on you. 5. I’m not going to stop working until I’ve finished this report. 6. You can be sure that Brian will be there when you need him. 2. Look at these remarks by different people and the read the statements 1-5 below. If the statement is true, tick (v) the box. If the statement is false, put a cross (x) in the box and explain why it is false: Richard: I was working late and didn’t realise it was 8 p.m. The main door out of the office had been closed for the night and I had no key. Louise: I’ve got some mosquito bites. Have you got any cream that’ll stop them itching? Alice: My new skirt was far too loose so I reduced the waistband by three centimetres. 196 Bob: I’ve always been able to ask my parents to help me when I have had financial problems. Anwar: Oscar seems to be not answering his phone. I’ll tell him the news when I see him tomorrow. Jan: I’ve got a lot of problems which are worrying me at the moment. 1. Anwar has decided to keep on phoning Oscar. …………………. 2. Alice decided not to take her skirt in. …………………. 3. Jan has a number of things weighing on her mind. …………………. 4. Louise wants to rub in some cream. …………………. 5. Bob can’t really count on his parents’ support. ………………….. 6. Richard got locked in. …………………. 3. Correct the mistakes in these sentences. There is one mistake in each sentence: 1. Hey, that man just pushed on – that taxi should have been ours! 2. Mary’s bad news has been weighing my mind on all day. 3. I need time for to sink in the news. 4. I couldn’t leave the room because someone had locked me out. 5. Phrasal verbs may seem hard but you must keep upon trying. 6. You’ll never guess who called at the office in today! III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS – GAS POISONING59 A geological explosion cracked the bottom of a volcanic lake in a remote region of northern Arehon two days ago, releasing a cloud of toxic gas that is estimated to have killed at least 1,200 people. The casualty figures are incomplete and the death toll may be much higher. The gas is believed to have escaped at night. The wind blew the toxic fumes over villages scattered on the hillside, and caught people in their sleep, in several cases wiping out whole families. The cloud, a mixture of 59 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 197 unspecified lethal gases of volcanic origin, was apparently trapped in the sediment at the bottom of the lake and might have been released by a small tremor. It then rose to the surface and exploded. Although the gas is said to have dispersed by now, many residents have fled the area, fearing for their lives. A relief operation is now under way. Hundreds of people injured by the fumes are being treated in hospitals, which are ill-equipped to deal with the blistered and paralyzed survivors. The site has been isolated and army teams are searching the foursquare-mile disaster area for more victims. As the temperature soars, the soldiers have been instructed to bury the dead immediately in mass graves so as to head off the threat of epidemics. A stench of decay hangs in the air while the decomposing animal bodies have already contaminated the water supply, endangering the lives of those who refused to be evacuated. The disaster reportedly caused unprecedented emotion among the tragedystricken population and the evacuees were offered all that was available. The President has called for international assistance to cope with the catastrophe. Several countries have already responded to the call and offered to fly in help, donations and supplies during the emergency. Doctors in many countries are on standby ready to fly to Arehon at three hours’ notice. An air-strip has been improvised to facilitate the relief operation. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. The gas was volcanic in origin. 2. It was released as a result of a volcanic eruption. 3. People did not realize what was going on. 4. The mixture consisted of carbon monoxide and hydrogen sulphide. 5. Most of the survivors had left the area in panic. 6. One can still smell the deadly gas in the air. 7. Those who were injured by the fumes have found expert help in local hospitals. 8. There was no time to bury the bodies separately. 9. There was no drinking water. 10.The inhabitants of Arehon have shown their generosity towards the victims of the calamity. 198 11.Doctors from other countries have already arrived in Arehon to assist their colleagues in the hospitals. 12.There was no airport in the affected region. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B blistered ……………….. explosion casualty …………………. figures death ………………….. fumes geological ………………… gases lethal ……………………… graves mass ……………………. lake relief ……………………… region remote …………………….. operation scattered ……………………… survivors toxic ………………………… toll volcanic …………………….. villages 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: PEOPLE – KILL – DEADLY – MYSTERY – IN – 1,200 – FUMES – DRAMA ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. Phrases to learn: -a elibera un nor de gaz: - r…………….. a c………………. o………….. g………….. - cifrele sunt incomplete: - f……………. are i………………… - a-i surprinde pe oameni în timpul somnului: - c……………. p……………… i…… their s……………… - gaz de origine vulcanică: - g………… of v……………. o………………. 199 -acţiunea de salvare este în toi: - the r…………… o………….. is u…………. w………. - a-i trata pe cei care au suferit leziuni: - t…………… the i……………….. - a izola locul accidentului: - i……………… the d……………. s………………….. -a înlătura pericolul epidemiei: - h…………. o………… the t…………… of e……….. -a solicita ajutor international: - c………….. f……………. i…………. a……………… - populaţia afectată de nenorocire: - t…………. –s……………. p…………….. - la trei ore de la notificare: - a three h………….. n……………. - a facilita acţiunea de salvare: - f…………… a r…………… o………….. 200 LESSON 14 *Grammar: Questions (2) * Vocabulary: General – Work and Employment * Phrasal Verbs: Down and Over* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Surrogate Motherhood *** I. GRAMMAR – QUESTIONS (2)60 *Wh – questions - question word + auxiliary verb + subject QUESTION WORD AUXILIARY SUBJECT VERB What is Kitty doing? Where have you put the map? When can we travel safely? QUESTION WORD AUXILIARY SUBJECT VERB Where do people meet? How does the radio work? What did the guerrillas say? - question phrases – what, how What time is your friend arriving? - Half past eight. What kind of/ What sort of club is it? – A nightclub. How often do you go out? – About once a week, usually. How long will the meeting last? – An hour or so, I expect. How much money did you spend? – About a hundred pounds. What colour is your toothbrush? – Yellow. How old is your sister? – She’s twenty. How far is the beach? – Only five minutes’ walk. How many televisions have you got? – Three. 60 John Eastwood. Oxford Practice Grammar. OUP, 2011. 201 1. What would you say in these situations? E.g.: You are talking to a man at a party. Ask him where he works. Where do you work? 1. You want to know what the date is today. Ask your friend. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 2. You’ve forgotten when the course finishes. Ask your friend. ………………………………………………………………………………………. 3. Your friend is having a party. You’d like to know who he has invited. Ask him. ………………………………………………………………………………………. 4. Your favourite band are going to give a concert. Ask how you can get tickets. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 5. You are in town with a friend, and you are wondering where the two of you are going to have lunch. What do you ask? ………………………………………………………………………………………. 2. Guy is interviewing a guest on his chat show. It’s the actress Melissa Livingstone, who is in the TV soap opera ‘Round the Corner’. Put in Guy’s questions: Guy: How often do you record ‘Round the Corner’? Melissa: Oh, we record it every day. It’s a full-time job, you know. 1. Guy: Melissa: 2. Guy: Melissa: And …………………………………………………………it? In Birmingham, at the BBC studios. ………………………………………………………………… How many? Well, let me see, I think we’ve done a thousand programmes. 3. Guy: Melissa: ………………………………………………………………….. I’m not going to tell you. How much money I earn is my business. 202 4. Guy: Melissa: 5. Guy: Melissa: OK, I’m sorry. …………………………………………………. Oh, a long time ago. I started acting when I was twelve. …………………………………………………………………... My plans for the future? I just want to go on with ‘Round the Corner’. - subject/object questions – who, what SUBJECT OBJECT Who rang you? Who did you ring? (Someone rang you.) (You rang someone.) Who is helping you? Who are you helping? (Someone is helping you.) (You are helping someone.) What will happen next? What will they do next? (Something will happen next.) (They will do something next.) Who was talking to you? Who were you talking to? (Someone was talking to you.) (You were talking to someone.) What wine goes with fish? What does this colour go with? (Some wine goes with fish.) (This colour goes with something.) - subject/object questions – which, whose, how many, how much SUBJECT OBJECT Which program will work best? Which program will you use? (One of the programs will work best.) (You will use one of the programs.) Whose dog is barking over there? Whose dog is Melanie walking? (Someone’s dog is barking over there.) (Melanie is walking someone’s dog.) How many people came past? How many people did you see? (Some people came past.) (You saw some people.) How much oil got into the river? How much oil did you buy? (Some oil got into the river.) (You bought some oil.) 203 3. Read about the situations and answer each question in a single phrase: E.g.: The morning after his party, Tom was cleaning up. David came along and took away some empty bottles for him. Nick had just woken up after spending the night on Tom’s sofa. He watched them for a while. a) Who helped Tom? – David b) Who did Nick help? - No one. 1. Nick wants to marry Rita. She’s been out with him a few times, but really she’s in love with Tom. Unfortunately he isn’t in love with her. a) Who is Nick in love with? - …………… b) Who is in love with Tom? - ……………….. 2. Mark met Sarah at the airport. The plane was two hours late. On the way out they passed Mike standing at a bus stop, but they didn’t notice him. a) Who met Sarah? - …………… b) What was Mike waiting for? - …………….. 3. There was an accident at the crossroads. A lorry crashed into a van that was waiting at the lights. The van slid forward and crashed into a car. The van driver had to go to hospital. a) What hit the van? - …………… b) What did the van hit? - ………………… 4. Harriet is visiting her grandmother, Mrs Evans. It’s Mrs Evans’s birthday. She can’t hear very well, and she sometimes gets confused. Complete her questions: Harriet: Mrs Evans: So ten people have sent cards. Pardon? How many people have sent cards? I met David’s friends yesterday. What? Whose friend did you meet? 204 1. You can keep those photos. Photos? Which………………………….. 2. Those flowers look lovely. Do they? Which…………………………. 3. Fifty pounds went missing. Missing? How much…………………….. 4. I passed Mark’s house earlier. Pardon? Whose …………………………. 5. The doctor has four children. Really? How many……………………… 6. Doctors earn lots of money. I don’t know. How much……………….. 7. Mike’s uncle has died. What’s that? Whose…………………….. 8. Trevor’s wife is coming later. Oh? Whose……………………………… 5. Choose the correct form61: E.g.: Who works/does work in that office? What means catalyst?/ does catalyst mean? 1. What caused/did cause the explosion? 2. How many people came/did come to the party? 3. What sort of music helps/does help you to relax? 4. What mean you/do you mean? 5. Who told/did tell you? 6. What happened/did happen to your arm? 7. Which car costs/does cost more? 8. What colours suit/do suit your best? 9. What says the letter/does the letter say? 6. Make questions. Ask about the words in italics: E.g.: a) Sam loves computers. b) Sam loves computers. a) Who loves computers? b) What does Sam love? 1. (a) Alice broke her arm. (b) Alice broke her arm. ……………………………... ………………………………… 2. (a) Paul found a necklace. (b) Paul found a necklace. …………………………… ………………………………… 61 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 205 3. (a) The bomb destroyed a school. (b) The bomb destroyed a school. …………………………….. ……………………………….. 4. (a) Fred lost the map. (b) Fred lost the map. ……………………………. ………………………………….. 5. (a) Julie teaches Japanese. (b) Julie teaches Japanese. ……………………………. ………………………………….. - prepositions in questions – what + for/about62 What are you looking for? (You are looking for something) What are you worrying about? (You are worrying about something) - in the same place as in a statement: looking for, worrying about; in more formal English – the preposition – before the question word In which warehouse were the goods stored? (more formal) Which warehouse were the goods stored in? - in formal English – preposition + whom From whom did you obtain the information? (formal) Who did you obtain the information from? Who are we waiting for? – Rachel. What’s Nick laughing at? – Oh, one of Tom’s jokes. Where are you from?/ Where do you come from? – Sydney. What kind of holiday are you interested in? – A package holiday. Who did you go out with last night? – Just a friend. - what….for, what….like - purpose - what….for What did you buy this computer magazine for? To read about business software. What are these bricks for? We’re going to build a wall. 62 John Eastwood. Oxford Practice Grammar. OUP, 2011. 206 What are they digging the road up for? They’re repairing a gas pipe. = Why - something is good/bad/interesting/boring - what….like What was the party like? Oh, we had a great time. What’ s the place like where you live? It’s pretty quiet. - look like What does your friend look like? She’s very tall and blond. - someone’s well-being - how How are you? I’m OK, thanks. And you? How are you getting on in your new job? I’m really enjoying it. - compare: How’s Melanie? Oh, she’s fine, thanks. (She is happy/ in good health.) What’ s Melanie like? She’s very nice. (She’s a nice person.) 7. Put in the question. Use what and put the preposition in brackets at the end: Melanie: Tom is smiling. He’s pleased. (about) David: Yes, he is. What is he pleased about? 207 Laura: I’m busy today. I’m getting ready. (for) Trevor: What are you getting ready for? 1. Jessica: I’ve done something awful. I’m ashamed. (of) Andrew: 2. Trevor: Ilona: 3. Sarah: Claire: 4. Matthew: Daniel: 5. Vicky: Rachel: 8. Trevor ………………………………………………………………………….. Haven’t you heard of Kitty Beamish? She’s famous. (for) No, I haven’t. …………………………………………………………. Mark is annoyed. He’s going to complain. (about) ………………………………………………………………………….. Emma’s in a hurry. She’s going to be late. (for) ………………………………………………………………………….. I don’t feel very relaxed. I feel nervous. (about) ………………………………………………………………………….. has just come home from work. Complete the conversation. Put in for, how, like, what: Trevor: Hello, my love. How are you? Laura: Hello. I’m all right, but I’m in a bit of a rush getting ready for the barbecue. Trevor: Er, I forgot to tell you that I invited two more people. Laura: (1)…………………are you telling me now (2)…………..? I’ve bought all the food. I just hope there’s enough. Anyway, who are these people? (3)…………….are they (4)……………….? Trevor: They’re friends of Harriet’s. They’re very nice people. And after all, (5)……………are parties (6)…………….? To meet new people. Laura: It isn’t a party, it’s a barbecue. (7)……………..’s the weather going to be (8)……………? Trevor: The forecast said it’s going to be perfect. Warm and dry. Laura: Good. And (9) ……………was your day? Trevor: Oh, not too bad. Busy as usual. 208 9. Complete the conversation with two-word questions63: E.g.: ‘I’m writing a poem.’ ‘What about?’ ‘Lost love’ 1. ‘I’ve had a strange letter.’ …………………………………. ‘My American friend’. 2. ‘I’ve bought some chocolates.’ ……………………………………………... ‘You’. 3. ‘We’re thinking of moving.’ ……………………………………………... ‘Ireland’. 4. ‘Joanne’s in love again.’ …………………………………………… ‘A policeman’. 5. ‘Carola’ s got engaged.’…………………………………… ‘To my cousin Robert.’ - who, what, which64 + noun: What sport do you play? What books do you read? (wide choice of possible answers = lots of different sports) Which way do we go here? Which finger did you break? (limited nr of possible answers = only two or three ways) + possible answers Which café did you go to, Snoopy’s, the Coffee Pot or the Tea Gardens? Which phone shall I use, this one or the one in the office? +both possible What day/ Which day is your evening class? What platform/ Which platform does the train go from? What train/ Which train will you catch? What part/ Which part of Italy are you from? 63 64 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. John Eastwood. Oxford Practice Grammar. OUP, 2011. 209 - without a noun Who sent the fax? What do you think of our plan? Which is quicker, the bus or the train? - before a noun Which secretary sent the fax? + one, ones, of You can have a photo. Which one would you like? You can have some of the photos. Which ones…..? Which of these photos would you like? Which of the secretaries? -who = person Who did you see? (a person) - what = thing; person = before a noun What did you see? (a thing) What doctor/ What film did you see? -which = person or thing Which doctor/ film did you see? 10. The questions you are asking have a number of possible answers. If the list of answers is incomplete, ask a question with what. If the list is complete, use which: E.g.: (Do you play the piano, or the violin, or the guitar, or…..?) What musical instrument do you play? (Did you go to the Little Theatre or the Theatre Royal?) Which theatre did you go to? 210 1. (Did you take the morning flight or the afternoon flight?) ………………………………………………………………………………… 2. (Did you stay at the Grand Hotel or the Bristol?) ………………………………………………………………………………… 3. (Do you like classical music, or jazz, or rock music, or…..?) ………………………………………………………………………………… 4. (Did you buy ‘Time’ magazine, or ‘Newsweek’, or a computer magazine, or….?) ………………………………………………………………………………… 5. (Do you work for EuroChemicals, or ICM, or SenCo, or…..?) ………………………………………………………………………………… 6. (Are you learning English, or Spanish, or Arabic, or Japanese, or….?) ………………………………………………………………………………… 11. Rita is moving into a new flat. Trevor has come to see the flat and help her move in. Complete his questions. Put in what or which: E.g.: Trevor: What number is this building? Rita: Forty-two. 1. Trevor: I didn’t realize there were only three floors. ……………….floor is your flat on? Rita: The first floor. 2. Trevor: It’s a very nice flat. ……………………….room will be your living-room? Rita: This one here, I thought. 3. Trevor:……………………………………………..colour are you going to paint it? Rita: Oh, I don’t know yet. 4. Trevor:…………………….time is your furniture arriving? Rita: Three o’clock, they said. 5. Trevor: I’ll need some petrol. …………………..way is the nearest petrol station? Rita: Turn left at the end of the street. 211 12. Detectives Wilson and Taylor are looking into the murder of Lord Weybridge at his country house. Put in who, what, which: Wilson: Which of the guests in this house is the murderer, do you think, Taylor? Taylor: I don’t know yet. (1)……………… had the opportunity? (2) ……………. of the guests had the chance to do it? Wilson: (3) ……………happened after dinner last night? That’s what we have to find out. Taylor: There must be a motive for the murder. (4) ……………motive could the murderer have? Wilson: Love or money – they’re the usual motives. (5)…………..of them is it, I wonder? Taylor: (6)……………..did Lord Weybridge leave his money to? That’s the question, Wilson. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – WORK AND EMPLOYMENT65 1. Match each job in box A with a place in box B: A: cashier farmer hairdresser miner musician porter mechanic photographer pilot vicar garage studio kitchen hotel office surgery salon church dentist cook librarian waiter B: bank restaurant receptionist coal-mine cockpit field concert-hall library cashier/bank,…………………………………………………………………………… ………….......................................................................................................................... .......................................................................................................................................... 65 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 212 2. Match each job from the box with the sentence which best refers to the job: accountant chef firefighter carpenter estate agent plumber refuse collector vet a) Yesterday I had to give an injection to an injured bull. vet b) I get rather tired of picking up rubbish all day. ……….. c) I can help you sell your house. ……….. d) I can make new doors for the wardrobe if you like. ……….. e) Make sure that the fish is fresh by looking at the eyes. ……….. f) I’ll come round and replace all the pipes in the kitchen. ……….. g) Unless you keep the receipts you’ll pay more tax. ……….. h) The cause was either an electrical fault or a cigarette. ……….. 3. Which person from 1 and 2 above would you need in each situation? a) One of the radiators has burst and flooded your bedroom. plumber b) You have to carry a lot of heavy bags at the airport. ……….. c) You think you need three fillings. ……….. d) Your fringe is too long and you want a perm. ……….. e) The floorboards in the living room need replacing. ……….. f) Your pet goat has started sneezing. ……….. g) You have read the menu twice and you are feeling hungry. ……….. h) Your car makes a funny whistling noise. ……….. 213 4. Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use the words more than once: business job living work a) Jack makes his living working as a journalist. b) She has just left to go to ………………………………………………, I’m afraid. c) They worked very hard and now have their own ………………………………… d) There are still nearly two million people without ………………………………… e) The cost of …………………………………….has risen greatly over recent years. f) Stop interfering! This is none of your …………………………………………….. g) Lucy has a very good…………………………………in an international company. h) I can’t come out tonight. I’ve got too much ………………………………….to do. i) Some ……………………………….-men came and dug a hole in the road outside. j) An early………………………………………..by Picasso was sold for £3,000,000. 5. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: call draw fall get take come face fill go turn a) I think we should go over our plan again before we tell the managing director. b) Have you……………………...up with any ideas for advertising the new products? c) Our deal with the Chinese company may ……………….through, but we can sell the machinery to the German firm if necessary. d) You have to………………………………in this form, and return it to the manager. e) She didn’t ……………………………….on with her boss, so she left the company. f) If they don’t give us a better price, we’ll ………………………….down their offer. g) I’m afraid we have to ……………………..up to the fact that we are losing money. h) Our lawyers are going to ……………………………..up a new contract tomorrow. i) A multinational company is trying to ……………..over our firm, but we want to stay independent. j) We had to …………………..off the office party because of the economic situation. 214 6. Complete each sentence (a-h) with a suitable ending (1-8). Use each ending once: a) If you work hard, the company will 1. qualifications for a job of this kind. give you.....4 b) In a different job I could get a higher 2.advertisement in the local press on Friday. c) The best way to find new staff is to put 3.application for the job as soon as a/an…. possible. d) Because he had stolen the money, we 4.promotion decided that to a more responsible position. e)She has a pleasant personality but 5.references hasn’t got the right. from your previous employer. f) In the meeting we are going to discuss 6.dismissing him was the only possible the action we could take. g) I think it would be a good idea to send 7.salary and in your employment. h) We cannot give you the job without 8.appointment better of conditions a new of sales representative. 7. Use the word given in capitals to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: Leaving a job I recently left my job in an (ADVERTISEMENT) advertising agency after a disagreement with my boss. She accepted my (RESIGN)…………………but warned me that because of the (3) (ECONOMY) …………………situation, I might have to get used to the idea of being (4) (EMPLOY) …………………….for a while. I thought that she was trying to make a point, but after I had made over fifty (5) (APPLY) …………………..to other companies, I realised that she was right. Although I am a (6) (QUALIFICATIONS)………………………..designer, I didn’t receive any offers of a job. After that I tried working from home, but it was not very (7) (PROFIT) …………………… Then 215 I became an (8) (EMPLOY) ………………….. in a fast-food restaurant, even though my (9) (EARN) ……………………were extremely low. I wish I had accepted early (10) (RETIRE) …………………….from my old job. That is what I disagreed with my boss about! 8. Choose the right version: Choosing a job One of the most difficult decisions is choosing what to do for a (1) salary/living/ employee/work. For example, do you want to company/training/business/career, and (3) money/profit/cheque/salary the beginning, at follow a earn/gain/win/take but have definite a low good (2) (4) (5) hopes/prospects/futures/promotions in a company that trains its (6) employers/crew/ staff/persons? Or are you more interested in taking any kind of work, because you need a/an (7) money/cash/account/income? You may have to (8) face up to/go over/come up with/call off the fact that a good (9) work/labour/job/seat can be difficult to find. In that case, why not take a (10) temporary/overtime/profitable/short one? You will gain some useful (11) experiences/experienced/experience/ experiencing. Remember that even if you have the right (12) qualifications/exams/ letters/degrees, you may have to (13) fall through/get on/turn down/fill in lots of application forms before you are asked to (14) be/attend/make/advertise an interview. But don’t worry if you don’t know what you want to (15) work/job/do/employ exactly. You’ll enjoy finding out! VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS – DOWN AND OVER66 A. Different meanings of ‘down’ General meaning of example meaning of phrasal verb in example down move in the direction 66 We’ll have to chop/cut cut through it so that it falls to Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 216 of the ground down that old tree. It’s the ground dead. heaviness which We were weighed down carrying too much. causes difficulty with luggage, so we couldn’t run to catch the train. I was loaded down with carrying too many things. library books, so I took the bus home. put on paper Just take down the main write something, especially points, not everything the something that someone says lecturer says. I’ll write down your write something on a piece of phone number, or else I’ll paper, so that you do not forget forget it. it reduce a number or I’m taking these tablets to stop the number, level, or size amount, or not let it keep my blood pressure of something from increasing rise down. I’m trying to cut down on eat or drink less of a particular burgers and chips as I’ve thing, started to put on weight. stop an activity usually in order improve your health. The car factory has shut closed and stopped working down, and 2,000 people have lost their jobs. That nice Italian restaurant stopped doing business in town has closed down. What a pity! B. Over Read Ali’s e-mail to Karen about a report at work. 217 to Could you please read over [read something from the beginning to the end in order to find any mistakes or to understand it better] Philippa’s latest report and just look over [quickly examine something] the figures in the appendix? We can go over [talk or think about something in order to explain it or make sure that it is correct] it together when we meet tomorrow. Then I’ll add our comments and hand the whole thing over [give something to someone else] to the sales team. Listen to this answerphone message: Hi, mum. I’m staying over [spending the night somewhere rather than going home] at Sheila’s tonight – she’s a bit miserable because she didn’t win the tennis championship. I’m sure she’ll get over [recover from an illness or disappointment] it soon, though. She also fell over [fell to the ground] and hurt her knee quite badly. Anyway, I’ll see you tomorrow. Bye. 1. Read these sentences with phrasal verbs and answer the questions: 1. Jamie is weighed down with luggage. What do we know about Jamie’s luggage? 2. She’s trying to cut down on chocolate. Does she still eat chocolate? 3. Sid took down everything we said. Did Sid tape or write what was said? 4. The garage has shut down. Has the garage shut for the evening? 5. They chopped down the bushes in front of their house. Why might they have decided to do this? 218 2. Complete these newspaper headlines with the correct verbs from the box. Write the verbs in the correct form: chop cut go hand keep shut 1. Local café ………………………………………………down by health inspectors. 2. Doctors warn teenagers to……………………………………..down on cigarettes. 3. Rebel troops ………………………………………………………...over weapons. 4. Twenty oaks ……………………………………….down to make way for bypass. 5. Government promises to …………………………………………..down inflation. 6. Cabinet of ministers to …………………………….over report in detail tomorrow. 3. Answer these questions about phrasal verbs with down and over: 3.1. Match each of the phrasal verbs below with the correct general meaning of down from the table in A: a) I need a holiday. Stress and overwork are wearing me down. b) Let me note down your e-mail address on this slip of paper. c) A lot of fences blew down in the hurricane last night. d) The police are trying to crack down on street crime. e) The government is doing all it can to hold prices down. 3.2. Explain what these phrasal verbs with over mean in the sentences below: a) Sally is very good at putting her ideas over in meetings. b) I haven’t got enough room. Can you move over, please? c) Can you check over these figures for me, please? It’s important that there are no mistakes. d) Don’t put your glass of wine on the floor. Someone is sure to knock it over. e) Make sure the milk does not boil over. 219 III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS – SURROGATE MOTHERHOOD67 Commercial surrogate motherhood has created a legal stir. In full surrogacy, a fertilized egg is taken from one woman, physically unable to have a child, and implanted in the uterus of another, who agrees to bear it for an agreed sum of money. In other words, the commissioning couple leases the womb of the surrogate mother. Has a woman got the right to do this? Problems may arise when the father is the only true biological parent, donating his sperm to the surrogate mother. Occasionally, the surrogate mother changes her mind, claiming that the child is hers and that she wants to keep it. Who is the baby’s legal mother in such a case? Most children born under such contracts are wanted very much by the commissioning parents. Condemning surrogate motherhood is easy for those who are fertile, or wealthy enough not to have to consider offering their bodies for money. Whatever the outcome of the debate, it will always leave someone emotionally hurt. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. The courts are not certain how to rule in cases concerning surrogacy. 2. Full surrogacy involves one man and two women. 3. The commissioning couple are people who are buying another’s woman child. 4. When the commissioned child is born it goes to the woman who wants it more. 5.The childhood of commissioned children is often happier than that of other children. 6. Surrogate contracts may be a way of making money for some people. 7. The issue is too emotional to find a successful solution in the courts. 67 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol Educational, 2001. 220 2. Bucureşti: All 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B biological …………………. couple commissioning …………………. mother legal ………………………….. parent surrogate ………………………. stir 3. Rearrange the words to form the headlines to the story: CREATES – MOTHERHOOD – LEGAL – SURROGATE – QUESTIONS ……………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: - a produce o controversă (agitaţie): - c……………… a s………………… - incapabilă de a naşte un copil: - u…………… to h…………… a c………………. - a schimba intenţia: -c………….. one’s m………………… 221 LESSON 15 *Grammar: “It” and “There”; Place and Position * Vocabulary: General – Sport and Leisure * Phrasal Verbs: Around and About * Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Cosmetic Surgery *** I. GRAMMAR – IT AND THERE68 *Introducing new information - there – something exists: There are many possibilities. - something happens: There’s a football match every Saturday. - number or amount: There are twelve students in this class. - modals: There could/may/shouldn’t be a problem. There seems/ appears to be: There seems/ appears to be a mistake. - it – times, days, dates: It’s one o’clock. It’s Tuesday. - the weather: It’s raining. It rained all night. - opinions: It was a difficult choice. - adjectives: It’s strange that we’ve never spoken before. It looks like: It looks like the sun is going to come out this afternoon. It seems/appears: It seems/appears (that) our new teacher is Jane. => look + as if + subject + verb – It looks as if Carol has won. => look + like + noun phrase – She looks like a real champion. => seem/ appear (that) + subject + verb – It seems (that) the Brazilians are going to win. - It appears (that) one of the customers called the police. 68 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate. Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 222 *Referring back - something already mentioned. There is a shop at the end of the street. It is open every day. *Referring to a place - there A famous writer used to live there. Who is that over there? *it’s and its - it’s < it is/ it has - its < possessive form of it I like this hotel. It’s (= it is) comfortable and its restaurant is good. It’s ( = it has) got a lovely swimming-pool, too. *they’re and their - they’re < they are - their < possessive form of they Nancy and Dominique have arrived. They’re both wearing the same dress! Ask them to leave their coats in the hall. 1. Choose the correct word in each sentence: a) Are their/there any eggs in the fridge? b) It’s/Its really cold this morning. c) Peter says they’re/there arriving at about 5.00. d) I like this bike but its/it’s wheels are too small. e) Is there/they’re anybody their/there? f) It’s/Its a pity we missed the opening of the film. g) Patrick and Bridget have sold their/they’re house. h) What a lovely dog. What’s it’s/its name? 223 2. Put it or there in each space: a) There is a tree in the garden. It is an apple tree. b) …………………………looks as if…………………………………is going to rain. c) …………………………is strange that ……………are no restaurants in this town. d) ‘Who’s that at the door?’ ‘……………………………………………...is only me!’ e) ‘Which house is yours?’ ‘……………………….is the one at the end of the street.’ f) ……………seems to be something under the cupboard, but what is …………….? g) …………………appears that……………….was nobody…………when I phoned. 3. Rewrite each sentence, ending as shown, so that it has a similar meaning to the first sentence, and so that it contains it or there: E.g.: a) Near the hotel is a small restaurant. There is a small restaurant near the hotel. b) You went to Thailand for your holiday too, which is strange. ………………………………………………..to Thailand for your holiday too. c) My road has a big tree at the end of it. ……………………………………………………………………………..road. d) Brian seems to have left. …………………………………………………………………………..has left. e) Today is really cold! …………………………………………………………………………....today. f) Budapest is a long way from here. ……………………………………………………………………..to Budapest. g) Your torch hasn’t got any batteries in it. …………………………………………………………………………….torch. h) We appear to be lost again! ……………………………………………………………………….lost again! 224 - PLACE AND POSITION69 *in, inside, out, outside - in = something contained by something else There are some cups in that cupboard. -inside = same meaning; emphasis Luckily there was nobody inside the burning house. -out = away from the inside; not in the place where you usually are Close the door on your way out. I’m sorry, Kate’s not here right now. She’s out. (= she’s not at home) - outside = ‘out of a particular room or building, but still near it’. Kate’s outside in the garden. I’ll just call her. *Expressions with ‘in’ countries My parents are in Canada at the moment. (no article) cities My sister lives in Madrid. (no article) streets Jack lives in Garden Avenue. (no article) roads She was walking in the road, not on the pavement. ‘the mirror’ Tony could see his face in the mirror. ‘hole/crack in’ There was a hole in my shoe. ‘hand’ Ellen had a bunch of flowers in one hand. ‘armchair’ She sat in an armchair. ‘the country’ Paul and Mary live in the country, not in the city. ‘hospital’ Sally is ill and is in hospital. (no article) ‘prison’ Keith stole some money and ended up in prison. (no article) *Expressions with ‘on’ -a thing touching the surface of another thing Don’t leave your bag on the floor. There’s a photograph of London on the wall. 69 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate. Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 225 transport There were few passengers on the plane/bus/train. ‘chair’ She sat on a chair. ‘television’ What’s on television/the radio this evening? ‘wall’ Let’s hang this picture on that wall. injuries Tim cut his foot on a piece of glass. ‘left’/ ‘right’ There a cinema on the left. ‘side’ There are small houses on this side of the street. ‘pavement’ She was walking in the road, not on the pavement. *at, in, to at – general location at a point or place in – the name of a container, place or area – someone or something is inside it. We met at the airport. (the place in general) We met in the airport building. (inside the building) I’ll see you at the cinema. (the place in general) I’ll see you in the cinema. (inside the building) We arrived at Prague Airport. (the place) We arrived in Prague. (the city) to – + verbs of motion Last night we went to the cinema. Could you take this letter to the post office? I sent a parcel to my sister. at – ‘the beginning’/’the end’ There’s a café at the end of the street. ‘the front’/ ‘the back’ Do you sit at the front or at the back of the class? ‘school’ John isn’t at school. (no article) ‘home’ He’s at home. (no article) ‘work’ Mr King wasn’t at work yesterday. (no article) *above/below, over/under above/below = ‘higher/lower than’ You can see the top of the tower above the trees. 226 From the mountain, I could see the lake below. over/under = ‘directly above/below’ The alien spaceship hovered over the building. I keep my suitcase under my bed. = ‘across’ or ‘covering’ There is a footbridge over the motorway. (= across) There was a plastic sheet over the hole in the roof. (= covering) *next to/beside, near/by next to = ‘exactly at the side of’ beside = ‘more formal’ Maria sits next to Paula. Come and sit beside me on the sofa. near = ‘close to’ by = ‘at the side of’ – descriptions of rooms Tom’s house is near the sports center. There was a table by the window. He was standing by the door. We had a holiday near the sea. (close to the sea – a few kilometres away) *opposite ‘exactly on the other side of’ a space There is a baker’s opposite our house. 4. Choose the correct word in each sentence: a) There’s a small shop at/by the end of the road. b) Paula was standing on/with one foot. c) Laura has moved at/to Barcelona. d) Don’t walk at/in the road! It’s dangerous! e) From the plane we could see the mountains below/under. f) Brian spent his holiday at/in Hungary. g) When the horse came to a small stream it jumped above/over it. 227 h) Julia’s house is at/on the other side of the street. i) Lisa cut her foot at/on some broken glass. j) Tim was sitting in/on an armchair. 5. If the word underlined is not appropriate, write a new word in the space. Tick (v) the space if the word is correct: a) Jane’s sister has a job at Manchester Airport. V b) I met David yesterday by the city centre. ………. c) Ellen had a large hole at her left boot. ………. d) Jack sits in the back of the class. ………. e) There was a small table at the bed. ………. f) The robber was holding a gun in one hand. ……… g) There was a beautiful portrait hanging at the wall. ……… h) William didn’t feel well and his doctor sent him to hospital. ……… i) The children usually sit at the back of the car. ……… j) To reach our village we take a road above the mountains. ……… 6. Complete each sentence with one suitable preposition: a) Maria lives in Bellingham Road. b) Can you put the plates back ………………………………………..the shelf please? c) Please don’t stand ……………………………………………………….your desks! d) I’d really like to live …………………………………………………….the country. e) Go down this street, and you’ll see the cinema ……………………………the right. f) The police searched the building but there was no one …………………………….. g) I met Anna ……………………………………………………….the bus yesterday. h) Sorry, George isn’t here at the moment. He’s ……………………………………… i) Alice wants to know what’s ………………………………....television this evening. j) Just as Tom arrived ………………………………………..the bus stop, the bus left. 228 7. Complete each sentence with one suitable preposition: a) The statue was holding a sword in one hand. b) What’s on …………………………………………………...the cinema this week? c) When I look…………………………………..the mirror, I don’t recognize myself! d) What have you got ……………………………………………………….your bag? e) Pete found someone’s wallet …………………………………………the pavement. f) My family moved from the country…………………………………………the city. g) You’ve got a small hole ………………………………………………your pullover. h) The burglar climbed…………………………………..the fence and into the garden. 8. Choose the correct word or phrase in each sentence: a) Karen is living at/in London Street. b) Maggie sits by/next to Sally in the physics class. c) I want to send this letter at/to Brazil. d) When I opened the box, there was nothing in/inside. e) Exactly by/opposite the cinema, there’s a really good restaurant. f) We had a holiday in a small village by/near Monte Carlo. g) Paula lay down at/on the floor to do her exercises. h) We had a lovely meal in/on the plane. 9. Complete each sentence with one suitable preposition: a) Bye for now. I’ll see you at school tomorrow. b) We put a blanket ……………………………….the injured man to keep him warm. c) It’s not far. We’re getting …………………………………………………………... d) We found our cat hiding ……………………………………………………….a car. e) Daniel hung his coat …………………………………………….the back of a chair. f) I decided to go to the shops………………………………………………...my bike. g) What time is the news ……………………………………………………the radio? h) I decided to visit my grandmother ………………………………………….hospital. 229 II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – SPORT AND LEISURE70 1. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: handlebars racket rope glasses whistle saddle gloves rod net club costume ice a) When Brenda entered the swimming competition she bought a new costume. b) I learned to ride a horse without using a ……………………………………………. c) Gemma tried to hit the golf-ball with her ……………………………, but missed it. d) After the tennis match, one of the players jumped over the ………………………... e) Diana’s bike crashed into a tree, and she was thrown over the …………………….. f) A mountain-climber’s life may depend on their ……………………………………. g) Open-air skating can be dangerous if the ………………………………..is too thin. h) Peter put his ……………..in front of his face to protect himself from his opponent’s punches. i) Suddenly the referee blew his………………………and pointed to the penalty spot. j) Skiing can be dangerous if you don’t wear dark …………………………………… k) I had to play the doubles match with a borrowed ………………………………….. l) Terry went fishing with the new………………………………his parents gave him. 2. Match the words in the box with a suitable comment (a-h): billiards crossword gambling cards embroidery hiking draughts model-making a) Catherine dealt, and gave me the ace, king and queen of hearts. cards b) You need a small needle, and threads of different colours. ……………… c) I couldn’t do ten down, so I used the dictionary. ……………… d)Ian glued the parts together wrongly because he didn’t read the instructions. ………………………………………………………………………………….. e) When Ellen is losing, she knocks the pieces off the board. 70 ……………… Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 230 f) The path we want doesn’t seem to be on the map. ……………… g)Nigel missed the red, and put the pink in the pocket by mistake. …………………………………………………………………………………. h)I want to put $20 on ‘Ealing Comedy’ to win in the 4.30 at York. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. Choose the most suitable word: a) Sue came first in the 5000 metre competition/game/race. b) Jack and Eddie arranged to meet outside the football ground/field/pitch. c) Brenda goes jogging every morning to keep exercised/fit/trained. d) Our team beat/defeated/won the match by two goals to nil. e) The local stadium isn’t large enough for so many audience/viewers/spectators. f) I’m afraid I don’t find basketball very interested/interesting. g) The final result was a/an draw/equal/score. h) Norman won first media/prize/reward in the cookery competition. i) All competitors/rivals/supporters for the race should make their way to the track. j) Collecting matchboxes is Rebecca’s favourite leisure/occupation/pastime. 4. Replace the word or words in italics in each sentence with a word from the box: arranged outdoors record second referee side champion professionally captain score a) Mary plays tennis as a way of earning her living. b) Tomorrow’s hockey match has been put off for another time. postponed spare professionally ……………… c)In motor racing last year William Green was the best driver of all. ………………………………………………………………………………….. d) The player with the lowest number of points wins the game. ……………… e)A match between the two top teams has been fixed for next month. …………………………………………………………………………………. f) I like going swimming in my free time. ……………… g) Jane Briggs was the runner-up in the 100 meters hurdles. ………………. 231 h) Who is the player in charge of your football team? ………………. i)She won all her matches this season, which is a best ever performance. ………………………………………………………………………………….. j)Charles was sent off for punching the person who controls the match. ………………………………………………………………………………….. k)We decided to hold this year’s dancing competition in the open air. ………………………………………………………………………………….. l)Everyone agreed that United were the best team. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 5. Use the word given in capitals to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: How a hobby can make you angry! Recently I decided to take up (1) photography (PHOTOGRAPH) as a hobby. I like taking snaps, but I am not very (2) ………………..(SKILL). My snaps are either a complete (3) ……………….. (FAIL) for technical reasons, or are just not very (4)……………….. (IMAGINE). First I decided that to be (5) ……………….. (SUCCESS), I would have to buy new equipment. Just then I had an (6) ………………….. (EXPECT) piece of good luck. A friend who works in a camera shop said she could sell me a (7) ………………. (VALUE) camera. A customer had left it at the shop to be repaired, but there had been a (8) …………….. (UNDERSTAND), and it was actually for sale. I thought this was a rather (9) ………………. (BELIEF) explanation and so I asked her some more questions. She said she had had a (10) ………………. (AGREE) with the customer and he had thrown the camera at her because she disliked his photos! 6. Choose the most suitable word of phrase to complete each sentence: a) Mary stopped swimming and just sank/floated/dived/poured on the surface. b) Jack turned the last corner and approached/arrived/waited/ headed for the finishing line. 232 c) David was trying to overpass/overcome/overtake/overcharge another cyclist when he crashed. d) You have to chase/rush/jump/drop the person with the ball until you catch them. e) The fans climbed over the fence to avoid/prevent/abandon/refuse paying. f) I fell over while skiing and my sister had to bring/take/fetch/carry a doctor. g) It’s very easy to slide/skid/skate/slip over when the snow is hard. h) Don’t pass/cross/across/pass by the road until all the runners have gone by. i) The swimmers fell/crawled/rolled/leaned forward as they waited to begin the race. j) When I was hiking in the mountains, I tripped/stepped/surprised/carried on a snake. 7. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: anywhere dinner ready through back lost right together better off stuck used a) After Paul’s leg was injured, it took him a long time to get better. b) Unfortunately Sally rode her bike into the mud and got …………………………… c) Before the race I went to the stadium to get ……………………………………….. d) Some of the competitors got ………………………………because of the thick fog. e) I tried learning to do embroidery but I didn’t get …………………………………. f) She worked on her stamp collection and he got the ………………………………... g) I didn’t get …………………………from the match till late because of the crowds. h) David practised hitting the golf ball until he got it …………………………………. i) Kate enjoyed riding the horse but found it hard to get …………………………….. j) I tried to phone the tennis club but I couldn’t get ………………………………….. k) We have a great time whenever our rugby team gets ………………………………. l) I can’t get ……………………………………....to playing football on plastic grass! 233 8. Choose the right version: Sport Someone once said that there are three kinds of people who are (1) playing/really/interested/succeed in sport: people who (2) take/have/make/get part, people who watch, and people who watch (3) on/with/by/from television. It’s very easy to make fun of stay-at-home-sports (4) people/centres/programmes/fans, but on the other hand, television does enable us to enjoy all kinds of (5) the/future/sports/athlete events. We can watch a racing car (6) cross/overtake/or/ from another, see a cyclist (7) overtake/and/cross/professional the finishing line, or enjoy the goals of our favourite football (8) group/class/band/team. The first time I watched a tennis (9) match/it/which/that was on television, and I found it (10) valuable/ imaginatively/unexpectedly/real interesting. It’s not always easy to (11) trip/tour/ pass/travel long distances to football (12) areas/grounds/teams/fans, and television is a good solution. Of course, you can (13) or/which/get/is used to sitting indoors all the time, and this is dangerous. We should all try to (14) keep/make/do/have fit, and have other interests and (15) customs/habits/pastimes/leisure. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS: AROUND AND ABOUT71 Around and about are often interchangeable in phrasal verbs: both particles are equally possible with all the verbs in A below and with some of the verbs in B. Note also that round can sometimes replace around. Phrasal verbs with around and about often express the idea of acting in a relaxed way, without a particular purpose or without concentrating. Most of the verbs in this unit are informal. 71 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 234 A. Spending time: phrasal verb meaning example wait about / stay in one place without If you can wait around for about around doing anything as you wait an hour, we should be able to tell for something to happen you your results. laze about / relax and enjoy yourself For the first week of our holiday around by doing very little we usually just laze about on the beach. sit about/around spend time sitting down Please let me help you. I don’t like (somewhere) and doing very little hang about spend /around without doing very much time just sitting about all day. somewhere There are always a lot of rather (somewhere) suspicious-looking men hanging round outside the bar. (informal) mess about/ spend time playing or Tim spends his weekends messing around doing things with no around in the garage repairing particular purpose behave stupidly, things. waste The pupils were given extra time doing unimportant homework for messing around in things class. mess sb about / treat someone badly or He’s been messing her around for around (informal) waste their time, e.g. by ages and just won’t commit to the changing your mind or not relationship. doing what you promised lie about/around spend time lying down I hate the way he just lies around doing very little all day watching TV while I’m working. 235 B. Being in a place Fans were milling about/around/round the hotel hoping to see the film star and get her autograph. [walking around a particular place or area, usually while waiting for something] Meanwhile photographers and journalists were standing about/around/round chatting to each other. [spending time standing in a place waiting for someone or doing very little] Mick: Can you stick around this afternoon? [informal: stay somewhere for a period of time] If so, I’ll take you around/round the office and introduce you to the other secretaries if you like. [visit a place with someone showing them the most interesting or important parts] Anne: No, it’s all right, thanks. The boss has already shown me around/round. [gone with someone to a place that they have not visited before and shown them the interesting parts] 1. Match the verbs in the left-hand column with the best definitions in the right-hand column: 1. mess a) lie down doing very little 2. hang b) spend time sitting down and doing very little 3. lie c) relax, enjoy yourself and do very little 4. sit d) behave stupidly or waste time 5. laze e) spend time somewhere not doing very much Example: mess about/(a)round = behave stupidly or waste time ………………………………………………………………………………………….. …….................................................................................................................................. .......................................................................................................................................... .......................................................................................................................................... 236 2. Now use the verbs from exercise 1 to fill the gaps in these sentences. Write the verbs in the correct form and use each verb once only: 1. She just………….........around on the sofa all day reading magazines. I wish she’d get a job. 2. We could be…………………….round here for hours waiting for a taxi. Let’s walk. 3. After the meeting we were just ………………………..around chatting for a while. 4. My idea of a perfect weekend is just ………………..around at home with a good book. 5. I wish the kids would stop ………………….about. 3. Rewrite the underlined words in these sentences, using phrasal verbs: 1. Do you want to stay here after the meeting? I finish work at 5 p.m. and I could go with you and show you the most interesting places in the old town. 2. Nothing much happened at the demonstration. We just stood in one place not doing much and held our banners up. 3. They spend most weekends just doing things without much purpose in their boat; they don’t really sail it seriously. 4. On my first day, the boss went with me through the workshop and introduced me to various people I’d be working with. 5. At the drinks party people were just wandering here and there hoping to find someone they knew. 6. Look, I’m sorry, I don’t want to cause you problems and waste your time, but I wonder if we could postpone our meeting till next week? 237 4. Here are some other phrasal verbs with about/around. Read these sentences and try to explain in your own words what they mean: 1. I’ve got to go now but I’ll see you around. 2. Don’t order me about! I’m not your servant, you know. 3. Shop assistant: Customer: Can I help you? No thanks. I’m just looking around. 4. My suitcase got a bit bashed about on the plane. 5. He told the kids to stop fooling around. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS – COSMETIC SURGERY72 Clinics which perform corrective cosmetic surgery are enjoying a real boom as more and more people seek assistance in improving upon nature. The range of procedures available to meet the demand for the beautiful body is comprehensive, including both breast reduction and augmentation, facelifts, the elimination of wrinkles, “bat ear” correction and hair transplants to reverse baldness. One of the most common procedures reshapes the nose. Advertising leaflets claim that the nose is the key to a beautiful face; it is central to the way one feels about one’s appearance. They say that this procedure is a must to create “a new confident you”. Suction lipectomy is another intrusion into one’s own body for which there is considerable demand. This painful technique, otherwise known as the fat vacuum, involves removing the fat from the abdomen, bottom and/or thighs, sucking it off with a thin tube attached to a vacuum-cleaner type device. It does away with bulges, which are virtually impossible to eliminate through diet and exercise. However, this technique is a means of body contouring, not of weight reduction. The success of the operation depends on how elastic and resilient the patient’s skin is. Recuperation lasts a week and medication is prescribed to minimize discomfort. 72 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1, 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 238 Achieving physical perfection, that is, making essentially normal people look better merely for aesthetic purposes, may seem unethical. It could be argued that the money spent on such procedures, not to mention the surgeons’ time and efforts might be put to a better use. But for women, who make up almost all of the clinics’ clientele, the motivation behind the quest for a new look and an improved self-image is largely psychological. If some feature is discomforting enough to affect one’s mental wellbeing, the operation can be regarded as part of a psychiatric therapy. Still, unless real deformities justify surgery, it remains a matter of human vanity. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Very few people are dissatisfied with the way they look. 2. Corrective cosmetic surgery is solely intended for people who are disfigured because of an accident. 3. If a woman wishes so, she may have her breasts made to look bigger or smaller. 4. Nose reshaping is one of the most popular procedures. 5. If one wants to feel satisfied with one’s appearance a beautiful nose is essential. 6. Suction lipectomy is done with the use of a vacuum cleaner. 7. If one is too fat, suction lipectomy is the answer to his problem. 8. The success of suction lipectomy is not always guaranteed. 9. Some people maintain that medicine is meant to serve purposes other than corrective surgery. 10. Men are as much interested in corrective surgery as women are. 11.There are people who seek cosmetic surgery on the recommendation of their psychiatrists. 12. Corrective surgery is generally performed to make people happier. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B advertising …………………. feature aesthetic …………………….. leaflets 239 common ……………………… perfection comprehensive …………………… procedures corrective ………………………… purposes discomforting ……………………. range painful …………………………. reduction physical …………………………. surgery psychiatric …………………………. technique weight …………………………… therapy 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: POPULARITY – VANITY – OF – HUMAN – SURGERY – REFLECTS – INCREASED – COSMETIC ………………………………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: - a căuta ajutor: - s…………….. a……………….. - a corecta natura: - i……………… u…………….. n……………….. - a veni în întâmpinarea – m…………….. the d…………………. - o cerere considerabilă: - c………………. d…………………. - a scăpa de ceva: - d…………… a…………… w……………. something - a minimaliza proasta dispoziţie: - m…………. d………………… - atingerea perfecţiunii fizice: - a…………….. p…………. p………………. - în scopuri estetice: f……………. a…………….. p……………. - a găsi o mai bună utilizare: - p…………….. to a b………….. u…………….. - a avea influenţă asupra bunei dispoziţii a cuiva: - a……………. one’s w…………… - b…………….. - a considera drept……- r………….. a…………… -a justifica intervenţia chirurgicală: - j………………. s………………….. 240 LESSON 16 *Grammar: Revision – Purpose, Reason and Result, Contrast, Relatives, Questions, “It” and “There”, Place and Position * Vocabulary: General – Clothes and Appearance * Phrasal Verbs: For and With* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Teenage Gambling *** I. GRAMMAR – REVISION – PURPOSE, REASON AND RESULT, CONTRAST, FUNCTIONS, RELATIVE CLAUSES, QUESTIONS, ‘IT’ AND ‘THERE’, PLACE AND POSITION73 1. Choose the correct word of phrase in each sentence: a) We arrived early, so that we/in order to get tickets. b) It was too/enough long to wait, so we went home. c) Tim and Helen have arrived, and they’re/there waiting outside. d) The boy which/whose bike I borrowed had forgotten about it. e) We went to the beach for/so that a swim. f) Ann felt lonely because/so no one had invited her to the party. g) Despite/Although I felt tired, I worked until late. h) We spent a lovely holiday in/into the country. i) Yesterday was so/such cold that I stayed at home. j) However/In spite of the rain, we went for a walk. 2. For each question, complete the second sentence so that it means the same as the first, using no more than three words: E.g.: a) Although it was late, we decided to go for a walk. It was late but we decided to go for a walk. 73 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. Intermediate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 241 b) John is someone with whom I used to work. John is someone I …………………………………………………………with. c) The exam was so difficult that I couldn’t finish it. It was …………………………………...difficult exam that I couldn’t finish it. d) Although it was raining, we worked in the garden. Despite …………………………………………….., we worked in the garden. e) Let’s spend the afternoon at the beach. How………………………………………………...the afternoon at the beach? f) Ann’s house has got four large bedrooms. ……………………………………………four large bedrooms in Ann’s house. g) We might feel hungry, so we’ll take some sandwiches. We’ll take some sandwiches so that we ………………………….. feel hungry. h) The cat hasn’t come home, which is strange. ………………………………………………….that the cat hasn’t come home. i) Harry can’t afford to go on holiday. Harry hasn’t got ………………………………………………... to go on holiday. j) Where’s the National Museum? Would………………………………...telling me where the National Museum is? 3. Decide the correct answer: A case of mistaken identity When Diana got off the train, (1) who/there/whose/it was a woman waiting for her (2) below/to/on/in the platform. ‘(3) You Diana, are you?/You’re Diana, isn’t it?/Are you Diana?/You aren’t Diana?’ she asked. ‘(4) There’s/Theirs/Its/It’s a car waiting for you (5) out/in/inside/outside.’ Diana was not very surprised, (6) so/despite/to/as she thought that her aunt must have been (7) so/too/enough/marry busy to meet her (8) at/too/in/for the station. (9) However/Since/In spite of/Although she did not recognize the woman, (10) she/who/and/whose was dressed very formally, and had a small briefcase (11) at/in/under/by her arm, she was (12) enough/so/too/very tired after the journey that she was happy to get (13) with/by/at/into the car. The woman, (14) however/despite/although/in spite of, just said a few words to the driver, and then walked away. Diana wondered (15) whether//there/who/however she was. ‘It’s strange that she didn’t even introduce herself,’ she thought. 242 4. Complete each sentence with one suitable preposition: There was another woman (a) on the bus, and Kate sat (b)…………..her and started chatting. She said she was going (c) …………..Forbes Road too. ‘I’ve got an interview (d) ………….a place called Murcott House,’ said Kate. ‘Is it (e) ……………..the bus stop?’ ‘It’s not far. It’s (f) ……………..the right (g) ……………..the end of the street,’ the woman replied. ‘In fact, I live (h) ………………When I look out of my window, I can see people working (i) ……………’ When they arrived (j) ………….the stop, they got off and walked up the street together. 5. What would you say in these situations? E.g.: a) You want to know if Andrew has ever been to America. Ask him. Have you ever been to America? b) You want to know if Andrew has ever been to America. Ask Amanda. Has Andrew ever been to America? c) You want to know if Rita likes rap music. Ask Isabel. ………………………………………………………………………………… d) You want to know if Rita likes rap music. Ask her. ………………………………………………………………………………… e) You want to know if Nigel enjoyed the film. Ask him. ………………………………………………………………………………… f) You want to know if Nigel enjoyed the film. Ask Petra. ………………………………………………………………………………… g) You want to know if Maria is going to London next summer. Ask her. ………………………………………………………………………………… h) You want to know if Maria is going to London next summer. Ask Patricia. ………………………………………………………………………………… i) You want to ask Patricia if you can borrow her mobile phone. Ask her. ………………………………………………………………………………… j) You want to ask Patricia if she could lend you her mobile phone. Ask her. ……………………………………………………………………………….. 243 6. Complete each sentence, using the verb given where necessary: a) ‘(have got) You’ve got a book, haven’t you?’ ‘Yes, thanks.’ b) ‘They’ll be back by 6.00, …………………………………………………..?’ ‘I expect so.’ c) ‘(go)…………………………………………………..for a walk, shall we? ‘Good idea!’ d) ‘You (leave)………………………………………...now, are you? Stay a bit longer.’ ‘Sorry, I can’t. I have to catch the bus.’ e) ‘Jim and Sara have seen the film, …………………………………...?’ ‘Yes, I think so.’ f) ‘You can meet Helen at the station, ………………………….?’ ‘Yes, of course I can’. g) ‘(be)………………………………………….here yesterday, were you?’ ‘No, I wasn’t.’ h) ‘You don’t happen to know the time, ………………………………..?’ ‘Sorry, I don’t.’ i) ‘Both drivers were driving too fast, ……………………………….?’ ‘Yes, that’s right.’ j) ‘You (forget) ……………………………………….the milk, did you?’ ‘No. Here it is.’ 7. Rewrite each pair of sentences as one sentence. Do not change the meaning: E.g.: a) Sue read a book. She really enjoyed it. which Sue read a book which she really enjoyed. b) Some friends visited me. They brought me a present. who The friends ………………………………………………………………….present. c) I stayed in a hotel. It was cheaper than this one. that The hotel……………………………………………………………………this one. d) I borrowed a friend’s bike. He wanted it back. whose The …………………………………………………………………………….back. e) I saw the vase in the shop. I wanted to buy it. that I wanted……………………………………………………………………….shop. 244 f) A girl sings in the group. She’s got green hair. who The girl…………………………………………………………………..green hair. g) I met a girl. He brother is in my class. whose ………………………………………………………………………………..class. h) We’re taking the train. It leaves at 4.30. that The train…………………………………………………………………….at 4.30. i) A man knocked at the door. He was selling brushes. who The man ……………………………………………………………………brushes. j) I saw a film with Luke. It was interesting. which The film………………………………………………………………….interesting. 8. Look carefully at each line. Some lines are correct but some have a word which should not be there. Tick (v) each correct line. If a line has a word which should not be there, write the word in the space: A case of mistaken identity After a few minutes, the car stopped in front of 1 …v…. a large hotel. The driver who opened the door, and 2. who said, ‘Please follow me’. They went up in to a lift. 3……… Then there was a long corridor with two or three 4……… doors. Although it seemed strange so that the car hadn’t 5……… taken her to her aunt’s house, Diana who wasn’t surprised. 6. ……… Her aunt, who she was very rich, owned several large 7……….. hotels, which she often stayed in them. I suppose she felt 8……….. so much bored at home that she decided to stay here. 9………. ‘Please you wait here, will you?’ said the driver, and 10……… disappeared into a room at the end of the corridor. 11……….. There seemed to be a lot of people that in one of the 12………. 245 rooms. Then the driver, who he hadn’t been gone long, 13………… came back at and asked Diana to follow him. They went 14………. into a large room full of people, who all started clapping. 15………. There was a poster that it said, ‘Diana Harris, Supermodel.’ 16………….. ‘Oh, dear’, said Diana, ‘I think so there’s been a mistake!’ 17………… II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – CLOTHES AND APPEARANCE74 1. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) At Harry’s school, the children have to wear a special style/uniform. b) If we go to the Embassy ball we’ll have to wear fashion/formal/polite clothes. c) I really like Jack’s new dress/suit/trouser. d) In the summer I always wear shirts with short collars/cuffs/sleeves. e) Paul answered the door wearing his pyjamas and his dressing gown/nightdress. f) You get really dirty repairing a car unless you wear overalls/underwear. g) I didn’t get wet in the rain because I put on my plastic mac/overcoat/tights. h) When it snows, Freda always wears a/an anorak/glove/scarf around her neck. i) David had to stop three times to tie up his small daughter’s shoelaces/soles. j) My hands were cold so I put them in my pockets/turn-ups. k) The waitresses in this restaurant all wear white aprons/dungarees/robes. l) When Tom goes to a party he always wears a bow/butterfly/knot tie. 2. Use the word given in capitals to form a word that fits in the space: Father and son My next-door neighbour has a very unusual (1) (APPEAR) appearance. He has long hair with a (2) (PART)………………..in the middle, and usually wears and old pair of jeans and a (3) (STRIPE)………………shirt. His clothes are very (4) (SUIT) 74 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 246 ………………for working in a bank, but that is what he does! Unless he (5) (DRESS)…………………when he gets to work and changes his clothes! His clothes are usually filthy and I am sure he never washes them or takes them to the (6) (CLEAN)……………….When he wears a coat it is always old and (7) (WEAR)……………., and even on very cold days it is (8) (BUTTON)…………….. all down the front. The funny thing is that his son is very (9) (FASHION)…………………, always wears the latest styles, and never wears casual clothes, even on an (10) (FORMAL)……………….occasion. 3. Correct any errors in these sentences. Some sentences contain no errors: a) This shirt is too small, it’s not my number. size b) You have so many clothes. Why did you buy this cloth as well? ………….. c) What costume did you wear to the fancy dress party? ………….. d) Joan was dressed completely in white. ………….. e) I like your new trouser. How much was it? ………….. f) As far as I can see, the man in this photograph wears a suit. ………….. g) What are you wearing to the party this evening? ………….. h) You’re soaked! Put out your clothes immediately! ………….. 4. Complete the word in each sentence. Each space represents one letter: a) It’s cold today. I’m going to put on a thick sweater. b) Graham usually wears a leather j_ _ _ _ _ . c) My trousers are falling down! I must buy a b_ _ _. d) It’s too hot for trousers. I’m going to wear my s_ _ _ _ _. e) Let’s roll up our shirt s_ _ _ _ _ _ and start work. f) I can’t wear these jeans! They are too t_ _ _ _. g) I bought this lovely s_ _ _ scarf in Japan. h) Don’t forget to put your clothes away in the w_ _ _ _ _ _ _. 247 5. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) My hands were so cold that I couldn’t open/remove/put out/undo my coat buttons. b) Those trousers are far too big. Why don’t you have them taken in/let out/taken up/let in? c) I don’t think that purple shirt suits/fits/goes/wears with your yellow skirt. d) This jacket is the kind of thing I want. Can I wear it/dress it/take it off/try it on? e) You look really silly! Your pullover is on upside down/inside out/round and round/ side by side. f) I don’t want a pattern. I prefer just a/an plain/simple/clear/only colour. g) You look hot in that coat. Why don’t you put it on/take it off/put it away/take it out? h) I went shopping today and bought a new winter costume/outfit/suit/clothing. 6. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) If I wear a long-sleeved shirt, I usually put up/take up/roll up/get up the sleeves. b) That skirt is very short. Why don’t you have it left out/set in/let down/taken round? c) The thief wore gloves so that his fingerprints didn’t give him in/give him away/give him out/give him up. d) I can’t walk in these high-heeled boots. I keep falling off/falling back/falling out/falling over. e) Why is my swimming costume too small? What are you seeing to/getting at/making up/putting out? f) I’m making for/getting over/putting aside/turning in money every week to buy a new sports jacket. g) Some of the young people in my town go out with/go in for/go through with/go back on very strange haircuts! h) Before we choose a dress for you, let’s look into/look through/look up/look around all the shops. 248 7. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: Choosing clothes Are you one of the thousands of people who eagerly follow every new (1) appearance/fashion/uniform/dress that appears? Or are you one of those who go to the shops and just buys whatever they can find in their (2) place/price/size/self that (3) suits/makes/takes/likes them? Or perhaps you order from a mail-order catalogue, and then have to send everything back because nothing (4) sizes/styles/fits/measures ? Whatever (5) means/typical/idea/kind of shopper you are, one thing is certain. Everyone finds (6) out/clothes/dresses/vests important. According to a recent survey, people spend more time either buying clothes, or thinking about buying them, or looking at them in shop (7) centres/sale/times/windows, than they do on most other products, (8) apart/or/according/taken from food. And the reason is obvious. Clothes are an important part of our (9) nowadays/appearance/looking/events. At work, you may need to impress a customer, or persuade the boss that you know what you are doing, and clothes certainly help. (10) Well/Good/Best/Fancy dressed people, so they say, get on in the world. And as far as attracting the opposite sex is concerned, clothes also play a vital role. If a friend who has been (11) dressing/putting on/carrying/ wearing the same old jacket or the same old dress suddenly appears in the (12) last/minute/latest/complete fashion, you can be sure that romance is in the air. And apart from work and romance, there are the influences of sport, music and leisure on the way we (13) clothes/have/dress/go. So excuse me while I (14) put/dress/wear/have on my tracksuit and training (15) fit/shoes/tonight/again. I’m just dashing off for some fast window-shopping. VOCABULARY – GENERAL - PHRASAL VERBS: FOR AND WITH75 Note that with all the verbs in this unit the particles for and with must go before the object of the verb. 75 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 249 A. FOR Each response in the dialogues below contains two phrasal verbs with for. Nina: I’ve been the chance to apply for that new post in Head Office. What do you think? Gary: I think you should go for it [try to get or achieve it]. We’ll all be rooting for you [informal: showing support for you in a competition, or hoping that you will succeed] Melanie: How’s your new babysitter? Brad: We couldn’t ask for a better babysitter [the new babysitter is the best of her kind]. She just lives for our kids and they just adore her. [believes that the kids are the most important people in her life] Val: I saw you going into Betty’s flat with her this morning. Is anything wrong? Irene: Her washing machine has flooded the kitchen. She sent for a plumber and got fixed but it left a terrible mess [send someone a message asking them to come to see you]. We had planned to go into town and I was calling for her on the way there, but in the end we stayed at home and tidies the mess in the kitchen. [visiting her place in order to collect her]. Joe: What does ‘R’ mean on that sign? Ray: I think it stands for ‘restaurant’ [is the first letter of a word or name and is used to represent it]. Let’s stop. You must be dying for something to eat. [informal: wanting something very much, especially food or drink] B. With phrasal verb meaning example could do with sth/ need or want something or I could do with a cup of tea. sb someone (informal) deal with sth if something [e.g. book, His latest book deals with the 250 film, article] deals with a civil war of 1984-1989. particular subject or idea, it is about that subject or idea stick with it continue doing something I know studying for a PhD is even though it is difficult hard, but I think you should stick (informal) go with sth with it. if one thing goes with That shirt goes really well with another, they suit each your blue jacket. other or they look or taste good together put up with sb/sth accept unpleasant I don’t know how she puts up behaviour or an unpleasant with his bad temper. situation, even though you do not like it catch up with sb meet someone you know, I hope to catch up with Freda after not seeing them for a when I’m in Berlin. I haven’t period of time seen her for years. 1. Look at the phrasal verbs in A. Then match the questions 1-6 with the appropriate answers a-f below: 1. Do you think I should buy these shoes a)Couldn’t have asked for anything – they’re a bit expensive? better! 2. Oh dear, look at that accident. b) Yes, go for it! 3. What did you think of the restaurant? c) Quick! Send for an ambulance! 4. Do you know what CV means? d) Yes, I’m dying for an ice cream. 5. Would you like to go to a café? e) We’re rooting for the Reds, as usual. 6. Who are you supporting in the league? f) Sure! It stands for curriculum vitae. 251 2. Complete these sentences with an appropriate verb. Write the verb in the correct form: 1. He……………………………...for a doctor as soon as he felt the pains in his chest. 2. Martha…………………..for her work so she’s going to find it very hard when she has to retire. 3.These boots don’t really……………………..with this skirt, but they’re comfortable. 4. You…………………………………...for a nicer teacher. She’s so patient and kind. 5. I’ll have to have a word with Gina. I can’t ……………..up with her rudeness any longer. 6. Your hair is too long – you……………………………………………with a haircut. 7. You should ………………….with the course. It would be a shame to give up now. 8. I love going back to my home town and ……………….up with all my old friends. 3. Use a phrasal verb from the opposite page to complete these dialogues: 1. Anne: This fish tastes delicious with your tomato sauce. Jenny: Yes, they do…………………….well………………each other, don’t they? 2. Bob: Shall we go to the concert together? Tina: Good idea. I’ll …………………………………………you on the way there. 3. Tessa: I’ll go and put the kettle on. Tony: Great, I’m ………………………………………………………a cup of tea. 4. Joan: I thought the film was great. Ivan: Yes, I thought it………………………….the theme of love really sensitively. 5. Mark: Let’s meet for a coffee and a chat next week. Karen: Yes, I can’t wait to………………………………………………………you. 4. Rewrite these sentences, using phrasal verbs: 1. I couldn’t tolerate such noisy neighbours as yours. 2. It’s been such a busy week. I can’t wait for the weekend. 3. Jean’s shoes match her handbag perfectly. 252 4. All the students at his university were hoping Kyle would win the golf championship. 5. I have the best job you could imagine. 6. Her grandson is the most important person in Stella’s life. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS – TEENAGE GAMBLING76 Having a bit of fun on a slot machine can soon become a real fixation for some unaware teenagers, leading psychologists warned today. According to specialists, gambling is a kind of addiction and can be as compelling as drugs. Amusement arcades, with their machines and flashing lights, can mesmerize youngsters and form a compulsion which they are unable to resist. It is the noise when the machine starts paying out, the thrill, which really gets teenagers hooked on the game. Soon the game becomes the only thing on their minds: they start playing truant from school, they steal from their parents, they lie and do anything to get money for gambling; their sole purpose in life is to return to the “one-armed bandit” to have another go! Although the law forbids admission to the places in question to anyone under 16, underage gambling is on the increase. It has now been proved beyond any doubt that playing these machines can create a kind of dependence. This, in turn, causes behavioural problems, such as lack of interest in any other activity, and in school in particular. Not everyone will become a problem gambler but, when a person realizes that he is one, it is already too late. Every addiction leaves mental scars. Therapy takes a long time and the process of adaptation to normal life is gradual. Violence and aggression are typical withdrawal symptoms. Teenagers are not allowed to handle money for several years. They are encouraged to take up new interests, make new friends and get a job. Apart from this, parents of young gamblers are organizing themselves to help young victims kick the habit and straighten out their lives. But, above all, they are campaigning to have slot machines removed from all venues to which children have access in order to reduce 76 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol Educational, 2001. 253 1. Bucureşti: All the temptation to play the game. They also seek penalties for those arcade owners who admit youngsters below the age of 16. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Playing the slot machines can become an addiction. 2. Teenagers take this for a fact. 3. Amusement arcades can have a mesmerizing effect. 4. The excitement of the game is too high and teenagers run away. 5. The only thing they can think of is how to go back and play again. 6. They have the money because they are given more and more by their parents. 7. The problem concerns only those who are over 16. 8. Young gamblers have better results at school. 9. One can always quit playing the machines any time one likes. 10. It takes a lot of time to free oneself from the habit. 11. At first young patients may behave very violently. 12. The purpose of the parents’ organization is prevention and offering help to young gamblers. 13. Teenagers should have as little contact with slot machines as possible. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B behavioural ………………… fixation flashing ……………………. gambling mental ……………………… lights real ………………………. machine slot ……………………….. problems unaware ……………………. scars underage ……………………. symptoms withdrawal …………………… teenagers 254 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: GAMBLING – FIGHT – OF – PARENTS – TEENAGE – GROWING – WAVE ……………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: - a se distra: - h……………… a b………… of f……………… - a forma deprinderi comportamentale – f…………….. a c…………………. - a trage chiulul – p…………….. t……………. f…………… s…………….. - fără urmă de îndoială – b……………. a…………….. d………………….. - lipsă de interes faţă de orice activitate: - l…………… of i………….. in a………… a……………….. -simptome de reacţie în timpul curei de dezintoxicare: - w…………….. s…………… - a se folosi de bani: - h………….. m…………. -a dezvolta noi preocupări – t……………. u…………. i……………… - a abandona viciul: -k……………… the h……………….. - a diminua ispita: - r…………….. the t………………. 255 n…………… LESSON 17 *Grammar: Nouns (1)* Vocabulary: General – Towns and Buildings* Phrasal Verbs: Into and Away* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – School Violence *** I. GRAMMAR – NOUNS (1)77 English nouns can be countable (we can say two dogs) or uncountable (we can’t say two waters). Countable nouns have plurals (dogs), and we can use a/an with them (a dog, an apology) Uncountable nouns have no plurals, and we can’t use a/an before them. We can join two nouns: #with a possessive ‘s or s’ (for example my sister’s car, my parents’ neighbours) # with a preposition (for example the top of the hill) # directly one after the other (for example orange juice, a flower shop) *Countable and uncountable nouns - countable – plurals; can be used with a/an a chair - chairs a house – houses an idea – ideas - uncountable - no plurals; not a/an air, water, sand, intelligence, English, weather Can you open a window? I need air. She speaks good English. It’s terrible weather. (NOT – a terrible…..) 77 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 256 1. Can you divide these words into countable and uncountable? book, cup, dust, flour, flower, happiness, knowledge, love, milk, meat, mountain, music, oil, piano, rain, river, snow, song, table, wall COUNTABLE………………………………………………………………………….. .…………………………………………………………………………………………. UNCOUNTABLE……………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………….. -some nouns can be countable or uncountable, with different meanings. Paper is made from wood. I’m going out to buy a paper. (= a newspaper) Did you remember to buy coffee? I’ll have a (cup of) coffee, please. My mother never drinks wine. Spain produces some wonderful wines. (= kids of wine) 2. Uncountable, singular countable (with a/an) or plural? Complete these sentences: 1. Could you pass me…………………………………………………………..? (glass) 2. This table is made of…………………………………………………………. (glass) 3. I need a piece of ……………………………………………………………...(wood) 4. The house was near …………………………………………………………..(wood) 5. She looked at him with …………………….......................................................(pity) 6. It’s …………………………………………………………….Ann isn’t here .(pity) 7. ………………………………………………………………..goes so quickly.(time) 8. She phoned six …………………………………………………….yesterday. (time) 9. Three …………………………………………………………………, please. (beer) 10. ………………………………………………………………..makes you fat. (beer) 257 11. He hasn’t got much ……………………………………………………(experience) 12. It was …………………………………………….. …..I won’t forget. (experience) 13. There’s ……………………………………………….........in the garden. (chicken) 14. Do you want ………………………………………………..........or beef? (chicken) - the following words are normally uncountable in English (but countable in some other languages). They are normally only singular. We can use some with them, but not a/an. (NOT a travel, an information) advice baggage bread furniture hair knowledge luck luggage news research travel work spaghetti (and macaroni etc.) information I need some information. This bread is too expensive. Her hair is very long. Travel teaches you a lot. 3. Put ‘a’ with the countable nouns and ‘some’ with the uncountable nouns: ……....baggage ……....bread ………bus ……...dishwasher …………furniture ………holiday ………house ………luck ……..knowledge …………magazine ………problem ……….research ………table ……….travel …………work -sometimes uncountable and countable nouns have similar meanings food – a meal clothing – a coat crockery- a plate 4. Can you put these words in pairs (one uncountable, one countable) expressing similar ideas? accommodation advertisement luggage bread cars dollar fact flat furniture information job journey loaf money publicity suitcase table traffic travel work 258 E.g.: accommodation, a flat ………………………… ……………………………. ………………………… …………………………… ………………………… ……………………………. ………………………… ……………………………. ………………………… …………………………… ……………………….... 5. Fixed expressions. The nouns in the box are normally uncountable. They can be made countable by adding other words. Find out which words go with which: advice bread chess chocolate luck news soap thunder grass lightning a piece or word of advice a blade of ……………………….. an item or piece of ……………… a bar of ……………OR ………… a flash of ……………………….. a loaf of………………………….. a stroke of ……………………… a game of ……………………….. a clap of………………………….. -with a few uncountable nouns referring to emotional and mental activity, we use a/an where there is an adjective or other description a love of music a good education an excellent knowledge of German *Plurals of nouns: special cases: aircraft, sheep, arms 6. Here are seven groups of nouns. Look in the box and find two more nouns to add to each group: aircraft crisis dozen mathematics means mouse news police scissors sheep shelf thousand tooth wolf 259 1. COUNTABLE NOUNS WITH SINGULAR (AND PLURAL) IN –s series crossroads analysis-analyses …………. - ………… …………………. 2. NOUNS WITH SINGULAR AND PLURAL THE SAME trout deer fish salmon ………… ………………. 3. NOUNS THAT HAVE A PLURAL WITHOUT –s AFTER A NUMBER hundred (e.g. two hundred) million ……………… ………………….. 4. NOUNS WITH SINGULAR IN –f(e), PLURAL IN –ves calf-calves half knife leaf life loaf ………….. - ………………… self thief wife ……………….- ……………… 5. NOUNS WITH IRREGULAR PLURALS child-children criterion-criteria foot-feet fungus-fungi goose-geese man-men medium-media ox-oxen penny-pence phenomenon-phenomena woman-women ………………….. - ………………… ……………………..-…………… 6. UNCOUNTABLE SINGULAR NOUNS ENDING IN –s (NORMALLY NO PLURAL) athletics billiards economics gymnastics politics ………….. …………… measles physics 7. PLURAL NOUNS WITH NO SINGULAR arms belongings cattle clothes congratulations earnings goods outskirts people thanks troops trousers ……………… 260 remains contents surroundings ………………… *Mixed singular and plural: My family are angry with me #singular nouns for groups of people often have plural verbs and pronouns in British English, especially when we are talking about personal kinds of action. Compare: My family are very angry with me: they think I should go to university. The average family has 3.5 members: it is much smaller than in 1900. The team are going to lose again. They’re useless. A cricket team is made up of eleven players, including its captain. 7. Choose the best expressions from the box to complete the sentences: class is club has orchestra is school has staff do class are club have orchestra are school have staff does 1a. In England, a state……………………………..to give time to religious education. 1b. My daughter’s ……………………decided to hold their sports day next Saturday. 2a. The………………………………………………given $5,000 to charity this year. 2b. The …………………………………fifty per cent more members than a year ago. 3a. The ……………………………………............................not like the new manager. 3b. The ………………………………………………………not need to be increased. 4a. Jane’s …………………………………………………………………..in Room 6. 4b. Our ………………………………………………………………planning a party. 5a. The …………………………………………………just tuning up – let’s hurry in. 5b. An ……………………….composed of string, wind, and percussion instruments. #the following singular expressions can be followed by plural nouns and verbs: 261 a number of the majority of a lot of the rest of a couple of a group of A number of us are worried about it. (NOT A number of us is) The majority of teachers disagree. There are a couple of children outside. The rest of the members are ill. #some plural expressions (names of quantities, and expressions joined by and) have singular verbs. Ten pounds is too much to pay. The United States is smaller than Canada. Fish and chips costs $8. 8. Choose the right verb: 1. A number of people has/have complained about the noise. 2. Do you think three pounds is/are a big enough tip? 3. Hamburger and chips is/are not a very healthy lunch. 4. In the latest rail union vote, the majority has/have voted to go on strike; the rest of the members is/are expected to support the strike fairly solidly. 5. Two kilos is/are pretty small for a newborn baby. 6. Our teenage son thinks there is/are a number of good reasons for staying up late and having a good time. 7. A couple of dangerous-looking men is/are waiting for you outside. 8. Six weeks is/are a long time to wait for news of your family. 9. The majority of the children’s parents is/are unemployed. 10. A lot of shops is/are opening on Sundays now. 11. The United States has/have serious economic problems. 12. Tom and Rosie were late, but the rest of us was/were on time. 13. Is/Are bacon and eggs what you usually eat for breakfast? 14. We’ve just learnt that a couple of our club members has/have been chosen for the national team. 262 *Revise the basics: possessive ‘s #SINGULAR noun(s) + ‘s: my mother’s car; Sarah and Henry’s house #PLURAL noun + ‘: my parents’ home #IRREGULAR plural + ‘s: the children’s names 9. Make possessive forms from the expressions in List 1, to combine with expressions from List 2. Make fifteen combinations: List 1: List 2: your sister Jonathan Emily and Claire those women my teachers Katie our dog Simon and Jill most people doctors address car/cars father/fathers ideas nose/noses health legs clothes education fear of heights Ex: your sister’s address 8…………………………………. my teachers’ clothes 9…………………………………. 1. ……………………………… 10………………………………... 2. ……………………………… 11 ……………………………….. 3. ……………………………… 12………………………………... 4. ……………………………… 13. ………………………………. 5 ………………………………. 14 ……………………………….. 6 ………………………………. 15………………………………... 7……………………………….. #Possessives usually replace articles before nouns. We can say the car or Sue’s car, but not Sue’s the car or the Sue’s car. But a possessive word can have its own article: the boss’s car. Note also: that car of Sue’s; a friend of Joe’s (like a friend of mine) 263 10. Right or wrong? Correct the mistakes or write ‘Correct’: E.g.: my mothers car mother’s Anna’s sister. correct 1. Is this the teacher’s pen? ……………………. 2. Are you the Al’s daughter? ……………………. 3. Do you know Lesley’s last name? ……………………. 4. Here’s the Barry’s address. ……………………. 5. Here’s my parents’ address. ……………………. 6. It was the school’s responsibility. ……………………. 7. What’s the Wilson’s number? ……………………. 8. That’s an old habit of Marion’s. ……………………. 9. It’s a crazy idea of Alice. ……………………. 10. Where is that brother of Carol? ……………………. Note: We spent the evening at Cathy’s ( = at Cathy’s house) She’s at the hairdresser’s. I bought it at Harrod’s. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – TOWNS AND BUILDINGS78 1. Choose the most suitable world: a) As you can see, the garden has two ornamental iron doors/gates and there is a stone path/pavement leading to the house. b) This is the front entry/entrance, but there is another door at the edge/side of the house. c) All the rooms have covered/fitted carpets. d)All the cupboards/wardrobes in the kitchen and the bookshelves/library in the living room are included in the price. 78 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 264 e)There is a beautiful stone chimney/fireplace in the living room, and there are sinks/wash-basins in all the bedrooms. f) At the top of the stairs/steps there is a coloured/stained glass window. g) The bathroom has a shower/washer and modern mixer pipes/taps. h)At the top of the house there is a/an attic/cellar and the garden contains a glasshouse/greenhouse and a garden hut/shed. i) There is a wooden fence/wall on one side of the garden, and a bush/hedge on the other. j) This is a fine single/detached house in a quiet neighbourhood/suburb. 2. Match the words in the box with a suitable explanation (a-i). Not all words given are possible: curtains drive parking shelf central heating dishwasher furniture radiator stool cook landing rug door knocker letterbox a) Rectangular hole in the front door. doormat settee/sofa letterbox b) Long narrow rectangular piece of wood or metal fixed to the wall. …………… c) Short road between the street and a house of its garage. …………… d) Use this if you want someone to open the front door. …………… e) Put the dirty dishes in this. …………… f) This system make the house warm. …………… g) A small carpet. …………… h) More than one person can sit on this. …………… i) An area at the top of some stairs. …………… j) Wipe your feet on this before you enter the house. …………… k) Pull these to cover the windows. …………… l) Small seat without back or arms. …………… 265 3. Complete each sentence (a-j) with a suitable ending (1-10) so that the meaning of the word in italics is clear. Use each ending only once: a) I would prefer to live in a cottage 6 1) on the third floor of a modern block. b) The shopping centre has a multi-storey 2) and he commutes to work in the centre. car park c) My grandmother bought a bungalow 3) with room for over 2000 vehicles. d) Jenny lives in a small flat 4) but the rent is so high that she cannot afford much furniture. e) This street is only for pedestrians 5) which has a beautiful garden in the middle. f) Helen and John live in a square 6) in a small village in the country. g) Peter has moved to a London suburb 7) and the neighbours often bang on the wall. h) This village is surrounded by lovely 8)because she had difficulty climbing countryside stairs. i) Sue’s new house is unfurnished 9) with fields, woods, streams and a small lake. j) My house is semi-detached 10) and cars and lorries are not allowed. 4. Complete each sentence with the words home, house or a word formed from one of these words: a) The old couple decided to live in an old people’s home. b) Jane can’t stand washing and ironing and other …………………………………… c) Graham bought a terraced ……………………………………. in a quiet city street. d) Many……………………………………….. people sleep on the streets of London. e) Jack was unable to look after his children so he employed a ………………………. f) I come from Newcastle. It’s my ……………………………….town, you could say. g) Paul used to live on the river on a ……………………………………………...boat. h) When I went to boarding school I felt very …………………………….sick at first. 266 i) Our first home was on the …………………………………estate on Oakwood Hill. j) Pour yourself a drink and make yourself at…………………………………………. 5. Choose the most suitable word or phrase to complete each sentence: a) The view from the skyscraper shows up/sees about/stands up/looks out over New York harbor. b) The old houses opposite are going to be broken down/knocked down/put down/ taken down. c) Hang up/Stop off/Get away/Look out! You’re about to push the wheelbarrow over my foot! d) Please take in/make up/put out/tie down the rubbish because the dustman is coming tomorrow. e) Please come and unblock our drains! I’m doing without/counting on/seeing to/ waiting for you! f) I can’t put these plants in pots. I’ve run out of/put up with/given up/come up with earth. g) We fell out/got in/ended up/set off through the window by climbing up a ladder. h) I’ve been planting trees all day and I’m worn out/taken in/run down/grown up. 6. Use the word given in capitals at the end of each line to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: A house in the country When Ann decided to move house, it was mainly because she was tired of the (1) neighbourhood she lived in. It was NEIGHBOUR crowded, there was a (2) ………………of parking places, and SHORT the view from her (3)…………………windows was of distant STAIRS factory chimneys. Luckily she arranged the (4)……………….. SELL of her house very easily, and with a small (5) ………… from LEND the bank, was able to buy a house in the country. It was an 267 old farm building, which had been (6)…………and turned into BUILD a modern house. After loading all her belongings in a van, Ann managed to get them into the new house (7) …………….. DAMAGE She (8)……………..most of the rooms with what she already FURNITURE owned. Even her curtains were the right (9)……………for the LONG windows and she only had to buy a new (10)………………for COOK the kitchen. It seemed too good to be true. Surely something would go wrong! 7. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) Laura was sitting beside the fire in a comfortable armchair/sofa. b) We drove out of the village along a winding lane/path. c) Steve redecorated his room with flowery posters/wallpaper. d) Put the meat in the cooker/oven for two hours. e) These plums are ripe. They need picking/picking up. f) Peter was in the garden mowing the flowers/lawn. g) We used to keep the coal downstairs in the cave/cellar. h) Why don’t you put the car in the car park/parking? i) Kate lives in a flat on the first floor/storey. j) Put your wet socks on the central heating/radiator to dry. k) Let’s take the runway/motorway, we’ll get there faster. l) Go and get the lawnmower. The grass is/are very long. m) I like the painting but I don’t like the frame/surrounding. n) Mary has a lot of small ornaments on her window shelf/sill. o) There’s someone at/on the door. Can you see who it is? 268 8. Match the words in the box with a suitable explanation (a-o): shutters ceiling chimney pillow kennel blind cushion roof rubbish urban bunk duvet kerb litter rural a) Put this over you if you are cold in bed. duvet b) Put this behind your back if you are sitting uncomfortably. ………… c) This describes city places. ………… d) These protect your windows outside and can be closed in bad weather. …………. e) This is paper dropped in the street. …………. f) This is the top of the room. …………. g) This is a bed with others above it. …………. h) This describes country places. …………. i) This is the top of the house. …………. j) Put this under your head when you go to sleep. …………. k) Close this to keep the sunlight out of your room. ………… l) This is anything you throw away in the dustbin. ………… m) This is home for your pet dog. ………… n) This is the stone edge of the pavement at the side of the road. ………… o) The smoke goes up this from the fireplace. ………… 9. Choose the right version: Moving in The entrance to the flat was at the (1) side/inside/beginning/garden of the house. Jane had to walk along a (2) road/way/path/stairs across the lawn and past a (3) room/shed/cellar/floor full of gardening equipment. Inside the back door there was a flight of (4) ladder/upstairs/rooms/stairs and then another door on the (5) roof/ landing/balcony/bottom. It was a (6) multi-storey/semi-detached/furnished/cottage flat with a bedroom, living room, kitchen and bathroom. There was not a lot of (7) furniture/rent/neighbours/housing but certainly enough for a student like Jane. There was a/an (8) oven/fireplace/cooker/cooking in the living room with an electric fire, 269 and the kitchen had a small (9) cook/cookery/cooker/cooking and a fridge. The bathroom did not have a bath, only a (10) waterfall/shower/splash/sink and a basin, but Jane didn’t mind. She was thinking about other problems. There wasn’t a washing (11) machine/up/room/powder, and there was no (12) central/much/radiator/good heating. It was raining outside, and the flat felt damp and chilly. On the bed there were some (13) wrappings/rugs/carpets/blankets and a duvet, but no (14) whites/sheets/spreads/cloths. It was lucky that Jane had brought a sleeping bag. As she was wondering what to do next, there was a knock (15) for/behind/to/at the door. VOCABULARY: GENERAL - PHRASAL VERBS: INTO AND AWAY79 A. INTO Read the entries in Diana’s personal diary. Each entry has a phrasal verb with into. 7 Mon - Ran into Mary W in town today. met someone I know when I did not Nice to see her again. expect to meet them 8 Tue – Car problems again today! Must investigate and examine the facts about a look into getting a new one. problem or situation 9 Wed – Poor old Eileen! The boss told suddenly started to make a noise, her he didn’t like some work she’d done especially to start crying, laughing or and she burst into tears singing 10 Thu – The boss wants to have lunch believe that an action, remark or situation with me. Anne says I shouldn’t read has a particular importance or meaning, anything into it, but I’m suspicious of his often when this is not true motives 11 Fri – Met Liam today. He went into described and discussed something in a his marriage problems into great detail. detailed way. Felt sorry for him. 12 Sat – Decided to throw myself into start doing something with a lot of 79 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 270 doing some gardening now that spring is enthusiasm and energy here! 13 Sun – Saw Liam again. Told him I start to become involved in something, was busy as I didn’t want to enter into especially a discussion. (Note that you another discussion about his private life enter a room, not enter into a room) B. AWAY phrasal verb meaning example tidy away sth or tidy put things in cupboards Mum told me to tidy away all sth away and drawers, etc. after you my things before my aunt came have been using them to visit. pack away sth or put something into a bag The scouts packed away their pack sth away or container, or put tents and left the camping something in the place ground. where it is usually kept tear sb away (usually force someone to stop I’m sorry to tear you away + from) doing something enjoy in order they from your computer, but I need to do your help. something else stay away from sth avoid something that has a I think I should stay away bad effect on you from desserts. I’m putting on weight. send away for sth write to an organization to I’ve sent away for a brochure ask them to send you about holidays in New Zealand. something lock yourself away go to a room or building I decided to lock myself away where you can be alone, in my room till I’d finished my usually so that you can essay. work run away (often + secretly from) leave a place Did you ever run away from because you are unhappy home as a child? there 271 1. Match the beginning of each sentence with its ending: 1. At the supermarket yesterday Julia ran a) into his words. 2. Kim is getting over his broken heart by throwing b) into Martin. himself 3.When she saw me dressed up as a pirate she burst c) into the causes of the war. 4. He doesn’t think before he speaks so don’t read too d) into the argument. much 5. In your essay you should have gone more fully e) into what happened. 6. We were disagreeing about the film and then Jo f) into laughter. entered 7. The police are doing all they can to look g) into his studies. 2. Complete these sentences using a phrasal verb with away. Write the verb in the correct form and add, if necessary, a reflexive pronoun (e.g. myself, yourself): 1. I once terrified my parents by …………………………………………...from home. 2. Please ………………………………….your games and books. It’s time for dinner. 3. You really should …………………………....Stanley. He’s a bad influence on you. 4. She was so upset that she ………………………in her room until the next morning. 5. Adam has ………………………………….an application form for that job he saw. 6. Please could you …………………….from the TV, I need some help in the garden. 3. Complete these sentences in any way that makes sense using one of the phrasal verbs from the opposite page: 1. I was very surprised when Helen burst……………………………………………… 2. It makes sense to stay………………………………………………………………... 3. My best friend always throws……………………………………………………….. 4. Sometimes I’d really like to run …………………………………………………….. 5. I find this job so stressful. I really should look ……………………………………... 272 6. When I went to the town centre last week, I ran ……………………………………. 7. Before moving house, I spent weeks packing ………………………………………. 8. Whenever visitors are coming, I usually tidy ……………………………………….. 4. Here are some more phrasal verbs with into and away. Read the sentences 1-5 and match the phrasal verbs with the definitions a-e: 1.As soon as Joe saw me, he launched a)knock against something, usually by into a long account of his travels. accident 2.Because it is so expensive in this b)meet someone you know when you country at the moment, tourists are have not planned to meet them keeping away. 3.Trying to cross the room in the dark, he c)start doing or saying something (e.g. a banged into a small table and knocked speech or a story) in a very enthusiastic over. way 4.It isn’t a person in that field, it’s a d)make a person or animal so frightened scarecrow- the farmer wants to scare the that they go away birds away. 5. I bumped into your sister in town this e) not go to a place morning. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS – SCHOOL VIOLENCE80 The Teachers’ Union has published a report which provides substantial evidence as to why scores of discouraged teachers are leaving the profession seeking less stressful alternative employment. Five hundred men and women were surveyed for the report, and as many as 40% revealed that they had been subjected to daily verbal abuse, intimidation, threats and physical violence from their pupils. The deterioration in children’s behaviour is manifested by foul language and appalling manners. The badly-paid profession is held in very low esteem. Teachers say that 80 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 273 there is a limit to the enthusiasm one can generate for the job on a tiny salary. For many, the strain is too high and it is driving them out of the classroom for good. The teachers report a horrifying degree of classroom violence, with children as young as eight being suspended for being disruptive. Vandalism, graffiti, arson and theft are commonplace, and few schools manage successfully to tackle rowdies who disrupt school life. Parking outside a school means finding scratched paintwork, twisted aerials and punctured tyres. The violence involves knifing, punching and beating. In one case, a boy turned on a teacher, grabbed him by the throat and threatened him with a broken bottle. But even in such drastic cases, there is little support from the headmasters who are reluctant to pass details to local authorities because such reports reflect badly on their schools. A breakdown in discipline at home has affected students’ behaviour at school. Bad behaviour has increased dramatically since corporal punishment was abolished. Many young people drink excessively and parents turn a blind eye to it. If a teacher tries to correct or reprimand an unruly student, he or she risks physical assault and severe verbal abuse. On top of it, there is no support from the parents who rather come and tell the teacher off for trying to keep their children in order. Pupils know they can get away with assaulting teachers because no-one takes such acts seriously. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. The report explains why fewer teachers nowadays are doing their job. 2. Teachers find their job very stressful. 3. More than half of those interviewed for the report have been victims of classroom violence. 4. The profession of a teacher is highly respected in society. 5. They are paid inadequately for the work they have to do. 6. Eight-year-olds are being thrown out of school for violent behaviour. 7. Most schools do not know how to deal with the problem. 8. Teachers’ cars are often vandalized by pupils. 9. Headmasters are helpful in solving disciplinary problems because they do not want to lose their teachers. 274 10.Students behave at school just as they must be behaving at home towards their parents. 11.Many parents would rather pretend not to notice their children drinking alcohol. 12.Pupils moderate their language when they address their teachers. 13.Parents who cannot control their children are grateful to teachers for bringing them up properly. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B appalling ……………….. abuse corporal ………………….. cases discouraged ……………….. degree drastic ……………………. evidence foul ……………………. language horrifying ………………… manners physical ………………….. punishment substantial………………….. students unruly …………………….. teachers verbal……………………….. violence 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: MORE-CLASSROOM-OF-TEACHERS-TO-DISCIPLINE –OVER-LACK-RESIGN ………………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. Phrases to learn: -a căuta un alt post: – s…………… a……………… e……………… -limbaj vulgar şi maniere îngrozitoare: - f…………… l…………… and a………………. m……………. -a stima foarte puţin: - h……………. a l……………. e…………….. 275 -a se descurca cu golanii: - t………….. r………… -a reflecta negativ asupra: - r…………. b…………….. o………….. something -a închide ochii la ceva: - t………….. a b…………… e…………….. t……………. something -a ţine pe cineva la respect – k…………….. somebody i…………… o……………. -a scăpa nepedepsit: - g……………….. a………….. w…………. something 276 LESSON 18 *Grammar: Nouns (2)* Vocabulary: General – Vehicles and Transport* Phrasal Verbs: Time – Spending Time* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Soccer Hooliganism *** I. GRAMMAR – NOUNS (2)81 *possessive ‘s or of: my father’s name; the name of the book #we use the possessive’s structure especially when the first noun is the name of a person, group of people, organisation, country or animal. In other cases we generally prefer a structure with of. Compare: my father’s name the name of the book the firm’s structure the structure of plastic America’s influence the influence of alcohol the dog’s head the head of the bed #we also use the possessive’s structure with common ‘time when’ expressions, and in expressions of measurement of time. today’s paper tomorrow’s weather a month’s holiday three hours’ delay yesterday’s news 1. Join the expressions in the box to make expressions with possessive ‘s or , ’ or with of: the club + its monthly meeting Angela + her leg his parents + their car the trees + their highest branches your dog + its mouth the bank + its branch in Paris the river + its mouth my family + its name 81 the world + its end my suitcase + its lock your office + its floor the town + its atmosphere Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 277 our company + its best sales manager next week + its timetable E.g.: the police force + its main problem last night+ its party today + its news the club’s monthly meeting ………………………………………. his parents’ car ………………………………………. the end of the world ..................................................... ……………………………….. …………………………………. ……………………………….. …………………………………. ……………………………….. …………………………………. ……………………………….. …………………………………. ……………………………….. …………………………………. ………………………………… ………………………………..... 2. Make two noun groups from each set of words: E.g.: file: your secretary, legal documents: your secretary’s file, the file of legal documents 1. story: Helen, the French Revolution ………………………………………………………………………………...... 2. bed: the stream, the patient ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. policy: full employment, the company ………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. style: my favorite author, the 1930s …………………………………………………………………………….......... 5. place: language education, women …………………………………………………………………………….......... 6. ideas: modern physics, my son ………………………………………………………………………………...... 7. rules: the club, football …………………………………………………………………………….......... 278 8. view: the committee, the lake ………………………………………………………………………………… 9. head: the cat, the queue ………………………………………………………………………………… 10. arm: the chair, John ………………………………………………………………………………… *revise the basics: noun + noun #we often put one noun in front of another. The first noun is rather like an adjective, and is usually singular, even if the meaning is plural. a horse race (a kind of race) a race horse (a kind of horse) a shoe shop a Lancashire man a ten-mile walk #articles belonging to the first noun are dropped in this structure. Officers in the army = army officers (NOT the army….) 3. What do you call these? 1. a shop that sells music……………………………………………………………….. 2. a man from Birmingham…………………………………………………………….. 3. a frame for a picture…………………………………………………………………. 4. tea made from mint………………………………………………………………….. 5. the clock in the station …………………………………………………………….... 6. a rocket that goes into space……………………………………………………….... 7. a factory that makes biscuits………………………………………………………… 8. powder made from soap…………………………………………………………….. 9. furniture for the garden …………………………………………………………….. 10. a sign in the road ………………………………………………………………….. 11. a brush for teeth …………………………………………………………………… 12. programmes about wildlife ……………………………………………………….. 13. a bottle for wine…………………………………………………………………… 14. a play produced by a school………………………………………………………. 279 15. a paper that is sold in the evening………………………………………………… 4. Put these words into pairs to make noun + noun expressions. Change plural to singular if necessary: antique bicycle bus cowboy kitchen map newspapers shop station door film publisher grapes race juice roads ………………………………………….. ……………………………………... ………………………………………….. ……………………………………... …………………………………………... ……………………………………... …………………………………………... ……………………………………... #Note the difference between, for example, a water bottle (a bottle for water, which may be full or empty) and a bottle of water (a bottle with water in). *noun + noun or preposition: road signs; signs of anger #we use the noun + noun structure for well-known everyday combinations. #to talk about things that do not go together so often, we usually prefer a structure with a preposition. Compare: a war film a film about a dog (NOT a dog film) a history book a book about violins (NOT a violin book) a postman a man from the bank (NOT a bank man) road signs signs of anger (NOT anger signs) a corner table the girl in the corner (NOT the corner girl) 5. Eight of these ideas can naturally be expressed by ‘noun + noun’. Which are they? Rewrite them: 1. a cake made of chocolate …………………………………………………... 2. a child in the garden …………………………………………………... 280 3. a cupboard in the kitchen ………………………………………………….. 4. a box for matches …………………………………………………... 5. paste for cleaning teeth …………………………………………………... 6. discussions about furniture …………………………………………………. 7. the door to the kitchen …………………………………………………. 8. a bottle designed for wine …………………………………………………. 9. a timetable of trains …………………………………………………. 10. a book about the moon …………………………………………………. 11. chairs for the garden …………………………………………………. 12. a man with a hat …………………………………………………. #Newspaper headlines often save space by using the noun + noun structure instead of the preposition structure. Strings of three or four nouns are common. Channel ferry safety drill leaves 18 injured. Decision day in rail dispute. Football club burglars cut home phones. *one (s): a big one with cream #we use one (s) to avoid repeating a countable noun. ‘What sort of cake would you like?’ ‘A big one with cream’. I’d like some shoes like the ones in the window. ‘Could you lend me a pen?’ ‘Sorry, I haven’t got one.’ #we don’t use one for an uncountable noun. We haven’t got fresh cream. Would you like tinned? (NOT tinned one) 281 6. Put in words and expressions from the box with or without one(s): Chinese cold small metal long sunny solid practical new that I’ve read red woollen sharp unsweetened orange white cotton E.g.: ‘What colour cardigans would you like to see?’ ‘Red woollen ones, please.’ 1. There’s my suitcase, the …………………………………………………………….! 2. I’ve lost my jacket. It’s a ……………………………………………………………. 3. ‘What kind of juice is that?’ ‘…………………………………………………’ 4. I’ve got too many books. I’m giving away the …………………………………….. 5. She doesn’t sell used cars, only ……………………………………………………... 6. ‘What sort of holiday are you having this year?’ ‘A………………………………...’ 7. This isn’t Thai food, it’s ……………………………………………………………. 8. I don’t want pretty shoes, but ………………………………………………………. 9. Hand me a knife, will you – a ………………………………………………………. 10. Don’t wash this in warm water. Use ………………………………………………. #If there is no adjective, we do not use a with one. ‘What sort of cake would you like?’ ‘One with cream.’ #we use some/any without ones. We use mine etc instead of my one etc. ‘Could you lend me some stamps?’ ‘I haven’t got any’ ‘Which car shall we take?’ ‘Mine’ 7. Put in one, some, any or mine/yours etc: 1. ‘What sort of job would you like to do?’ ‘…………………….where I travel a lot.’ 2. I haven’t got a train timetable, but ask Adrian – he may have ……………………… 3. ‘Is that your car or Anna’s?’ ‘………………………...- Anna hasn’t got a car.’ 4. There aren’t any matches here, but there may be …………………….in the kitchen. 5. I need a watch - ……………………………………………………….with an alarm. 282 6. ‘Where are the forks?’ ‘Oh, no! We didn’t bring ……………………………...! 7. Barry has put his name on this book, but Liz says it’s……………………………… 8. If you haven’t got enough plates, I’ll be happy to bring…………………………… *nouns: more practice 8. Irregular plurals. See if you can remember the plurals of these nouns: criterion…………. fish……………….. thief…………… fungus…………… phenomenon…………………. series…………… analysis…………… tomato………………. goose………….. 9. No singular; no plural. Seven of these nouns are normally singular with no plural; seven are plural with no singular; seven are normal. Write S, P or N: athletics: S belongings: P end: N clothes: …… congratulations: …… gymnastics: …. hand: ….. physics: ….. billiards: …… economics: ….. idea: ….. meal: ….. research: ….. scissors: …. thanks: ….. cattle:…. exam: ….. glass: …… measles: …… paper: … trousers: …. 10. Mixed singular and plural. Choose the best forms: 1. The missing group of climbers has/have radioed to say that they are safe. 2. A number of people has/have written to Professor Taylor to show their support for his plan. 3. Ten euros is/are a lot to pay for one coffee. 4. Fish and chips is/are a traditional British supper. 5. Most of the people here agrees/agree with me. 6. A couple of policeman is/are outside and wants/want to speak to you. 7. A rugby union team has/have fifteen players. 283 8. My family thinks/think I’m crazy. 9. Eight months is/are a long time to wait for a visa. 10. The majority of us wants/want a change of government 11. Mixed structures. Choose the correct forms: 1. I’d like one/a one with long sleeves. 2. Have you got a bus timetable/timetable of buses? 3. Do you know school’s/the school’s phone number? 4. Here’s a photo of Mark’s/Mark and Sylvia’s baby. 5. I’m reading a Napoleon book/ book about Napoleon. 6. I can hear the postman’s van/ the van of the postman. 7. She’s a John’s friend/ a friend of John/ a friend of John’s. 8. Please don’t put your cup on the chair’s arm/ the arm of the chair. 9. There was an empty wine bottle/wine’s bottle/bottle of wine under his bed. 10. That was a really good idea of Maggie/Maggie’s. 12. Grammar and vocabulary: words beginning with sun. Complete the sentences with the words in the box. There is one expression too many – it doesn’t exist! sunburn suncream sundial sunfall sunflowers sunrise sunset sunspots sunstroke suntan sunglasses 1. Let’s just sit here and look at the ……………….………………….until it gets dark. 2. Those ……………………………………………………………are taller than I am. 3. If you don’t put on more…………………….., you’ll get …………………………. 4. John got……………………………….during the race. He’s been taken to hospital. 5. Apparently there are more……………………………than usual every eleven years. 6. I’ve lost my ………………………………………. Have you seen them anywhere? 7. That’s not a real……………………………………….She puts it on out of a bottle. 8. Do you think that………………………………………………..tells the right time? 9. What time is …………………………………………………….tomorrow morning? 284 13. Grammar in a text. Complete the news story with expressions from the box. Don’t forget to add ‘s or ‘: a man children girls the other children Josie and Cara local people the shopkeeper their grandmother their grandparents Police looking for two young girls The two girls disappeared from their grandmother’s garden in Ilkley yesterday evening. Josie and Cara Sharp, aged 7 and 9, were staying at (1) ……………………… house for a week. They were in Ilkley for a (2)………………. theatre course. The police have asked the course teachers for (3) ……………………names and addresses, and they have also put (4)………………. photos on local television. The two (5) ………………mother, Mrs Jenna Sharp, has appeared on TV as well. A shopkeeper thinks she saw Josie and Cara getting into (6) …………………….car; police officers have asked for (7) ……………..help with a photofit picture of the man. The police have also got (8) ………………… help in looking for the girls near the town. *nouns: revision test 1. Put a/an before the countable nouns, and some before the uncountables: ………advice ……..artist ………bread ………company ……….curtain …….furniture ………information ………job ……….joke …….journey ………money ……....publicity ……….traffic …….train ………travel 285 2. Write the plurals: baby: babies boy………. bus………. city……… crossroads…………… deer………. echo…….. loaf……… gas……………… half……….. kilo………. monkey………….. phenomenon……………… series…………….. watch……………….. piano………….. 3. What do you call these? 1. a shop that sells flowers ……………………………………………………………... 2. juice made from raspberries ………………………………………………………… 3. a brush for shoes …………………………………………………………………….. 4. a radio in a car ………………………………………………………………………. 5. a paper that you buy in the morning ………………………………………………… 6. bottles for water……………………………………………………………………… 7. poison for rats ………………………………………………………………………. 8. exams in universities………………………………………………………………… 9. a factory that makes marmalade ……………………………………………………. 10. a cupboard in a bathroom …………………………………………………………. 4. Right or wrong? Correct the mistakes or write ‘Correct’: E.g.: Are those Johns’ glasses? John’s I need some advice. correct 1. I’m going to buy some new furnitures. ……………………. 2. Athletics are my favourite kind of sport ……………………. 3. My Parker’s cattle have got out again. ……………………. 4. My family are planning to move to Scotland. ……………………. 5. The majority of the voters wants a change. ……………………. 6. The United States are having serious economic problems. ……………………. 7. Those keys are yours. My ones are on the kitchen table. ……………………. 8. I’d really like some juice of fruit. ……………………. 286 9. Do you know the basketball’s rules? ……………………. 10. I’ve lost Sue and Andy’s phone number ……………………. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – VEHICLES AND TRANSPORT82 1. Complete each sentence with a word from the box: captain crew guard pedestrian cyclist mechanic flight attendant motorist traffic warden chauffeur conductor driver a) The company chairman has a Rolls-Royce driven by a chauffeur. b) When my car broke down a passing …………………………...towed it to a garage. c) The police wanted me to describe the …………………………………….of the car. d) The four passengers on the ship had dinner with the ………………………………. e) The train couldn’t leave until the ……………………………. waved his green flag. f) Hilary was given a parking ticket by a ……………………………………………… g) Before take-off, the ………………………………….told me to fasten my seat belt. h) When I got on the ship, one of the ……………………….helped me find my cabin. i) There isn’t a …………………………………………on this bus, you pay the driver. j) Eddie is a keen ……………………………….and rides his bike to work every day. k) The bus mounted the pavement and injured a …………………………………….. l) Jim works as a …………………………………………………….in a local garage. 2. Choose the most suitable word or phrase to complete each sentence: a) The ship stopped because two passengers had fallen upside down/overboard/ underground/inside out. b) The platform/quay/runway/pavement was crowded with passengers waiting for the train. 82 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 287 c) We had to stop for petrol at a filling garage/service/pump/station. d) Mary looked up the fastest train to Glasgow in the catalogue/timetable/dictionary /programme. e) The train was very crowded because there were only four coaches/wagons/trucks /cars. f) Peter’s car crashed/collided/hit/skidded off the icy road and fell into a ditch. g) I dropped my wallet from the boat but luckily it drifted/floated/sank/rescued. h) Everything went dark when the train entered a/an underground/tunnel/tube/metro. i) David missed his train because of the queue in the ticket office/agency/room/ lounge. j) To get to our hotel we had to cross the railway road/route/rails/line. 3. Use the word given in capitals at the end of each line to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: A letter of apology I am writing to apologise for the (1) cancellation of your Happy CANCEL Holiday Coach Tour to Aberdeen. (2) ……………..our luxury FORTUNE coach was involved in a (3) …………….in France a week ago, COLLIDE and our driver has been (4) …………….obliged to remain there EXPECT for the moment. The coach was travelling on a road (5)………… SUIT for heavy traffic, and the accident was (6)……………Luckily AVOID none of the passengers suffered any (7) ……………, and we have INJURE complained to the authorities that the road needs (8)……………. WIDE Our new coach will be fitted with (9) ……………..seat belts for ADJUST the safety and comfort of passengers. We will of course return the (10)……………you have made for your holiday as soon as possible. 288 PAY 5. Complete each sentence with sail or ship, or a word formed from one of these words: a) Jack has been working as a sailor for ten years. b) We’re all flying home but our furniture is being …………………………………… c) What time does the ferry set ………………………………………………………..? d) We are expecting a ……………. ………………….of coffee from Brazil this week. e) We have decided to go for a …………………………………..tomorrow afternoon. f) When Paul was young, he ………………………………………….round the world. g) It’s time you were aboard …………………………………….. We’re leaving soon. h) Do you like………………………………………..? Or do you prefer water-skiing? i) Graham works in the harbour as a ……………………………………………..clerk. j) The boats on the lake had brightly coloured………………………………………… 6. Match the words in the box with a suitable description (a-j): chain gear parachute bonnet cockpit handlebars brakes deck oars wings a) An aeroplane has two of these: wings b) Change this in a car to change speed. ……………. c) Hold these when you ride a bicycle. ……………. d) This will save your life if you fall from a plane. ……………. e) You need these to row a boat. ……………. f) This might be on a bicycle or around your neck. ……………. g) Put these on if you want to stop. ……………. h) Your car engine is usually under this. ……………. i) Walk on this when you are on a ship. ……………. j) The pilot of a plane sits in this. ……………. 289 7. Complete each sentence with one suitable word: a) I’m really looking forward to sailing in Jean’s new yacht. b) In cities, cars and other vehicles……………………………….up most of the space. c) We’ll come with the van and ……………………………up the rest of the furniture. d) When the storm began, the small boat………………………for the nearest harbour. e) How can you ………………………………………up with all those exhaust fumes! f) We can’t ………………………………...up with that speedboat in the rowing boat! g) Jane likes………………………...off by driving her sports car at 100 miles an hour. h) A fire engine arrived and soon………………………………………….out the fire. i) Little Johnny is in the garden…………………………………..out his new tricycle. j) One way of ……………………………….with pollution is to use unleaded petrol. 8. Choose the right version: Past, present and future A hundred years ago, most people travelled (1) by/on/with/to foot, by train, or on horseback. (2) Tracks/Lines/Ways/Railways had made it possible to travel rapidly over long distances. Bicycles were also becoming (3) popular/invented/then/ handlebars, after the invention of the air-filled (4) boot/brake/tyre/engine, which made cycling a lot more comfortable. Buses, trams and (5) metro/buried/underground/ submerged railways had already been invented, and cities all over the world already had traffic (6) blocks/sticks/knots/jams. There were very few private cars, and city (7) streets/pavements/lawns/carts were still full of horses. What a difference a hundred years have (8) taken/done/made/got! (9) Presently/Nowadays/Then/Later we have got (10) more/them/motorists/used to the problem of private cars, and some cities are so noisy and (11) even/polluted/so/poisoned that in many places (12) vehicles/traffic/ transport/trips have been banned from the city centre. How will we be travelling in a hundred years’ time? Perhaps (13) cars/by/even/transport then there will be only personal helicopters. There may be no need to (14) have/transport/decide/commute to work or school in the future, since everyone will have a computer at home. There might even be more people walking and horse-riding, for pleasure and (15) exercise/ keep fit/energy/healthy. 290 VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS: TIME– SPENDING TIME83 A. AT WORK Florence works as a nurse. When she starts work she has to clock on [record the time she arrives at work, usually at a machine with a clock] and when she leaves she clocks off [record the time she leaves work]. If the machine shows that she has worked an extra long shift, the she is able to take time off [spend time away from work] at a later date. She was planning to take a holiday in July this year but has had to bring it forward [change the date or time of something so that it happens earlier than expected] as July is going to be a particularly busy time for her hospital this year. Florence loves her work, but her hospital is understaffed and she hates to always be pressed for [not have enough of something, usually time or money] time. She finds it almost impossible to fit in [find time to do something or see someone] time to talk to the patients although she feels that is an important part of her job. She can chat for a few minutes, but then she has to press on [continue doing something in a determined way] with her other duties. The hospital employs many nurses from overseas; but when their work permits run out [come to an end (of the period of time of a document or agreement); more formal equivalent is expire)] after two years they have to leave. B. AT LEISURE When Florence does have spare time, she likes to relax. She usually hangs out [spends a lot of time (informal)] with friends she was at school with. They have knocked around together [spent a lot of time with one another because they are good friends (informal)] for years and love whiling away [spending time in a relaxed way either because they are waiting for something, or have nothing special to do] their days off, going round the shops of just chatting at one of their homes. Sometimes they go away for a weekend and muck about [waste time doing silly things (informal)] at Florence’s aunt’s cottage in the countryside. Last time they did that, a colleague of 83 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 291 Florence’s latched on to [spent time with them, especially when they did not want her with them] them. The others didn’t really like her at first, especially as they always had to hang on [wait, usually for a short time (informal)] while she got ready, but now they all like her very much. 1. Complete these sentences with a verb from A: 1. I’m afraid I’m a bit ………………………for cash today. Could you lend me some? 2. Oh dear! My passport has ……………………...out. I must renew it before our trip. 3. I usually ……………………on at 9 a.m. every day, but if my train is late it might be 9.15. I……………………off at 5 p.m., but sometimes I can finish a bit earlier on Fridays. 4. Mr Chan wants to …………………….the meeting forward to this week, as he’s busy all next week. I’m not sure if we can………………….it in this week as we’re ever so busy too. 5. If we ……………………on after lunch we can probably finish the report by 5 p.m. 6. I’m going to………………….some time off next month and go and stay with my parents. 2. Write an appropriate question to fit each answer: 1. …………………………………………………………………………………….? Oh, I usually just hang out with friends, or sometimes I do some sport. 2. …………………………………………………………………………………….? Well, he never studied; he just spent all his time mucking about, so it’s no surprise. 3. …………………………………………………………………………………….? Oh, about ten years. We used to knock around together as teenagers. 4. ……………………………………………………………………………………...? No, she’s not a friend. She just latched on to our group and followed us. 5. ………………………………………………………………………………………? Oh, it’s great for whiling away the time if you’re waiting for a plane or a train. 6. ………………………………………………………………………………………? Let’s just hang on for five minutes. I want to speak to someone. 292 3. Correct the mistakes with the phrasal verbs in these sentences: 1. We had to wait an hour for the next train, so we went for a walk to while off the time. 2. A young French woman latched to me at the party last night. I think she wanted to practise her English. 3. I clock on work at 7.30 a.m. every morning. 4. We have to finish this job by six o’clock. We’d better press up with it. 5. I just don’t know how we’re going to fit three meetings on before the summer break. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS - SOCCER HOOLIGANISM84 1. Fighting broke out shortly after a football match between two rival clubs ended with the guests winning 4 to 1. Tension had been high for over an hour before the violence erupted. Fans rampaged through streets, smashing windows, tearing up fences and clashing with rival supporters. Trouble also broke out in pubs and at the station, as coachloads of fans were assembling to make their way home. Coaches had windows smashed and seats ripped. Twenty-five men, who were arrested by the police and now await trial, deny causing violent disorder. They were released on bail but barred from going within a mile’s radius of any football ground on a match day. 2. Football supporters who took part in the “fire bombing” of a train, endangering the safety of passengers, will be charged today. They are members of a gang of football hooligans who threw milk bottles full of petrol at a train carrying rival supporters. Four hundred fans damaged cars and hurled missiles during a spate of violence, when gangs of youths from opposing sides met each other near the station. The police charged the rioting supporters, many of whom were carrying offensive weapons. A number of officers were assaulted during the scuffle. It took police two hours to restore order and the match was put off till the next day. 84 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1, 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 293 3. New measures will be introduced today in an effort to stamp out the current wave of soccer hooliganism. Known offenders will be barred from going abroad on the day the team they support plays a match in a foreign country. They will have to report to their local police and make their presence known. Both police and football clubs are determined to gain control of unruly fans. The new laws mean that thugs may face up to ten years in jail for causing an affray. British supporters in particular are notorious – they get drunk on cheap whisky bought on the ferry to the Continent and then roam round towns in drunken packs. Those who indulge in violence and vandalism and who bring disrepute to the game are warned that they can expect no mercy. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Trouble erupted because the fans were unhappy with the score. 2. The fighting started immediately after the match. 3. Coaches were vandalized in the scuffle. 4. Those who were arrested are now back on the streets. 5. Hooligans wanted to set the train on fire. 6. The reason was that rival supporters were on that train. 7. More violence erupted at the stadium. 8. Some policemen were hurt because the rioters were well-equipped for fighting. 9. The match was played two hours after the police had restored order. 10. Known hooligans will not be allowed to travel abroad to support their team. 11. On that day, they will be locked up in jail. 12. Soccer violence is alcohol related. 13. Offenders will be severely punished as a warning to other thugs. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B high……………. disorder offensive……………. fans 294 rival…………………. hooliganism smashed………………. supporters soccer……………….. tension unruly……………….. weapons violent………………… windows 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the third story: TRAVELLING – TO – LAW – THUGS – CONVICTED – BY – BE – ABROAD – FROM – BARRED – SOCCER …………………………………………………………………………………………. …………………………………………………………………………………………. 4. Phrases to learn: - a pleca acasă: - m……………… w………………. h……………………… - a produce tulburări violente: - c…………….. v…………….. d………………….. - a elibera pe cauţiune: - r……………. o……………. b……………………. - a ameninţa securitatea: - e…………… the s……………… - a restabili ordinea: - r……………. o……………………. -a amâna pentru a doua zi: - p……………. o…………… t………….. the n……………….. d……………… - a introduce norme noi: - i………….. n……………. m………………….. - a confirma prezenţa – m…………… one’s p……………. k…………………….. - a nu te aştepta la clemenţă: - e…………. n……………. m………………….. 295 LESSON 19 *Grammar: Adjectives and Adverbs (1)* Vocabulary: General – Food, Restaurants and Cooking* Phrasal Verbs: Time – Passing of Time* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – The Homeless *** I. GRAMMAR – ADJECTIVES AND ADVERBS85 Adjectives are words like easy, slow, sorry, important. They can go before nouns, or after some verbs (e.g. be, seem, look, appear, smell, taste). Some kinds of adjective normally go before others (e.g. opinion before description). an interesting old cathedral The exact rules are complicated (and not very important). Adverbs are words like easily, slowly, yesterday, there. Different kinds of adverb go in different positions, for example with the verb, or at the end of a sentence. Harry often goes to Denmark. I’ve never seen a rhinoceros. I only play tennis with Gary. The team played badly last night. You are probably right. Some words (e.g. fast, loud, daily) can be both adjectives and adverbs. Many adverbs end in –ly (e.g. carefully). But a few words ending in –ly are adjectives (e.g. friendly) *revise the basics: adjectives, adverbs of manner ADJECTIVES: kind, shy, cold, angry, wonderful, bad, unusual, mad ADVERBS OF MANNER: kindly, shyly, coldly, angrily, wonderfully, badly, unusually, madly 85 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 296 #we use adjectives after some verbs, to say how something is, seems, becomes, looks, feels, sounds, tastes or smells She is kind. She seems/appears shy. He felt angry. That smells wonderful. It’s getting cold. #we use adverbs of manner with other verbs to say how something happens or is done. She spoke kindly but shyly. He answered me coldly. He closed the door angrily. 1. Complete the sentences with words from the box: beautiful beautifully calm calmly terribly unhappy unhappily slow slowly terrible 1. I suppose I should be nervous, but I’ve never felt so ……………………. in my life. 2. ‘I suppose we’ll never see each other again,’ she said………………………………. 3. The house is small and rather simple, but Anne has decorated it…………………… 4. This soup tastes ……………………………………………………………………... 5. He spoke very………………………………, but she heard every word like a shout. 6. The train was very…………………………; perhaps they were working on the line. 7. This is a ………………………...house. I enjoy looking at it every time I walk past. 8. The team played……………………………………………………….last Saturday. 9. Time seemed to go so……………………………………… When would he arrive? 10. He looks really…………………………………………….I wonder what’s wrong. #we also use adverbs before adjectives, past participles, other adverbs and prepositional expressions. It’s terribly cold. This is very badly cooked. You’re driving unusually fast. He was madly in love with her. 297 2. Choose the right word: 1. Angela is amazing/amazingly good with animals. 2. As soon as I saw him I was sure/surely he had been drinking. 3. Do you think that’s a real/really diamond in her ring? 4. I read an amazing/amazingly thing in the newspaper this morning. 5. One leg of the chair was slight/slightly damaged. 6. The door was bad/badly painted. 7. The food was wonderful/wonderfully, but the service was awful/awfully. 8. The room is clever/cleverly organised so three of us can work there. 9. We’re all complete/completely on your side. 10. He’s acted unbelievable/unbelievably stupidly in the past year. - some verbs are used with both adjectives and adverbs, with different meanings. You look angry. (= ‘You seem angry.’) He looked angrily at the manager. ( = ‘He turned his eyes…’) His plan appeared impossible. (= ‘His plan seemed….’) She suddenly appeared in the window. ( = ‘She was visible….’) *interested and interesting etc. #interested, bored, excited etc. say how people feel. interesting, boring, exciting etc. describe the people or things that cause the feelings I was very interested in the lesson. His lessons are always interesting. Do you ever get bored at work? My job’s pretty boring. 298 3. Complete the words: 1. I was surpris……... to see Ann there. 2. It was surpris……… to see her. 3. I find this work very tir…… 4. It makes me tir……. 5. Her exam results were disappoint……. 6. She was pretty disappoint……… 7. She was excit……….. about her new job. 8. It was an excit……….. new challenge. 9. We were shock……….to hear about your brother. 10. The news was really shock…………. 11. This explanation is very confus…………. 12. Reading it, I got confus…………….. 13. I get annoy……….. when people break promises. 14. It’s annoy………… when that happens. 4. Grammar and vocabulary: specialists. What are the people interested in? Make sentences with words from the two boxes: astronomer botanist cook doctor explorer fashion designer geographer historian linguist mathematician zoologist animals clothes food languages medicine numbers places plants the past the stars unknown places E.g.: An astronomer is interested in the stars. 1. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 2. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 5. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 299 6. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 7. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 8. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 9. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 10. …………………………………………………………………………………........ *adjectives without nouns: in the country of the blind #we can use the + adjective (without a noun) to talk about some social groups. the young the old the rich the poor the sick the disabled the blind the deaf the mentally ill the homeless the unemployed the dead #these expressions are plural: the blind means ‘blind people’. Compare: I’m collecting money for the blind. Do you know the blind person next door? I met a blind man on the train. #we can’t use all adjectives in this way: we don’t normally talk about the foreign or the greedy, for example. 5. Complete the sentences with expressions from the box: the blind the dead the living the living the old the poor the rich the rich the young the young the poor 1. In the country of ………………………….the one-eyed man is king. (Anonymous) 2. Love, like youth, is wasted on ……………………………………...(Sammy Cahn) 3. When the rich make war on each other, it’s …………...who die. (Jean-Paul Sartre) 4. It’s all that……………....can do for……………, to shock them and keep them up to date. (George Bernard Show) 300 5. ‘Let me tell you about………………………...They are different from you and me.’ ‘Yes, they have more money.’ (F Scott Fitzgerald and Ernest Hemingway) 6. We owe respect to the dead; to ……………………….we owe only truth. (Voltaire) 7. …………...have more children, but …………….have more relatives. (Anonymous) 8. Pray for ………………….and fight like hell for …………………..(Mother Jones). #the structure is also used with the following nationality words: Dutch, English, French, Irish, Spanish, Welsh. The Welsh have a very old literary tradition. But: I like the Welshman who works in the garage. #Note: Most other nationality words are nouns, not adjectives. The Brazilians speak Portuguese. *order of adjectives: a terrible little boy; old and grey #this is a complicated (and not very important) point of grammar. The following rules have exceptions. Words for colour, origin/place, material and purpose go in that order. Other adjectives come before these. OTHER COLOUR ORIGIN/PLACE MATERIAL PURPOSE Noun old red Spanish riding boots a funny brown German beer mug leather 7. Here are descriptions from a newspaper, a journal, a biography and a novel. Rewrite each description in the right order: E.g.: club: jazz, local: local jazz club (place before purpose) 1. buildings: modern, industrial: ………………………………………………………. 2. dress: evening, silk, red: ……………………………………………………………. 3. eyes: narrow, colourless: …………………………………………………………… 4. trunks: black, swimming, nylon: …………………………………………………… 5. frame: gold, flat: ……………………………………………………………………. 301 6. tie: blue, woolen: …………………………………………………………………… 7. jacket: short, leather: ……………………………………………………………….. 8. boots: French, ski: ………………………………………………………………….. #opinions often come before descriptions OPINION DESCRIPTION NOUN funny old buildings a terrible little boy nice new clothes 8. Rewrite these descriptions in the right order: Ex: books: old, terrible: terrible old books (opinion + description) 1. city: Belgian, beautiful, little: ……………………………………………………….. 2. dinner: excellent, cold: ……………………………………………………………… 3. furniture: old, lovely: ……………………………………………………………….. 4. ideas: strange, new: ………………………………………………………………… 5. university: grey, concrete, depressing: …………………………………………...... # we use and with adjectives that refer to different parts of something. Compare: a long green dress a long green and black dress # when adjectives come after a verb, we usually put and before the last. He was tall, dark and handsome. I’m cold, tired and hungry. 9. Rewrite the words in italics, adding and if necessary: E.g.: The brick was rough/pink: a narrow/brown room: rough and pink narrow, brown 302 1. hot/breezy weather: …………………………….. ……………………………... …… 2. untidy/red hair: ……………………………………………………………………… 3. The man was young/bearded: ………………………………………………………. 4. The sea was cold/rough: ……………………………………………………………. 5. The church was old/ugly: …………………………………………………………… 6. a quiet/tense woman: ……………………………………………………………….. 7. yellow/grey sand: …………………………………………………………………… 8. The badges were red/blue: …………………………………………………………. #first, next and last usually come before numbers. the first three weeks my last two holidays *adverbs with the verb: I can never wake up in time #adverbs that go with the verb include words expressing frequency (e.g. always, often, usually, never) and certainty (e.g. definitely, probably). Note the exact position: AFTER AM/ARE/IS/WERE AFTER AUXILIARY VERBS You are usually right. She has probably forgotten. It was certainly cold. I can never wake up in time. BEFORE OTHER VERBS NOT BETWEEN VERB AND OBJECT He always forgot my birthday. NOT: He forgot always I often get headaches. NOT: I get often 10. Make ten sentences about yourself and people you know, from the box: I am always usually ……………..is sometimes ……………..are occasionally often not often never happy late friendly bad-tempered depressed in love 303 tired worried in trouble E.g.: My father is often bad-tempered. 1………………………………………………………………………………………… 2………………………………………………………………………………………… 3………………………………………………………………………………………… 4………………………………………………………………………………………… 5………………………………………………………………………………………… 6………………………………………………………………………………………… 7………………………………………………………………………………………… 8………………………………………………………………………………………… 9………………………………………………………………………………………… 10………………………………………………………………………………………. 11. Say how often you do some of the following things: stay in bed late have bad dreams eat chocolate get headaches play tennis read poetry fall in love go to concerts play the piano forget people’s names go to the doctor write letters get depressed feel happy go skiing E.g.: I sometimes stay in bed late. go to the cinema cook go swimming I don’t often go to the doctor. 1. ……………………………………………………………………………………….. 2………………………………………………………………………………………… 3………………………………………………………………………………………… 4………………………………………………………………………………………… 5……………………………………………………………………………………….... 6……………………………………………………………………………………….... 7……………………………………………………………………………………….... 8………………………………………………………………………………………… 9………………………………………………………………………………………… 10……………………………………………………………………………………….. 304 12. These sentences are all taken from real recorded conversations. Can you put the adverbs in the right places? E.g.: You are here when something happens. (usually): are usually here. 1. Her mum cooks a meal in the evenings. (always): …………………………………. 2. We book that April holiday in January. (usually): …………………………………. 3. They think that we have got bread. (probably): …………………………………….. 4. You should look where you’re going. (always): ……………………………………. 5. She is going to stay overnight. (probably): …………………………………………. 6. Chocolate cakes are the best. (definitely): ………………………………………….. 7. I will be able to get it cheaper. (probably): …………………………………………. 8. I have had an illness in my life. (never): ……………………………………………. 9. We saw sweets in those days. (never): ……………………………………………… 10. I remember buying some. (definitely): …………………………………………….. #if there is more than one auxiliary verb, adverbs of frequency and certainty usually go after the first auxiliary. The roof has never been repaired. I will definitely be seeing him tonight. #adverbs go before or after not, depending on the meaning. Compare: It’s definitely not raining. She’s not often late. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – FOOD, RESTAURANTS AND COOKING86 1. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) Waiter, could you bring me the account/bill/ addition, please? b) It’s a very popular restaurant – we should apply for/book/keep a table. c) If you’re hungry, why not ask for a large dish/plate/portion? 86 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 305 d) Please help/serve/wait yourself to salads from the salad bar. e) Waiter, can I see the catalogue/directory/menu, please? f) This fish is not what I called/commanded/ordered. g) This dish/plate/serving is a speciality of our restaurant. h) Have you tried the crude/raw/undercooked fish at the new Japanese restaurant? i) Paul never eats meat, he’s a vegetable/vegetarian/vegetation. j) Have you decided what to have for your main course/food/helping? 2. Complete each sentence (a-j) with a suitable ending (1-10). Use each ending once: a)Dinner’s nearly ready. Can you lay…6 1.up if you dry and put the dishes away. b)There’s some meat in the fridge. Just 2.it up in the microwave oven for a few warm…. minutes. c)Keep an eye on the milk or it might 3. coffee you made for me this morning. boil…. d)Jake likes his steak rare but I prefer 4.meal mine well…. at the pub opposite the supermarket. e)When we finish lunch, I’ll do the 5.knife as it makes really thin slices. washing…. f)I always cut roast beef with an electric 6.the small table in the dining room? carving… g)Mary bought a lovely set of cups 7.saucers in the sales last week. and…. h)They serve a very cheap three course… 8.done, but not burnt if you see what I mean. i)I really enjoyed that freshly ground…. 9.away the plates and bring the next course. j) If you have finished eating I’ll clear…. 10.over and make a mess on the cooker. 306 3. Complete each phrase with the most suitable word from the box: bacon butter forks pepper beer grapes saucers bread chocolate instant coffee chips wine a) cups and saucers g) a loaf of……………………….. b) fish and ……………… h) a bottle of …………………….. c) knives and …………… i) a can of ……………………….. d) bread and ……………. j) a bar of………………………… e) eggs and ……………… k) a jar of ……………………….. f) salt and ……………….. l) a bunch of…………………….. 4. Complete each sentence with one suitable word: a) I’m trying to cut down on fatty food. b) Don’t worry! The smell of garlic wears ……………………………….after a while. c) Let’s look………………………………...the market before we buy any vegetables. d) I can’t understand this recipe. Can you work……………………….what it means? e) I’m afraid I don’t feel up ……………………………….eating another cream cake. f) I visited a farm once, and it put me ………………………. eating meat for a week. g) I haven’t got………………………………………………..to cleaning the fish yet. h) Why don’t we warm……………………………….last night’s leftovers for lunch? i) Keith usually makes…………………………………..his recipes as he goes along. j) The waiter seemed a bit put…………………………....when we didn’t leave a tip. 5. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) Would you prefer poached/ground/mashed/powdered potatoes or chips? b) I bought this bread four days ago and now it’s stale/off/bad/rotten. c) Don’t forget to buy a packet of chilled/frozen/frosted/chilly peas. d)Can you give me the prescription/instructions/ingredients/recipe for this pie? It’s delicious. 307 e)There was a wonderful smell of cooking/roasting/baking/grilling bread in the kitchen. f) Don’t buy those fish, they aren’t very fresh/new/recent/young. g) I’d like to eat more of this cake, but it’s very fat/fatty/fattened/fattening. h) Waiter, I can’t eat this meat. It’s under-done/developed/nourished/weight. i) Is the hamburger for you to eat here, or to go out/take away/carry on/sit down? j) That was fantastic. Could I have a second plate/course/helping/service, please? 6. Make a word or compound word to match the description: a) A spoon used for putting sugar in tea. teaspoon b) A cloth put on the table at meal times. ……………….. c) A metal device for opening bottles. ……………….. d) A pot in which tea is made. ……………….. e) An electrical appliance for making toast. ……………….. f) A cup specially made for coffee. ……………….. g) An omelette containing mushrooms. ……………….. h) An electrical appliance for mixing food. ……………….. i) A napkin made of paper. ……………….. j) The amount contained in a tablespoon. ………………. k) An electrical appliance for washing dishes. ………………. 7. Choose the right version: Chickpea soup This recipe is both (1) expensive/tasty/worth/cold and cheap. If you use dried chickpeas, (2) soak/bury/wash/water them for at least twelve hours in cold water. Drain them and put them in a large (3) kettle/mug/sink/saucepan with plenty of water. Bring them to the boil, and then let them simmer gently (4) when/until/if/enough the chickpeas are soft. I find it easier to use (5) the/to/canned/crude chickpeas, which are already cooked. This (6) makes/takes/saves/gives time, and also guarantees that the chickpeas will be soft, since it can take hours of boiling before they (7) soften/harden /widen/lengthen. Two small 450 gram cans are usually (8) much/enough/mine/few. 308 Strain the chickpeas, but keep some of the liquid for the soup. (9) Grate/Peel/Beat/ Pour three tablespoons of olive oil into a saucepan, and gently heat a chopped (10) onion/up/one/water, two or three cloves of garlic and some (11) melted/beaten/ poached/sliced carrot. (12) One/Then/Add/Serve half the chickpeas and then turn them in the oil over a low heat. Meanwhile blend the remaining chickpeas in a food (13) just/not/dish/mixer until they make a smooth cream. Add about half a litre of water to the vegetables and bring to the boil. Mix in the creamed chickpeas and cook slowly. Add salt and (14) paper/puppy/pepper/poppy and a pinch of mixed herbs. Some (15) cookers/cooks/cookery/chiefs and lemon juice at the end. VOCABULARY: GENERAL: PHRASAL VERBS: TIME – PASSING OF TIME87 A. THE PAST Journey into the past at the Charnbury Folk Museum: If you’re young, come on a journey into the past before you were born. If you’re senior, let us take you back [make you remember a period or an event in the past] to your childhood. Think back [think about things that happened in the past] to what everyday life was like 50, 60, 100 years ago, before TV, before computers, before fridges and washing machines. Many of our exhibits date back [have existed since a particular time] to the early 19th century. Is that old vacuum cleaner in your attic just a leftover [something which exists from an earlier time] from a bygone [from a time which does not exist any more] era or is it a piece of industrial history? Come and find out. *Leftover and bygone are formed from the verbs be left over and go by. We used some balloons that were left over from the Christmas party to decorate the house for her birthday. [still existed / were unused from an earlier time] As time goes by you realise that your parents’ advice was in your best interest. [passes] 87 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 309 *Note that bygone also exists as a noun, but it is usually always in the plural bygones. B. TIME MOVING I’m sorry to hold you up but you must sign these forms before you go in. [delay you] If there are no hold-ups, we should arrive by about seven o’clock. [delays] Jim, can you hurry the kids up. The coach is about to leave. [make them act more quickly] Mum walks so fast. It’s quite hard to keep up with her. [go at the same speed as someone] The meeting dragged on and everyone got irritable. [continued for too long] I’m sorry I’m late. My French lesson ran on, so I didn’t leave school till 4.30 p.m. [continued for longer than expected] Three weeks passed by before I got a reply to my letter of complaint. [went past] It’s difficult to plan for the future. Nobody knows what lies ahead [will happen in the future] 1. Write the best phrasal verb expression from the options below to complete the text: The film is a time travel adventure and I found it very entertaining though my companion felt that it (1) passed by/dragged on/held up/dated back a bit. At the beginning it (2) thinks back/hurries you up/takes you back/holds you up to the Iron Age where the hero is living an ordinary Iron-Age life. He eats a mysterious plant, however, and the years suddenly start (3) going by/lying ahead/hurrying up/keeping up like minutes. Suddenly he is in the future and, as he is now a (4) bygone/holdup/bygones/leftover from a (5) bygone/hold-up/bygones/leftover era, he finds it very hard to understand what is going on. This results in a number of amusing incidents. Although the plot is occasionally a little difficult to follow I would certainly recommend it. 310 2. Explain the difference in meaning between these pairs of sentences: 1. a) The lecture ran on./ b) The lecture dragged on. 2. a) John held us up./ b) John hurried us up. 3. a)This song takes me back to my childhood./ b) This song dates back to my childhood. 4. a) It was not easy to keep up with the children as we went through town. / b) It was not easy to hurry up the children as we went through town. 3. Here are some things people might say relating to time. What does the speaker mean in each sentence? 1. The older you get, the faster time goes by. 2. Music and smells have great powers to take you back. 3. Mr Jones is a leftover from a bygone age. 4. We should let bygones be bygones! 5. You never know what lies ahead. 4. Rewrite these sentences using the words in brackets. Write the words in the correct form: 1. The old oil lamps in my grandfather’s house looked like things that had survived from a different era. (LEFTOVER, BYGONE) ………………………………………………………………………………………. 2. The smell of chalk always reminds me of my schooldays. (TAKE BACK) ………………………………………………………………………………………. 3. The traffic was delayed on the motorway because of an accident. (HOLD-UP) ………………………………………………………………………………………. 4. Sometimes, if the textbook is boring, the lesson seems to last longer than it should. (DRAG ON) ………………………………………………………………………………………. 311 5. We can never know what the future will bring. (LIE AHEAD) ………………………………………………………………………………………. 6. These pizzas were from the party. Nobody ate them. Would you like one? (LEFTOVER) ………………………………………………………………………………………. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS – THE HOMELESS88 A group of squatters have taken possession of a derelict building under the slogan “The Homeless Help Themselves”. Although the commandeered building is in an appalling condition, they promise to make the hovel habitable again. They will do it up and turn it into a place where the homeless can have a warm bed and a hot meal. The deserted property had remained disused and boarded up for the last year. Even in its present state, the squatters say, it is much better than sleeping rough. At the moment, there are seventy people housed there, their ages ranging from twenty to seventy-six. In a press interview, the man behind the project talked about how easy it is to end up on the street and, describing the meagre resources now at his disposal, appealed for donations and voluntary work. Impressed by his determination to keep the project going, many people have responded. Donations of bedding, clothes and food are slowly coming in. The action raises the question of the government’s responsibility to provide cheap rented accommodation for people who need assistance in this respect. Too many of the nation’s poor are unable to find an affordable place to rent. However, among them are people who have made themselves intentionally homeless. These cases are not top priority on the housing list. It is widely felt that the government money, which is desperately needed to finance shelters for the desolate and the dispossessed, is being misused. Most of the “meals-on-wheels” programmes and soup kitchens are funded by charity organizations. The current action offers more than just a roof over people’s heads. It is a means of helping the homeless to move back into the social system. Yet, despite their 88 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 312 efforts at self-help, the squatters may still face eviction, as the city council is reluctant to give up its plans to pull the building down. A demolition contractor has already surveyed the building, which is scheduled for demolition next month. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. The building that was commandeered by the squatters is in a terrible condition. 2. The squatters want to turn it into a hotel. 3. They occupied the building because it had been abandoned for a year. 4. The building looks so bad that, for the time being, it is still better to sleep in the park. 5. At the moment, there are 76 people staying there. 6. The organizer of the squat has asked for public financial support. 7. Many people are contributing whatever they can to keep the place going. 8. The government is failing in its responsibility to help people on the streets. 9.There are many cases where people are homeless because they do not want to return to their homes. 10. Soup kitchens are being financed by the government. 11. The only problem that the homeless have is where to stay for the night. 12. It is likely that the squatters will soon have to find another place to stay. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B affordable …………….. bed appalling………………… building charity…………………. condition derelict………………… interview deserted………………. list hot……………………… meal housing………………… organization meagre………………… place 313 press…………………… property voluntary……………….. resources warm…………………… work 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: SQUATTERS – HOMELESS – FOR – CLAIM – SCHEDULED – SHELTER – DEMOLITION ………………………………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: - a lua în posesiune: - t…………….. p…………….. of - a dormi sub cerul liber: - s…………… r………………… - a rămâne fără casă: - e…………… u…………. o………… the s…………….. -a face apel pentru donaţii şi muncă voluntară: - a………….. d………….. f…………. and v…………. w……………… - a ridica o problemă: - r……………… a q…………….. -locuinţă de închiriat la un preţ accesibil: - a…………… p…………… to r…………. - finanţat de instituţii de binefacere: - f…………. by c……………. o………………. - a nu fi dispus să abandonezi un plan: - be r……………. to g………… u…………. p………………… -a demola o casă: - p………….. d…………. a b……………… 314 LESSON 20 *Grammar: Adjectives and Adverbs (2)* Vocabulary: General – Shops and Shopping* Phrasal Verbs: Location* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Experiments on Animals *** I. GRAMMAR - ADJECTIVES AND ADVERBS (2)89 *even and only; end-position adverbs #even and only can go just before the words that they emphasise He plays tennis even in the rain. They’ve lived here only a few weeks. He eats anything – even raw potatoes. Only you could do a thing like that! #but they most often go with the verb when they focus on words later in the sentence He even plays tennis in the rain. They’ve only lived here for a few weeks. He’s rude to everybody. He’s even rude to me. I only liked the first part of the concert. 1. Put in even or only: E.g.: She talks to her brother. (only) She only talks to her brother. 1. He sings in his sleep. (even) ……………………………….. 2. I am doing this because I love you. (only) ……………………………….. 3. She gets up at six on Sundays. (even) ……………………………….. 4. He wears a suit on holiday. (even) ……………………………….. 89 Michael Swan &`Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 315 5. She ate a piece of dry toast. (only) ……………………………….. 6. I can play very easy music. (only) ……………………………….. 7. He can’t write his own name. (even) ……………………………….. 8. They make you pay for a carrier bag. (even) ……………………………….. 9. I’m sorry. I was trying to help. (only) ……………………………….. 10. You can ski there in summer. (even) ……………………………….. #at the end of a sentence we often put words and expressions which say how, where, when. They most often go in that order. She sang very well at the concert last night. The children were playing quietly in the garden. He works in the garage on Tuesdays. He’s working there now. Let’s go to bed early. #we do not normally put adverbs between a verb and its object. You speak English very well. Can you repair my watch now? 2. Put the words in brackets into the sentences (not before the verb): E.g.: I work at night. (best): I work best at night. 1. I don’t think she plays tennis. (very well) …………………………… 2. He always moves very slowly. (in the morning) …………………………… 3. She was crying in her room. (quietly) …………………………… 4. We talked about it briefly. (at lunchtime) …………………………… 5. I’m going to break the eggs into the bowl. (carefully) …………………………… 6. Ann works at the village shop. (on Saturdays) …………………………… 7. I paid at once. (the bill) …………………………… 8. She speaks Japanese. (fluently) …………………………… 9. I can’t explain my feelings. (clearly) …………………………… 316 10. The team played yesterday. (brilliantly) …………………………… #after verbs of movement, the order can be different: we must often put an expression of place first He went upstairs quietly. *confusing adjectives and adverbs: fast, hard, late….. #Some words can be both adjectives and adverbs. If you’ve got a fast car, why don’t you drive fast? More examples: daily early well yearly hard late loud monthly weekly 3. Put in suitable words: 1. It’s getting ……………………………………………, so I’m going to stop work. 2. The Times is a ………………………….paper (but it isn’t published on Sundays). 3. The postman’s …………………………..I wasn’t expecting him for another hour. 4. She speaks English very …………………………… She must have spent time in an English-speaking country. 5. We usually have ………………..meetings, but there were only two in September. 6. Don’t talk so………………………………………………………It hurts my head. 7. If you want me to work………………………………, you’ll have to pay me more. 8. Fresh milk is delivered…………………………………………...to the local shops. 9. I’m sorry I’m ………………….. My train arrived very…………………………… 10. I can’t stand ………………………………………………………………...noises. #some words that end in –ly are adjectives, not adverbs. She’s a very friendly person. She always speaks in a friendly way. (NOT: She always speaks friendly) 317 More examples: cowardly deadly likely lovely silly ugly lively lonely 4. Put in suitable words: 1. Curare is a ……………………………………………………………………poison. 2. I don’t think rain is very ……………………………………………………....today. 3. What………………………………………………………………………....flowers! 4. Why does he wear such a ……………………………………………………….hat? 5. She was……………………………………………………, so she got herself a dog. 6. This music is really depressing. Can you put on something more………………….? 7. He was too…………………………………………..to tell the boss he was leaving. 8. Cinderella was beautiful, but she had two……………………………………sisters. *adjectives and adverbs: more practice 5. Adjective or adverb? Choose the correct word: 1. I haven’t got much money. If I travel this year, I’ll have to do it cheap/cheaply. 2. I felt her arm gentle/gently to see if any bones were broken. 3. Her hair is so soft/softly – like a baby’s hair. 4. Mary doesn’t speak very clear/clearly. I often have trouble understanding her. 5. You’re looking very happy/happily today. 6. I’m sorry, but you’re complete/completely wrong. 7. He may appear stupid/stupidly, but in fact he’s extreme/extremely intelligent. 8. That fish smells bad/badly. 9. Please carry this very careful/carefully. 10. John was in an accident yesterday, but he wasn’t bad/badly hurt. 318 6. Mixed structures. Right or wrong? Correct the mistakes or write ‘Correct’: E.g.: Please don’t drive so fastly. fast I’m not well today. correct 1. She spoke to me very cold. ……………. 2. The soup tastes wonderfully. ……………. 3. The play was brilliantly performed. ……………. 4. I feel lonely these days. ……………. 5. There’s a deaf in the downstairs flat. …………….. 6. You speak very well Japanese. …………….. 7. The secretary always smiles at me friendly. ……………… 8. Don’t talk so loud – I’m not deaf. ……………… 9. He always wears blue old jeans. ……………… 10. I was very boring in the maths lesson today. ……………… 7. Focusing adverbs. Complete the sentences with expressions from the box. Put in only or even. brush their teeth for a few minutes on Sundays really understands me she likes rats watch tennis the cat thinks the clock the guides got lost E.g.: My mother: Only my mother really understands me. 1. I work every day, ………………………………………………………………….. 2. They do everything together. They………………………………………...together. 3. She likes all animals: ………………………………………………………………. 4. Everybody thinks you’re wrong. …………………………………….you’re wrong. 5. Everything went quiet. :…………………………………………...broke the silence. 6. You can borrow it, but……………………………………………………………… 7. They all got lost in the fog.: ……………………………………………………….. 319 8. I don’t like sport much. I ……………………………………………….sometimes. 8. Grammar and vocabulary: personality. Choose one word from each pair in the box to complete the definitions: bad-tempered/good-tempered open/reserved practical/not practical generous/mean optimistic/pessimistic shy/self-confident hard-working/lazy patient/impatient slow-thinking/quick-thinking sociable/unsociable 1. An……………………………………………………….person doesn’t like waiting. 2. A………………………………………………………….. person easily gets angry. 3. A………………………… ………... person is good at making and mending things. 4. A……………………………………………………….. person doesn’t like giving. 5. A…………………………... person often doesn’t like to be talked to or looked at. 6. A………………………………………………………………. person likes parties. 7. A……………………………………. person doesn’t like to talk about him/herself. 8. A………………………………………………………… person doesn’t like work. 9. An……………………………..person thinks that things will probably be all right. 10. A……………………………………. person can soon find solutions to problems. 9. Confusing adjectives and adverbs. Choose the best words to complete the quotations: 1. ‘Say it loud/hard/friendly, I’m Black and proud.’ (Title of song by James Brown) 2. ‘Once the toothpaste is out of the tube, it’s awfully fast/silly/hard to get it back in’. (H R Haldeman) 3. ‘People tell me there are a lot of guys like me, which doesn’t explain why I’m lovely/lonely/lively’. (Mort Sahl) 4. ‘Give us this day our daily/weekly/friendly bread.’ (The Lord’s Prayer) 5. ‘The universe is not hostile, nor is it lonely/silly/friendly. It is simply indifferent.’ (J B Holmes) 320 6. ‘It is better to be beautiful than to be good. But….it is better to be good than to be loud/ugly/lovely.’ (Oscar Wilde) *adjectives and adverbs: revision test 1. Write the sentences with the adverbs in the correct positions: 1. That girl spends hours in the bathroom. (always) ………………………………….. 2. I have been to Jamaica. (never) ………………………………….. 3. We got home very late. (last night) ………………………………….. 4. Somebody was trying to open the door. (definitely)………………………………… 5. He puts tomato ketchup on cornflakes. (even) …………………………………. 6. Life is hard. (sometimes) …………………………………. 7. I know some French, and I speak Russian. (very badly) …………………………… 8. We have been invited to Jamie’s parties. (never) …………………………… 9. Alice needs somebody to help her. (probably). …………………………… 10. The water was too cold for swimming. (usually) …………………………… 2. Right or wrong? Correct the mistakes or write ‘Correct’: E.g.: She works too hardly. hard I’m terribly happy. correct 1. I’m collecting money for the blind. …………… 2. Jake always is so optimistic. …………… 3. ‘Hi!’, she said friendly. …………… 4. I’m really not interesting in that woman’s problems. …………… 5. Alex has never been to my house. …………… 6. The thieves took even my old clothes. …………… 7. Your hair looks beautifully. …………… 8. The work isn’t complete finished. …………… 9. I only believe half of what he says. …………… 10. Please put the glasses away careful. …………… 321 II. VOCABULARY – GENERAL – SHOPS AND SHOPPING90 1. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) That new clothes shop has a lot of very good bargains/sales. b) It costs $9, so give her $10, and she’ll give you $1 change/rest. c) I don’t go to that supermarket because it’s a bit priced/pricey. d) You cannot return goods without the original recipe/receipt. e) Supasoft Soaps are for sale/on sale here. f) A carrier bag is free with each buyer/purchase over $10. g) If you pay cash, we can give you a 10 per cent cutting/discount. h) How much did you pay/spend for your new shoes? i) This is a good show shop, but the costs/prices are very high. 2. Rewrite each sentence so that it includes the word given in capitals: Ex: a) I can’t manage to see what the price is. Let’s ask inside. MAKE I can’t make out what the price is. Let’s ask inside b) Is this coat the right size? Can I check? TRY …………………………………………………………………………………… c) Two masked men robbed the supermarket yesterday. HELD …………………………………………………………………………………… d) You need a new coat. Your old one is too small. GROWN …………………………………………………………………………………… e) I’ve been shopping all morning. I feel exhausted. WORN …………………………………………………………………………………… f) I’ll come and collect the goods on Thursday. PICK …………………………………………………………………………………… 90 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 322 g) Sorry, we don’t have any bread left. RUN …………………………………………………………………………………… h) Are you going to the chemist’s? CALLING …………………………………………………………………………………… i) I don’t like supermarkets. I can’t bear the queues. PUT …………………………………………………………………………………… j) I don’t know whether to buy this car. I’ll consider it. OVER …………………………………………………………………………………… 3. Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: change deliver find fit go help order pay queue serve try wrap a) You have to queue for ages to pay in this supermarket. b) In the London area, we …………………………furniture free of charge in our van. c) The trousers I bought are the wrong size. I’d like to…………………………..them. d) Could somebody…………………….me, please? I’ve been waiting for ten minutes. e) Is this a present? Would you like me to …………………………………..it for you? f) I like the colour of this skirt, but it doesn’t ………………………………………me. g) Good morning, madam. Can I…………………………………………………..you? h) We don’t have your size at the moment, but we can ……………………. it for you. i) Can you………………………………………………..at the other cash desk, please. j) Would you like to…………………………………………………on this green pair? k) I went shopping but couldn’t ………………………………..exactly what I wanted. l) Food is so expensive now. Prices seem to …………………………...up all the time. 323 4. Complete each sentence (a-j) with a suitable ending (1-10). Use each ending once: a)I bought my new television from a 1.centre near the public library? department …. 5 b)Don’t forget to write a shopping…. 2.register doesn’t work. c)Can you pay over there? This cash…. 3.of that new shop next to the post office. d)Most of the tourists went bargain…. 4.size box of paper tissues. e)Why don’t we go to the new shopping…. 5.store in the town centre. f) Quite late at night the little corner ….. 6.shop down the road is still open. g)It would be much better to buy an 7. assistant in a shoe shop. economy…. h)Don’t forget that we have to stop at the 8.list before we go to the market filling…. tomorrow. i)There’s a very nice suit on display in the 9.station to get some petrol. window… j)Mary has just started work as a shop…. 10.hunting in the old part of the city. 5. Choose the right version: a) I bought these jeans very cheaply in the bargains/reductions/sales/discounts. b) The washing instructions for this shirt are given on the label/badge/notice/mark. c)All the small shop assistants/shoppers/shopkeepers/shop stewards closed their shops in protest at the price rises. d) We don’t have the CD, I’m afraid. It’s out of order/stock/shelf/sale. e)The street market was full of counters/boutiques/tables/stalls selling fruit and vegetables. f)The shop opposite my house sells a variety of objects/purchases/goods/productions. g)I’m sorry, but the dress you want is not possible/economical/suitable/available in red. h) Every Friday you can buy cheap vegetables in the market street/place/store/sales. i) I like street markets, because you shop in the open prices/sunshine/bargains/air. 324 j) I like your new car. What brand/make/name/label is it? 6. Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: baked beans chocolates jam breakfast cereal flowers a) a tube of toothpaste b) a bunch of ……………… c) a pot of ……………… d) a tin of ……………… e) a box of ……………… f) a box of ……………… g) a packet of ………………. h) a bar of ………………. i) a carton of ………………. j) a tub of ………………. orange juice margarine soap paper tissues toothpaste 7. Match the words in the box with a suitable description (a-j): advertisement bargain catalogue deposit purse receipt trolley wallet list manager a) You push this in the supermarket and fill it with food. trolley b) You are given this as proof of buying something. ……… c) This tries to persuade you to buy something. ……… d) You put money, especially banknotes, in this. ………. e) This person is in charge of a shop. ………. f) You might make this before you go shopping. ……….. g) Leave this if you can’t pay now but want to buy later. ……….. h) Do this if you want to get a better price. ……….. i) Coins are usually carried in this, especially by women. ……….. 325 j) Read this to find descriptions of goods. ……….. 8. Use the word given in capitals at the end of each line to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: Supermarkets Nowadays, a great (1) variety of different food is available VARY from large supermarkets. There are rarely any (2)……………. SHORT of fresh food, and there is far less (3)…………….of our having LIKELY to rely on (4) …………………products. Does this mean that FREEZE supermarkets have become the most (5) …………….shops of SUCCESS all time? Certainly they seem to have made some kinds of food less (6) …………….and most people enjoy shopping in EXPENSE them. There has been a (7) ……………in the number of REDUCE (8) …………….made against supermarkets in recent years. COMPLAIN The assistants are no longer (9) ………………., but smile and POLITE try to be helpful. Above all, supermarkets have shown a (10)………………to listen to their customers, and to adapt to WILLING customers’ needs. 9. Choose the right version: Street markets Most people enjoy looking for (1) cheap/sale/inexpensive/bargains in street markets. It can be very enjoyable walking around the (2) tables/stalls/boxes/stores, among the crowds of (3) shoppers/public/buys/goods, and trying to spend as (4) little/soon/late/is as possible. Of course it depends (5) from/with/on/to the market. In fruit and (6)salads/green/farm/vegetable markets, there is usually a wide variety of (7) new/fresh/young/early produce, but it may not be cheap. There may be goods at (8) half/bottom/reduced/down prices at the end of the day, however. Clothes markets can be a problem, as it is difficult to (9) look/try/have/take on new clothes in the open (10) time/shop/light/air! My favourite are antique markets, where although there is not much (11) likelihood/instead/in spite/luck of finding valuable objects which are also 326 cheap, you can enjoy yourself looking at all the things for (12) that/all/sale/others. Whatever kind of market you look (13) round/for/up/out, and whether you buy things or not, you usually (14) shut/bring/get/end up feeling completely worn (15) clothes/ however/out/through. Still, it is an interesting way of shopping. VOCABULARY: GENERAL: PHRASAL VERBS: LOCATION91 A. Describing where places are: example meaning We stayed in a lovely hotel which was was in a quiet or hidden place that not tucked away in a little valley. many people see or go to Our room opened onto a balcony with opened in the direction of the countryside lovely views of the countryside. or had a view of it Fields and woods stretched away to the continued over a long distance horizon. We could see a few farmhouses which were in different parts of a large area and were spread out over the landscape. not close together We felt we were completely cut off from very far away from other places and the busy modern world! people B. People in locations: Read this conversation between two students: Deb: Come in, John. John: What a great room! Deb: Well, I like it. It was a bit dull when I moved in, but I bought these nice curtains which help to brighten it up [make more attractive, often by adding colours]! In fact, I like it so much here that I’d rather stay in [remain at home, especially in the evenings] than go out most evenings. John: You’re lucky! The room I rent is so miserable that I stay out [come home late or not come home at night] as long as I can! I even stayed on [stayed in a place 91 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 327 longer than planned] in the library tonight until it closed! Anyhow, I’ve come to bring you your file – you left it behind [left a place without taking something with you] at the seminar this morning. Deb: Oh, thanks. How silly of me. I’m glad you noticed it. John: Well, I stayed behind [did not leave a place when other left it] to ask the Prof some questions and then saw it lying here. Deb: Thank you very much. Would you like a coffee now you’re here? John: Well, I can’t stay now. But I’d love to call back [go back to a place to visit someone] another time if that’s OK? Deb: Sure, that’d be nice. 1. Which phrasal verb from B opposite means…. 1. the opposite of go out, as in meet friends or go to a restaurant? 2. not come home at night or come home late? 3. forget to take something with you when you go away from a place? 4. stay in a place when other people have left? 5. make something which is dull or boring more attractive or colourful? 6. stay somewhere longer than you planned? 7. go back to a place to see someone, often to visit someone briefly or to collect something? 2.Use the phrasal verbs from exercise 1 to complete these sentences. Write the verbs in the correct form: 1. I………………my floppy disk………………..at the computer class. I’ll have to go back and see if it’s still in the machine. 2. When you were a teenager, did your parents allow you to ……………………..late? 3. Shop assistant: I’m afraid your photographs aren’t ready yet. It will be another couple of hours. Customer: Okay. I’ll ……………………..tomorrow. 4. We’ve decided to paint the kitchen to………………….it……………………. a bit. It’s so gloomy and dull at the moment. 328 5. I’m really tired. I think I’ll …………………..tonight and not go to the party after all, sorry. 6. The teacher asked the naughty boy to ……………………after the lesson. 7. We loved the resort so much we decided to …………………..another week, even though our friends had gone home. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS – EXPERIMENTS ON ANIMALS92 Animal rights’ activists staged a demonstration in front of a research laboratory yesterday as part of a massive campaign now being mounted to combat the abuse of animals and condemn those scientists who perform experiments on them. It has been revealed that a staggering number of creatures are slaughtered annually in laboratories, among them popular pets like cats and dogs. Brochures distributed during the demonstration describe the horror and torment these animals experience at the hands of scientists. The public is not aware of how the animals suffer convulsions, vomiting, loss of balance, sores and skin rashes. Creatures, which also include rats, mice, guinea pigs, rabbits and monkeys, are subjected to electric shocks, doses of radiations and induced infections. Toxic chemicals are injected into their bodies and tablets are mixed with their food in order to screen medicines for effectiveness and safety. Drugs are force-fed, and then the animals are closely monitored for side-effects even though their metabolisms are different from that of humans. Unbearable pain is inflicted, especially when testing cosmetic products to see if they are safe for people. A common practice is to squirt irritants into the eyes of rabbits to measure safety levels. Activists reveal that these horrifying experiments often leave animals blind, burned and mutilated before their suffering is mercifully put to an end by a lethal injection. Demonstrators carried placards reminding the public that animals also deserve human treatment. A human being, they maintain, has no right to usurp its dominance over other animals, no matter how justifiable that action may seem. To communicate the message effectively, heart-breaking posters were displayed depicting animals in 92 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1, 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 329 whose eyes one can see an appeal for mercy. Bearing these pictures in mind, we must never forget that they are living creatures that have every right to coexist alongside human beings. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Yesterday’s demonstration was an isolated event. 2. The place where the demonstration was staged had nothing to do with what it was all about. 3. The current campaign is directed against experiments on animals. 4. Cats and dogs are dying at the hands of scientists. 5. Leaflets were distributed during the demonstration to inform the public about the cruelty of scientists. 6. People are well-informed about what is going on behind the research laboratories’ doors. 7. One of the aims of the experiments is to determine safe levels of chemicals in medicines and cosmetics. 8. Animals do not take the drugs willingly. 9. When the experiments are over, the animals undergo treatment. 10.Animal rights activists do not want animals to be treated differently from human beings. 11.Posters displayed at the demonstration showed how happy animals can be when looked after by men. 12.The message of the demonstration was that every living creature has a right to live in peace. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B common …………….. action electric………………. chemicals horrifying…………….. experiments 330 humane………………. infections induced………………. injections justifiable…………….. laboratory lethal………………… levels research……………… pain safety……………….. practice toxic……………….. shocks unbearable…………… treatment 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: END – FOR – ANIMAL – CALLS – MEDICAL – DEMO – TO – AN – EXPERIMENTS –RIGHTS ………………………………………………………………………………………… …………………………………………………………………………………………. 4. Phrases to learn: - a organiza o demonstraţie: - s……………. a d……………. - a desfăşura o campanie intens susţinută: - m…………….. a m………………… c…………….. - a efectua experienţe: - p……………… e………………. - a injecta substanţe chimice toxice: - i…………… t………….. c………………….. - a monitoriza efectele secundare: - m…………….. f…………. s…………………. e…………….. - a produce durere: - i…………… p…………….. - a măsura nivelul de siguranţă:- m………….. s……………. l………….. - a merita un tratament umanitar: - d…………. h…………… t……………….. - implorare pentru clemenţă – a………….. f………… m………………… - a avea în minte: b………….. l……………… m…………………… 331 LESSON 21 *Grammar: Comparison (1)* Vocabulary: General – Crime and The Law* Phrasal Verbs: Cause and Effect* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Curbs on Dogs *** I. GRAMMAR – COMPARISON (1)93 We can compare people and things with each other using as….as, -er than or more…than. You’re as silly as me. Luke’s younger than me. The second problem was much more difficult than the other three. We can use the –est or the most to compare people and things with all of their group. Carl is the fastest of the young sprinters. Ramona is the most sociable person in the class. We use –er and –est with shorter adjectives and some short adverbs. We use more and most with other adjectives and adverbs. Double comparatives It’s getting colder and colder. The children are more and more difficult these days. the….the… The more money she has, the more she wants. The warmer it gets, the happier I am. 93 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 332 Some colorful and unusual comparisons: as slow as a broken down snail as nervous as a brick wall as dirty as a dustbin lid as brave as the first man who ate an oyster as thick as two short planks (= prost as cold as an ex-wife’s heart ca noaptea) as black as two o’clock in the morning as big as the little end of nothing as ugly as home-made soap as welcome as a wet shoe as happy as a dog with two tails as noisy as two skeletons dancing on a tin roof as poor as a church mouse as dark as the inside of a wolf as crooked as a dog’s hind leg as scarce as hen’s teeth as crooked as a barrel of fish hooks as exciting as watching paint dry *revise the basics: comparative and superlative adjectives #forms more/most beautiful more/most careful easier, easiest faster, fastest more/most distant happier, happiest more/most intelligent later, latest nicer, nicest older, oldest Comparative adjectives are forms like younger, more expensive. Superlative adjectives are forms like youngest, most expensive. 1. Look at the examples above and then complete rules 1-5 from the box: put more and most in front add –er, -est put more and most in front add –r, -st change y to i and add –er, -est To make the comparative and superlative of: 1. one-syllable adjectives ending in –e, ……………………………………………….. 2. other one-syllable adjectives, ……………………………………………………….. 333 3. two-syllable adjectives ending in –y, ……………………………………………….. 4. other two-syllable adjectives, ……………………………………………………….. 5. longer adjectives, ……………………………………………………………………. 2. Look at the examples in the box and choose the correct way of completing the rule: bigger fatter hottest longest plainer shortest sweeter thinnest oldest meaner Before -er and –est, we double the last letter of….. 1. all adjectives 2. adjectives that have three letters 3. adjectives that have one vowel 4. Adjectives that end in one vowel + one consonant 5. adjectives that end on one consonant. 6. adjectives that end in –g or –t 3. Write the comparatives and superlatives: 1. boring……………………. 8. interesting…………………… 2. cheap……………………. 9. lazy………………………….. 3. fine……………………… 10. nervous…………………….. 4. funny……………………. 11. sad…………………………. 5. green……………………. 12. silly………………………… 6. handsome……………….. 13. slim………………………… 7. hard……………………… 18. wet…………………………. #A few words have irregular comparatives and superlatives: good-better-best bad-worse-worst old-older/elder-oldest/eldest far-farther/further- farthest/furthest little-less-least 334 much/many-more-most Farther/further and farthest/furthest are both used to talk about distance. We use further to mean ‘additional’ in some expressions. (NOT farther) She lives three miles farther/further away from the office than I do. further education further information further discussion Elder and eldest are used with brother, sister, son, daughter, grandson, granddaughter. John’s my elder brother. (I have one brother older than me.) Sarah’s my eldest sister. (I have more than one sister.) 4. Complete the sentences with irregular comparatives: 1. ‘My computer keeps crashing.’ ‘Get a……………………………………computer.’ 2. ‘Why did your song win the competition?’ ‘It was the……………………………… 3. It takes me the longest to get to work because my house is the …………………….. from here. 4. My cold was getting……………………………………………….., so I went home. 5. I used most of the old apples, but I had to throw away the three……………………. 6. Megan was born in 1990. Her sisters Sarah and Rachel were born in 1992 and 1993. So Megan is Sarah’s …………………… sister, and she’s Rachel’s ………………………………………………………………………………………. 7.Jacob and Ryan were born in 1991 and 1994. So Jacob is Ryan’s ……………………………………………………………………………….brother. 8. The doctors don’t know what’s wrong, so they’re going to do…………………tests. 9. I took the job that paid the …………………money for the …………………..work. 10. We’ve got………………...money than Andy and Tara, but we’re happier. Maybe. 11. It’s nicer to drive if you go there through the mountains, but it’s much…………… #using comparatives and superlatives We use a comparative (with than) to compare one person, thing, action or group with another person, thing etc. We use a superlative to compare one person, thing etc. with the whole group that he/she/it belongs to. 335 Mary’s taller than her three sisters. Mary’s the tallest of the four girls. Your accent is worse than mine. Your accent is the worst in the class. Before a superlative we normally use the or a possessive. the best singer my oldest friend John’s most attractive quality. Some people use a comparative instead of a superlative when the whole group has two members. I like them both, but Sally’s the nicer/nicest of the two. You can have the bigger/biggest steak if you like – I’m not very hungry. *revise the basics: comparative and superlative adverbs Comparative and superlative adverbs normally have more and most. We can put the before superlative adverbs, but we often leave it out. Could you drive more slowly? French is the language that he speaks (the) most easily. The following adverbs have –er, -est like adjectives: early, fast, hard, late, near, soon. Better, best, worse and worst can be used as adverbs. 5. Complete the sentences with the comparatives or superlatives of words from the box: beautifully clearly early fast fluently hard late peacefully 1. If we don’t walk……………………………………….., we’ll never arrive on time. 2. She sings…………………………………………..than anyone else I’ve ever heard. 3. Andy’s the most intelligent, but Sue works ………………………………………… 4. Eight is late – could you possibly get here any……………………………………..? 336 5. Off all the children, Helen writes……………………………………………………. 6. I would sleep………………………………………..if I weren’t worried about Tom. 7. For the 10.20 train, ………………………………………..we can leave home is 10. 8. Mark speaks French……………………………………...of all the boys in his class. *as…as: as many people as possible #We use as…as to say that people or things are equal in some way. She’s as tall as her brother. Is it as good as you expected? She speaks French as well as the rest of us. #After not, we can use so…as instead of as….as. He’s not so/as successful as his father. #Other useful structures: as much/many as, the same as I haven’t got as much time as I thought. We need as many people as possible. She earns twice as much money as me/as I do. He went to the same school as me/as I did. 6. Look at the information about Jake and Susie, and then write sentences comparing them using as…as, not so/as….as and the same….as: JAKE SUSIE UNIVERSITY Manchester Liverpool SCHOOL Leeds H.S. Leeds H.S HEIGHT 1.92 m 1.70 m WEIGHT 87 kg 56 kg JOB accountant accountant BORN: WHEN? WHERE? 27.7.84 Leeds 31.3.84 Leeds SALARY $26,000 $52,000 337 WORKS FOR IBM Rolls Royce HOLIDAY 5 weeks 3 weeks ADDRESS 3 Ross Street, Manchester 3 Ross Street, Manchester CHILDREN 2 1 LANGUAGES Fluent READING French, some Fluent French, fluent German German Newspapers Newspapers, magazines, non-fiction E.g.: Susie went to the same school as Jake. Jake’s not as old as her. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. 7. Here are the beginnings of some traditional expressions with as….as. See how many can you put together correctly from the box: a beetroot a mouse grass night a pancake a picture Ex: as cold as ice the grave a rake the hills ice a sheet 6. as pretty……………………. 1. as black …………………. 7. as quiet…………………….. 2. as flat……………………. OR…………………... 3. as green………………….. 8. as red………………………. 4. as hard…………………… 9. as thin……………………… 5. as old…………………….. 10. as white…………………... *more on comparatives: taller and taller; the more the better #we can use double comparatives to say that things are changing. We went more and more slowly. 338 iron It’s getting colder and colder. 8.Complete the sentences with is/are getting and double comparatives of words from the box: bad boring dangerous hard long young difficult expensive good Ex: My mother’s driving is getting more and more dangerous as the years go by. 1. My daughter’s maths homework……………………………………...to understand. 2. Jeremy’ s doing well. His piano playing…………………………………………….. 3. It seems as if police officers…………………………………………………………. 4. My temper…………………………………………………………………………… 5. It………………………………………..to find time for everything you want to do. 6. Professional tennis………………………………………………………….to watch. 7. Restaurants…………………………………………………………………………... 8. School holidays……………………………………………………………………… #we can use the…the with comparatives to say that things change or vary together. Note the word order: The older I get, the happier I am. The more dangerous it is, the more I like it. The more money he has, the more useless things he buys. ‘Can I invite some friends over?’ ‘Sure. The more the better.’ 9. Complete the sentences with expressions from the box. Use the…the: faster/louder longer/more more/angrier more/less more/more older/darker older/more warmer/more Ex: The older Mark gets, the more he looks like his grandfather. 1. …………………………….he talked, ……………………………………I listened. 339 2. …………………………….I live here, ……………………………………..I like it. 3. …………………………..it got, ……………………….time we spent on the beach. 4. ………………………….I get to know you, ……………………...I understand you. 5. ………………………….money he lost, ……………………………….it made him. 6. …………………………he drove, ………………………………………he laughed. 7. …………………………clothes she buys, ……………..…clothes she wants to buy. 8. ………………………..….I get, ……………………………………….my hair gets. Before comparatives, we can use much, far, very much, a little, a bit (informal), a lot/lots (informal), any, no and even. He’s much/far older than her. She’s very much happier in the new job. I feel a little/a bit better. These grapes are a lot sweeter than the others. The train’s no quicker than the bus. You look even more beautiful than usual. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL- CRIME AND THE LAW94 1. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) Sally didn’t realize that she had broken/countered/denied the law. b) The police have banned/cancelled/refused parking in this street. c) I must remember to get a/an agreement/licence/permission for my television. d)The president admitted that there had been a breakdown of law and crime /government/order. e) Jim’s parents wouldn’t agree/allow/let him go to the demonstration. f) Jake was arrested because he had entered the country falsely/illegally/wrongly. g) Talking to other students is against the law/orders/rules of the examination. h)The two men were arrested before they could commit/make/perform any more crimes. 94 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 340 i) I had to take the company to court/justice/law to get the money they owed me. j) Smoking is compulsory/prohibited/refused near the petrol tanks. 2. Match the word in the box with a suitable description (a-i): blackmailer burglar forger hijacker hooligan kidnapper murderer shoplifter vandal pickpocket smuggler witness a) This person takes control of a plane or boat by force: hijacker b) This person sees what happens during a crime or accident:………………………… c) This person brings goods into the country illegally:………………………………… d) This person might steal food from a supermarket:………………………………….. e) This person kills someone on purpose: …………………………………………….. f) This person takes people and demands money for their return: ……………………. g) This person makes illegal copies of paintings, documents, etc: …………………… h) This person damages other people’s property: …………………………………….. i) This person might steal your wallet in a crowd: ……………………………………. j) This person steals from houses: …………………………………………………….. k) This person gets money from others by threatening to tell secrets: ………………... l) This person causes trouble at football matches: …………………………………….. 3. Complete each sentence (a-j) with a suitable ending (1-10). Use each ending once: a)I decided to buy a burglar alarm after 1)in by a salesman who cheated them out someone broke….5 of their money. b)When Alan was stopped outside the 2) away by stealing a car parked nearby. supermarket he ended…. c)As it was Sheila’s first offence she was 3) up at the police station, charged with let… shoplifting. d)After climbing over the prison wall, 4) it, although everyone suspected what Peter managed to get… had happened. 341 e)The old couple who live opposite were 5) into my house and stole my stereo. taken… f) At the end of the trial Hilary was found 6) off with only a warning g)My neighbors admitted denting my car 7) with paying only $100 damages. but got away… h)The bank at the end of the street was 8)hostage and demanded $1,000,000 held… from the authorities. i)Nobody saw Jack cheating and he got 9)guilty and sentenced to six months in away with… prison. j)The hijackers took fifteen people… 10) up by two masked men last week. 4. Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: accused evidence guilty fine jury sentence lawyer statement charged suspect a) The custom officers arrested Bob and charged him with smuggling. b) The police spent all morning searching the house for ……………………………… c) Jean left her car in a no-parking area and had to pay a/an ………………………….. d) Unfortunately at the end of the trial my brother was found ……………………….. e) The trial took a long time as the …………………………...couldn’t reach a verdict. f) George won his case because he had a very good defense………………………….. g) The police visited Dawn and asked her to make a/an……………………………….. h) Because of his past criminal record, Brian was the main…………………………… i) Pauline decided to sue the police because she had been wrongly ………………….. j) The murderer of the children received a life………………………………………… 342 5)Choose the most suitable word or phrase to complete each sentence: a)Most schools in my country no longer have physical/capital/bodily/corporal punishment. b) The policemen following the robbers were in plain/ordinary/normal/simple clothes. c) The two old ladies were stolen/attacked/robbed/snatched of their purses. d) At the end of the story, the hero manages to arrest the offenders/villains/wrongs/ evils. e) I had to answer question A because it was compulsory/necessary/a must/an obligation. f) Charles could not refuse/object/deny/alter having been at the scene of the crime. g) As there was no evidence, the judge dismissed the trial/witness/court/case. h) If your dog damages your neighbor’s property, you could be guilty/liable/payable /illegal. i) After ten years in prison, Stephen was pardoned/released/innocent/forgiven and set free. j) The detective inspector told the young officer/official/guardian/police to make some tea. 6. Rewrite each sentence, beginning as shown, so that the meaning stays the same: a) They said that John had stolen the money. They accused John of stealing the money. b) Ian said that he hadn’t punched anybody. Ian denied…………………………………………………………………………… c) ‘Ok, Andy, you can go now’, said the detective. The detective gave Andy……………………………………………………………. d) ‘James Frogget, you will go to prison for ten years,’ said the judge. The judge sentenced………………………………………………………………… e) ‘I forged the signature,’ said Mary. Mary admitted………………………………………………………………………. 343 f) Harry stole $60,000 and was arrested. Harry was arrested……………………………………………………………….. g) ‘We saw the accused break into the car,’ said the witness. The witness stated……………………………………………………………….. h) Graham said that he wouldn’t go to the police station. Graham refused………………………………………………………………….. i) ‘It’s true,’ said Norman, ‘I murdered Alan.’ Norman confessed to……………………………………………………………. j) ‘Can you come with me, please,’ the detective said to Helen. The detective asked……………………………………………………………... 7. Use the word given in capitals at the end of each line to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: Arthur’s life of crime At his last trial, nobody believed in Arthur’s (1) innocence. He INNOCENT had been accused of the (2)……………...of a valuable Chinese vase THIEF and was also charged with ten other (3)……………. ....The value of OFFEND the (4)……………...goods was said to be over $20,000. Arthur said STEAL in his own (5)………………..that the vase had been put into his car DEFEND (6)………………….He also pointed out that the Chinese vase was a ACCIDENT fake, and was almost (7)………………….The judge did not believe WORTH Arthur’s story. He told Arthur he was a hardened (8)………………. CRIME and that he deserved a severe (9)……………………………….Then PUNISH the judge sentenced Arthur to five years’ (10)……………………… Arthur just smiled. He had spent most of his life in prison and so he was used to it. 8. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) Harry was told that fishing in the lake was against/by/over the law. b) Catherine led a secret life for/in/of crime before she was caught. c) Having trouble with your phone? Send at/for/to Fix-a-phone! 344 PRISON d) I regret to tell you that you are for/in/under arrest. e) I only attacked the young man from/in/with self-defense. f) David was often at/in/with trouble with the police when he was young. g) The robbers’ car was hidden below/by/from sight behind the bank. h) The kidnappers have been caught, and the child is no longer at/in/on danger. i) Tony was caught by a policeman who was off/out/away from duty and cycling to work. j)The thieves took the wrong painting by/in/under mistake. k) The suspicious manager left the safe unlocked from/on/with purpose. l) The robbers met to plan the bank raid from/in/with secret. 9. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: Inspector Crumb investigates ‘I think I know the identity of the murderer,’ said Inspector Crumb, ‘and at (1) last /least/the/school one of the guests in the hotel was a/an (2) witness /offender/guilty/verdict to the crime, probably by (3) now/damages/law/accident. I believe that the same guest is also a (4) blackmailer/hostage/hooligan/forger, and has been given money by the killer.’ ‘So whoever (5) confessed /committed /admitted /performed this terrible crime is still here,’ I said. ‘But of course. In (6) crime/selfdefense/fact/danger he – or she – is in this room, and will soon be (7) to/having/ under/my arrest.’ There was silence for a moment. I noticed that everyone was trying to look (8) accused/suspicious/ordinary/innocent, but they all looked guilty instead! ‘Do you have any (9) evidence/witness/permission/body, Inspector,’ asked Lady Grimshaw finally, ‘or are you simply (10) suspecting/suing/denying/accusing people for fun? If you intend to (11) trial/charge/sentence/confess someone, you should do it now.’ The Inspector smiled. ‘I asked you here (12) with/for/on/by purpose, Lady Grimshaw. I have been reading your (13) statement/biography/evident/history, you see, and it is quite clear that you have told several (14) people/errors/times/lies.’ ‘How dare you!’ Lady Grimshaw spluttered. ‘Do you (15) refuse/deny/contradict/suppose that you were with Tim Dawson in the garden on the night of the murder?’ the Inspector said. ‘You forgot about the security cameras, you see….’ 345 VOCABULARY: GENERAL - PHRASAL VERBD: CAUSE AND EFFECT95 A. VERBS WITH OFF A number of phrasal verbs associated with cause and effect have the particle off. The terrorists set the bomb off in the middle of the rush hour. [caused an explosion] We accidentally set off the burglar alarm when we came into the house. [made the alarm ring] The scandal set off a series of events which caused the collapse of the government and a general election. [caused a series of events or a lot of activity, often without intending to do so] You shouldn’t have mentioned flying saucers. You’ve set him off now. He’ll talk for hours. [made him start to talk about something he often talks about] The ending of the play really set her off. I didn’t know whether she was laughing or crying. [made her start to laugh or cry] The crisis sparked off a bitter civil war. [caused something to suddenly happen or exist] The Prime Minister’s speech triggered off violent protests in cities up and down the country. [made something suddenly begin , often a difficult or violent situation] B. OTHER CAUSE AND EFFECT VERBS Read these spoken extracts: The new airport has brought about [made something happen] a lot of changes on this island. I don’t know what lies behind [is the real reason for] Mr Wild’s attack on me. Maybe he’s trying to pay me back [do something unpleasant to me because I have done something unpleasant to him] for something I said about him. Or maybe 95 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 346 he’s just stirring things up. [causing arguments or bad feeling between people, usually on purpose] This photograph brings back [makes me remember or think about something from the past] memories of when we lived in Scotland, when I was a child. The doctors still haven’t ruled out [decided that something is impossible] the possibility that he might have cancer. I think most problems teenagers experience spring from [are caused by] a feeling of insecurity. 1.Choose the best phrasal verb from the box to complete each sentence. Write the verb in the correct form: bring back lie behind stir up set off spark off spring from 1. That song always ………………………….wonderful memories whenever I hear it. 2. I think my problems at work……………………….the fact that I never really wanted to go into accountancy as a career. 3. I wonder what really ………………………………………..Maria’s dislike of Paul. 4. I don’t like the way Maxine is always trying to ………………..trouble between us. 5. The film……………………………………………...a lively discussion in the class. 6. The tragic pictures of the earthquake victims…………………..her……………..and she just couldn’t stop crying. 2. Fill the gaps in the paragraph below, using the correct verb or particle: There has been a lot of discussion in the newspapers about what triggered (1) ……………….. the recent explosion in the city centre. Some people believe that a bomb was (2) …………………. off by a terrorist group who hope to (3) …………………. about the downfall of the government. Others believe that the explosion was probably sparked (4) …………………. by an electrical fault and have (5) …………………. out any criminal activity. But the question still remains: was it a deliberate explosion set (6) ……………….. by a group who wanted to (7) 347 …………………. things up in order to (8) ………………… the government back for some injustice? 3.Which word from the box provides the best ending for these sentences? suspects fireworks memories feelings reforms violence 1. At midnight on New Year’s Eve we usually set off some ………………………….. 2. The police used fingerprint tests to rule out some ………………………………….. 3. The political demonstration triggered off …………………………………………... 4. That music brings back ……………………………………………………………… 5. The government plans to bring about ……………………………………………….. 6. Violet’s comments stirred up a lot of bad …………………………………………... 4. Complete these sentences using a phrasal verb. Write the verb in the correct form: 1.Take no notice of what he says. He’s always trying to ……………………...trouble. 2.She vowed that one day she’d ………………….for all the heartbreak he had caused her. 3. I wonder what ………………………………………………...the protests last week. 4.The decision to increase taxes……………………..demonstrations all across the country. 5. Detectives still haven’t …………………………………....the possibility of murder. 6. His therapist thought that his unhappiness…………………...a traumatic experience in his childhood. 348 III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC-NEWS – CURBS ON DOGS96 Curbs on dogs became law today as the Dangerous Dogs Act comes into effect. It puts owners of the fighting dogs listed in the Act under an obligation to ensure that their dog does not appear in public without a muzzle and a leash. Failure to comply with the new rules will be treated as a criminal offense carrying a penalty, upon conviction, of up to £2,000 or six months’ imprisonment. Yesterday, there was a last minute run on muzzles at pet shops. Owners and breeders are also worried about the cost of neutering and third-party insurance. The new law gives the owners of the three breeds branded as killer dogs, pit bull terriers, the Japanese Tosa, and the Dogo Argentino, a deadline by which they must decide if they want them humanely destroyed or else neutered, insured and officially registered. The law also aims to encourage responsible ownership. This means that, as well as being registered, dogs should additionally be branded with an identity mark, such as a microchip implant. In this way, their owners can be held accountable. Dogs are also expected to be properly trained and obedient. The listed breeds, which were developed specifically for fighting, have been singled out after a series of savage attacks on people. Pit bull terriers, of which there are about 10,000 in Britain, are fifty times more powerful than other breeds. This increases the chances of attack being fatal. However, Rottweilers and Dobermann Pinschers, exempt from the list because they are not bred specifically for fighting, are also responsible for savage attacks, and there are calls for an extension to the new law to cover these breeds, too. Opponents of the Act argue that there is no genetic reason why a pit bull should attack humans. Meanwhile, the police will be taking proper steps to make sure that the law is obeyed. Dogs that are spotted by the police running loose and without a muzzle will be caught and disposed of in a humane way. Their owners will be punished. 96 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 349 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. The Dangerous Dogs Act concerns public safety. 2. Owners must decide for themselves if their dog is dangerous or not. 3. If a dog’s owner is found guilty of breaking the law he will go to prison. 4. Many dog owners waited till the last minute before buying a leash and a muzzle. 5. The only thing that the Act obliges people to do is to keep their dog muzzled and leashed in public. 6. Unless the dogs affected by the Act are neutered, insured and registered, they cannot stay alive. 7. Branding dogs with identity marks will enable the police to locate their owners. 8. The listed breeds are the only kinds of dogs that attack people. 9. If a person is attacked by a pit bull terrier, he may die because the dog is so strong. 10. Rottweilers are not on the list because they are not dangerous. 11.It is felt that the Dangerous Dogs Act stopped short of guaranteeing real protection. 12.If the dogs involved are spotted without a leash and a muzzle, they will be shot by the police. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B criminal……………….. attacks fighting……………….. dogs humane……………….. implant identity……………….. mark microchip……………... offense pet…………………….. ownership proper…………………. shops responsible……………. steps savage………………… way 350 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: BY- CURBED – LAW – ATTACKS – VIOLENT – TO – NEW – BE ………………………………………………………………………….. 4. Phrases to learn: -a intra în vigoare: c………….. i…………… e……………… -a obliga: p…………. u………….. an o…………………… -a apărea în locuri publice: a………….. in p……………… -a acţiona în acord cu normele: c…………… w………… the r…………………. -infracţiune: a c…………… o………………… -a fixa ultimul termen: g……………… a d………………….. -a trage la răspundere: h……………… someone a…………………… -a întreprinde măsuri corespunzătoare: t………………. p…………… s…………….. -a respecta legea: o…………… the l……………… -a vagabonda: r……………….. l……………….. 351 LESSON 22 *Grammar: Comparison (2)* Vocabulary: General – Entertainment and The Arts* Phrasal Verbs: Change* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Race-related Issues *** I. GRAMMAR – COMPARISON (2)97 *more about superlatives: the best player of us all #after superlatives, we often use of. It was the most successful of his early plays. She’s the best player of us all. The nicest moment of the day. #but we do not use of with a singular word for a place or a group. I’m the happiest man in the world. She’s the best player in the team. 1. Of or in after the superlative? E.g.: the most interesting of all the suggestions the most experienced general in the Army 1. the most famous actor ………………………………………………………them all. 2. the best restaurant……………………………………………………………..Rome. 3. the most expensive……….............................................................the books I bought. 4. the worst student……………………………………………………………the class. 5. the highest mountain ………………………………………………………...Europe. 97 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 352 6. the oldest person………………………………………………………….my family. 7. the most frightening……………………………………………………the four men. 8. the shortest day…………………………………………………………...of the year. 9. the most valuable ……………………………………….the paintings in the gallery. 2. Write sentences with superlatives: E.g.: Where I live, August / quiet month / year: Where I live, August is the quietest month of the year. Which / high mountain / Africa? Which is the highest mountain in Africa? 1. Who / young / your three sisters/? ………………………………………………………………………………… 2. Which / cheap / these three jackets/? …………………………………………………………………………………. 3. For a time, my grandfather / famous footballer / country ………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. Cassie and Louise / fast swimmers / team ………………………………………………………………………………….. 5. When I was a child, I / tall boy / my class ………………………………………………………………………………….. 6. For me, the early morning / good time / day ………………………………………………………………………………….. 7. Andy is very quiet, but he / interesting person / the group ………………………………………………………………………………….. #we normally use the before a superlative when we are comparing one person /thing/group with others. It’s the longest day of the year. This winter is the coldest in living memory. 353 #but we do not use the when we are comparing somebody or something with him/her/itself in other situations. He’s nicest when he’s had a few drinks. England is best in spring. 3. Invent suitable beginnings for these sentences. The or not? E.g.: The weather is usually worst in February. Kathleen Ferrier was the best singer of her generation. 1. ……………………………………………………most beautiful city in my country. 2. ………………………………………………..most dangerous when they’re hungry. 3. …………………………………………………………………...best modern writer. 4. ……………………………………………….most interesting person I’ve ever met. 5………………………………………………………….quietest in the early morning. 6. ………………………………………………most efficient way to learn a language. 7. ………………………most comfortable when there aren’t too many people around. *like and as; so and such #we can use like and as to say that things are similar. Like is a preposition, used before a noun or pronoun. As is a conjunction, used before subject + verb or a prepositional expression. He runs like the wind. She looks like me. Nobody knows her as I do. On Friday, as on Monday, we meet at eight. Note the common expressions as I said, as you know, as you see, as usual 354 4. Like or as? 1. He died………………he lived, fighting. 6. My brother isn’t at all………me. 2. Being in love is……………….an illness. 7. She left….......she came, silently. 3. It’s mended, ……………….you can see. 8. You’re shy, …….....................me. 4. In Paris, ……...in Rome, traffic is heavy. 9. Your smile is ……….your sister’s. 5. His eyes are………………...........knives. 10. …………...I said, you’re too late. #in informal speech (but not writing), many people use like as a conjunction. Nobody loves you like I do. Like I said, she wasn’t there. #to talk about jobs, functions etc., we use as, not like. He’s working as a waiter. I used my shoe as a hammer. Compare: As your brother, I must warn you to be careful. (I am your brother). Like your brother, I must warn you……(We both warn you). #we use so before an adjective (without a noun), or an adverb. we use such before (adjective +) noun. A/An comes after such. She’s so babyish. I’m so hungry that I could eat a horse. …..your country, which is so beautiful. I wish you wouldn’t drive so fast. She’s such a baby. I didn’t know you had such nice friends. It was such a comfortable bed that I went straight to sleep. 5. Put in such or so: 1. The weather was…………………cold that all the football matches were cancelled. 2. The book was ………………………………………boring that I stopped reading it. 3. It was…………………………………...a good film that I went to see it three times. 4. They’ve got…………………………...a nice house that I always love staying there. 355 5. It was……………………………………a hot day that nobody could do any work. 6. Their garden is…………………………………………………………….beautiful! 7. His voice is………………………………pleasant that I could listen to him all day. 8. I don’t know why she talks in ………………………………………….a loud voice. 9. The canteen served……………………………….bad food that nobody could eat it. 10. The case was……………………………………………heavy that I couldn’t lift it. *comparison: more practice 6. Forms. Write the comparatives and superlatives: active: more active, most active bad:………………………………. clean:…………………………… dirty: …………………………….. famous:………………………… far:……………………………… OR: ………………………………. fit: ……………………………… green:……………………………. happy: ………………………….. lazy:……………………………... modern: ………………………… nice: …………………………….. red: ……………………………... short:…………………………….. slim: ……………………………. sweet: …………………………… tall: ……………………………… thin:……………………………… tiring: …………………………… white: …………………………… 7. Mixed structures. Right or wrong? Correct the mistakes or write ‘Correct’: E.g.: The weather’s gooder today. better I feel much happier now. correct 1. My feet are cold like ice. ………………. 2. You’re the strangest man in the world. ………………. 3. Ann’s more late than usual. ………………. 4. This shirt’s not so expensive as the others. ………………. 356 5. More I learn, more I forget. ………………. 6. We need to ask further questions. ……………….. 7. It’s getting more warm and more warm. ……………….. 8. The more he has money, the more he spends. ……………….. 9. Pete’s the fastest swimmer in the team. ………………… 10. I feel the same like you. ………………… 8. Comparisons. Make two sentences for each item: E.g.: a tiger / large / a leopard large / of all the big cats/? A tiger is larger than a leopard. Is it the largest of all the big cats? 1. this box / strong / that one/? strong / you’ve got/? ………………………………………………………………………………….. 2. Alistair / tall / anyone else / the team tall / the team ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. the state of Alaska / big / any of the other states / the US big / the US ………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. this wine / expensive / that one expensive / in the world …………………………………………………………………………………. 5. Max’s party / good / Rob’s party good / I’ve ever been to …………………………………………………………………………………. 6. this job / bad / my last one bad / I’ve ever had ………………………………………………………………………………… 9. The….the…Circular situations: make sentences like the one in the example: E.g.: He drives fast; he gets nervous The faster he drives, the more nervous he gets. And the more nervous he gets, the faster he drives. 1. He eats ice cream; he gets fat. 357 The more ice cream…………………………………………………………….. 2. He reads; he forgets. ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. She ignores him; he loves her. ……………………………………………………………………………….. 4. She buys shoes; she wants shoes. (Mind the word order.) ……………………………………………………………………………….. 5. We spend money; we have friends. ……………………………………………………………………………….. 6. I sleep; I’m tired. ……………………………………………………………………………….. 10. Grammar in a text. Put in the superlatives of the words in the box: fast fast high large large long long long small tall The (1)………………….man in medical history was Robert Pershing Wadlow (US). When he was measured in 1940, he was 2.72 m tall. The world’s (2)…………………hair measured 5.62 m in 2004. It belonged to Xie Qiuping (China), who had been growing her hair since 1973, from the age of 13. The (3)…………….........ski lesson was given to 594 skiers by Hansjürg Gredig at Sarn-Heizenberg, Switzerland, on 23 February 2008. The 16-minute lesson extended over 1,300 meters. There were extra instructors for every 20-30 people to help them follow the lesson correctly. The (4) …………………windsurfing journey was made by Flavio Jardim and Diego Guerreiro. They went from Chui to Oiapoque on the Brazilian Coast (8,120 km) between May 2004 and July 2005. The (5)…………………motorized sofa was driven at 148 km/h in 2007 by Marek Turowski (UK). 358 The (6)…………………time for a hundred-meter barefoot sprint on ice is 17.35 sec. The record was set by Nico Surings in Eindhoven, Netherlands, in December 2006. The world’s (7)…………………ruby measures 130 x 138 x 145 mm and weighs 8184 g. It belongs to a Chinese jewellery company. The (8)………………...ears on a dog belong to Tigger, a bloodhound, owned by a couple in Illinois. The ears measured 34.9 cm (right) and 34.2 cm (left) in September 2004. The world’s (9)………………….. jump by a pig is 70 cm. It was made by a Japanese pig called Kotetsu in 2004. The (10)………………..dog measured in 2005 was a female Chihuahua who lived in Florida. She was 15.2 cm long. *comparison: revision test 11. Write the comparatives and superlatives: boring:……………………………………… bright:…………………………… cheap:………………………………………. clean:……………………………. distant:……………………………………… exciting: ………………………… far:………………………………………….. fit:………………………………. funny:………………………………………. honest:………………………….. lazy:………………………………………... nice: ……………………………. plain:……………………………………….. safe:…………………………….. short:………………………………………. slim:…………………………….. thin:………………………………………... well:…………………………….. wet:………………………………………… 12. Choose the right words: 1. I’ve got three sisters. Jane’s the older/elder/eldest. 2. Do you feel better that/than/as yesterday? 3. Your dress is same as/the same as/the same like mine. 359 4. The doctors are going to do further/farther/farthest tests. 5. This hotel is worse/the worse/worst/the worst I’ve ever stayed in. 6. I’ve got a more easy/an easier job this week. 7. I always feel best/the best about 11 o’clock in the morning. 8. Karen’s working as/like a secretary at the moment. 9. Rebecca is the more/the most/more/most remarkable singer I’ve ever heard. 10. More/The more/The most I listen to him, more/the more bored I get. 13. Right or wrong? Correct the mistakes or write ‘Correct’: E.g.: The weather’s getting badder: worse The train’s even later than usual: correct 1. Real life is stranger as novels or films. ……………… 2. He’s the fastest man of the world this year. ……………… 3. The older I get, the less hair I have. ……………… 4. Holidays are becoming more and more cheap. ……………… 5. I’ll see you this evening like usual. ……………… 6. The more he gets tired, the more mistakes he makes. ……………… 7. My father is a lot older than my mother. ……………… 8. Did you receive any further information? ……………… 9. The ticket wasn’t as expensive as I expected. ……………… 10. This shirt’s not so expensive as the others. ……………… II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – ENTERTAINMENT AND THE ARTS98 1. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) I like this book, and I’ve read six capitals/chapters/prefaces already. b) It’s not a proper drawing, only a rough/plan/sketch. 98 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 360 c) The play is very long but there are three breaks/intervals/rests. d) At the cinema I don’t like sitting too near the film/screen/stage. e) We heard a piece by Mozart performed by a German band/group/orchestra. f) Her second book was very popular and became a best buy/seller/volume. g) I like the painting but I can’t stand its ugly border/frame/square. h) Robert’s new book will be broadcast/published/typed in August. i) I liked the acting, and the costumes/dressing/outfits were good too. j) The best act/place/scene in the film is when Jack meets Kate. 2. Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: announcer composer critic editor conductor director novelist sculptor playwright author a) The orchestra would not be so successful with a different conductor. b) I want a book on art, but I don’t know the name of the …………………………….. c) We must see the new film by that Italian …………………………………………… d) The………………………………..said that the sports program is on after the news. e) Harry writes for the theatre, but he is not only a…………………………………….. f) We saw some interesting metal objects made by a French ………………………….. g) That’s a nice piece of music. Who is the…………………………………………....? h) Peter Smith was the only …………………………..who wrote in praise of the film. i) Charles Dickens is probably the best known British ………………………………... j) The………………………………of the newspaper usually decides what it contains. 3.Complete each sentence by putting in, on, at or out of in each space: a) Harry Smith is hard at work writing his new screenplay. b) The music was terrible and the singer was……………………………………tune. c) I can’t tell what that is………………………………the background of the picture. d) Jane’s new book is coming out………………………………..paperback next year. 361 e) Is there anything good……………………………………..Channel 4 this evening? f) The school put on Hamlet……………………………………………..modern dress. g) The critics found Joe’s kind of writing rather……………………………………… h) In the last scene, all the actors are…………………………………..stage together. 4.Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: current electric humorous modern public special dull gripping live popular readable still a) No recording can be as good as a live concert in my opinion. b) It was a very…………………………………………story and made me laugh a lot. c) I couldn’t put that book down, it had such a ……………………………………plot. d) Most people find it difficult to understand ……………………………………....art. e) My favorite television programs are about…………………………………...affairs. f) Of course it’s possible to like both classical and ……………………………..music. g) Everyone enjoyed the………………………………..effects in the Star Wars films. h) I don’t buy books because there’s a good …………………………..library nearby. i) We both found it a very…………………………………………….film, I’m afraid. j) George doesn’t pay people, but mainly does ………………………...life paintings. k) It was an interesting book, and very……………………………………………….. l) Unfortunately the boy upstairs is learning the………………………………..guitar. 5. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) Susan’s first painting was a/an self/own/selfish/auto portrait. b) We all enjoyed the play so much that we booed/screamed/applauded/handed for ten minutes. c) Peter sings every Sunday in the local church concert/chorus/opera/choir. d) I bought this book mainly because it has a very attractive folder/cover/coat/ wrapping. 362 e) The play was a success and had very good reviews/critics/advertisements/notes in the papers. f) If you can’t find what you are looking for in the book, use the preface/directory/list /index. g) The average viewer/audience/spectator/observer watches television for about 15 hours a week. h) First we see their faces from far away, and then we see a side by side/foreground/ replay/close up. i) Please note that the next program is unusual/unsuitable/unmistakable/unreasonable for children. j) All the members of the scene/cast/circle/drama had a party after the play was over. 6.Use the word given in capitals at the end of each line to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: The school play Congratulations to all involved with the school (1) production of PRODUCE The Woman Next Door. The (2)……………..was carried out by the ADVERTISE Art Department, and the posters were very (3)……………….. We IMAGINE certainly have some very (4) ………………..students in our school! ART Many people helped with building and painting the (5)………….. SCENE and the play was written by the English Department, who managed to create an (6)………………..story, with excellent songs. AMUSE The music was written by Sue Porter, who also (7)……………...the COMPANY singers on the piano. Everyone enjoyed a thoroughly (8)………… ENTERTAIN evening, and there was a long round of (9)……………….at the end. APPLAUD Jim Barrett gave a brilliant (10)……………..as Sergeant Moss, and PERFORM Liz Aitken was a delightful Mrs Jump. Well done everyone! 363 7.Complete the compound word in each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: back book ground fair piece operas rehearsal biography circle scripts a) Edward’s third book is usually considered his master piece. b) A lot of people enjoy watching soap…………………………………..on television. c) I found the Prime Minister’s auto…………………………………..very interesting. d) Some of the actors still did not know their lines at the dress………………………. e) I won’t buy the book until it comes out in paper…………………………………….. f) We had very good seats in the dress…………………………………………………. g) There is a black cat painted in the fore………………………………..of the picture. h) Writing film …………………………………....is rather like writing for the theatre. i) I was fined because I forgot to return my library……………………………………. j) The scene showed them on a roundabout in a children’s fun……………………….. 8. Replace the verbs in italics with a verb from the box. Do not change the meaning. Change the verb form where necessary: call off go over pick up take over look up put on take up work out turn up come out a) My radio doesn’t receive the BBC World Service very easily. My radio doesn’t pick up the BBC World Service very easily. b) Our school is going to do ‘The Tempest’ next month. ………………………………………………………………………………… c) The management cancelled the performance an hour before the opening. …………………………………………………………………………………. d) I searched for the reference in the index. …………………………………………………………………………………. e) I can’t hear the radio. Can you make it louder? …………………………………………………………………………………. 364 f) Collin’s new book is published next week. …………………………………………………………………………………. g) The conductor studied the music carefully before the concert. …………………………………………………………………………………. h) The publishing company was bought by a Japanese firm. …………………………………………………………………………………. i) I like detective stories where I can’t think who committed the murder! …………………………………………………………………………………. j) Jim has started painting as a hobby. …………………………………………………………………………………. 9. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: Why read books? Is it worth reading books, (1) in/or/why/since nowadays there are so many other forms of (2) entertain/entertainment/entertained/entertaining? Some people say that even (3) paperback/the/so/when books are expensive, and not everyone can (4) borrow/buy/lend/take books from a library. They might add that television is more (5) excited/excitable/exciting/excitement and that viewers can relax as they watch their favorite (6) ones/programs/episodes/cereals. All that may be true, but books are still very (7) too/public/live/popular. They encourage the reader to use his or her (8) imagination/author/index/amusement for a start. You can read a (9) capital/head/ chapter/cover of a book, or just a few pages, and then stop. Of course, it may be so (10) current/imagined/interest/gripping that you can’t stop! There are many different kinds of books, so you can choose a crime (11) history/novel/booklet/poetry or an autobiography, or a book which gives you interesting (12) advise/idea/information /fact. If you find it hard to choose, you can read (13) announcements/gossip/reviews/ prefaces, or ask friends for ideas. Personally, I can’t (14) do/make/have/take without books, but I can (15) pick/look/give/turn up television easily enough. You can’t watch television at bus stops! 365 VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS: CHANGE99 A. UP MEANING MORE OR BETTER When up is used in a phrasal verb with an idea of change, it often adds an idea of becoming ‘more’ or ‘better’: The number of students getting good marks in their exams is going up. [increasing] I was afraid no-one would come to my lecture, but the room is filling up nicely now. [becoming fuller] Things were bad last week but the situation is looking up now. [improving] Business was down at the beginning of the year, but is picking up now. [improving after a bad period] Would you like me to heat up the rice or will you have it cold? [make warmer] Simon’s been ignoring the situation for ages – it’s time he woke up to what’s happening. [became more aware of a situation or problem] B. OTHER PHRASAL VERBS RELATING TO CHANGE When I look back over the last year I see an awful lot of changes in my life. For instance at work, there has been an almost total changeover [a change from using or having one thing to using or having another] of staff in the office. Then during the year we have phased out [gradually stopped using] all the old computers and phased in [gradually started using] a completely new system of office administration. I wasn’t sure how things would pan out [develop or happen] at first and there were a few problems to begin with. However, the arguments about the new system blew over [became less important and were then forgotten] quite quickly. At the beginning of the year, my girlfriend left me and it took me a while to get over [begin to feel better after an experience that has made you unhappy] that. But everything’s fine with my personal life too now. Best of all, of course, is the fact that I’ve managed to give up [stop a habit or stop doing or having something unhealthy] 99 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 366 smoking this year. I didn’t feel too good for the first few weeks but that’s all worn off [gradually disappeared] now. I stuck with [did as I had planned and did not change to something else (informal)] my new regime and now I feel fitter than I have for ages. 1. Complete the word puzzle: 1. change from one thing to another: _ H_N_ _ O _ _ R 2. We can’t change it; we’re ...............................................................with it: (_ _ _ _ _) 3. I’m angry, but I’ll .................................................................................over it: (_ _ _) 4. The scandal will .....................................................over after a few months: (_ _ _ _) 5. The firm will......................................................in a new pension scheme: (_ H_ _ _) 6. I’m not sure how the situation will ..........................................................out: (_ _ N) 7. I think I’ll ..................................up soccer and start playing golf instead: (_ _ _ _) 8. I had an injection at the dentist’s and it hasn’t....................off yet, so I can’t eat properly: (_ _ R _) 2. Correct the mistakes with the phrasal verb expressions in these sentences: 1. The overchange to the new accounting system has caused endless problems. 2. There was a lot of trouble in the office last month, but it’s all blown up now and things are back to normal. 3. Shall I hot up that pizza for you? I expect it’s gone cold by now. 4. All these old telephones will be faced out over the next year and we’ll get new, digital ones. 367 III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS – RACE-RELATED ISSUES100 A huge rally was held yesterday in Gloomford in support of the neo-fascist National Front, a political group which places national and racial issues at the top of their agenda. Addressing the rally, the party chairman called for an end to coloured immigration. “We believe in a mono-racial society”, he said. “All the blacks, Asians and Hispanics should be sent back to the countries from which they originate”. Still, he had no suggestion as to what to do with nearly 40 per cent of this population who were born in this country. The party is usually associated with hatred-inciting protest marches, with allwhite demonstrators chanting racist slogans like “No To Niggers” and “Wogs Go Home”. However, the campaigns, which demand the expulsion of all “coloureds”, have become less abusive and more open to dialogue. Primarily, the party calls into question the effectiveness of the Government’s policies on race and immigration, accusing it of ducking the delicate issue and avoiding open discussion. Despite antidiscrimination acts, racial prejudice in many communities, especially where unemployment is high, appears to be growing. The Front argues that, for the benefit of racial harmony, the number of incoming immigrants must be drastically curtailed. Over the last decade, the coloured population has grown considerably and race-related violence has steadily increased. Two hundred and fifty people were injured this year alone in racial riots in which the coloured population crashed with police and gangs of white youths. With its overt racial prejudice, the party’s political platform does appeal to certain elements in the electorate. Coloured communities, often alienated by language, religion and culture, are concentrated in industrial cities. Many whites see them as a threat to both their jobs and traditions. At the same time, members of ethnic minorities are underpaid, poorly educated, and their urban ghettos overcrowded. They are as dissatisfied with the existing policy of integration and assimilation as is the Front. They accuse the authorities of neglecting cases of widespread discrimination and say that the negotiated race equality policies are never put into action. 100 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1, 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 368 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. People who joined the rally wanted to voice their protest about what the Front is saying and doing. 2. According to the party chairman, all the countries of the world should be racially segregated. 3. He proposed sending home all “coloureds” regardless of whether they are first generation immigrants or not. 4. The Front puts into practice the ideals of racial harmony and peaceful coexistence. 5. “Wog” is an impolite word for a colored person. 6. The leaders of the Front are now prepared to discuss the problem of immigration more rationally. 7. It is believed that the government is sweeping the issue of coloured immigration under the carpet. 8. In practice, the anti-discrimination acts introduced by the government have helped towards an easier assimilation of immigrants. 9. The more race-related violence there is, the fewer “coloureds” decide to come and stay in this country. 10.Different languages, religions and cultures are obvious stumbling blocks on the road to racial harmony. 11.Growing unemployment in industrial cities has got nothing to do with the existence of urban ghettos. 12.Despite sporadic racial incidents, coloured minorities are happy with the quality of their lives in this country. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B anti-discrimination………………… acts coloured…………………………… chairman ethnic……………………………… ghettos 369 mono-racial………………………... immigration party………………………………. marches political……………………………. minorities protest……………………………... platform race-related………………………... prejudice racial………………………………. society urban………………………………. violence 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline of the story: COLOURED – FRONT – CALLS – ON – IMMIGRATION – FOR – NATIONAL – DIALOGUE ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. 4. Phrases to learn: -a organiza un miting, o adunare: h…………… a r…………………. -a pune pe primul loc al programului (politic): p……………. a………….. the t………… of the a………………… -a cere (pentru) oprirea: c……………. f…………….. an e……………….. -a asocia cu marşurile de protest: a…………. w…………… p…………… m…………… -a pune la îndoială eficienţa: c…………. i………….. q………… the e…………… -a evita discuţiile deschise: a………….. o………… d…………… -a creşte considerabil: g…………….. c…………………. -violenţă în context rasial: r………….. –r…………….. v……………… -a considera drept ameninţare: s……………. a………….. a t………………. -a fi nemulţumit (dezamăgit) de politica: be d……………. w………… p………….. -a aplica în practică: p…………. i………… a…………….. 370 LESSON 23 *Grammar: Articles – a/an and the (1)* Vocabulary: General – The Natural World* Phrasal Verbs: Succcess and Failure* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Political Refugees – Economic Migrants *** I. GRAMMAR – ARTICLES: A/AN AND THE (1)101 A/An shows that we are talking about one person or thing. We often use a/an. *in descriptions She’s a kind woman. He’s got an interesting face. *when we say what something is, or what somebody’s job is. This is an earring. She’s a farmer. The usually means ‘You know which one(s) I’m talking about’. Can I use the bathroom? (The hearer knows that this means ‘your bathroom’) Nouns used without articles often have a special meaning. I’m interested in birds. (This means ‘all birds’) Sayings: ‘Writing about art is like dancing about architecture.’ (Anonymous) ‘A woman without a man is like a fish without a bicycle’ (Attributed to Gloria Steinem) ‘A diplomat is a person who can tell you to go to hell in such a way that you actually look forward to the trip’ (Caskie Stinnett) 101 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 371 ‘Equality is a lie – women are better’ (Anonymous) ‘An optimist is someone who thinks the future is uncertain.’ (Anonymous) ‘Treat a work of art like a prince: let it speak to you first.’ (Attributed to Arthur Schopenhauer) ‘The happiest time of anyone’s life is just after the first divorce.’ (John Kenneth Galbraith) ‘I always pass on good advice. It is the only thing to do with it. It is never any use to oneself.’ (Oscar Wilde) ‘An accountant is a man who is hired to explain that you didn’t make the money you did.’ (Anonymous) *revise the basics: a/an and one #we use a before a consonant and an before a vowel But it depends on the pronunciation of the following word, not the spelling: a dog a hat an orange a one-pound coin (/ə ‘wʌn…/) an uncle an hour (/ən ‘auə/) a union (/ə ‘ju:niən/) an MP (/ən em ‘pi:/) 1. A or an? 1. ……………elephant 10. …………SOS 2. ……………university 11. ………….X-ray 3. ……………umbrella 12. ………….European 4. ……………ticket 13. ………….hand 5. ……………VIP 14. ………….underpass 6. ……………honest man 15. ………….unit 7. ……………half-hour lesson 16……………CD 8. …………....one-hour lesson 17. …………..exam 9. …………… useful book 18. …………..school 372 #we use one, not a/an: *in contrast with another or other(s) *in the expression one day *with hundred and thousand when we want to sound precise *in expressions like only one and just one One girl wanted to go out, but the others wanted to stay at home. One day I’ll take you to meet my family. ‘How many are there? About a hundred?’ ‘Exactly one hundred and three.’ We’ve got plenty of sausages, but only one egg. 2. A/An or one? (1)……………..day last year – it was (2)…………….very hot afternoon in June – I was hurrying to get home. I was about (3)……………..hour late – well, to be precise, exactly (4)……………..hour and ten minutes: I had missed my train. Anyway, there was (5)…………….woman standing under the trees, and there were several children with her. I saw (6)…………….child clearly – she was (7)…………….lovely darkhaired girl – but I only heard the others. Suddenly (8)……………..strange thing happened. The girl took some stones out of her pocket, and threw (9)……………stone after another into the air. *revise the basics: a/an: She’s a farmer. He’s got a long nose #we use a/an to say what job a person does, what kind of thing somebody or something is, or what something is used as. A/An has no plural. She’s a farmer. They’re farmers. He worked as a taxi-driver. They worked as taxi-drivers. Don’t use the plate as an ashtray. Don’t use the plates as ashtrays. 373 #we use a/an in singular descriptions. She’s got a small nose. He’s got an interesting face. *revise the basics: a/an: A spider has eight legs. A man called #A/An can mean ‘any example of something.’ A spider has eight legs. Have you got an Italian dictionary? # A/An can mean ‘a particular one’ (if you don’t say exactly who or which). A man called while you were out. James married a doctor. I’ve bought a new bike. # NOTE: We don’t use a/an with uncountable nouns. (NOT a rain) We don’t use a/an with possessives. (NOT a my friend) After kind of or sort of, a/an is usually dropped: a kind of tree. (NOT a kind of a tree) In exclamations with what, a/an is not dropped. What a pity! (NOT What pity!) A/An usually comes after quite, rather and such: quite/rather/such a nice day. In the plural, we use no article or some, not a/an. They both married doctors. *revise the basics: the: Please close the door #The means ‘you know which (one/ones) I mean’. 374 Some men called. I bought a TV and a radio, but the radio didn’t work. (= the radio I just told you about – you know which one) The women over there work with my sister. (= the women I’m showing you – you know which ones.) Please close the door. (You can see which one) He’s been to the North Pole. (It’s obvious which – there’s only one.) #we often use the with only and with superlatives. 3. Put in the if the speaker and hearer probably know exactly which (one/ones). Put in a/an if not: 1. Who opened………………………………………………………………...window? 2. She lives in ………………………………………………………center of Glasgow. 3. I’d like………………………………………………………………...glass of water. 4. My sister is married to ……………………………………………………….farmer. 5. …………………………man in …………………………………next flat is French. 6. He’s ……………………oldest child in ……………………………………..school. 7. Who’s…………………..girl by………………………………………………piano? 8. There’s …………………strange man in …………..garden. What’s he doing there? 9. Today is ……………………………………………………...only day that I’m free. 10. ‘Which coat is yours?’ ‘…………………………………………………...red one.’ 4. Put in the or a/an: ‘Do you see (1)…………...man standing near (2)………….door? He works as (3)……………assistant in (4) ……………same shop as I do. Well, I saw him the other day and he was driving (5)………………big red Porsche. And do you see (6)…………………expensive clothes he’s wearing? Where does he get (7)………………..money to pay for it all? (8)…………….month ago he hadn’t got 375 (9) ………………..penny. I told you about (10)………………..burglary that we had at (11)……………..shop, didn’t I? Do you think I should go to (12)………….police? *revise the basics: generalizations without the: I like music #The does not mean ‘all’ We do not use the in generalizations with plural and uncountable nouns. Compare: I like music. Can you turn off the music? She’s very interested in nature. What is the nature of his illness? People have to live in society. I’ve joined the Poetry Society. Books are expensive. Put the books on the table. 5. Put the or- (= no article) in each blank: There must be something wrong with me. (1)……………….people usually think that (2)……………….babies are sweet and (3)……………..teenagers are annoying. Not me. I think (4)……………..babies are boring. For me, (5)…………..children start being interesting at (6)…………….age when you can understand (7)…………...things that they say. But (8) …………..years that I like best are (9)………………..period between ages thirteen and twenty. Oh, it’s difficult at times, but I still prefer talking about (10)……………..life with a teenager to cleaning a baby’s bottom. #we do not normally use the in generalizations with plural and uncountable nouns, even if there is an adjective before the noun. She’s studying Chinese history. He collects antique clocks. 376 #but we use the when a description with of follows the noun. She’s studying the history of China. 6. Use some adjectives from the box, or other adjectives, to write true (or false!) sentences about yourself. Don’t use the: air casual classical historical Italian loud romantic spicy stormy detective foggy formal really hot pop quiet train 1. I (don’t) like eating …………………………………………………………….food. 2. I can’t stand listening to……………………………………………………….music. 3. I love…………………………………………………………………………..music. 4. I hate………………………………………………………………………...weather. 5. I love………………………………………………………………………...weather. 6. I (don’t) like wearing………………………………………………………...clothes. 7. I (don’t) like ………………………………………………………………….people. 8. I (don’t) like……………………………………………………………………travel. 9. I (don’t) like reading………………………………………………………….novels. 10. I often/sometimes/never go for ……………………………………………...walks. II. VOCABULAR: GENERAL – THE NATURAL WORLD102 1. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) The fields were flooded after the river burst its banks/edges/sides. b) After the rain the street was full of floods/lakes/puddles. c) During the storm, the climbers sheltered in a cave/cliff/valley. d) A small river/stream/torrent runs across the bottom of our garden. e) It was difficult to swim because the waters/waves/tides were so high. 102 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 377 f) From the peak/summit/top of the hill you can see the sea. g) You must carry a lot of water when you cross the desert/plain/sand. h) In the middle of the square there is an old fountain/source/tap. i) I think it’s going to rain. It’s very clouded/clouding/cloudy. j) The church caught fire when it was struck by hurricane/lightning/thunder. 2.Complete each sentence (a-j) with one of the endings (1-10). Use each ending once: a) A large green snake…5 1. was spinning its web across the window. b) A small brown duck ….. 2. was plodding across the field, mooing loudly. c)A large black and yellow wasp 3. was buzzing around the jar of honey on the …… table. d) A shiny green crab…. 4. was sitting on a branch and miaowing. e) An enormous black spider….. 5. was slithering across the floor towards me. f) A bright green frog… 6. was sitting on a leaf and croaking. g) A black and white puppy…. 7. was following the flock, baaing softly. h) A herd of cattle…. 8.was swimming on the pond and quacking loudly. i) A dirty black lamb…. 9. was barking furiously outside the gate. j) A small ginger kitten…. 10.was pinching Fiona’s toe as she stood on the seashore. 3.Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: forest leaves stone twig plant seeds trunk lawn peel roots a) We cut down the tree but then we had to dig up its roots. b) The road goes through a beautiful pine……………………………………………… c) When Tom was eating a cherry, he accidentally swallowed the ……………………. d) In autumn, these paths are covered in fallen ………………………………………... 378 e) Who is going to cut the……………………………………………while I am away? f) We bought Diana a beautiful indoor………………………………..for her birthday. g) A tree fell, and its massive………………………………………...blocked the road. h) Harry buys………………………………………..and grows all his own vegetables. i) The bird was carrying a ……………………………………………..to build its nest. j) Some people like eating orange……………………………………………………… 4. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) The dog shook/wagged/moved/rubbed its tail furiously when it saw the children. b) A large trunk/bark/twig/branch of the tree broke off in the storm. c) There was field after field of golden corn/bushes/grass/herbs waving in the wind. d) Before railways were built, many goods were carried on channels/water/canals/ river. e) The children enjoyed rolling down the grassy mountain/cliff/stone/slope. f) What kind of breed/race/mark/family is your dog? g) Some wild animals will become peaceful/tame/organized/petty if they get used to people. h) There’s a house/home/cage/nest of blackbirds at the bottom of the garden. i) Many people are interested in watching wildlife/wilds/wilderness/wildly. j) You have to sleep under a net to avoid being bitten by lobsters/geese/cockroaches/ mosquitoes. 5. Use each word given in capitals at the end of each line to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: A pet parrot From early (1) childhood Jane had always wanted a pat parrot. CHILD Her parents told her that a parrot was an (2)……………..pet, but Jane SUIT insisted. She was worried about the (3)………………………….of the DESTROY rainforests where parrots live, and she felt that parrots needed more (4)………………….Her father argued that a parrot would suffer from PROTECT (5)…………………….if it lived in a house. He also explained that pet LONELY 379 parrots are caught by (6)…………………, who need money and don’t HUNT care about protecting species. ‘They catch the parrots and send them to Europe in (7)…………………….boxes’, he told her. ‘And in any case, WOOD parrots are very (8)…………….and don’t make good pets.’ Jane soon OBEY made an interesting (9)……………………., however. She found a pet DISCOVER shop which bred parrots instead of importing them. So she took all her (10)………………...and bought a tiny parrot, which she called ‘Pixie’. SAVE 6. Complete the compound word in each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: forecast hive skin trap house side top fountain hole mower a) There were so many mice we had to buy a mouse trap. b) Paula was cutting the grass with an electric lawn …………………………………... c) There’s a drinking……………………………………...on the other side of the park. d) What’s the weather…………………………………………………...for tomorrow? e) The hill ……………………………………...was covered in beautiful wild flowers. f) You can see the mountain ………………………..among the clouds in the distance. g) At the end of the field was a large stone farm………………………………………. h) We collect honey from our own bee………………………………………………… i) There’s a rabbit………………………………………….....in the corner of this field. j) Martin was wearing imitation snake…………………………………………...boots. 7. Complete each sentence with one suitable word: a) I think this fruit juice has gone off. It smells funny. b) Mind………………………………………………...! Our cat has very sharp claws! c) I keep my dog on a leash, but I let it……………………………………..in the park. d) I like the idea of camping, but I am put……………………………….by the insects. e) Our dog never got used………………………………………..sleeping in its kennel. f) I don’t think I want to find……………………….whether that bull has sharp horns! 380 g) My puppy managed to tear……………………………….three of my school books. h) I’ve taken…………………………………..going for long walks in the countryside. 8. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: Pets If you decide to buy a pet, you should (1) go/look/find/take out as much as possible about the pet you (2) choose/decide/take/do. Cats are easy to (3) run/change/find/look after and seem to be (4) singular/depended/independent/single, but also need the company of people. If your cat finds someone who (5) feeds/cares/looks/loves for it more than you do, it will change owners! A small puppy may look like a (6) suited/ suiting/suit/suitable pet, but don’t forget that it will (7) grow/get/stand/buy up. You may not be able to (8) stay/live/put/feed up with a very large dog that is too big for its (9) lodging/kennel/cupboard/box and which (10) relies/insists/carries/concentrates on sleeping on your bed! Unless you (11) train/learn/lesson/educate it, it may attack people, or (12) wag/quack/moo/bark loudly day and night. Nobody loves a (13) disobey/disobeying/disobedient/disobeyed pet. Perhaps this is why so many people (14) go/prefer/decide/take in for birds or fish as pets. Whatever you decide in the (15) house/fact/first/end, think carefully before you make a decision. VOCABULARY: GENERAL: PHRASAL VERBS: SUCCESS AND FAILURE103 A. Read these extracts to understand the underlined phrasal verb expressions in the headlines: NORTHCORP BRINGS OFF $10M DEAL Northcorp Telecommunications announced last night that the company had secured a $10m dollar deal in the face of severe competition and despite many difficulties. 103 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 381 STARFINDER CD TAKES OFF The first CD by the group which won the TV show ‘Starfinder’, where bands competed for a record contract, has become instantly popular one day after it was released, and is now number one. TINA TAKES OVER AS NUMBER ONE POP IDOL 18-year-old singer Tina Hoogan has been voted number one female performer in a national pop poll, replacing last year’s winner, Francie Moon as the country’s most popular female artist. MINI-BALLOON ATTEMPT COMES OFF DESPITE WEATHER An attempt to fly a mini hot-air balloon under Tower Bridge in London has succeeded, despite fog and rain which threatened to prevent the event. UMBRELLAS FAIL TO CATCH ON WITH TEENAGERS An attempt by a Japanese company to market a new range of jazzy umbrellas to teenagers has failed. Sales show that they have not become as popular as the company hoped. DRUMA PULLS OFF RECORD ATTEMPT ZAFI DRUMA yesterday succeeded in winning the 100m, 400m and 800m all on the same day at the International Athletics Championships in Mexico City, despite fierce international competition. DOWNFALL OF REBEL GROUP MARKS END OF CIVIL WAR The failure of the rebel army to hold on to the western part of Kahuba and the rapid collapse of popular support for the rebels means the country’s civil war is at an end. PLAN TO BUILD NEW STADIUM FALLS THROUGH The President of the Football Association announced last night that the plan to build a new £200m national stadium has failed and the stadium will not be built. 382 B. Read this speech by a headteacher to pupils who are leaving schools. When you leave this school, we hope you will build on [use a success or achievement as a base from which to achieve more success] what you have learnt here. You must not expect to just walk into [get very easily] a highly-paid job, but most of you will, with hard-work and self-discipline, succeed and achieve great things. Never be content to just muddle through [succeed in doing something even though you have difficulties because you do not really know how to do it] as so many people do, always trying to catch up [reach the same quality or standard as someone] and failing to do so. Hard work, dedication and commitment will, in the end, pay off [be successful]. To keep up [make progress at the same speed as something or someone else so that you stay at the same level as them] with the competition we all have to give 100%, so that our country can stay ahead [continue to be more advanced and successful than other people] in business and industry. It will be your job to make this happen. Good luck. 1.Find phrasal verb expressions from A that match these definitions: 1. fail to happen ………………………………………………………………………... 2. replace someone in a position of success……………………………………………. 3. the sudden failure of a person or organization………………………………………. 4. suddenly become successful or popular……………………………………………... 5. succeed in achieving something difficult……………………………………………. 6. happen successfully or as planned…………………………………………………… 2. Decide whether these phrasal verbs are mainly associated with success or with failure, by writing S or F in the box: 1. bring off……… 4. pay off………. 7. take off…….. 2. come off……… 5. catch up……... 8. fall through…… 3. muddle through……. 6. stay ahead……. 9. walk into……. 383 3. Fill the gaps in this school report with phrasal verbs from B: SUBJECT History COMMENT Tina’s work in history is not very good, but she does manage to …………………. somehow. Maths Tina has managed to successfully …………………the work she did last year in order to make excellent progress this term. English Tina missed a lot of schoolwork through illness at the beginning of term, but she has managed to …………………….and is doing fine now. Geography Tina has always been top of the class in geography and she has managed to …………………this year too. Physics Tina has never found physics easy but her hard work is beginning to ……………………. 4. Rewrite these sentences using the words in brackets. Write the verb in the correct form: 1. Miranda immediately got a job in London. (WALK) ………………………………………………………………………………… 2. Jim’s hard work eventually brought him success. (PAY) …………………………………………………………………………………. 3. The company is hoping to make an important deal this week. (PULL) ………………………………………………………………………………….. 4.Rachel never expected her singing career to meet with such instant success. (TAKE) ………………………………………………………………………………….. 5. The project may well not happen because of a lack of funds. (FALL) ………………………………………………………………………………….. 6. Teri finds it hard to make as much progress as the other kids in her class. (KEEP) ………………………………………………………………………………….. 7. The new design of mobile phone has become successful almost overnight. (CATCH) …………………………………………………………………………………. 384 8. Top software companies are finding it increasingly difficult to remain in front of their competitors. (STAY) ………………………………………………………………………………….. III. VOCABULARY : SPECIFIC – NEWS – POLITICAL REFUGEES – ECONOMIC MIGRANTS104 1. Thousands of Ishmadic refugees are fleeing into neighbouring Anturia from a massacre being carried out by government forces on the civilian population. The bloodshed comes in retaliation for the support given to the rebels in the recent civil war. Reliable reports speak of the exodus of eleven thousand people who are seeking refuge from the troops. Vast areas in war-torn regions are now said to be depopulated, as the newcomers pour into Anturia as a rate of more than one thousand a day. Temporary shelters have been provided at border posts from which the exiles are transported to makeshift camps. There they can wait for weeks before they are permanently resettled. The medical condition of the displaced is described as catastrophic and may result in many deaths due to starvation. 2. Refugees seeking political asylum in Mardonia claim they are persecuted in their homeland and refuse to be turned back. Two hundred people, whose application for asylum have been turned down, are now facing deportation to Agunda; only a handful were given official entry permits and permanent residence. The Minister of Interior is quoted as saying that the asylum-claimants are not genuine and their real motivation is economic. Most of them tried entering the country with bogus papers. Deportation orders have already been signed against the first fifty. Human Rights organizations have called on immigration authorities to adopt a more lenient approach and halt the expulsion. 3. Several thousand unemployed marched yesterday through the streets of Mosterra demanding forced repatriation of economic refugees. The protest stems from a growing exasperation over the unending stream of foreign nationals who are seeking refugee status in Veldonia. Though claiming to be escaping political repression and ethnic persecution in their homeland, they are also after better economic 104 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1, 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 385 opportunities. The influx is creating an even tighter job market and is threatening the economic well-being of many Veldonians. The marchers demanded a more through screening of applications, and proposed that all jobless economic migrants should be returned to their country of origin. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Anturian soldiers are killing Ishmadic civilians. 2. From the report we can conclude that Ishmad is a fully democratic country in which the opposition can operate legally. 3. Thousands of people have decided to leave their homes and cross the border. 4. The Anturian authorities are not doing anything to help the refugees. 5. Refugee camps have inadequate facilities to deal with the number of exiles. 6.The people seeking asylum in Mardonia say they are members of the illegal opposition in Agunda. 7.The Mardonian authorities have decided to send some of them back to Agunda because they have an agreement with that country concerning the expulsion of immigrants. 8. Fifty per cent of the applicants for refugee status will stay in Mardonia. 9. The decision to expel the Agundans is seen as a violation of human rights. 10. The march in Mosterra was organized by economic refugees demanding work. 11. The demand for work in Valedonia is greater than the number of jobs available. 12.The authorities are expected to examine more carefully the motivation of refuge claimants. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B civilian……………….. asylum deportation…………….. authorities economic………………. market entry………………….. minorities 386 ethnic………………… nationals forced……………….. orders foreign………………… permits immigration……………… population job………………….. refugees permanent……………… repatriation political………………. residence temporary……………….. shelter 3. Rearrange the words to form the headlines to the stories: 1. ANTURIA – ESCAPE – INTO – THOUSANDS – TO – FLOOD – REFUGEES – PERSECUTION – OF ………………………………………………………………………………………… …………………………………………………………………………………………. 2. HUNDRED – FROM – ASYLUM – SEEKERS – TO – TWO – MARDONIA – BE – EXPELLED ………………………………………………………………………………………… …………………………………………………………………………………………. 3. ECONOMY – MARCHES – OF – PROTEST – PROTECT – DEMAND – WORKERS – TO – REPATRIATION – MIGRANT ………………………………………………………………………………………… ………………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: -a masacra, a săvârşi un masacru: - c……………… a m………………….. -a acorda sprijin: g……………….. s…………………… -a căuta refugiu, adăpost: – s…………….. r…………………. - a asigura adăposturi: - p……………… s……………………. -a respinge cererea: - t………………. d…………… an a……………….. -a acorda permisiunea de intrare: - g………….. an e………….. p………………… -a cita (pe cineva): – q…………… somebody a…………… s………………. 387 - a semna ordinul de expulzare: - s…………… a d…………… o………………… - a solicita autorităţile: - c……………… o…………. a…………….. -a căuta posibilităţi mai bune: - be a…………. b…………….. o………………….. - a restrânge şi mai mult piaţa de muncă: - c………….. a t………….. j……………. m………….. 388 LESSON 24 *Grammar: Articles – a/an and the (2)* Vocabulary: General – People and Behaviour* Phrasal Verbs: Starting and Finishing* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Computer Viruses *** I. GRAMMAR - ARTICLES: A/AN AND THE (2)105 *the in generalizations: Who invented the telescope? #we can use the in generalizations with singular countable nouns, to talk about a whole class of things. This is common in scientific and technical language. Who invented the telescope? The tiger is in danger of dying out. I can’t play the piano. I hate the telephone. 1. Complete the sentences with the words from the box. Use the: ballpoint pen camera computer dog train violin whale wheel novel ostrich wolf X-ray machine E.g.: Some birds can’t fly – for example, the ostrich. 1. Before people invented………………..., they couldn’t transport heavy loads easily. 2. In its early years, ………….......wasn’t thought to be good reading for young ladies. 3. Scientific calculations were much slower before the invention of………………….. 105 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 389 4. …………………………………………….is one of the hardest instruments to play. 5. What did people write with before…………………………………………………? 6. Is…………………………….descended from…………………………………......? 7. What can we do to save……………………………………………..from dying out? 8. …………………………is a valuable tool for doctors, but it has its dangers as well. 9. In the 19th century, ……………………………………………revolutionized travel. 10. Has…………………………………………....made portrait-painting unnecessary? 2. Grammar and vocabulary: musical instruments. Put in the correct instruments from the box: cello guitar harp organ piano saxophone trumpet violin 1. It has four strings. You put one end under your chin and play it with a bow. …………………. 2. Children often learn this instrument. It has 36 black keys and 52 white keys. ………………….. 3. It has six strings. You hold it in front of your body; it can be played with both hands. ………………….. 4. A big one can have 46 or 47 strings, stands on the floor, and is played with both hands. …………………… 5. It has four strings. You put one end on the floor and play it with a bow. ……………………. 6. This is a wind instrument, often played by jazz musicians. It was invented by Adolphe Sax in 1841. …………………….. 7. This is a very big wind instrument often found in churches, played with the hands and feet. …………………….. 8. A wind instrument made of metal, widely used in traditional jazz. …………………….. 390 #some other common general expressions with the: the sea, the mountains, the town, the country, the cinema, the theatre. I love the sea. Do you like living in the country? I never go to the cinema or the theatre. *place names: Lake Superior; the Atlantic #PLACE NAMES WITH NO ARTICLE: -continents, most countries: Africa, Germany, Peru (BUT The Netherlands) -states, counties etc: Texas, Oxfordshire, Normandy - towns: Ottawa, Prague, Sydney (BUT The Hague) - most streets: Fifth Avenue, Westgate Street - lakes, most mountains: Lake Superior, Everest, Mont Blanc - town + building: Oxford University, York Airport, Reading Station #PLACE NAMES WITH THE -seas, rivers, deserts: the Atlantic, the Thames, the Sahara -mountain and island groups: the Alps, the Himalayas, the West Indies -name includes common noun: the Czech Republic, the United States, the Far East -most buildings: the British Museum, the Ritz, the Playhouse 3. Choose the correct expression: E.g.: We went on a boat trip on the Mississippi/Lake Superior. They’re hoping to drive across Africa/Sahara. 1. My brother works in China/People’s Republic of China. 2. There are four countries in the Great Britain/United Kingdom. 3. We’re going on holiday to the South America/Republic of Ireland. 4. Here’s a photo of Annie and me in USA/Oxford Street. 5. I’ve never been to Netherlands/Norway. 391 6. Joe has a small farm near the Marseille/Mediterranean. 7. There are a lot of European immigrants in the USA/America. 8. This is a piece of rock from the Himalayas/Mount Everest. 9. Our hotel is just opposite the Ritz/Victoria Station. 10. From the plane window we had a wonderful view of River Rhine/Mont Blanc. 4. Put in the or – (= no article): E.g.: the British Museum 10………..River Seine - Canterbury Cathedral 11………..Victoria Street 1. ………….California 12. ………Rocky Mountains 2. ………….Mount Kilimanjaro 13. ………Berlin 3. ………….Lake Garda 14. ………Morocco 4. ………….Australia 15………..Pacific Ocean 5. ………….National Gallery 16. ………Apollo Theatre 6. ………….Hilton Hotel 17. ………Cambridge Town Hall 7. …………Three Dragons Restaurant 18. ………White House 8. …………Geneva Airport 19. ………Yorkshire 9. …………Dominican Republic 20. ………Gobi Desert *other special cases: in prison; She became Queen #some common expression with no article after a preposition: to/at/from school/university/college at home to/at/from work to/in/out of church/prison/hospital/bed on holiday by car/bus/bicycle/plane/train/underground/boat She’s in prison. (She’s a prisoner) She works as a cook in the prison. You should be in bed. (resting) I found chewing gum in the bed again. 392 on foot 5.Choose a word or expression for each blank, and add a preposition: bed bicycle bus home prison school bus church foot underground holiday university 1.‘How do you usually go to the shops?’ home work ‘Oh, I usually go…………….., but sometimes if I have a lot to carry I go………………………………………………’ 2.After a hard day…………………………, my mother used to come home and go ……………………………………… to rest for half an hour before making supper. 3. Children go………………………………………………..to learn to read and write. 4. Does your family usually go away………………..or do you stay…………………? 5.When Juliet was studying ……………………….., she broke her leg and had to stay ………………………………………………………………………..for two weeks. 6. My aunt goes…………………………………every morning and twice on Sundays. 7. If you’re travelling across London, it’s much faster………………….., but you can see more ……………………………………………………………………………. 8. Another way of getting across London is ………………..., but it’s quite dangerous. 9. My friend George spent three months……………..for something that he didn’t do. #some other expressions with no article: He was elected President. She became Queen. They made her Manager. What’s on TV? Let’s watch television. (BUT on the radio, listen to the radio) #note that we do not usually drop articles after with, without, as or what. note also: the same, on the right/left, a hundred/thousand You can’t eat soup with a fork. I had to do the translation without a dictionary. I worked as a guide last summer. 393 What a surprise! Most of the government ministers went to the same school. ‘Where are the toilets?’ ‘Over there on the right.’ I’ve just planted a hundred tulips. 6. Put in a/an, the or – (= no article): 1. They appointed him……………………………...General Manager at the age of 23. 2. You can’t go there without ……………………………………………………..visa. 3. ‘What’s for lunch?’ ‘…………………………………………….same as yesterday.’ 4. There’s absolutely nothing on……………………………………..TV this evening. 5. What…………………………………………………………………strange haircut! 6. Please don’t use your plate as……………………………………………….ashtray. 7. Did you hear the weather forecast on…………………………..radio this morning? 8. ‘I’m trying to learn……………….thousand new words every mouth.’ ‘Good luck.’ 9. I don’t like writing with………………………………………………………pencil. 10. They didn’t elect him ……………………….Chairman – he gave himself the job. *articles: more practice 7. Mixed article uses. Correct or not? Correct the mistakes or write ‘Correct’: E.g.: I really like the Indian food. Indian food I’m learning the violin. Correct 1. The life is sometimes difficult. …………………………………... 2. You can’t go out in the rain without a coat! …………………………………... 3. I go to cinema two or three times a week. …………………………………... 4. We always go to mountains on holiday. …………………………………... 5. Do your children go to school on Saturdays? …………………………………... 6. I’ll see you at Dragon Restaurant at 8.00. …………………………………... 7. I climbed the Mont Blanc last year. …………………………………... 394 8. Do you think Foster will be elected the President? …………………………………. 9. Ann’s interested in sport and nature. …………………………………... 10. About a hundred people came to the festival. …………………………………... 8. Mixed article uses. Complete the quotations with a, an, the or – (= no article): 1. When I was born, I was so surprised that couldn’t talk for ……… year and…………..half. (Gracie Allen) 2. California is ………….great place – if you happen to be ………..orange. (F. Allen) 3. Never put anything on ………….paper, my boy, and never trust …………man with…………….small black moustache. (P.G. Wodehouse) 4. …………dog is ………..only thing on earth that loves you more than you love yourself. (Josh Billings) 5. ………...Americans like……….fat books and ……….thin women. (Russell Baker) 6. ………..actor’s ………..guy who, if you ain’t talking about him, ain’t listening. (Attributed to Marlon Brando) 7. …………...death is……….nature’s way of telling you to slow down. (Anonymous) 8. ………….diplomacy is the art of saying ‘nice doggie!’ until you can find………………stone. (Wynn Catlin) 9. ……..birds do it; …….bees do it; even……….educated fleas to it. Let’s do it. Let’s fall in ………love. (Cole Porter) 10. I love acting. It is so much more real than ……………………..life. (Oscar Wilde) 11. Nothing’s illegal if …………hundred businessmen decide to do it, and that’s true anywhere in ………world. (Andrew Young) 12. Remember that as……….teenager you are at………..last stage in your life when you will be happy to hear that …………………..phone is for you. (Fran Lebowitz) 13. Save………………water, shower with………………………friend. (Anonymous) 14. When I was………..boy of fourteen, my father was so ignorant I could hardly stand to have ………….old man around. But when I got to be twenty-one, I was astonished at how much he had learned in seven years. (Mark Twain) 15. A banker is………..man who lends you……….umbrella when………..weather is fair, and takes it away from you when it rains. (Anonymous) 395 *articles: revision test 9. Put a or an: 1. ………..uncle 6. ……….half-hour break 2. ……….X-ray 7. ……….one- hour break 3. ……….union 8. ……….hole 4. ……….bus 9. ……….useful idea 5. ……….hour 10. ………student 10. Put a/an or one: 1. It happened…………………………………………………...afternoon last summer. 2. Could I have …………………………………………………………………..knife? 3. The journey lasts exactly ……………………………………………………...hour. 4. Only ………………………………………………………………...person was late. 5. It was ………………………………………………………………………cold day. 6. If it’s not……………………………………………………….problem, it’s another. 7. I’m going to put on ………………………………………………………….sweater. 8. He went out wearing……………………………………………………………sock. 9. I’ve got to make…………………………………………………………..phone call. 10. I booked……………………………………………………………..room, not two. 11. Put a/an, the or -.: 1. Have you seen……………………………….........small blue bag anywhere around? 2. Can you lock …………………………………………..front door when you go out? 3. She’s interested in ………………….art and………………………..African history. 4. May I use………………………………………………………………….bathroom? 5. What’s that black stuff on …………………………………………………….floor? 6. Is there………………………………………………………...post office near here? 7. I’ll meet you at 8.00 outside………………………………………………….station. 8. I’ll drive you to………………..airport. What time is ………………………..plane? 396 9. …………………..people are more interesting than……………………….grammar. 10. I’ve had…………………………………………………………….interesting idea. 11. My brother is married to…………………………………………………….doctor. 12. You’ve got……………………………………………………………….nice smile. 13. …………………woman in …………………..next office comes from New York. 14. I work in ……………………………………………………center of Birmingham. 15. Do you like…………………………………………………………Chinese food? 16. I’m learning………………………………………………………………….guitar. 17. My youngest brother is …………………………………………………..engineer. 18. I don’t know how we managed before…………………...computer was invented. 19. What’s on ……………………………………………………….TV this evening? 20. You can’t get in here without………………………………………………..ticket. 12. Put in the or -. 1. ………Ritz Hotel. 11. ………Smithsonian Museum 2. ………Oxford Street 12. ………New Theater 3. ……....Czech Republic 13. ………Dublin Airport 4. ……....Cambridge University 14. ………Atacama Desert 5. ………Lake Geneva 15. ………River Nile 6. ………Mount Everest 16. ………Great Pyramid 7. ………North Sea 17. ………Netherlands 8. ………Wales 18. ………Hague 9. ………Washington 19. ………Alps 10. ……..Eiffel Tower 20. ………Yorkshire II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PEOPLE AND BEHAVIOUR106 1. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) Please don’t push. It’s very bad-tempered/rude/unsympathetic. 106 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 397 b) Jack hates spending money. He’s rather frank/greedy/mean. c) Our teacher is very proud/strict/tolerant and won’t let us talk in class. d) Helen never does her homework. She is rather gentle/lazy/reliable. e) I didn’t talk to anyone at the party because I felt ambitious/lonely/shy. f) When Harry saw his girlfriend dancing with Paul he felt jealous/selfish/sentimental. g) I don’t like people who are noisy and aggressive/courageous/sociable. h) Thanks for bringing us a present. It was very adorable/grateful/thoughtful of you. i) Teresa never gets angry with the children. She is very brave/patient/pleasant. j) Tom always pays for everyone when we go out. He’s so cheerful/generous/honest. 2. Match the words in the box with the descriptions (a-l). Use each word once only: bad-tempered determined lazy reliable cheerful mean considerate honest punctual sympathetic selfish frank a) You always arrive on time. punctual b) You are always happy. ………………………….. c) You do what you say you will do. ………………………….. d) You say exactly what you think. ………………………….. e) You don’t think about the needs of others. ………………………….. f) You have a strong wish to get what you want. ………………………….. g) You are unkind, or not willing to spend money. ………………………….. h) You easily become angry with others. ………………………….. i) You think about the needs of others. ………………………….. j) You tell the truth and obey the law. ………………………….. k) You understand the feelings of others. ………………………….. l) You try to avoid work if you can. ………………………….. 398 3.Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: ambitious stubborn greedy grateful polite sociable brave kind snobbish tolerant imaginative a) I think I’ll stay here on my own, I’m not feeling very sociable today. b) Diana wants to get to the top in her company. She is very …………………………. c) It’s not…………………………………………....to stare at people and say nothing! d) I think you have to be very………………………………………….to write a novel. e) Thank you for helping me. It was very……………………………………….of you. f) Peter refuses to change his mind, although he is wrong. He’s so…………………… g) It was very………………………………….of Sheila to put out the fire on her own. h) Our neighbors look down on us. They are a bit…………………………………….. i) Don’t eat all the cakes! You really are becoming…………………………………...! j) If you lend me the money, I’ll be very……………………………………………… l) My parents don’t mind my crazy hairstyle. They are very…………………………. 4. Use the word given in capitals at the end of each line to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: Jack’s real character How easy is it to understand another person’s character? My friend Jack, was once a rather (1) annoying person. He was ANNOY always getting into trouble at school because he was so OBEY (2)…………. In class he was very (3)…………………and never stopped making TALK jokes. The teachers all told him he was (4)…………………because POLITE he interrupted them. When I met him he was very (5)……………… FRIEND and didn’t want to talk to me at all. People told me that he stole things, and that he was (6)……………………His school work HONEST was terrible. He didn’t take any (7)………………in his writing, he PROUD 399 never spent enough time doing his homework, and he was not at all (8)…………………. One day he saw a gang of boys CONSCIENCE attacking an old man. Jack hated (9)…………………and he fought VIOLENT them all until they ran away. He was awarded a medal for (10)………………. ……After that, people changed their minds BRAVE about him. 5.Choose the most suitable word or phrase to complete each sentence: a) You can’t tell what someone is like just from their character/appearance /personality/looking. b) I was born in Scotland but I grew up/raised/brought up/rose in Northern Ireland. c) Edward was named after one of his father’s distant family/brothers/members/ relations. d) Jane and Brian got married a year after they got divorced/proposed/engaged/ separated. e) Graham works well in class, but his rudeness/behavior/politeness/acting could be better. f) Julie had a terrible row/discussion/argue/dispute with her parents last night. g) I got to introduce/know/meet/sympathize Steve well last year when we worked together. h) Is Brenda married or spinster/alone/bachelor/single? I don’t like to ask her. i) Parents have to try hard to understand the younger generation/people/adolescents/ teenagers. j) My father likes to be called a senior citizen, not an old age person/relative/ gentleman/pensioner. 400 6. Match the words in the box with a suitable definition (a-l). Use each word once: adult colleague nephew toddler best man fiancé niece twin bride neighbor sister-in-law widow a) The son of your brother or sister. nephew b) A woman on the day of her marriage. ………………….. c) A young child who is learning to walk. ………………….. d) What a woman calls the man she is engaged to. ………………….. e) One of the two children born at the same time. ………………….. f) A person who lives near you. ………………….. g) The daughter of your brother or sister. ………………….. h) A person who is fully grown. ………………….. i) A woman whose husband has died. ………………….. j) At a wedding, the friend of the bridegroom. ………………….. k) The sister of the person you marry. ………………….. l) A person you work with. ………………….. 7. Complete each sentence with one suitable word: a) After a few days they realized they were in love. b) I went…………………………………………with a very interesting girl last week. c) Andrew acts as ……………………..he was the most important person in the room. d) After two years, their marriage broke………………………………………………. e) John discovered that he was related………………………..his next-door neighbour. f) My parents keep treating me………………………………..a child, but I’m not one! g) I was brought……………………………………..by my aunt after my parents died. h) It was very kind………………………………………………...you to give me a lift. i) Teachers should be patient……………………………………………small children. j) James was very disappointed…………………………………………….his new job. k) It’s very…………………………………….of character for Bill to behave like that. l) Most famous people behave quite normally………………………………….private. 401 8. Replace the words in italics with a verb from the box. Use each verb once only: call in fall out get on well with give away put up with turn down look up to take after turn up a) The wedding was cancelled when the bride failed to arrive. count on turn up b) Susan feels that her boss is someone to respect. ……………………………………. c) I’m sorry, but I just can’t stand your behavior any longer. …………………………. d) My brother and I really have a good relationship with our parents. ………………... e) Why don’t you visit my house on your way home from the shops? ………………… f) Tony felt that he could rely on his friend Mary. …………………………………….. g) The millionaire decided to make a present of his money to the poor. ……………… h) Paula and Shirley are good friends but sometimes they quarrel. …………………... i) Jean decided to refuse Chris’s offer of marriage. …………………………………… j) All three children behave like their father and are very sociable. …………………… 9. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: Ann Johnson – A confidential report Ann Johnson has worked at this college for three years. She is a (1) conscientious/ conscience/consciousness/conscious employee, and (2) goes/carries/gets/likes on well with the other members of the department. We have all found her to be an excellent (3) colleague/adult/employer/fellow. She has always been (4) times/late/hourly/ punctual for her lessons, and is an extremely (5) greedy/reliable/stubborn/lazy member of staff who is able to work independently. I can always (6) request/ concentrate/take/rely on her to organize the end of term play, and she has put on some extremely (7) imaginary/imagination/imaginative/imagined productions. Her students often tell me how (8) tempered/cheerful/frank/proud she is, always ready with a smile, and she has been very (9) kind/aggressive/polite/mean to many of them. In (10) first/times/usual/private she is not very talkative and seems rather (11) but/ shy/however/alone at first, and might not show her true (12) person/behavior/ 402 character/part in an interview. Her work is excellent, and she is (13) used/determined/ had/supposed to succeed. She is also quite (14) obedient/disappointed/grateful/ ambitious, and has applied for two other positions as Director of Studies. I think that you can count (15) on/for/with/to Ann to make your school a success, and I recommend her for the post of Director. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PHRASAL VERBS: STARTING AND FINISHING107 A. STARTING: If you… then you…. Example set about start doing something that The kitchen looked as if it something/ doing uses a lot of time and energy something hadn’t been cleaned or tied for months, but Jessica set about making it look as good as new. start a journey set out We set out at 7 a.m. and didn’t return until after dark. start off or start begin life, existence or a Yvonne started out as a model out profession in a particular way but soon realized that it was not the career for her. Note that the noun ‘the outset’, from the verb ‘set out’, means the beginning, e.g. There were problems from the outset and things became progressively worse. B. FINISHING Joe called off [decided to stop an activity that had already started] the building work his team was doing on the new company offices, because he had heard that the company was going bankrupt. He knew the money was going to dry up [end or stop coming], so he was not prepared to continue. Most of the team immediately broke off [stopped or interrupted] what they were doing, but some of them first finished off 107 Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 403 [completed the last part of what they were doing] the task they were working on. Joe himself quickly polished off [finished something quickly and easily] the last of his paperwork and then packed up [collected his things together, usually after finishing doing something] Suzanna is trying to give up smoking. At first she cut down [reduced the amount or number] to five rather than fifteen a day, but she is finding it very hard. She says that a cigarette helps her to wind down [gradually relax after something that has made you feel tired or worried] after a hard day at work. She hopes her determination won’t fizzle out [gradually end or disappear, usually in a disappointing way] after a few weeks, as she is very anxious not to give up this new regime. 1. Complete these comments by various people with words from the box below. Write the words in the correct form: set fizzle break dry start give polish pack cut finish call outset 1. I……………………..out as a chemist, but I knew from the ……………….that it wasn’t what I wanted to do. So I ……………….it and joined the navy instead. 2. I had 50 exam papers to correct that day, and so I………………….about marking them. I managed to …………………off about 20 by 12.30, so I ……………….. off for lunch and decided to ………………….the job off later. 3. I was putting on weight, so I decided to ………………… up fatty foods. I………………… down on sweet drinks too, but I’m afraid my efforts ……………… out after a couple of weeks and now I’m back where I started. 4. Our research project was getting nowhere, and our funds were ………………….. up. We didn’t really want to …………………..the whole thing off, but we had no choice. We’re very disappointed. 404 2. Answer these questions about yourself, using full sentences with a phrasal verb: 1. What should you set about doing soon, even though you don’t really want to? 2. Can you think of something you were planning to do, but then were forced to call off? 3. What helps you to wind down when you are tired or stressed? 4. What do you eat or drink too much of which you think you should cut down on? 5. What did you once start off doing but later gave up? III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS – COMPUTER VIRUSES108 1. All over the world today, many computers are waking up crippled, with the words “Frodo lives” illuminating their screens. The latest computer virus designed by invisible computer saboteurs has been triggered. Frodo is called a stealthy virus because it is very effective at hiding and lying dormant until activated. It is just one of several thousand distinctive viruses worldwide which, like disease, are spread through exchange of “infected” computer discs. The most dangerous ones, with sinister names like Dark Avenger or Datacrime, are said to be on dramatic increase. Electronic viruses are not always hostile. Some do no erase information; they only irritate users by writing nonsense or playing tunes when activated. Trojan Horse, so-dubbed because it infiltrates in disguise, may, for example, conceal erotic pictures in business files. But computers can also be attacked by worms which move information around. By multiplying, they eventually render the system ineffective by filling up all available disc space. 2. The deadly Michelangelo virus is to strike on Friday, March 6th, computer users were warned today, triggered by the date of the Italian artist’s birthday. Upon switching the computer on, the virus suddenly bursts into life, repeatedly replicates itself, and wipes out the existing software by overwriting hard discs. The remedy for 108 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1, 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 405 computer users, who are bracing themselves for the attack, is to run anti-virus software to detect and destroy the menace in time, or to bypass the virus’ trigger date by moving a computer’s clock a day forward to March 7th. The deletion of data can cause considerable disruption and financial loss to a company which owns affected systems and many firms are believed to be carrying the virus. Since the virus installs itself from “infected” floppy discs, unlicensed, pirated software should never be run on company computers. Only by standing within the law as far as copyright is concerned, can one avoid the often irreversible damage to computer data. Companies are also advised to have a constantly updated backup system to replace damaged files. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. If the words “Frodo lives” appear on a computer screen, it means that the system has been damaged. 2. Computer users know that their discs have been infected with the Frodo virus long before it activates itself. 3. The several thousand viruses in existence have their own characteristic features. 4. A computer can become infected only from the outside. 5. Every computer virus means total damage to the system. 6. A worm’s job is to move erotic pictures from one disc to another. 7. The Michelangelo virus always strikes on Friday, March the 6th. 8. The virus has the ability to increase the area it occupies on the disc. 9. Anti-virus software works by changing the date on the computer’s clock. 10. The virus can be cheated by changing the date from the 6th to the 7th of March. 11. Pre-packed licensed software is guaranteed to be virus-free. 12.The virus simultaneously damages both hard discs and the backups stored on floppy discs. 406 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B affected……………… damage anti-virus…………….. date business………………. disc disc…………………… files erotic…………………. loss financial………………… names hard…………………….. pictures invisible…………………. saboteurs irreversible………………. software sinister………………….. space trigger…………………. systems 3. Rearrange the words to form the headlines to the stories: 1. FRODO – COMPUTER – VIRUS – USERS – THREATENS ……………………………………………………………………………………… 2. PIRATED – MICHELANGELO – AGAIN – USERS – PUNISH – AND – TO – STRIKE – SOFTWARE ……………………………………………………………………………………… ……………………………………………………………………………………… 4. Phrases to learn: -aici: a nu se manifesta, a dormita: - l……………….. d……………………. -a răspândi boala: - s………………… d…………………… -a pătrunde sub altă formă: - i…………….. in d………………… -a face (ceva) să fie inefficient: - r……………….. i………………….. -a reînvia brusc: - b…………… into l…………….. -a lua măsuri pentru a preveni un atac: - b…………. f………… the a…………….. 407 -a înainta, aici: a schimba (data cu o zi mai târziu): - m…………… f………………. -a provoca perturbarea: - c……………….. d…………….. -a poseda sisteme virusate: - o……………. a……………. s……………. -a respecta legea: - s……………. w………….. the l…………….. -a evita deteriorarea: a…………… d…………….. -a înlocui documentele deteriorate: - r…………… d……………… f……………… 408 LESSON 25 *Grammar: Determiners (1)* Vocabulary: General – Technology and Machines *Phrasal Verbs: Actions and Movement* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Abusive Phone Calls* *** I. GRAMMAR – DETERMINERS (1)109 this, that, these, those some, any, no both, either, neither much, many, a little, a few too much/many a lot, lots all, each, every enough less, least more, most (articles a/an, possessives my, your etc.) which, what Determiners are words that come at the beginning of noun phrases, before adjectives. Determiners help to show which or how much/many we are talking about. this small dog some new suggestions all Scottish towns enough time *revise the basics: this, that, these, those 1.Study the examples and think about the difference between this/these and that/those: Come and look at this picture. What’s that on the roof? This isn’t a very good party. He’s ill. That’s why he’s away. Do you like this music? Stop that noise! 109 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 409 Listen – this will make you laugh. Thanks – that was a great meal. (on the phone) This is Emma. (on the phone) Who’s that? This is my friend Paula. I didn’t like those stories he told. These shoes are hurting my feet. Do you remember those people we met in Edinburgh? These grapes are really sweet. 2. Look at the examples again. Which words and expressions in the box go with this/these and which go with that/those? finished happening now said before just about to start near over there distant unwanted here THIS/THESE: …………………………………………………………………………. THAT/THOSE: ………………………………………………………………………... 3. Put in this/that/these/those: 1. Why am I living in ………………………………………………………….country? 2. Get me…………………………………………………………....box from the table. 3. Ugh - …………………………………………………………...potatoes taste burnt! 4. What was………………………………………………………………………noise? 5. Who are …………………………………………………………..people over there? 6. Come……………………………………………………………………way, please? 7. Isn’t …………………………………………………………………..weather great? 8. Did you hear…………...........................................................explosions in the night? 9. Tell her to stop……………………………………………………………...shouting. 10. ………………………………………………………….was a great party – thanks. 11. Who said…………………………………………………………………………..? 12. Why did she marry…………………………………………………………...idiot? 13. Do it………………………….way, not like………………………………………. 14. Listen – you’re not going to believe………………………………………………. 15. Look at………………………………………….earrings. Jamie gave them to me. 410 *revise the basics: some and any #some vvvvvv v SOME v vvvvvv #Some means ‘a certain (not large) number or amount of’. - We use some mostly in affirmative sentences. -we also use some in questions when we expect or invite people to say ‘Yes’ (for example, in requests and offers) She’s got some interesting ideas. ‘Could I have some coffee?’ There’s some mud on the carpet. ‘Sure. Ann would you like some biscuits?’ #any xxxxxx x ANY ? ? ????? #we use any instead of some in negative sentences, in most questions and with if. Do you know any good jokes? He hasn’t got any money. If you find any mistakes, please tell me. #the difference between somebody/anybody, someone/anyone, something /anything etc. is the same as the difference between some and any. There’s somebody outside. Would you like something to drink? Does anybody understand this? 411 She didn’t say anything. 4. Put in some, any, somebody, anybody, something or anything: 1. I can’t find …………………..butter, but we’ve got ……………………..margarine. 2. Did you meet………………………………………………..interesting at the party? 3. Emma has got ……………………………………………..old pictures of the house. 4. Can I offer you……………...............................................................................wine? 5. Do you know……………………………………………………………….German? 6. Helen brought me…………………………………………………….beautiful roses. 7. Is there……………………………………………………………………..I can do? 8. There’s ……………………………………………………………...waiting for you. 9. I haven’t got …………………………………………………………………to wear. 10. Shall we listen to…………………………………………………………….music? 11. If you have………………………………………………..problems, just phone me. 12. Have you got………………………………………………………………children? 13. Would you like ………………………………………………………..to help you? 14. There aren’t ……………………………………………………...buses on Sunday. #we use any with words like never, hardly, without, refuse, doubt (which have a negative kind of meaning). She never has any fun. We got there without any difficulty. I refuse to give him any help. 5.Here are some sentences with any. Which word in each sentence gives the ‘negative kind of meaning’? E.g.: He never listens to anyone. 3. There was hardly anybody in town. We’ve hardly got any cat food. 4. You never get any sense out of her. 1. The baby refuses to eat anything 5. You seldom hear any birds here. 2. I doubt if you’ll find any bread now. 6. I left the house without any money. 412 6. Choose the right word: 1. Have you got some/any time free on Wednesday afternoon? 2. There’s something/anything strange about the way Pete’s acting today. 3. Nobody can find out something/anything about when the exams will be. 4. Is there something/anything we should bring to the meeting? 5. Shall I bring you something/anything to read while you wait? 6. Do you know if some/any of the Morrises are coming on Sunday? 7. Can I get you some/any coffee? I’ve just made some/any. 8. She refuses to have something/anything to do with her family now. 9. If there’s some/any soup left, could you put it in the fridge, please? 10. I doubt if there’s something/anything we can do now. *some/any or no article: Have some toast. I don’t like toast. #We use some and any to talk about limited numbers or quantities. Compare: LIMITED NUMBERS/QUANTITIES NOT LIMITED ‘Have some toast.’ (one or two pieces) ‘No thanks. I don’t like toast.’ (toast in general) I need some new clothes. She always wears nice clothes. Is there any water in the fridge? Is there water on the moon? #We don’t normally use some in descriptions. She’s got black hair. (NOT some black hair) #we don’t use some when we say what people/things are. Andy and John are students. (NOT some students) 413 7. Join the beginnings and ends: ‘What are those? A. ‘Chocolates.’ 1. ‘What did she give you?’ B. any money with you? ……. 2. Cheese is made from C. some milk in my coffee? …… 3. Could I have D. ‘Some chocolates.’ …… 4. Why does she always talk about E. milk. …….. 5. Have you got? F. money? …….. 6. Her children are both G. air. …….. 7. In the pub we met H. students. ….. 8. Let me show you I. good photos. …… 9. Open the window and let in J. some fresh air. ….. 10. This camera takes K. some photos of the children. …… 11. You can’t live without L. some students. …… 0 *any, not any, no and none #No is a more emphatic way of saying ‘not a’ or ‘not any’. Note the sentence structure. Sorry, I’ve got no time. (NOT….I haven’t got no time) There were no letters for you this morning. #At the beginning of a sentence, no is almost always used. No cigarette is completely harmless. (NOT Not any cigarette…) No tourists ever come to our village. 8. Change not…any to no, or no to not…any: E.g.: I haven’t got any American friends. I’ve got no American friends. There’s no bread. There isn’t any bread. 1. She speaks no German. She doesn’t ………………………… 2. He’s written no letters to her. ……………………………………… 3. We don’t get any rains here. ……………………………………… 414 4. There isn’t any post on Sundays. ………………………………………. 5. She hasn’t got any brothers or sisters. ………………………………………. #Before of, or without a noun, we use none, not no (often with a singular verb). None of his friends likes his wife. There’s none in the house. 9. Put in no or none: E.g.: None of these telephones works. I had no difficulty understanding her. 1. ‘How many children has he got?’ …………………………………………………… 2. There are ………………………………………………………trains after midnight. 3. Did you buy milk? There’s …………………………………………….in the fridge. 4. ……………………………………………………………...of us can play the piano. 5. There are…………palm trees in Antarctica, and there are……………in Greenland. #Nobody, nothing etc. are used in the same way as no. Nobody loves me. I’ve got absolutely nothing to say. 10. Put in no, none or nobody: 1. ‘Why can’t I have toast for breakfast?’ ‘Because there’s …………………bread.’ 2. ‘My students expect me to know everything.’ ‘……………….knows everything.’ 3. ……………………………………………………...newspaper tells the whole truth. 4. ‘What were your photos like?’ ‘I’m afraid……………………..of them came out.’ 5. ‘Do you think he’s honest?’ ‘…………………….politician is completely honest’. 6. …………………………...of the people there remembered seeing anything unusual. 7. I’ve got………………………………………………..patience with people like her. 8. There’s ……………………………………………………I can talk to in this place. 9. ……………………………………………………………...of you care what I think. 10. He had…………………money, ……………….job and …………….place to live. 415 *any = ‘one or another – it’s not important which’ #We can use any to mean ‘one or another – it’s not important which.’ With this meaning, any is common in affirmative sentences. ‘When shall I come and see you?’ ‘It doesn’t matter – any time.’ ‘What newspaper do you want?’ ‘I don’t mind. Any paper is ok.’ #In negative sentences, we can use just any to make this meaning clear. I don’t do just any work: I choose jobs that interest me. 11. Complete each sentence with any and a word from the box: bank boy question bus colour day doctor problems supermarket E.g.: Any doctor will tell you to stop smoking. 1. He gets angry with ………………………………………who talks to his girlfriend. 2. ‘Would you like red, blue, …?’ ‘It doesn’t matter…………………………..is Ok.’ 3. You can get this kind of rice in …………………………………………………….. 4. I think she knows everything. She can answer……………………………..you ask. 5. If you have…………………………………………….., come and ask me for help. 6. ‘When shall we meet?’ ‘I don’t mind. ………………………………….this week.’ 7. ‘Where can I change money?’ ‘In ………………………………………………..’ 8. You can’t take just …………………………………………...- you need a 4 or a 16. #We can use anybody, anything and anywhere to mean ‘it’s not important who/what/where.’ It’s easy. Anybody can do it. That dog eats anything – meat, bread, shoes, ….. 416 ‘Where shall I sit?’ ‘Anywhere you like.’ She doesn’t go out with just anybody. 12.Put the beginnings and ends together and put in anybody, anything or anywhere: It’s not hard to dance. A. ‘I don’t mind. I’m so hungry I’ll eat……………..’ …….. 1. ‘Where would you like to live?’ B. ‘It’s true. Ask…………….’ …….. 2. ‘What would you like for lunch?’ C. ‘Yes. Put it……………….you like.’ …… 3. ‘I don’t believe you.’ D. Anybody can do it. 0 4. ‘Can I park the car behind your E. He can play ………………. ……. house?’ 5. Joe’s a brilliant pianist. F. ‘…………….in America.’ …… #Any is not negative – it is the opposite of no or not any. Compare: That’s easy: anybody can do it. That’s too hard: nobody can do it. I’m really hungry – I’ll eat anything. I’m not hungry – I don’t want anything. 13. Choose the best word or expression in each sentence: 1. Any/No doctor can tell you if you’ve got flu. 2. Any/No doctor can tell you how long you’re going to live. 3. Just say anything/nothing, so we can see if the microphone works. 4. If the police arrest you, say anything/nothing until your lawyer gets there. 5. What do you mean, music? I can’t hear/can hear any music. 6. You can hear any/no kind of music you like at the Reading Festival. 7. Anna’s very secretive: she talks to anybody/nobody about her problems. 8. Jim tells his problems to anybody/nobody who will listen. 417 *revise the basics: much, many, a lot (of) #We use much with singular (uncountable) nouns and many with plurals. How much time have we got? How many tickets do we need? #Much and many are most common in questions and negatives. In informal affirmative sentences, we generally prefer a lot (of), lots (of) or plenty (of). These can be used with both uncountables and plurals: ‘Do you have much trouble with English?’ I don’t have much trouble speaking, but I have lots of difficulty writing. ‘Are there many opera houses in London?’ ‘Not many, but a lot of theaters and plenty of cinemas.’ #After so, as and too, much and many are normal in affirmative sentences. That child makes so much noise! Take as much time as you like. There are too many people here. 14. Put in much/many with so, as, too: 1. It was nice to have………………………………………………..time to talk to you. 2. Are there……………………………………………………………chairs as people? 3. You can never have……………………………………………………………..love. 4. I don’t have …………………………………………………………..friends as you. 5. She’s got…………………………………………………………………....relatives! 6. Get………………………………………………………………...tickets as you can. 418 #In a formal style, many and much are more common in affirmative sentences: Many commentators have already thrown much darkness on this subject, and it is probable that if this continues we shall soon know nothing at all about it. (Mark Twain) *revise the basics: enough, too and too much 15. Look at the examples: This isn’t hot enough. Am I going fast enough? There is never enough time. Have you got enough rice? Now choose the correct forms of the rules: Enough normally comes before/after an adjective or adverb. Enough normally comes before/after a noun. 16. Pot in words from the box together with enough: big friends champagne clever confidence good hard money time old E.g.: In the art the best is good enough. (Goethe) 1. There was………………………………………………....to give everybody a glass. 2. This town isn’t ………………………………………………………..for both of us. 3. I never had…………………when I was young: now I never have…………… …… 4. Susan hasn’t got ……………………………………………….to play football with. 5. Daniel’s not………………………………………………………...to travel himself. 6. If you work…………………………………., you don’t have to be very intelligent. 7. She was………………to do anything she wanted, but she didn’t have…………… 419 17.Too much/many or too? Look at the examples and complete the rules: Examples: He’s too old. She’s driving too fast. My problem is too much work and too many late nights. Rules: Before an adjective without a noun, or an adverb, we use……………………… Before a noun (with or without an adjective), we use………………………….. 18.Invent answers to the questions, using too, too much or too many: E.g.: Why did Jack leave his car at the pub and take a taxi home? (beer) He’d drunk too much beer. 1. Why did they drive to the cinema in two cars? (people) ………………………………………………………………………………….. 2. Can you understand what he’s saying? (quickly) ………………………………………………………………………………….. 3. Why didn’t Joanna stop for lunch yesterday? (busy) …………………………………………………………………………………. 4. Why don’t we go to the Caribbean for our holiday? (expensive) …………………………………………………………………………………. 5. Why don’t you let the children cycle to school? (traffic) …………………………………………………………………………………. 6. What went wrong in your exam? (slowly) …………………………………………………………………………………. 7. Why did you have the phone installed in the other room? (noise) ………………………………………………………………………………….. 420 #We can use infinitive structures with enough and too. She’s old enough to vote. I’m too tired to go out tonight. #A structure with for + object + infinitive is also possible. It’s not warm enough for me to swim. The box was too heavy for us to lift. #We can drop for + object. It’s not warm enough to swim. The box was too heavy to lift. 19. Complete the sentences with enough or too: E.g.: Sally’s not old enough to take the dog for a walk. (old/ take) The food was too spicy for the children to eat. (spicy/children/eat) 1. There’s someone in the garden, but I can’t see ……………………………if it’s Emma. (well/decide). 2. I’ll work on this tomorrow – I’m ……………………...it tonight. (tired/think about) 3. I don’t understand Arabic……………………………to Egyptian radio. (well/listen) 4. I’m not ……………………………………………………..the piano. (strong/move) 5. I was……………………………………………..on the lecture. (bored/concentrate) 6. They were speaking…………………………….what they were saying. (quietly /me / hear) 7. Near some beaches the sea’s not ……………………………in. (clean/people/swim) 8. The room was………………………………………………..anything. (dark/us/see) 9. He drove……………………………………………………..him. (fast/police/catch) 10. This shirt isn’t ………………………………………………………. (clean/wear) 421 II.VOCABULARY: GENERAL – TECHNOLOGY AND MACHINES110 1. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) This is a small car, but it has a powerful engine/machine. b) Do you use an electric/electrical toothbrush? c) I can’t see anything. Where’s the light plug/switch? d) I’m going to buy a new notebook/desktop PC that I can take to work. e) You can’t use the lift. It’s out of order/work. f) If you don’t press this button, the washing machine won’t go/move. g) Use this torch. The other one doesn’t act/work. h) The lights have gone out. It must be a powerful break/cut. i) A car factory/industry has just been built in our town. j) Who exactly discovered/invented the computer? 2.Complete the sentences with a word from the box. Use each word once only: icon download website cursor highlight pull-down menu paste reboot scroll down engine a) The text appears at the position of the flashing cursor. b) Hold down the left mouse button and drag the mouse over the text that you want to ………………………………………………………………………………………. c) If your computer crashes, you may have to…………………………………………. d) To open a document, click on the relevant………………………………………….. e) To transfer text to another document you can copy and …………………………… f) If the text you want is below the part you can see, you can ……………………….. g) Look at the toolbar at the top of the screen and select the option you want from the ………………………………………………………………………………………. 110 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 422 h) Connect to the Internet and type out the address to go straight to the …………….. i) If you can’t find the information you want on the website, try typing out a key word into the search ………………………………………………………………………. j) If you need to get a whole program from the Internet, it can take a long time to…………………………………………………………………………………….. 3.Complete each sentence with a suitable word from the box. Use each word once only: axe file screwdriver needle scissors spade corkscrew hammer saw spanner a) You can make the edges smooth with a file. b) You need a ………………………………………………to open this bottle of wine. c) I’ve split my trousers. Do you have a …………………………………...and thread? d) I can’t open the back of the television without a special……………………………. e) You can cut that plank in half with this……………………………………………... f) We would chop this tree down if we had a sharp……………………………………. g) I was going to dig the garden but I can’t find the …………………………………... h) Oh bother! I’ve hit my thumb with the ………………………….instead of the nail! i) You can cut this cardboard if you have some sharp…………………………………. j) This nut is impossible to undo. I need a larger………………………………………. 4. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) James is going to be late. His car has broken out/broken up/broken in/broken down. b) If your camera is faulty, you should return it to the creator/manufacturer/inventor /builder. c) It is hard to get extra/spare/additional/emergency parts for this car if something goes wrong. d) I bought this electric drill from a do/repair/make/fix –it-yourself shop. e) This clock goes/works/runs/moves on two small batteries. f) Lift the microphone/dial/receiver/number and listen for the dialing tone. 423 g) Don’t touch the wire! You’ll get an electric surprise/current/charge/shock. h) It’s difficult to repair the car unless you have the right gadgets/instruments/ appliances/tools. i) This knife is really blunt/dull/flat/frank. I’ll have to sharpen it. j) Don’t forget to put/set/ring/go off your alarm clock for 6.30. 5.Use the word given in capitals at the end of each line to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: How does the DVD work? When I was young, I always dreamed of becoming a famous (1) scientist. When I was at school I decided to study SCIENCE (2)……………………, and then become a millionaire by inventing ENGINE a wonderful new (3)…………...........which would make the world PRODUCE a better place. Unfortunately, I wasn’t very good at technical subjects. Any time I operate any kind of (4)………………………. EQUIP something terrible happens. Machines which use (5)…………….., ELECTRIC such as computers or televisions, always seem to give me a (6)……………………..shock. The instruction booklets are always POWER (7)………………… They never help me at all. Nowadays you need USE to have (8)…………………….knowledge just to use the DVD. To SPECIAL my great (9)………………it is always a child of six who helps me EMBARRASS out of my (10)………………………………………………………. DIFFICULT 6. Complete each sentence with one suitable word: a) There’s nothing good on the television. Why don’t you turn it off? b) Can you plug the electric fire ……………………………………………….for me? c) Hurry up, sir. We’re just going to lock…………………………………for the night. d) The machine is quite automatic – it does everything ………………………….itself. e) We’d better stop for some petrol. We’ve nearly run………………………………... f) The parts come from Japan, but we put them…………………………..here in Italy. g) The workstation consists……………………….a keyboard, a monitor and a printer. 424 h) This looks like wood but actually it’s made ………………………………....plastic. i) What exactly is a file used…………………………………………………………..? j) These two metal sections are then bolted……………………………….to make one. k) Have you saved your accounts file………………………..my directory by mistake? 7. Replace the words in italics with a verb from the box: break down go off keep up with pick up run out do without hang up look out put off stand for a) My car isn’t as fast as yours. I won’t be able to star near you. knock down keep up with b) This torch doesn’t work. The batteries must have been used up. ………………… c) This radio doesn’t receive the BBC World Service very well. ………………… d) The car is making a funny noise. I think it’s going to stop working. ……………….. e) I was going to buy a motorbike, but I was discouraged by my parents. ……………. f) People call me on the phone, but then put down the receiver. …………………… g) Be careful! You’re going to give yourself an electric shock! …………………… h) It’s difficult to manage if you don’t have a washing machine. …………………… i) The letters DVD mean digital versatile disc, actually. …………………… j) Without a fridge, fresh food will become bad very quickly. …………………… k) They used special equipment to demolish that block of flats. …………………… 8. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: Do it yourself What do you do when something (1) falls/repairs/breaks/runs down? Are you the kind of person who knows how things (2) do/make/fix/work? Or do you prefer to have them (3) repaired/out/sometimes/operated by an expert? Personally, when I use a (4) drill/scissors/hammer/spade I always hit my finger, and I can never (5) drive/ unscrew/cut/unwind anything with my screwdriver because I can never find it. Despite having all the wrong (6) equipment/contents/instruments/gadgets, and despite being a useless (7) technician/engineer/machine/mechanic, I recently decided to take my bike to pieces and (8) make/fix/build/construct it. I had (9) spent/paid/run/fallen 425 out of money as usual, and as I use my bike (10) and/because/by/for getting to college, I had no choice. It was making a terrible noise, and the front tyre was (11) flat /empty/over/bad. I had a few (12) chances/tools/information/advice but I didn’t have any (13) spare/emergency/renew/repair parts. I managed to (14) remove/smooth/fill/ undo the wheel and take it off, but then I lost my (15) saw/plug/spanner/file, and couldn’t put the wheel back on properly. At least I am taking more exercise, as I now have to walk to college. VOCABULARY: GENERAL - PHRASAL VERBS: ACTIONS AND MOVEMENT111 A. ACTIONS AND MOVEMENT WITH DOWN AND UP Down in phrasal verbs about actions can mean ‘towards the ground’, ‘towards a lower level’, or ‘less intense’. example meaning She fell down and broke her arm. fell to the ground Can you reach the book down for me, get something that is above your head by please? reaching with your hand. Slow down! There’s a police care behind drive slower us. Up in phrasal verbs about actions can mean ‘towards a higher level’, ‘in a complete way’, or ‘to a greater degree’: example meaning I must wrap up Stella’s birthday present. cover in paper, especially in order to give Do you have any nice paper? as a present Can you help me to tie up this package? I put string or rope around something so don’t want it to get damaged in the post. 111 that it is fastened together Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 426 Will you help me blow up three balloons fill with air for the party? Could you pick up that box and follow lift using your hands me, please? It has the exam papers in it. He felt very angry and tore her letter up. tear into a lot of small pieces Could you move up and let Christine sit move slightly so that there is enough next to you? space for someone else I have a bad leg. I don’t want to slow you make someone or something slower up, so go ahead and don’t wait for me. B. OTHER ACTION AND MOVEMENT VERBS: Move over! I need to sit down. [change the place where you are sitting or standing so that there is space for someone else to sit or stand] I’m just popping out for a newspaper. Do you want anything from the shop? [informal: leaving the place where I am, to go somewhere for a short time] I reached out for the light switch but couldn’t find it in the dark. [stretched my arm in front of my body, usually in order to get or touch something] Can you help me on/off with these boots, please? [help me put on/ take off a piece of clothing] 1. Read these sentences and answer the questions: 1. Could you reach down that saucepan for me, please? Where do you think the saucepan is? 2. Emily has just popped out of the office. Is Emily going home for the day? 3. If Charlie moves up a bit, there’ll be room for all of us. Where does Charlie have to move – a bit higher or closer to someone? 4. If Sonia moves over, the Natasha can sit next to Nicholas. Does Sonia have to move more or less than Charlie in sentence 3? 5. Tear the cloth up into small pieces and soak them in the dye for a couple of hours. Is it necessary to use scissors to make the cloth into small pieces? 427 6. Help your grandmother on with her coat, Julie. Is Julie’s grandmother about to go outside or inside? 2. Rewrite these sentence using phrasal verbs which have the opposite meaning to the underlined verbs: 1. The children helped me to unwrap the parcel. 2. Can you untie Billy’s shoe laces for him? 3. Put down the ball at once. 4. Hurry up – it’s beginning to snow and there’s ice on the road. 5. Jill loves bursting balloons! 3. Choose the correct verbs to complete these sentences: 1. Their heavy rucksacks ……………………………………………...the climbers up. 2. In the darkness of the cinema, he ……………………………out and took her hand. 3. I’m just going to……………………………..out to the post office. I won’t be long. 4. Your bike tyres are flat. Let me…………………………………….them up for you. III.VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS – ABUSIVE PHONE CALLS112 A new device has been launched on the market which will enable telephone subscribers to know who is at the other end of the line even before they pick up the receiver. The device comes as part of a telephone identity system aimed at fighting the epidemic of abusive phone calls. Although it is a criminal offence to make obscene calls, the abusers get away with impunity when the subscriber is unable to identify and trace the culprit. The calls remain largely unreported as the authorities have so far been unable to deal adequately with this massive invasion of privacy. 112 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1, 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 428 The malicious calls, usually sexual in content, vary from heavy breathing and panting to shockingly offensive language used to make indecent proposals. What causes the most nuisance and distress is repetitive abuse, often going on for years, aimed specifically at one person. In the worst of cases, there are life threats which often leave their victims petrified with fear. The harassed victims resort to frequent changes of their telephone number and to ex-directory listings. However, statistically, 75% of the phone pests are known to the recipient of the malicious calls who may, unsuspectingly, reveal the new number to them and so the torment begins anew. “Every time the phone goes, I am physically afraid. I feel so violated”, says one of the desperate victims who has suffered mental anguish and marked personality changes as a result of this off-going harassment. Those who are persistently persecuted feel hunted and can even become paranoid. The new device is called a tracer. It consists of a visual display which is mounted on the telephone. It allows one to see, for twenty seconds, from which number someone is calling while the phone is still ringing. All unwanted callers will thus become traceable. It is hoped the device will play a role as a successful deterrent and an aid in prosecuting offenders in court. It will also enable subscribers to screen calls from tele-marketeers, insurance agents, and all those who make their lives a daily nuisance. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Thanks to the new device callers will cease to be entirely untraceable, even if they do not introduce themselves. 2. The number of abusive phone calls is increasing. 3. Making an obscene phone call is punishable by law. 4. So far subscribers have been totally helpless in coping with the problem. 5. Many victims of telephone harassment do not even bother to tell the police because there is little they can do. 6. Sometimes a person who makes an obscene phone call does not say anything. 7. People who receive life threats do not take them seriously. 8. Making one’s phone number unavailable to the general public gives an absolute guarantee of doing away with abusive calls. 429 9.Some recipients of the abusive phone calls require psychiatric treatment as the result of the harassment. 10.On the visual display, the subscriber can see the name of the person who is making the call. 11.People will now be afraid to use their listed phones to make jokes or harass others for fear of being traced and punished. 12.People will also be able to use the device to protect their privacy from people who use phones to sell things. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B criminal…………….. abuse daily………………….. anguish harassed………………. calls indecent………………. deterrent life………………….. language mental……………….. nuisance obscene………………. offence offensive………………. proposals repetitive………………. subscribers successful………………… threats telephone……………….. victims 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: CALLS – NEW – EPIDEMIC – TO – MALICIOUS – DEVICE – ERADICATE – PHONE – OF ………………………………………………………………………………………… …………………………………………………………………………………………. 430 4. Phrases to learn: -a lansa un dispozitiv pe piaţă: - l………….. a d……………. on the m……………… -a ridica receptorul: - p……………… u……………. the r……………….. -a lupta împotriva epidemiei: - f……………. the e………………….. -a rămâne nepedepsit: - g………….. a………….. with i………………….. -pe teme sexuale: -s……………. in c…………….. -a solicita ca numărul de telefon să fie confidential: - r…………….. t…………… e…………..-d………………. l………………. -a reîncepe: b…………… a……………. - schimbări evidente de comportament: - m…………… p…………….. c………… -a persecuta systematic (persistent): - p…………….. p………………. -mijloc auxiliar la acuzarea vinovatului în timpul judecăţii: - an a………… in p……………. o…………. in c……………. 431 LESSON 26 *Grammar: Determiners (2)* Vocabulary: General – Problems* Phrasal Verbs: Destroying and Reacting to Destruction* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Traffic Jams *** I. GRAMMAR – DETERMINERS (2)113 *revise the basics: (a) little, (a) few #(A) little is used with singular (uncountable) nouns and (a) few with plurals. We’ve got a little coffee left, and a few biscuits – not really enough if your mother’s coming. 1. Write little or few: 1. There is……………friendship in the world, and least of all between equals. (Francis Bacon). 2. A…………………………………..learning is a dangerous thing. (Alexander Pope) 3. Men of……………………words are the best men. (William Shakespeare, Henry V) 4.Never in the field of human conflict was owed by so many to so ………………. (Winston Churchill). 5. Never before have we had so……………time in which to do so much. (Franklin Roosevelt) 6. A country having …………….inflation is like a woman being a little pregnant. (Leon Henderson) 113 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 432 7. Death is one of the ……………things that can be done as easily lying down. (Woody Allen) 8. ……………..people can be happy unless they hate some other person, nation or creed. (Bertrand Russell) #Little and few are rather negative: they mean ‘not much/many’ (A) little and (a) few are more positive: their meaning is more like ‘some’: Cactuses need little water. Give the roses a little water every day. His ideas are very difficult, and few people understand them. His ideas are very difficult, but a few people understand them. 2. Little or a little? Few or a few? 1. There is………………………………………………use trying to change her mind. 2. Could you possibly give me…………………………………………………....help? 3. …………………………………………………..teenagers in the village could read. 4. Slowly, …………………………………………....children began coming to school. 5. I only need……………………………………………………..minutes to get ready. 6. She only wanted ……………………love, ………………………………..kindness. 7. Nadia drank…………………………………………………..coffee and no alcohol. 8. Unfortunately, he had ……………………………………………………….friends. #Little and few (without a) are rather formal; in a conversational style we more often say only a little/few or not much/many. Cactuses only need a little water. Not many people understand his ideas. 433 3. Rewrite these sentences in a more conversational style: E.g.: I have little time: I’ve only got a little time OR I haven’t got much time. 1. We have few friends: …………………………………………………………. 2. There is little that I can do for you. ……………………………………………….. 3. Few people wanted to help her. …………………………………………………. 4. They had little money, but they were pretty happy. .................................................. …………………………………………………………………………………....... 5. Few children are as difficult as Robert. ……………………………………………. 6. I dislike few people. ………………………………………………………………… 7. My father does little exercise. ………………………………………………………. 8. I need little sleep. …………………………………………………………………… 9. Vermeer painted few pictures. ………………………………………………………. 10. I speak little Japanese. ……………………………………………………………... *less and least, fewer and fewest #Less and fewer are comparative: they are the opposite of more. Least and fewest are superlative: they are the opposite of most. Less and least are used with singular (uncountable) nouns. Fewer and fewest are used with plural nouns. I’ve got less money than I thought. Of all my friends, Jake does the least work. There were fewer problems than we expected. Mandy was the person who made the fewest mistakes in the translation exam. 434 4. Write less/the least/fewer/the fewest: 1. Of all British cars, this one uses ……………….petrol. It also needs……………… repairs. 2. …………….girls than boys do mathematics at university. This may be because girls get……………..encouragement to study maths at school. 3. As the years went by, they had ……………. things to say, and………………. interest in talking to each other. 4. Do you want more time and ……………..money, or more money and ……………. time? 5. Liz is very clever, but she has got………………..self-confidence of anyone I know. 6. I’ve had …………………………………….days off work of anybody in the office. 7. There are ……………………………………………….apples on the trees this year. 8. I earn………………………….money in our family, and my brother earns the most. 9.Annie always has………………things to say, but what she does say is usually interesting. 10.Now that we’ve got two children we’ve got much ………………. spare time than we used to have. # Less and least can also be used with adjectives and adverbs. Amy’s less shy than Jessica. He drives less carefully than I expected. It was the least successful party we’d given. 435 5. Complete the sentences with less or the least and some of the words from the box: boring confident intelligent quickly confidently interesting religious dangerous optimistic selfish shy easily pessimistic shyly fluently important politely prosperous worried 1. I feel…………………………………………..about the future than I did a year ago. 2. My mother/father/brother/sister is/was ……………………person you can imagine. 3. I spoke English…………………………………………..a year ago than I do today. 4. I think this country is………………………………………....than it was a year ago. 5. People from the north of my country speak…………………..than people from the south. 6. My home town is………………………………………………………place I know. 7. Most of my friends are ……………………………………………………than I am. 8. Some people say that money is the ……………………..thing in my life, but I’m not so sure. 9. I think TV gets ………………………………………………………….late at night. 10. ………………………...intelligent people often think they are the most intelligent. #Many people use less with plurals (ex. There were less problems than we expected). This is also correct, but some people think it isn’t (including some teachers and examiners), so be careful! *revise the basics: all #All can go with a noun or with a verb: All the rooms cost the same. All cats climb trees. The rooms all cost the same. Cats all climb trees. 436 6. Change the sentences: E.g.: All the family got flu. The family all got flu. The trains all stop at York. All the trains stop at York.. 1. All the marketing people like Oliver. ……………………………………………….. 2. Our children all speak French. ……………………………………………...... 3. The tourists all went back home. ……………………………………………….. 4. All these cars cost too much. ……………………………………………….. 5. All meetings take too long. ……………………………………………….. 6. My friends all thought I was crazy. ……………………………………………….. 7. All my friends live a long way away. ……………………………………………….. 8. The classes all started late. ……………………………………………...... #Note the word order when all goes with a verb. All goes: -before one-word verbs Our children all speak French. The papers all arrived yesterday. We all went home. -after auxiliary verbs (will, have, can etc) and after are and were: Our children can all speak French. The papers have all arrived. We were all tired. 7. Put all in the right place with the verb: E.g.: Babies all cry………sometimes. Our visitors………have all gone home. The apples ……….. are all bad. 1. The museums…………………..close…………………………………on Tuesdays. 2. The interviews………................will…………………start……………...next week. 437 3. We ………….. ………………stopped…………………………………… for a rest. 4. Your clothes ………………....are……………………………………………..ready. 5. We ……………………………went …………………………….to Paris for Easter. 6. Sorry, the buses……………….have……………………………………………..left. 7. These children………………...can…………………..speak………………..English. 8. The apples…………………….have………………....gone…………………….bad. 8.Grammar and vocabulary. Cities and countries. Which one is different? Write sentences using the expressions in the box: Asia Australia German-speaking countries China England Europe Italy South America seaports the United States E.g.: Rome, Florence, Milan, Paris They are all in Italy except Paris. Sydney, Seoul, Brisbane, Canberra They are all in Australia except Seoul. 1. Melbourne, Tokyo, Beijing, Delhi ………………………………….. 2. Beijing, Shanghai, Delhi, Hong Kong ………………………………….. 3. Japan, Austria, the Czech Republic, Poland …………………………………... 4. Oxford, London, Birmingham, Edinburgh …………………………………... 5. Vienna, Berlin, Zurich, Athens …………………………………... 6. Rio, Mexico City, Buenos Aires, Lima …………………………………... 7. Chicago, Boston, Toronto, Los Angeles …………………………………... 8. Copenhagen, Rio, Madrid, Genoa …………………………………... *revise the basics: all, every, everybody, everything #we can use all with plural nouns and verbs. We use every with singular nouns and verbs. All birds lay eggs. Every bird lays eggs. 438 # we can use other determiners (the, my, this etc.) after all, but not after every. All the shops were closed. Every shop was closed. 9. Rewrite the sentences with every: E.g.: All the players were tired. Every player was tired. 1. Not all birds can fly. …………………………….. 2. I’ve read all the newspapers. …………………………….. 3. Please listen to all the words. …………………………….. 4. All the roads were under water. …………………………….. 5. All languages are difficult in one way or another. …………………………….. 6. All London trains are cancelled today. …………………………….. 7. The police have interviewed all the employees. …………………………….. 8. All the plates are dirty. …………………………….. 9. Not all changes are good. …………………………….. 10. All the computers are down today. …………………………….. #we don’t normally use all without a noun to mean ‘everybody’. Everybody was tired. (NOT All were tired) 10. Put in all or everybody: 1. ………………women become like their mothers. That is their tragedy. No man does. That’s his. (Oscar Wilde) 2. In the future, …………………. ..will be famous for fifteen minutes. (Andy Warhol) 3. ………………. human beings are born free and equal in dignity and rights. (Universal Declaration of Human Rights) 4. I am free of ………………..prejudices – I hate …………….equally. (W. C. Fields) 5. He who praises…………………………………..praises nobody. (Samuel Johnson) 439 6. Justice is open to ……………..people in the same way as the Ritz Hotel. (Judge Sturges) #we can use all to mean ‘everything’ or ‘the only thing’, but only with a relative clause (all that….). She gave me all/everything (that) she had. All (that) I want is a place of my own. The thieves took everything. 11. Put in all if possible; if not, put in everything: 1. ………………I need to make a comedy, a policeman and a pretty girl. (Charlie Chaplin) 2. I hurry to laugh at ………………………, for fear of having to cry. (Beaumarchais) 3. I can resist ………………………………………..except temptation. (Oscar Wilde) 4. ……………………………………….I want is a room somewhere. (My Fair Lady) 5. You can only have power over people so long as you don’t take ……………… away from them. (Solzhenitsyn) 6. They say………………………...in the world is good for something. (John Dryden) 7. [A cynic] knows the price of …………………and the value of nothing. (Oscar Wilde) 8. Life is like nothing, because it is …………………………………(William Golding) 9. ……………………………………………………………..I want is you. (song title) *every and each; every one #Every and each mean the same. They are both used with singular nouns and adverbs. Every is more common. Every/Each day brings a new problem. 440 #We use every for three or more. We use each for two or more. She had a ring on every finger. She had a bag in each hand. 12. Right or wrong? Correct the mistakes or write ‘Correct’: E.g.: You get more beautiful every day. correct I paid separately for each books. book 1. Every passenger have to show his or her passport. ………………. 2. There’s a mistake in each line. ………………. 3. Cars are parked on every side of the road. ………………. 4. Every children are different. ………………. 5. Please say each word slowly and clearly. ………………. 6. The doctor made him sit down and looked into every ear. ………………. #we often prefer each when we want to say that things are separate or different. Compare: We asked every politician the same question. Each politician gave a different answer. 13. Both answers are correct, but one is a little better. Which? E.g.: I work each/every month except August. 1. Each/Every day is new and different. 2. Not each/every Canadian speaks English. 3. I looked for my keys in each/every pocket, one after the other. 4. She wrote a different personal message on each/every card. 5. The doctor examined each/every patient very carefully. 6. Each/Every house in this village looks the same. 441 7. But inside, each/every house is quite different. #before of, or with no noun, we use every one, not every. She knows every one of her students by name. He’s got hundreds of books, and he’s read every one. 14. Put in every or every one: 1.………………..........................................................................of these oranges is bad. 2. I learnt Latin for seven years at school, but I’ve forgotten…………………….word. 3. ‘Can I have one of these chocolates?’ ‘Sorry, I’ve eaten…………………………...’ 4. ………………of his teachers said he was stupid; but he did well in ………………. of this exams. 5. When the soldiers left the town they burnt down…………………………….house. 6. The questions were easy: I could answer……………………………………………. 7. We’ve won…………………………………………………....match so far this year. 8. …………………………………………of my friends has got more money than me. *both, either and neither #we use both, either and neither to talk about two people or things. Both (* + * = ‘one and the other’) has a plural noun. Either (*/* = ‘one or the other’) has a singular noun. Neither (Ø Ø = ‘not either, not one and not the other’) has a singular noun Do you speak French or Spanish? I speak both languages. Which one is easier for you? Either language is OK. How about writing? No, I can’t write very well in either language. And your wife? No, she speaks neither language 442 15. Put in both, either or neither: 1. ……………………………………………………...sisters are studying engineering. 2. ‘Do you want to come round tomorrow or Friday?’ ‘…………………...day is fine.’ 3. ‘Do you like Brussels and Amsterdam?’ ‘I don’t know……………………….city.’ 4. Use …………………………………………… hands to carry the vase – it’s heavy. 5. ………................films looked interesting, but………...........was much good, in fact. 6. ………………....her sons studied physics, but ……………….boy works in science. 7. …………………...shirt would look good on you. Why don’t you buy one of them? 8. I don’t like…………………camera. And ……………..cameras are very expensive. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – PROBLEMS114 1. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) Many people were injured when the building demolished/collapsed. b) The ship radioed to say that it was in difficulties/dangers. c) The government has announced plans to help the poor/poverty. d)There was a large demonstration/manifestation against nuclear power in Manchester yesterday. e) Everyone agrees that the environment/nature must be protected. f) There has been another increase/rising in the level of crime. g) There are few jobs here and many people are away from work/unemployed. h) The train was in a/an accident/collision with a bus on a level crossing. i) The driver of the bus admitted that he had done/made an error. j) No ships are sailing today because of the high/storm winds. 114 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 443 2.Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: disaster emergency hooliganism living injuries rubbish earthquake floods disease invasion famine slums a) Food has been sent to areas in Africa suffering from famine. b) Many people live in overcrowded …………………………on the edge of the city. c) The cost of ………………………………………………has risen steadily this year. d) Thousands of buildings fell down during a severe …………………………………. e) ……………………………………...at football matches has been reduced this year. f) The ………………………of Ruritania has been condemned by the United Nations. g) The eruption of the volcano was a terrible…………………………………………... h) Hundreds of people drowned during the …………………………………………... i) Two of those involved in the crash had serious …………………………………….. j) Large cities face the problem of what to do with household………………………... k) Doctors announced that there was now a cure for the ……………………………… l) During the storm there were hundreds of……………………………………….calls. 3. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) Most young people want to look up/find out/deal with/make out more about green issues. b) Everyone knows about pollution problems, but not many people have thought over /got round to/looked into/come up with any solutions. c) Many factories break the anti-pollution laws and put up with it /take it over/get away with it/come round to it. d) Disposing of waste and rubbish is a hard problem to carry out/put up/get away/deal with. e) More people in cities should rely on/take up/set up/get around to cycling instead of using cars. f) Most governments seem to put off/make up for/do without/take after dealing with environmental problems. 444 g) In some countries environmental organizations have been set off/make up/set out /set up to inform people and gain their support. h) Unless we face up to/look up to/turn up to/get up to the problem, many animals could become extinct. i) Quite soon, the world is going to run out of/get into/keep up with/come up against energy resources. j) We must believe that problems can be solved, and not just make up/look up/give up /put up. 4. Replace the words in italics with a word or phrase from the box: banned ignored improved overpopulated increased polluted protected solved flooded unemployed a) Smoking has been made illegal in public places in some countries. banned b) Famine is a serious problem, and it hasn’t been dealt with yet. …………… c) Many kinds of wild animals need to be guarded by the law. …………… d)Living conditions have been made better in some parts of the world ………………………………………………………………………………………. e) Our local lake has been made dirty by nearby factories. ……………. f) A problem which is not thought about does not simply go away. ……………. g) A lot of people in industrial areas are without work. ……………. h) After the recent storms, the town was filled with water. ……………. i) Some countries are inhabited by too many people. ……………. j) Recently the number of people riding bicycles has grown larger. ……………. 5.Choose the most suitable word or phrase to complete each sentence: a) I’m glad I lost/refused/missed/altered my plane! I’ve just heard that it’s broken down. b) The cruise ship hit a rock and sank/drowned/flooded/crashed . c) I lost the keys to my house and had to climb in by/to/through/with the window. 445 d) The village was completely collapsed/destroyed/ruined/broken in an earthquake. e) The bus driver couldn’t protect/control/provide/prevent the accident. f) After police found drugs there, the disco was closed down/banned/ignored/ abolished. g) During the match, someone set/put/opened/caught fire to the stadium. h) We decided not to go camping because of the great/amount/heavy/extra rain. i) I had to shut the window because the noise outside was shouting/unbearable/in danger/enormous. j) When the fire broke out, an electronic alarm came in/opened up/went off/put out. 6.Use the word given in capitals at the end of each line to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: A modern Robinson Crusoe After a (1) collision between two ships in the Atlantic, Alan COLLIDE Connaught from Dundee ended up (2)…………………….living on a EXPECT desert island. ‘I fell (3) ……………………………and no-one noticed. BOARD A few hours later I found myself lying (4)………………………..on a EXHAUST beach after swimming for miles. It was (5) …………………...too, not FREEZE warm and sunny, like Crusoe’s island. The only (6)………………….. SOLVE I could find was to dig a hole in the sand as a shelter.’ After an (7) ………………in the weather, Alan waited to be rescued. IMPROVE ‘There was little food and no fresh water. It was an (8)………………. HEALTH life, and I felt ill most of the time. I suffered from (9)………………… LONELY too, but then I found a village on the other side of the island!’ he said. ‘The people had moved there after the (10)…………………of their homes by a volcano. Luckily they had a radio, and a ship soon came to rescue me.’ 446 DESTROY 7. Match the words in the box with the definitions (a-j): aid conservation emergency pile-up drought famine riot charity demonstration strike a) An organization which collects money to help those in need. charity b) When an area is desperately short of water. …………………... c) The act of protecting animals, or parts of the environment. …………………... d) When people march through the streets to show their opinions. ………………….. e) A collision involving several vehicles. …………………... f) When an area is desperately short of food. …………………... g) Something unexpected which must be dealt with quickly. …………………... h) When people stop working through disagreement with their employers. …………... i) Help (money, food, etc.) given by governments or other organizations. ……………. j) When a crowd of people is violent and out of control. …………………... 8. Complete each sentence with one suitable word: a) The fireman put his life at risk to rescue the child. b) Teachers have decided to go ……………………………………strike next month. c) Sue has a lot of work to do and is ……………………………stress at the moment. d) The coach driver went through a red light………………………………….mistake. e) Many people are dying…………………………………….hunger in the desert area. f) The boat which sank was crowded …………………………………………..people. g) The two countries are now …………………………………….war with each other. h) ……………………………………………………….an emergency, break the glass. i) When the fire brigade arrived, the church was no longer………………………..fire. j) When the volcano erupted, a party of tourists was…………………………...danger. 447 9. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: A letter to the editor Dear Sir, We are writing to suggest that all cars should be (1) stopped/banned/removed/altered from the center of the city as soon as possible. The amount of (2) this/problem /driving/pollution from car exhaust fumes is now (3) unbearable/much/overcrowded/ exceeded, and we believe that the public must be (4) preserved/saved/exhausted/ protected. Apart from this, the streets are crowded (5) from/in/with/between cars, and our lives are at (6) risk/danger/urgent/problem when we try to cross the road. There has been a huge (7) size/number/growing/increase in the amount of traffic recently, and the government just seems to put (8) out/away/up/off the problem, instead of (9) going through/dealing with/closing down/keeping up with it. Unless we (10) look for/ make out/face up to/come round to the traffic problem, and seriously consider some of the (11) solutions/errors/suggestions/matters, life in our city will become (12) lifeless /uninhabitable/impossible/destruction. Our organization, Cities for People, has been (13) taken after/set up/carried out/looked into to make the government do something! We are holding a (14) pile-up/riot/organization/demonstration next week in the city center, and hope that many people will (15) join/bear/increase/agree us. Your faithfully, Mary Kingwood, Secretary, Cities for People VOCABULARY: GENERAL - PHRASAL VERBS: DESTROYING AND REACTING TO DESTRUCTION115 A. DESTROYING Here are some phrasal verbs which relate to the concept of ‘destruction’: phrasal verb meaning fall apart break into pieces because Take care with this priceless old 115 example Michael McCarthy & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011 448 of being too old or too book. It’s beginning to fall weak apart. pull down sth or destroy a building or other They are planning to pull down pull sth down structure because it is not the old police station and build a wanted any more new one. screw up sth or twist or crush paper or You can tell he’s nervous – look screw sth up material with your hands how he’s screwing up those scraps of paper. tear apart sth or pull something violently The custom officers tore the bag tear sth apart so that it breaks into two apart and found the hidden or more pieces drugs. knock over sth/sb hit or push someone or As she was dusting the room, she or knock sth/sb something, usually knocked over a vase and split over accidentally, so that they water all over the table fall to the ground or unto their side put out sth or put make something that is We managed to put the fire out sth out burning, e.g. a fire or before the fire brigade arrived. cigarette, stop burning root out sth/sb or find and get rid of the The government says it will root root sth out thing or person that is out crime and the causes of causing a problem crime. stamp out sth or get rid of something that is The government says it is doing stamp sth out considered wrong or all it can to stamp out the harmful problem of drugs. B. REACTING TO DESTRUCTION AND NEGATIVE SITUATIONS Fight to save village home Meanborough Local Council has decided to destroy a beautiful old cottage in the village of Wareholt in order to widen the main road. However, the villagers are equally determined to fight back. The authorities want to evict an 89-year-old lady, Doris Jakes, who has lived all her life in the cottage, and seem to be bending over 449 backwards [trying extremely hard, often to help or please someone] to persuade her to go and live in a modern old people’s home in the nearest town. Doris does not want to move and villagers are doing all they can to see her through [help or support someone during a difficult period in their life] her difficult time. Doris may seem old and harmless, but she has turned on [criticised them very strongly or attacked them] several officers from the council who have tried to get her to change her mind. There was a recent setback [problem which caused time to be wasted] for Doris when she was told that she couldn’t stay in the cottage because repairs needed to be done to the roof. However, her neighbor, a builder, quickly saw to [did what needed to be done to solve the problem] it and her roof is now in good repair, so she is still in the cottage and hopes to win her battle. 1. Complete these sentences using verbs from the table A: 1. The border police have tried unsuccessfully to ……………out illegal immigration. 2.When the thefts at the school happened, the headteacher promised to …………………. out the person or persons responsible. 3. We got a lovely old chair from my grandmother’s house when she died, but it was …………………… apart so we had it restored. 4. She read the letter, then…………………….it up and threw it angrily into the wastepaper basket. 5. I got so excited I ……………………. over my coffee cup and made a terrible stain on the tablecloth. 2.Rewrite the underlined parts of these conversations, using phrasal verbs from B: 1. Pedro: I’m sorry you didn’t get the funds you applied for to do your research. Gisela: Yes, well, it was a bit of a disappointment and I did waste a bit of time because of it, but I’ve applied for a different grant, and hope I’ll get that. 2. Tony: Are you managing to survive without working? 450 Dan: Well, my parents have lent me some money to enable me to survive while I’m studying. 3. Connie: Teachers suffered very badly under the last government – their salaries fell and their conditions got worse. Hilda: Yes, but they are not just reacting passively any more now and their union is much stronger. 4. Ruth: Did you get much support from Mr Crombie? Bob: Oh yes, he did absolutely everything possible to help me. 5. Tom: I hear you experienced Lena’s bad temper this morning! Eric: Yes, I made an innocent comment and she just reacted really furiously. 6. Olive: The photocopier’s not working again. Gareth: OK, don’t worry, I’ll go and fix it. III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS – TRAFFIC JAMS116 1. Thousands of cars clogged the motorways of Veldonia yesterday, following a nationwide rail strike which forced commuters to take the roads. All those who had to crawl to work in the nose-to-tail traffic, while chocking on exhaust fumes, realized that the existing road network could no longer cope with the massive increase in traffic. The way back was equally exasperating, with those leaving towns for the weekend adding to the congestion. The strike came just hours after monumental traffic jams had stretched for miles in another fit of motorway madness, when thousands of motorists tried to leave the capital, Mosterra, for holiday destinations. As irate drivers inched along in bumper-to-bumper traffic, the police could afford some breathing space: huge tie-ups mean fewer crashes. With the summer holiday season soon in full swing, lorries have 116 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1, 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 451 been restricted to certain hours and no busloads of children are being allowed on the motorways on weekends. 2. This is the latest traffic report from Darum. The Crampton roundabout is very badly affected this morning by emergency gas repairs and drivers are advised to avoid it. The A 4 dual carriageway has been reduced from three lanes to one due to resurfacing and is congested northbound. A speed limit of 30 miles per hour has been set. There is a traffic light failure on Cromwell Street, with all the lights stuck on green. Maintenance workers have already been dispatched to repair them. A serious crash at the junction of A 52 and A 25 is causing tailbacks. Drivers are being urged to move on and not to add to the chaos by slowing down to gaze at the wrecks. It could be two to three hours before they are cleared. There was a serious accident on the M6 last evening. An articulated lorry skidded and overturned on one of the busiest routes to the capital, causing no collisions. Within minutes, thousands of vehicles tailed back as traffic came to a standstill. Desperate drivers sought diversions, clogging them too. Traffic police were unable to right the lorry and tow it clear before the arrival of a special crane. The accident disrupted the traffic for five hours. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1.The reason for yesterday’s heavy traffic jams in Veldonia was the temporary suspension of train services. 2. The number of registered vehicles far exceeds the capacity of the roads. 3. There were no delays in leaving towns. 4. Any other day of the week the situation might have been easier. 5. The railway strike coincided with the beginning of the holidays. 6. There is a dramatic increase in the number of car accidents when motorways are clogged. 7. No action has been taken to ease the situation on the roads during the holiday period. 8. The difficult situation at the Crompton roundabout was not foreseen. 9. The traffic signals on Cromwell Street are likely to be repaired soon. 452 10.Drivers are being told to look carefully at the crash site at the junction so as to avoid an accident like that in future. 11. The traffic of the M6 is usually quite heavy. 12. After the lorry blocked the M6, no vehicles could get through. 13. Diversions provided an effective way to get to the city on time. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B articulated…………………………. fumes bumper-to-bumper………………… jams exhaust……………………………. lorry huge……………………………….. madness maintenance………………………. network motorway…………………………. tie-ups road………………………………. traffic traffic………………………. ……. workers 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the first story: CLOGGED – SUMMER – IN – VELDONIA – OF – HOLIDAYS – MOTORWAYS – ON – EVE …………………………………………………………………………………………. …………………………………………………………………………………………. 4. Phrases to learn: -a pornit la drum cu maşina: - t…………… t…………… the r……………….. -bară la bară: - n………… -to-t……………, b……………-to-b………………… -a-şi permite o clipă de răgaz: - a…………. some b……….. s……………….. -în plin sezon de vară: - s………… h…………… s………….. in f…………… s………………. 453 -a introduce restricţii de viteză: - s………….. a s………… l…………… -defecţiune la semafoarele electrice: -t……….. l………….. f……………. -a produce o coliziune: - c…………….. a c………………. -a paraliza (blocaj total): - c…………. to a s…………………. -a căuta rute ocolitoare: - s…………. d……………. -a remorca (a degaja carosabilul de maşinile accidentate, rămase în pană): t………………. something c…………….. -a perturba circulaţia: - d…………… t…………………. 454 LESSON 27 *Grammar: Determiners (3)* Vocabulary: General – Health and The Body* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Celebrations *** I. GRAMMAR - DETERMINERS (3)117 *which? and what? #we ask which? when there is a limited choice. Which size do you want – small, medium or large? #we ask what? When there is a wide choice. What is your shoe size? #sometimes both are possible Which/What day next week can you come and see us? 1. Which or what? 1. We’ve got red wine and white - ……………………………………...will you have? 2. ………………………………….....books did you read for last year’s English class? 3. …………………………………….....was your favourite subject at primary school? 4. ………………………………………………………….English king had six wives? 5. ………………………………………………………………………...’s your name? 6. …………………………………………………………......hand do you write with? 7. …………………………………………………………….kind of car have you got? 8. I’m going to buy a new carpet. ………………………………...colour should I get? 9. …………………………………………….party do you think will win the election? 117 Michael Swan & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 455 10. ……………………………………….subject do you prefer, chemistry or physics? #before of and one, we can use which but not what. Which of the countries in Europe have you visited? Look at all those stars. Which one is the nearest? #when there is no noun, we use who for people, not which. Compare: Which boxer won? Who won? 2. Which, what or who? 1. ………………………………………of the books on the list have you already read? 2. There are two coats on the bed. ………………………………………..one is yours? 3. I really don’t know ………………………………...earrings to wear with this dress. 4. ……………………………………………………….time shall we meet tomorrow? 5. ……………………………………..of your brothers is the one who works in Paris? 6. …………………………………………………………….got the job, Andy or Liz? 7. …………………………………………………….language do you speak at home? 8. I don’t remember …………………………………...of your parents plays the piano. 9. ………………………………………………………..gave you that – John or Alex? 10. I can come to your place, or we can meet at mine. ………………..is best for you? *other(s) and another #when other is used before a plural noun, it does not have –s. when other is used without a noun, it has –s in the plural. Compare: Tell the other people. Tell the others. Can you show me some other shoes? Can you show me some others? 456 3. Write other or others: 1. I could see Karima and Nedjima at their desks – but where were the………………? 2. Long after all the …………………….cars had left, Dawson’s BMW was still there. 3. I’ll phone all the ………………………………..if you’ll phone Ted and Lucy, OK? 4. I can play the Sonata in C, but not any of the ………………………………………. 5. Do you know any ……………………...people who might have a reason to do this? 6. This doesn’t suit me. Have you got any……………………………………..colours? 7. Some metals are magnetic and ………………………………………………..aren’t. 8. The police arrested Jane, Fred and two……………………………………………... 9. I wish that girl would play more with……………………………………....children. 10. Gerald Durrell wrote a book called ‘My Family and ……………………Animals.’ #we can use another (one word) to mean ‘one more’. But with uncountables and plurals, we do not generally use other to mean ‘more’. Compare: Have another potato. Have some more meat. We need more cups. 4. Write expressions with another or with more: E.g.: English: more English 7. job:………………………… book: another book 8. possibilities: ………………. eggs: more eggs 9. money: …………………..... 1. clothes: …………………. 10. time: ……………………... 2. friends: …………………. 11. freedom: ………………… 3. child: ……………………. 12. holidays: ………………… 4. hour: ……………………. 13. problem: ………………… 5. mile: ……………………. 14. question: ………………... 6. sleep: …………………… 15. tickets: ………………….. 457 #we can use another + few or another + a number with a plural noun. Let’s wait another few minutes. ( = ‘….a few more minutes.’) The job will take another ten days. (= ‘…ten more days.’) 5. Change the expressions to use another: E.g.: three more pages: another three pages 1. a few more days: …………………….. 2. a hundred more pounds: …………………….. 3. twenty more miles: …………………….. 4. a few more mistakes: …………………….. 5. a million more dollars: …………………….. *determiners and of: most people; most of us #we use determiners (some, any, much, many, more, most, few, enough etc.) with of before other determiners (the, this, my etc.) and before personal pronouns (it, us etc.). DETERMINER + OF DETERMINER WITHOUT OF -before the: some of the matches we played some matches -before this: more of that coffee more coffee I’ll have more - before my: most of our meals most meals I cook most. enough water most elections -before it, us: enough of it most of them #the same thing happens with numbers one, two etc. two of the dogs four of my friends two dogs four friends #before of we use every one, not every, and none, not no. every one of the dogs none of my friends 458 every dog no friend 6. Put in of or nothing (-): Dear Phil, Well, some (1) ……..our luggage has arrived, so things could be worse. I’ve got the books and papers, but I’ve lost most (2)…………my clothes. I haven’t got any (3) ……….socks at all, and I’ll have to buy some more (4)…………jeans, but at least I’ve got enough (5)…………..underwear for this week. (They don’t sell it here. I don’t think they wear it.) I’m going to buy a few (6) …………..those woolen shirts that you like, and one (7)………..the big coats that we looked at. They’ve got no (8)…………shoes in my size, unfortunately, and none (9)………….the jackets suit me. Anyway, I’m not alone. Every one (10) ……………us has lost something – in fact, three (11)…………..people have got no (12)……………luggage at all. Well, as they say, into each (13)…………….life a little (14)……………….rain must fall. See you on the 17th. Andy #note the difference between most people (talking about people in general) and most of the people (talking about particular people): Most people want to have children. Most of the people I know live in the country. 7. Put in most people and most of the people: 1. ……………………………………………………...enjoy talking about themselves. 2. ……………………………………who wanted to see the match were disappointed. 3. I know…………………………………………………………………...in our street. 4. ………………………………………………………………………….like dancing. 5. I think fishing for sport is wrong, but ………………………………would disagree. 6. ……………………………………………..on the train they were going on holiday. 7. He gets on with……………………………………………………………………… 8. …………………………………………………….at the party were friends of Jan’s. 459 9. …………………………………………………………..I work with live in London. 10. ……………………………………………..would like more money and less work. #Note: we often drop of after all and both. After a lot/lots/plenty we always use of with a noun or pronoun: all (of) my problems both (of) her brothers a lot of good ideas *determiners: more practice 8. Mixed structures. Choose the correct forms: 1. This car hardly uses petrol/some petrol/any petrol/no petrol. 2. Could you lend me money/some money/any money for a few days? 3. I have never told someone/anyone about your past. 4. Helen can ride a bike without some/any help now. 5. You’ve got pretty toes/some pretty toes. 6. I understood little/a little of the lecture, but not very much. 7. She was sad because she had few/a few friends. 8. Of all the children, Billy is the less/the least trouble. 9. I don’t know where the other/others people went. 10. Not every bear/bears can climb trees. 9. Mixed structures. Correct the mistakes. (One of sentences 1-10 is correct): E.g.: I haven’t got some money: any Everybody was late: correct 1. Not anybody wrote to me last week. …………………. 2. None her friends helped her. …………………. 3. She talks so fast that anybody can understand her. …………………. 4. I have much free time. …………………. 5. You’re walking too much slowly. We’ll be late. …………………. 460 6. Have we got enough of chairs for everybody? ………………….. 7. This soup isn’t enough warm. .………………….. 8. ‘Did you find any mushrooms?’ ‘Yes, a lot of.’ …………………... 9. We found the place without no difficulty. …………………… 10. We’ll be here for another six days. …………………… 10. Grammar in a text: formality. Choose a phrase from each pair in the box to write: a) a formal text; and b) an informal text: few people learn foreign languages perfectly/ not many people learn foreign languages perfectly when they’re grown up./as adults. the majority of us/ most of us make many mistakes/make a lot of mistakes when we are speaking /when we’re speaking another language.(*2) it’s best/the best policy is to aim for a reasonable level of accuracy,/to try to get most things right but not to be too perfectionist. (*2) a lot of common mistakes/many common mistakes have little effect /don’t have much effect on communication. (*2) A) FORMAL: Few …………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. B) INFORMAL: ……………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. ………………………………………………………………………………………….. 461 ………………………………………………………………………………………….. *determiners: revision test 11.Choose the correct words. More than one answer may be possible: E.g.: Come here and look at this/that. Would you like some/any more juice? 1. John passed none/none of/any of/no of his exams last year. 2. My father won’t lend money to anybody/nobody. 3. There hasn’t been rain enough/enough rain this year. 4. Most/Most of my friends live in London. 5. Rashpal’s got beautiful/some beautiful hair. 6. There’s any/none/no money in my bank account. 7. I’ll be home in another two/other two/two other hours. 8. That child hardly eats anything/nothing/something. 9. Those people have much/a lot/a lot of/lots of money. 10. I bought the less/least expensive bike. 12. Right or wrong? Correct the mistakes or write ‘Correct’: Ex: I don’t want some help, thanks. any I’ve got some nice American friends. correct 1. Who’s this man over there talking to Anna? ………………. 2. I’ve hardly got no time these days. ………………. 3. Mark and Joanna are here, but where are the others? ………………. 4. We all will be on holiday next week. ………………. 5. Not every birds can fly. ………………. 6. Not all birds can fly. ………………. 7. What leg hurts – the left or the right? ……………….. 462 8. Sally got a lot presents for her birthday. ……………….. 9. She gave me a lot of information, but I don’t remember all. ……………….. 10. You can have either room – they’re both free. ……………….. II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL – HEALTH AND THE BODY118 1. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) There were ten people waiting in the doctor’s office/surgery/ward. b) After I ate the shellfish, I experienced/felt/happened ill. c) George’s cut arm took over a week to cure/heal/look after. d) David fell down the steps and twisted his ankle/heel/toe. e) Everyone admired Lucy because she was tall and skinny/slim/thin. f) I’ve been digging the garden and now my back aches/pains/injuries. g) Whenever I travel by boat I start feeling hurt/sick/sore. h) The doctor can’t say what is wrong with you until she cures/examines/recovers you. i) Use this thermometer and take his fever/heat/temperature. j) I seem to have caught/infected/taken a cold. 2. Replace the words in italics with one of the words from the box. Use each word once only: agony body breath heart spine tongue look stomachache beard brains a) Janet fell from her horse and injured her backbone: spine b) I had a very bad toothache, and was in great pain all night: ……………. c) The police discovered the dead person buried in the garden. : ……………. d) One thing you can say about Ann, she has certainly got intelligence: …………….. e) They have a new house right in the center of the countryside. : 118 …………….. Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 463 f) Italian is actually Mary’s native language: ……………… g) Before I dived in the water, I took a deep mouthful of air: ……………… h) After dinner, Jack had a pain from eating too much: ……………… i) Shirley has a strange expression on her face: ……………... j) David managed to grow a lot of hair on his face: ……………... 3.Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: cheek knees neck throat waist chin lips nose thumb wrist a) After speaking for two hours, the lecturer had a sore throat. b) Terry was on his hands and ……………………………, looking for the fallen coin. c) Paul gave his aunt an affectionate kiss on the ……………………………………… d) There was such a terrible smell that I had to hold my…………………………….... e) Stan is deaf, but he can understand people by reading their………………………... f) I never wear a watch because I don’t like the weight on my ……………………….. g) One of the boxers punched the other on the …………………and knocked him out. h) When Diane was a baby, she used to suck her……………………………………… i) I’ve lost a lot of weight, especially around the ……………………………………... j) Norma wears a heart on a golden chain around her…………………………………. 4.Complete each sentence (a-j) with a suitable ending (1-10). Use each ending once: a)I think we should send for an 1) to have that bad tooth of yours taken ambulance 3 out. b)Some people go jogging every morning 2) to check whether it had recovered from ……… its accident. c)It would be a good idea for you to go to 3) to take old Mrs. Jones to hospital. the dentist’s……… 464 d) The doctor gave Andy an injection….. 4) to put on my sunburnt arms and leg. e) I’m going into hospital tomorrow….. 5) to get rid of her headache. f) We took the cat to the vet …. 6) to reduce the pain and help him sleep. g) Susan took two aspirins…. 7) to take to the chemist’s. h) Nobody could find a stretcher…. 8) to keep fit, or to lose some weight. i) The doctor gave Helen a prescription… 9)to carry the injured man out of the building. j) I bought some special cream… 10) to have an operation on my foot. 5. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) Martin hasn’t quite recovered/got over/looked after/suffered his illness yet. b) Pauline was/put/had/gave birth to a baby girl yesterday afternoon. c) Your leg isn’t broken but it is badly fractured/bruised/bandaged/bent. d) Several angry drivers shook their fists/arms/hands/elbows at me as I drove away. e) That was a bad fall! Have you harmed/damaged/wounded/hurt yourself? f) Each time I sneezed, everyone said, ‘Cough/Bless/Cold/Thank you!’ g) Stop making that noise! You’re getting on my muscles/brains/nerves/blood! h) As the little boy cried, large drips/tears/puddles/streams rolled down his cheeks. i) I had a severe toothache and half my face was badly swollen/rounded/exploded /injured. j) I’ve got a headache, and I don’t feel very healthy/fit/sane/well. 6.Use the word given in capitals at the end of each line to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: A visit to the doctor’s Jim decided to visit the doctor after his trip to the jungle. He was normally a tall (1) muscular person, but over the past MUSCLE month he had lost a lot of (2)………………… He had also noticed WEIGH that his ankles and knees had become rather (3)…………………… PAIN He thought that he might have eaten or 465 drunk something (4)……………………………………….or caught POISON some kind of (5)………………………………..disease. The doctor INFECT took some blood for tests and told Jim to go back a week later. This time the doctor had an optimistic (6)……………...on her EXPRESS face, and Jim felt quite (7)………………... ‘Don’t worry’, said the HEART doctor, ‘it’s nothing serious. You haven’t caught an (8)…………… CURE disease, or anything terrible like that. It’s a simple virus, and you will need some (9)………………….Take these tablets twice a TREAT day for two weeks, and you’ll make a full (10)…………………….’ RECOVER 7.Complete each sentence (a-j) with a suitable sentence (1-10) below which has the same meaning: a) Henry’s heart was in the right place: 4 1) He talked b) Paul held his tongue. ……. 2) He supported him. c)Richard jawed away for at least an hour… 3) He said the wrong thing. d) Dave had a lot of cheek to talk like that… 4) He was kind. e) Keith couldn’t stomach his new boss….. 5) He was rather rude. f) Harry backed his boss. …. 6) He didn’t say anything. g) William kept poking his nose in….. 7)He interfered in other people’s business. h) Graham thumbed a lift to work….. 8) He hitchhiked. i) Charles put his foot in it…. 9) He missed home. j)Jack’s heart ached to be where he 10) He didn’t like him. belonged…. 8. Complete each sentence with one suitable word: a) I am afraid she is suffering from an incurable disease. b) I was ………………………………………………….agony all night with earache. c) I think you’ve put……………………………………………..a lot of weight lately. d) The effect of this drug will slowly wear …………………………………………… 466 e) You really get…………………………………………….my nerves sometimes! f) After Jack fainted, it was several minutes before he ……………………..round. g) Is Carol being operated ……………………………………………..tomorrow? h) Harry went…………………………………………with flu during his holiday. i) Peter was treated………………………………………minor injuries and shock. j) Don’t worry. I’ll take care …………………………………………..you myself. 9. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: A disastrous holiday The day Gerald arrived at the Almara Beach Hotel, he fell (1) down/to/with/for the stairs. The manager called a/an (2) stretcher/prescription/ambulance/emergency, but fortunately Gerald’s leg was only badly (3) sick/bruised/hurt/infected, and not broken. The doctor (4) went/prevented/said/recommended swimming as further (5) medicine/ cure/drugs/treatment, but gave Gerald a/an (6) recipe/paper/prescription/order for some tablets in case his leg became (7) painful/pained/painless/pain. The next day Gerald sunbathed by the pool, and then took a deep (8) end/breath/mouthful/water and dived into the water. There was not very much water in the pool, and he (9) hurt/injury/ached/sore one of his arms when he hit the bottom. This time he complained to the hotel manager, who sent a special meal to Gerald’s room. Later that night, Gerald was (10) ill/injured/suffering/damaged from a (11) sunny/sunburnt /sunshine/grilled back, the injuries to his arm and leg, and also had a terrible (12) agony/hurt/heat/stomachache. He had a high (13) pain/temperature/ache/degree and felt terrible. Luckily he had the tablets the doctor had given him to (14) hold/check/ rid/reduce the pain. As he reached for them, he fell out of bed and broke his (15) waist /lips/wrist/throat. He spent the rest of his holiday in bed. 467 III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS - CELEBRATIONS119 Today, war veterans returned to the little town of Riemen, the place which fifty years ago was the scene of a battle in which three thousand soldiers on both sides lost their lives. To commemorate the occasion, the veterans will pay their private tribute to their long-fallen comrades and give thanks for their own survival. This morning, a mass was held for those who had come from afar and for the local community who joined the tribute. Introducing the memorial service, the chaplain said, “We address all people who hate war. War must be made impossible and those who think of it must be dissuaded. Eradicating war from this earth is the moral obligation of all who have come today to pay tribute to the fallen.” Many of those assembled did not hide their tears. In the afternoon, as part of the celebrations, there will be a wreath-laying ceremony at the cemetery where the servicemen are buried. The President of the Veterans’ Association will lay a wreath of poppies in memory of those who were killed in action, in particular as a result of a friendly fire. There will be a one-minute silence followed by a gun salute. Also, fifty oak trees will be planted to mark the anniversary. Later, the veterans will march bareheaded with bands playing, banners held high, and campaign ribbons aflutter through the streets of the town before assembling in the market place. There, they will unveil a monument which has been erected to commemorate all the unknown soldiers who perished in the war. It was funded by 80,000 donations from war veterans all over the world. The monument depicts a group of soldiers, dead or dying. The suffering on their faces will forever remind all of the appalling realities of war. The ceremony will be the highlight of this year’s celebrations. It is an occasion to reunite, reminisce, and exchange stories of the campaign, and also to share a prayer for those who died in the battle. But the veterans will also look to the future: they will hold a round-the-clock vigil for a week to protest against the planned deployment of missiles in the Riemen area. 119 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1, 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 468 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. War veterans have chosen Riemen for their celebration because it is a nice little town. 2. The reason for the get-together was to celebrate the events of fifty years ago. 3. The memorial service was attended only by the veterans. 4. The chaplain seized the opportunity to give a pacifistic message. 5. He held those in attendance responsible for what happened in Riemen fifty years ago. 6. In the afternoon, the celebrations will continue at the battlefield. 7. Some soldiers were accidentally shot during the battle by their own units. 8. Fifty oak trees will symbolize the fifty soldiers who were killed by friendly fire. 9. The monument commemorates the three thousand soldiers who fell at Riemen. 10.The veterans funded the monument so that after they are gone the memory of the war will stay with people. 11. The unveiling of the monument will be the culminating point of the celebrations. 12.The veterans see the deployment of missiles as a fitting tribute to their fallen comrades. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B friendly …………………….. community gun………………………….. comrades local…………………………. fire long-fallen…………………... salute memorial…………………….. service one-minute…………………... silence private……………………….. soldiers round-the-clock……………… tribute unknown…………………… .. veterans war…………………………... vigil 469 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: THE – RIEMEN – BATTLE – OF – THE – MEMORIAL – ANNIVERSARY – FIFTIETH – MARK – IN – CELEBRATIONS …………………………………………………………………………………………. …………………………………………………………………………………………. 4. Phrases to learn: -a-şi pierde viaţa: l…………. one’s l…………….. -a comemora: c…………… the o………………. -a aduce un omagiu: - p…………….. t………………. -a ţine o liturghie (un serviciu religios) : h……………. a m……………….. -a depune o coroană: -l……………. a w………………… -a sădi un copac: - p…………….. a t…………… -a marca o aniversare: - m…………….. the a…………….. -a dezveli un monument: - u……………. a m…………………. -momentul central al ceremoniei: - h…………….. of the c……………….. -a se ruga împreună pentru ….: - s…………… a p………….. for…. -a privi spre viitor: - l…………. t………… the f………….. -a asigura garda: - h…………. a v…………….. -amplasarea rachetelor: - d…………….. of m……………… 470 LESSON 28 *Grammar: General Revision* Vocabulary: General – Money* Vocabulary: Specific - The News – Auctions* *** I. GRAMMAR – GENERAL REVISION120 1.Complete the conversations. Put in the correct form of each verb. Use the Present Continuous or the Present Simple: E.g.: A: Is Janet in, please? B:Yes, but I think (I/think) she’s busy at the moment. She’s washing (she/wash) her hair. 1. A: ………………………………………………(I/think) of buying a new computer. B: But computers…………………..(cost) so much money. What’s wrong with the one we’ve got? A: ………………………………………………………....(it/gate) out of date now. 2. A: Your new trousers………………………………………………….....(look) nice. B: Thank you. The trouble is ………………………………..(they/not/fit) properly. …………………………………………(I/not/know) why I bought them, really. 3. A: What…………………………………………………………………….(you/do)? B: …………………………….(I/weigh) this letter. ………………………(I/need) to know how many stamps to put on it. 120 John Eastwood. Oxford Practice Grammar. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. 471 4. A: ……………………………(I/think) this road is really dangerous. Look how fast that lorry ………………………………………………………………….....(go). B: …………………………………………….(I/agree). People shouldn’t go so fast. 5. A: ………………………………(I/like) musicals. And this is a great show, isn’t it? …………………………………………………………………….(you/enjoy) it? B: Yes, I am. …………………………………………….(I/love) every minute of it. 2. Complete the sentences. Put in the correct form of each verb. Use the Past Continuous or the Past Simple: E.g.: When Martin arrived (arrive) home, Anna was talking (talk) to someone on the phone. Martin started (start) to get the tea. 1. I ……………………(lie) in the bath when the phone …………………….(ring). It ………………………………………………………………(stop) after a few rings. 2. It………………………(be) cold when we ………………….(leave) the house that day, and a light snow ………………………………………………………….(fall). 3. Your friend who …………………..(come) here the other day………………… (seem) very nice. I……………………………………………...(enjoy) meeting her. 4. When I …………………………(see) the man, he ……………………(stand) outside the bank. He ………………………………..(have) a black baseball cap on. 5.When I…………………. (open) the cupboard door, a pile of books ……………………………………………………………………………..(fall) out. 6.I………………………..(walk) along the street when I suddenly …………………. (feel) something hit me in the back. I ……………………..(not /know) what it was. 7. We …………………..(go) to London yesterday, but on the way we ………………. (hear) about a bomb scare in Oxford Street. So we ……………….(drive) back home straightaway. 8. Something very strange …………………(happen) to me on my way home from work yesterday afternoon. I………………(drive) along the bypass at the time. Suddenly I …………………(see) my mother in the seat beside me. But she died three years ago. 472 3. Complete the news report. Put each verb into the correct form: The actress Vanesa Kemp has disappeared (disappear). Yesterday she (1) …………... (fail) to arrive at the Prince Charles Theatre in London’s West End for her leading role in the comedy ‘Don’t look now!’. Ms Kemp, who (2) ………………….(live) in Hampstead, (3) …………………..(leave) home at four o’clock yesterday afternoon for the theatre, a journey she (4) ………………..(make) several times the week before. Two people who (5) ……………………(walk) past her home at the time (6) ………………… (see) her leave. But no one (7) …………………..(see) her since then. At half past seven she still (8) …………………….(not/arrive) at the theatre. At eight o’clock the theatre manager had to break the news to the audience, who (9) …………………..(wait) patiently for the play to start. Since yesterday, theatre staff and friends (10)…………………….. (try) to contact Ms Kemp, but they (11) ………………..(have) no success so far. The police (12) ………………… (take) the matter seriously, but they (13)…………………(believe) that she is unlikely to be in any danger. Her friends all (14) …………………(want) to hear from her soon. 4. Read the telephone conversation. Then look at the answers below and choose the right version for each answer: Amy: When am/do/going/will I see you again? Simon: I don’t know. I’m (1) being/going/shall/will to be busy this week. And I’ll (2) be/do/for/to going to London on Saturday. Amy: Oh. But you (3) are/do/was/will be here for my party, won’t you? Simon: No, I (4) about/aren’t/be/don’t get back until Sunday evening. Amy: I (5) be/have/was/will going to invite you. Simon: Well, I’m sorry I can’t come. Amy: What (6) are/going/to/will you doing in London? Simon: Oh, I’m just going (7) be/for/is/to see one or two people. Look, I must go. I’m cooking something that I think is (8) about/might/probably/will to boil over. 473 5. Choose the right version: E.g.: Could/Shall/Will/Would I have some more tea, please? 1. Everyone’s asleep. We couldn’t/mustn’t/needn’t/wouldn’t make a noise. 2. Do/Should/Will/Would you like to go for a ride with us? 3. I wonder if this is the right way. It can/could/might/must not be. 4. I don’t think I want to see this film. ~ Oh, I think you can/shall/will/would enjoy it. 5. I’m quite happy to walk. You don’t/haven’t/mustn’t/needn’t drive me home. 6. Do/Shall/Will/Would I show you the way? ~ Oh, thank you. 7. It’s late. I think we had/have/should/would better go. 8. We all tried to push the van, but it can’t/couldn’t/won’t/wouldn’t move. 6. Read the story and write the missing words. Use one word only in each space: During periods of terrorist activity, people in Britain are always being warned to look out for bombs. Any bag or parcel without an owner (1)……………seen as a risk to the public. Some time ago a cardboard box was found at the entrance to Bristol Zoo one day. It was noticed (2)………….a visitor and reported to the director. Clearly, if it was a bomb and it went off, people might (3) …………..killed. So army bomb experts (4) ………….called in, and the box was safely blown up in controlled explosion. Soon afterwards (5) ……………was reported that the box had (6) ……………. left there by a boy wanting to find a new home for his pet rat. He was tired of the rat, he explained, but he was unwilling to (7) ……………...it put to sleep by a vet, so he left it in a box outside the zoo. The director of the zoo is thought (8)…………………...be unenthusiastic about looking after people’s unwanted pets. No one knows what the rat thought about (9)……………………….blown up. 474 7. Read the story about a silly mistake and decide if a word needs to go in the space. If the word is missing, write the word. If no word is missing, write x: This is also …a… true story. It shows how …x….plans can sometimes go wrong and how (1) ………..people can make silly mistakes. This too happened quite (2) ………..long time ago – in (3) …………1979, in fact. The scene was (4)…………. old people’s home in (5) …………small town in (6)………….. north of England called (7)………….. Otley. The owners of the home wanted to put (8) …………. fence around it to make it more private. The work began soon after (9)…………. Christmas when (10)…………… workmen arrived in (11) ………….lorry with planks of wood which they put up around the building. ‘It was (12)………….. very nice fence,’ said (13) ……………of the old people. But there was (14) …………. problem. The workmen forgot to leave a gap for the lorry to drive out through. They had to come back the next day to knock down part of (15) …………..fence. ‘(16) ………silly mistake!’ said another resident. ‘It was (17) ………..funny we had to laugh. It fact it was (18)…………most fun we’ve had for a long time.’ 8. Decide which word is correct: E.g.: What colour shall we have? ~ I don’t mind. Pick any/some/that/what colour you like. 1. Peter has two brothers, but he doesn’t speak to any/both/either/neither of them. 2. Anyone/Anything/Someone/Something has left a bicycle outside. 3. I like that/these/this/those pictures here. ~ Yes, so do I. 4. Would you mind waiting a few/a little/few/little minutes? 5. Any/Half/Part/Some countries still have a king or a queen, don’t they? 6. Safety should come first. People/Peoples/People’s/Peoples’ lives shouldn’t be put at risk. 7. Nigel isn’t very well. ~ Oh, I’m sorry to hear so/that/this/you. 8. Mr Jones is an uncle of Polly/Pollys/Polly’s/Pollys’. 475 9. Choose the right version: E.g.: We walked slow/slowly back to the hotel. 1. We could walk free/freely around the aircraft during the flight. 2. The young/The young man with dark hair is my sister’s boyfriend. 3. I’m getting quite hungry/hungrily. 4. The man looked thoughtful/thoughtfully around the room. 5. Have I filled this form in right/rightly? 6. I think Egypt is a fascinated/fascinating country. 7. The two sisters do alike/similar jobs. 8. I’m pleased the plan worked so good/goodly/well. 9. She invented a new kind of wheelchair for the disabled/the disabled people. 10. I’m very confused/confusing about what to do. 10. Put the words in the right order to form a statement: Ex: I/love/really/these trousers I really love these trousers. 1. is/rather/silly/this game ……………………………. 2. already/I’ve/paid/the bill ……………………………. 3. enough/isn’t/loud/the alarm ……………………………. 4. easily/Jonathan/passed/the test …………………………….. 5. a lot/cards/play/the children …………………………….. 6. didn’t/enough/sell/they/tickets …………………………….. 7. ask/many/questions/too/you …………………………….. 8. a member/anymore/of the club/I’m/not …………………………….. 9. enough/it’s/outside/to sit/warm ……………………………. 476 11. Choose the right version: E.g.: What did that man say at you/for you/to you/you? 1. I rang my friend in Australia yesterday, and she said it is/should be/to be/was raining there. 2. The last time I saw Jonathan, he looked very relaxed. He explained that he’d been on holiday the earlier/following/next/previous week. 3. I wonder what/when/where/whether the tickets are on sale yet. 4. I told you don’t/not/not to/to not switch off the computer, didn’t I? 5. Someone asked/said/spoke/told me there’s been an accident on the motorway. 6. When I rang Tessa some time last week, she said she was busy that/the/then/this day. 7. When he was at Oliver’s flat yesterday, Martin asked if he can/could/may/must use the phone. 8. Judy admitted/offered/promised/suggested going for a walk, but no one else wanted to. 12. Combine the two sentences into one: E.g.: That man was Anna’s brother. He just walked past. The man who just walked past was Anna’s brother. 1. The plane was twenty-five years old. It crashed. The plane………………………………………………twenty-five years old. 2. One day Tessa was ill in bed. Martin rang. The day……………………………………………………………..ill in bed. 3. Our offices are in Queen Street. They are new. Our………………………………………………………….in Queen Street. 4. Some documents have been found. They were stolen from a car. The documents ……………………………………………………….found. 5. That map is out of date. You were looking at it. The map………………………………………………………….out of date. 477 6. The King’s Theatre is in the center of town. It dates from 1896. The King’s ………………………………………………in the center of town. 7. A woman was terribly upset. Her dog was run over. The woman………………………………………………………terribly upset. 8. Janet solved the puzzle. She did it before everyone else. Janet was …………………………………………………………..the puzzle. 9. A man was standing outside the building. He was selling newspapers. A man…………………………………………………….outside the building. 10. The talk was very interesting. Judy gave it. The talk……………………………………………………….very interesting. 13. Look at the answers below and choose the correct version: E.g.: A: There’s always something going wrong with this car. B: If you had any sense, you’d be selling/have sold/sell/sold it long ago. 1. A: It’s a pity the lake wasn’t frozen yesterday. B: Yes, it is. If it had been/was/would be/would have been frozen, we could have gone skating. 2. A: Haven’t you got enough money for a holiday? B: Oh yes. I’ve got some saved up if/in case/that/unless I suddenly need it. 3. A: What are you going to do next year? B: I wish I knew/know/could know/would know the answer to that question. 4. A: These figures are too complicated to work out in your head. B: Yes, if better/only/really/that we had a calculator. 5. A: What are you doing later this afternoon? B: Oh, if/in case/unless/when the game finishes, I’ll go home, I expect. 6. A: Do you think I should take the job? B: You shouldn’t do anything if/in case/unless/when you think it’s the right thing to do. 478 II. VOCABULARY: GENERAL - MONEY121 1. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) I haven’t got enough money, I’m afraid. Could you borrow/lend me some? b) This car is too expensive. We can’t afford/pay it. c) There’s a small flat to hire/let in Bridge Street. d) How much do you earn/gain in your new job? e) She’s a good dentist, but she doesn’t charge/spend too much. f) I bought this coat in the sales. It was decreased/reduced a lot. g) Jack made his fortune/treasure buying and selling property. h) How much do you reckon/value that house would cost? 2. Replace each word or phrase in italics with a word or phrase from the box which has the opposite meaning: cash generous profit well off poverty purchase take out worthless a) I was surprised by how mean Charles was. generous b) Janet says that she is very hard up at the moment. ……………. c) Last year their business made a huge loss. ……………. d) I’d like to pay in £100 please. ……………. e) Most people in the city live in great prosperity. ……………. f) The manager insisted that I paid by cheque. ……………. g) Jean was able to make only one sale during the morning. ……………. h) The old painting I found in the loft turned out to be valuable. ……………. 121 Michael Vince & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 479 3. Complete each sentence with a word from the box. Use each word once only: safe wealth pension rent up tip credit card loan receipt a) The old couple had only a small pension to live on. b) My uncle Sam acquired his considerable ……………………………selling cars. c) David never carries cash with him and pays for everything by …………………. d) I wouldn’t have been able to buy my boat without a bank……………………… e) The shop won’t change any goods without the original ………………………… f) Keith didn’t like the waiter so he didn’t leave a ………………………………… g) The house is not in very good condition so the …………………………..is low. h) We keep all our money and valuables in this ………………………..in the floor. 4. Match each sentence (a-h) with a suitable response (1-8). Use each response once only: a) Who do I make the cheque out to? 6 1) Sorry, but it’s not for sale. b)We seem to be spending a lot of money 2) I’m saving up to buy a new motorbike. lately. …… c)The house has burnt down! What are 3) Perhaps we should try to economize a we going to do? …. bit. d)How much do you want for this 4) Yes, my Aunt Clara left it to me. drawing? ….. e) Did you inherit this house? …. 5) Well, we’ve nearly paid it all back. f) Do we still owe the bank any money? .. 6) To JB Woolbury PLC. g)Can we change money at the hotel to 7) I think they accept travelers cheques pay the bill? anyway. h)Why are you putting so much money in 8) Don’t worry, we’re insured. the bank? 480 5. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: a) I bought these shoes in the sale. They were a real cheap/economy/bargain/ purchase. b) If you put your money in the bank, it will earn ten per cent interest/profit/deposit/ investment. c) John asked his parents if they would pay off his rents/debts/accounts/credits. d) Adults have to pay £8 to get in, but children under fourteen get in free/nothing/ penniless/open. e) I’m trying to save for my holidays so I’m putting in/putting aside/putting behind/ putting up some money each week. f) Just a minute! You’ve forgotten to mark/make/place/sign your cheque! g) The blackmailer asked for the money in used notes/cheques/paper/cash. h) I gave the assistant ten euros and she gave me four euros rest/money/coins/change. 6. Use the word given in capitals at the end of each line to form a word that fits in the space in the same line: Money! Money! Money! Helen had always dreamed of becoming a (1) wealthy WEALTH woman, and imagined living in a (2) ……………………….mansion, LUXURY and how her friends would praise her (3) ……………………………. GENEROUS when she gave them expensive presents. In reality she was usually hard up. She had some (4) ……………………….. and a SAVE small life (5) …………………..., but her antique shop was not really INSURE very (6)……………….. Every time she took money out of the bank, PROFIT the (7) ………………….checked her account, and told her how little CASH there was in it! Helen had taken out a (8) ………………….. a month LEND before. How could she repay it? Then one day she noticed an old painting in her shop. She had thought it was (9) ……………... WORTH but as she brushed away the dust, she saw the (10) ………………….. SIGN at the bottom. It said ‘Renoir’! She was rich at last! 481 7. Complet each sentence with a word of phrase formed from pay. Each space represents one word: a) You can pay the full price now, or make six monthly payments. b) If you lend me the money, I’ll ..................... ....................... ...................... next week. c) I haven’t got enough money to ........................ .................................... the suit now. d) We ............................. ............................... a lot of money on decorating this house. e) I must do something about all these ....................................................................bills. f) Please make the cheque ....................................................................... to R.D. Smith. g) Take this money and ............................ ............................... ......................... to the bank. h) I like my job, and it’s very ............................... ........................................................ 8. Match the words in the box with a suitable definition (a-h). Use each word once only: accountant cashier heir pensioner agent customer swindler a) Someone who inherits money or property. heir b) Someone who has retired. ........................ c) Someone who keeps or checks financial records. ........................ d) Someone who buys things in a shop. ........................ e) Someone who pays out money in a bank. ........................ f) Someone who represents others in business. ........................ g) Someone who puts money into a business. ........................ h) Someone who cheats people out of money. ........................ 482 investor 9. Choose the most suitable word or phrase: Money matters Are you always (1) shut/hard/debt/money up? Do you often have to (2) borrow/lend/ save/pay money from your parents whenever you need a little extra (3) cheque/ pension/wealth/cash? If you (4) sign/spend/cost/cheat too much, and save too little, you will end up with more (5) owe/loans/debts/profits than friends. You know the solution, of course: just save a small (6) amount/number/note/rest every month. Most banks will pay (7) receipts/credits/rents/interest on your savings, and will soon be able to (8) lend/economize/afford/spend all those things which seemed to cost too much before. The trouble is, you’re a university student, and many banks treat you like a child. But not us. If you open a/an (9) cheque/customer/bill/account with Smith Fulton Bank before October 31st, we’ll not only send you your own (10) loan/cheque/cash/ money book and credit (11) plastic/tip/card/cheque, but you’ll also receive a copy of our booklet ‘Putting Money (12) aside/up/inside/work for Your Future’. Smith Fulton can pay your (13) sales/bets/bargains/bills, help you with special student (14) coins/ loans/fortunes/pensions, and your friendly branch (15) miser/swindler/manager/ cashier can give you advice for the future. Why not believe in us and open an account? III. VOCABULARY: SPECIFIC – NEWS - AUCTIONS122 Drawings, ceramics, and coins generated a great deal of interest at Lincoln’s Auction House yesterday. A seventeenth-century drawing by an unknown artist changed hands after fierce bidding and realized $200,000, only $20,000 short of Lincoln’s spring record for similar items. The drawing was one of a fifteen-piece oriental collection which belonged to the late Miss Florence Higgins. It was the star of the auction. The drawing depicted a cherry orchard in full bloom. Only one drawing was left unsold because oriental art is the current craze. The collection raised $750,000 and was sold, as instructed in the will, for the benefit of the Cancer Research Fund. 122 Barbara and Marcin Otto. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1, 2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. 483 A collection of Anturian coins, minted during the Great Revolution, also came under the hammer. The coins, described as undamaged and some even uncirculated, were auctioned off without difficulty at a record price. At a previous auction, one third of the coins on offer went unsold, proving once again that collectibles of lesser quality are not selling. Demand for a collection of ceramics was strong and prices repeatedly exceeded expectations. The highlight of the auction was a piece of Greek pottery offered at as reserve price of $60,000. It sold for $92,000 and was bought by a woman who was acting on behalf of a Swedish collector who wished to remain anonymous. The 18-lot sale ended with an overall total of $550,000. Lincoln’s also announced its intention to put a sixteenth-century painting by Charles Bourgani on the block in December. Only recently found and restored, it had been put under a six-month temporary export ban by heritage lobbyists in an effort to keep it in the country. But because no national museum has managed to raise the required sum, the painting will probably go to a foreign dealer. Two interesting pieces of jewellery will be put up for auction in November. One is a superb necklace of oriental pearls with a diamond-studded clasp, the other is a signet ring mounted with a six-carat ruby. These are among twenty lots which are hoped to sell in next to no time. 1. Tick the statements: true or false: 1. Collectors are not interested in drawings, ceramics and coins. 2. The seventeenth-century drawing set a new record at Lincoln’s. 3. Miss Florence Higgins is the current owner of the drawing. 4. Objects of oriental art are more likely to sell than others. 5. The benefactress intended that the proceeds from the collection should be donated to institutions which are fighting cancer. 6. Some of the coins are in mint condition. 7. The reserve price for the coins was too high to attract buyers. 8. The report says that the cheaper the object, the more likely it is to find a buyer. 9. The woman who paid $92,000 bought the piece of Greek pottery for herself. 10. The export ban on the Bourgani painting ends in December. 484 11. Heritage lobbysts are people who believe that the painting is part of the nation’s culture. 12. Only the necklace and the signet ring are likely to sell during the November jewellery auction. 2. Match the words from column A with those from column B to form collocations as they appear in the story: COLUMN A COLUMN B current............................ ban export............................. bidding fierce.............................. coins foreign........................... collection oriental.......................... craze record........................... dealer strong........................... demand uncirculated.................. price 3. Rearrange the words to form the headline to the story: TWO – HEAVY – TRANSACTIONS – IN – LINCOLN’S – BRINGS – AT – BIDDING – DOLLARS – MILLION .......................................................................................................................................... .......................................................................................................................................... 4. Phrases to learn: -a stârni un mare interes: -g............... a g................. d.................. of i.................. -a schimba proprietarul: - c........................ h...................... -de care va beneficia (fondul): - f................... the b................. (of a fund) -a depăşi aşteptările: -e...................... e..................... -a acţiona în numele cuiva: -a................... o................... somebody’s b.................. -a-şi declara intenţia: - a....................... an i...................... 485 -a expune la vânzare: - p................. o................ the b.................... -a impune o interdicţie temporară de export: - p................... t................... u.................... e...................... b...................... -a colecta suma necesară: - r........................ the r................. s....................... -a vinde la licitaţie: - p....................... u.................. f.................. a........................ -cât ai clipi din ochi: - i............. n................... to n................ t................... 486 a APPENDIX A. TENSES – SHORT VERSION *PRESENT TENSE SIMPLE AFFIRMATIVE INTERROGATIVE NEGATIVE I, you, we, they work He, she, it works Do I, you, we, they work? Does he, she, it work? I, you, we, they do not work He, she, it does not work *PRESENT TENSE CONTINUOUS AFFIRMATIVE INTERROGATIVE NEGATIVE I am working you, we, they are working Am I working? are you, we, they working I am not working you, we, they are not working he, she, it is working is he, she, it working ? he, she, it is not working AFFIRMATIVE INTERROGATIVE NEGATIVE I, you, we, they worked Did I, you, we, they work? she, he, it worked Did she, he, it work? I, you, we, they did not work she, he, it did not work *PAST TENSE SIMPLE *PAST TENSE CONTINUOUS AFFIRMATIVE INTERROGATIVE NEGATIVE I, he, she, it was working. You, we, they were working Was I, he, she, it working? Were you, we, they working? I, he, she, it was not working. You, we, they were not working. *PRESENT PERFECT SIMPLE AFFIRMATIVE INTERROGATIVE I, you, we, they have worked/seen He, she, it has worked/seen. Have I, you, we, they I, you, we, they worked/seen? have not worked/seen. Has he, she, it worked/seen? He, she, it has not worked/seen NEGATIVE *PRESENT PERFECT CONTINUOUS AFFIRMATIVE INTERROGATIVE I, you, we, they have been working/seeing. He, she, it has been working/seeing Have I, you, we, they been I, you, we, they have not working/seeing? been working/seeing Has he, she, it He, she, it has not been been working/seeing? working/seeing. 487 NEGATIVE *PAST PERFECT SIMPLE AFFIRMATIVE INTERROGATIVE NEGATIVE I, you, we, they had worked/seen. he, she, it, had worked/seen. Had I, you, we, they I, you, we, they had not worked/seen? worked/seen Had he, she, it worked/seen? he, she, it had not worked/seen *PAST PERFECT CONTINUOUS AFFIRMATIVE INTERROGATIVE I, you, we, they Had I, you, we, they been I, you, we, they had not been working/seeing? working/seeing Had he, she, it he, she, it been working/seeing? had not been working/seeing had been working/seeing he, she, it had been working/seeing NEGATIVE *FUTURE: WILL –FUTURE AFFIRMATIVE I, you, we, they will work. INTERROGATIVE Will I, you, we, they work? he, she, it will work Will he, she, it work? NEGATIVE I, you, we, they will not work. he, she, it will not work. *FUTURE: FUTURE CONTINUOUS AFFIRMATIVE INTERROGATIVE NEGATIVE I, you, we, they will be working he, she, it will be working Will I, you, we, they be working? Will he, she, it be working? I, you, we, they will not be working he, she, it will not be working *FUTURE: FUTURE PERFECT – SIMPLE AFFIRMATIVE INTERROGATIVE NEGATIVE I, you, we, they will have worked (vor fi lucrat) he, she, it will have worked Will I, you, we, they have worked? I, you, we, they will not have worked Will he, she, it have worked? he, she, it will not have worked *FUTURE: FUTURE PERFECT – CONTINUOUS AFFIRMATIVE INTERROGATIVE NEGATIVE I, you, we, they will have been working he, she, it will have been working Will I, you, we, they have been working? Will he, she, it have been working? I, you, we, they will not have been working he, she, it will not have been working 488 B. TENSES – LONG VERSION *PRESENT TENSE SIMPLE #Lucruri întotdeauna adevărate: Castford Castle stands on a high hill. The sun rises in the east. #Lucruri care se întâmplă întotdeauna, în mod repetat, deseori, uneori, niciodată You live in North London, don’t you? No thanks, I don’t smoke. Alice works for an insurance company. What do frogs eat? I play tennis every Wednesday. *PRESENT TENSE CONTINUOUS #Lucruri care se întămplă (cam) acum My sister’s living with me just now. Look – Ann’s smoking a cigar. Why is that girl standing on the table? Phil’s not working at the moment. Hurry up! We’re waiting for you. ‘What are you doing?’ ‘I’m writing letters. Why are you crying? What’s wrong? *PAST TENSE SIMPLE # Acţiune (lungă sau scurtă) terminată în trecut Joe got up at 7.00 and worked from 9.00 to 4.00. # + ‘when’ – ordine cronologică When Amy came home, John cooked supper. (1- Any a venit acasă; 2- John a gătit cina) #Acţiuni de durată, permanente, din trecut Explorers believed that the river ran into the Atlantic. #Obiceiuri din trecut I played a lot of tennis when I was younger. #Când cerem, întrebăm, sau sugerăm politicos I wondered if you were free this evening. How much did you want to spend, sir? I thought it would be nice to have a picnic. Could I ask you to translate for me? You might see if the consulate can help you. 489 *PAST TENSE CONTINUOUS #Acţiuni care nu erau terminate, complete, într-un anume moment din trecut: At 5.00, when Joe came home, I was reading. #Acţiuni sau situaţii de mai lungă durată: While I was cooking supper, Ellie phoned. As I was walking down the road, I saw Bill. # + “when” – “în timpul” When Amy came home, John was cooking supper. - “acţiuni sau situaţii temporare” When I walked in I found that water was running down the walls. #Politete: I was wondering if I could use your phone. *PRESENT PERFECT SIMPLE # Leagă trecutul de prezent = acţiuni terminate, dar care sunt importante acum, adică au consecinţe/rezultate în prezent, sau sunt ştiri (news) I can’t walk – I’ve hurt my leg. (de aceea nu pot merge) Have you heard? He’s arrived. (news) Look – he hasn’t drunk his tea. (de curând, constat eu acum, văzând ceaşca) You’ve passed your exam! (o veste..bună, importantă acum) # Ne gândim simultan şi la trecut, şi la prezent: I’ve phoned Ann, so she knows what’s going on. I’ve made coffee. Would you like a cup? Come and look – I’ve painted the kitchen. # Time words – cuvinte care exprimă timpul: today, ever, never, yet Has the boss phoned today? Have you ever broken your leg? We haven’t been to Scotland this year. Mary hasn’t written to me yet. # recently, lately, before Have you heard from Phil recently? ‘Who’s that’? ‘I’ve never seen him before.’ # already, yet, just ‘Coffee?’ ‘No, thanks. I’ve already had some.’ ‘Can I speak to Colette?’ ‘I’m afraid she’s already gone home.’ ‘Have you paid the electrician yet?’ ‘No, he hasn’t sent his bill yet.’ I’ve just heard from the tax office. The snow has just stopped. # this morning, at school I haven’t seen Carl this morning. (spus tot dimineaţa) 490 I’ve made lots of friends at university. (spus de un student, deci în timpul facultăţii) Have you seen Hamlet? (have you ever – nu aseară, ci dacă l-ai văzut vreodată) Alex has gone to Rome (şi acum e acolo). Sorry I’m late. I’ve been to the shops. (şi m-am întors) # News (ştiri) The Prime Minister has arrived in Washington for talks with the President. Jessica has bought a new car. A plane has crashed at Heathrow Airport. Some new people have moved into the house next door. # News and details (ştiri şi detalii) A plane has crashed in Yorkshire (news). It came down in a field outside York (details). *PRESENT PERFECT CONTINUOUS # Cât de mult a durat ceva până în acest moment: I’ve been learning English for four years. It’s been snowing since Tuesday. Have you been waiting long? # since, for It’s been snowing since Tuesday. (spunem când a început – marţi) It’s been snowing for three days. (ne interesează durata, de 3 zile, nu când a început) # Ce-am mai făcut până acum – rezultate prezente ‘You look tired.’ ‘Yes, I’ve been working in the garden.’ I’m sorry dinner isn’t ready – I’ve been helping Diana with her homework. We’ve been playing a lot of tennis in the last few weeks. # Durata unei acţiuni încă neterminate Jane has been learning Greek since August. # Cât de des: We’ve been travelling all this year. # Present Perfect Tense Simple/ Present Perfect Tense Continuous: Present Perfect Tense Simple Acţiuni terminate: I’ve read your book (= am terminat-o) Present Perfect Tense Continuous Acţiuni neterminate: I’ve been reading your book: I’m enjoying it. Arătăm de câte ori: Arătăm cât de des: We’ve travelled to nine countries this We’been travelling all this year. year. Stări/situaţii neschimbătoare: Situaţii de mai lungă durată: 491 The castle has stood on this hill for 900 He’s been standing there for hours. years. *PAST PERFECT SIMPLE # O acţiune trecută înaintea altei acţiuni trecute: I bought a ticket and went up to the platform. But the train had already left. I was glad that I had taken an early flight. # Acţiune complet terminată înaintea altei acţiuni trecute: After I had finished the report, I realised that it was too late to email it. *PAST PERFECT CONTINUOUS # Situaţii trecute care au continuat până la acel moment (din trecut): All the roads were blocked: it had been snowing all night long. After I had been walking for an hour, I decided to have a rest. *FUTURE: WILL –FUTURE # Cerem sau dăm informaţii: We will need the money on the 15th. It will be spring soon. Will all the family be at the wedding? She’ll be here in a few minutes. # Prezicem viitorul – ce credem, ghicim, calculăm Tomorrow will be warm, with some cloud in the afternoon. Who do you think will win? You’ll never finish that book. # Decizii, promisiuni etc: We’ll buy the tickets; you can buy supper afterwards. You’ll get your money tomorrow. I promise I’ll stop smoking. I’ll hit you if you do that again. # Anunţăm o decizie atunci când o luăm: There’s the doorbell.’ ‘Ok, I’ll go.’ # Won’t – refuzuri: He won’t talk to anybody. The car won’t start. # Will you…? – instrucţiuni, ordine, cereri Will you get me a paper while you’re out? Will you be quiet, please? # Would you…..? – mai blând, mai politicos Would you watch the children for a few minutes? 492 # I’ll have – când comandam la restaurant I’ll have a black coffee, please. # Simple present: sens de viitor – orare, rutină, program Next term starts on 6th April. My train leaves at 3.17 What time does the bus arrive in York? Do you have classes next Saturday? - instrucţiuni When you get to the office you go to the first floor, you knock on the first door on the right and you ask for Mrs Alstone. OK? What do we do now? Where do I pay? *FUTURE: FUTURE CONTINUOUS # Ceva se va întâmpla la un anumit moment din viitor (pe vremea asta mâine, la anul, etc) This time tomorrow I’ll be skiing. We’ll be thinking of you on Saturday. # Întrebăm politicos ‘Ce ai decis deja?’ Will you be staying in this evening? (doar întrebăm) *FUTURE: Be + infinitive = are to do # Ceva se va întâmpla – planuri oficiale sau aranjamente personale fixe The president is to visit Scotland in September. We are to get a pay rise. I felt nervous because I was soon to leave home for the first time.\ # You are (not) to - dăm ordine You’re to do your homework before you watch TV. She can go out, but she’s not to be back late. * FUTURE: Future in the past – was going, was going to, would be # Ceva era încă viitor la momentul din trecut despre care vorbim acum. She was a little nervous, because she was flying to America the next day. Sorry – I was going to tell you about Alice and Fred, but I forgot I knew that woman would be trouble They showed me the room where I was to sleep. * FUTURE PERFECT = Future (will) + Perfect (have done/ have been doing) (sens de acţiune terminată/ durata) # Future Perfect Simple = ceva se va termina până la un anumit moment în viitor The builder says he’ll have finished the roof by Saturday (va fi terminat până sâmbătă) The car will soon have done 100,000 miles 493 # Future Perfect Continuous = cât de mult va continua ceva până la respectivul moment din viitor/de cât timp Next Christmas I’ll have been teaching for twenty years. C. SEQUENCE OF TENSES The verb in the introductory or main clause controls the tense of the verb in the noun clause. Rule 1: If the main clause is in the present or future, then the verb in the noun clause can be in any tense. Main clause is in the Present or Noun clause is in any tense Future The prime ministers agree that the global warming is a serious world problem. They hope that all nations will be responsible for solving this serious problem. Scientists believe that atmospheric warming has already begun. Measurements have indicated that the average temperature on the earth has risen in the past one hundred years. Further research will prove that carbon dioxide is largely responsible. Rule 2: If the main clause is in the past tense, the verb in the noun clause is usually in the past form except for the cases when the noun clause reports a general truth. Main clause is in the Past The prime ministers agreed that They hoped that Scientists believed that Measurements indicated that Further research proved that Noun clause is in the Past the global warming was a serious world problem. all nations would be responsible for solving this serious problem. atmospheric warming had already begun. the average temperature on the earth had risen in the past one hundred years. carbon dioxide was largely responsible. Exception: We knew that New York is bigger than London. (The noun clause reports a general truth.) D. IRREGULAR VERBS: INFINITIVE PAST SIMPLE PAST PARTICIPLE be beat become begin was/were beat became began been beaten become begun 494 bite blow break bring build burn buy catch choose come cost cut dig do draw dream drink drive eat fall feel fight find fly forgive get give go grow have hear hide hit hold hurt keep know lay lead learn leave lend let lie light lose make mean bit blew broke brought built burnt/burned bought caught chose came cost cut dug did drew dreamt/dreamed drank drove ate fell felt fought found flew forgave got gave went grew had heard hid hit held hurt kept knew laid led learnt/learned left lent let lay lit lost made meant 495 bitten blown broken brought built burnt/burned bought caught chosen come cost cut dug done drawn dreamt/dreamed drunk driven eaten fallen felt fought found flown forgiven got given gone grown had heard hidden hit held hurt kept known laid led learnt/learned left lent let lain lit lost made meant meet pay put read ride ring rise run say see send shoot shut sing sit sleep speak spell spend stand steal swim take teach tell think throw understand wake wear win write met paid put read rode rang rose ran said saw sold shot shut sang sat slept spoke spelled/spelt spent stood stole swam took taught told thought threw understood woke wore won wrote 496 met paid put read ridden rung risen run said seen sold shot shut sung sat slept spoken spelled/spelt spent stood stolen swum taken taught told thought thrown understood woken worn won written BIBLIOGRAPHY Eastwood, John. Oxford Practice Grammar. Intermediate. OUP, 2006/2013. Print. McCarthy, Michael & Felicity O’Dell. English Phrasal Verbs in Use. Intermediate. CUP, 2011. Print. Otto, Barbara & Marcin. Engleza pentru jurnalişti. Here is the News. Vol 1,2. Bucureşti: All Educational, 2001. Print. Swan, Michael & Catherine Walter. Oxford English Grammar Course. Intermediate. OUP, 2011. Print. Vince, Michael & Paul Emmerson. First Certificate Language Practice. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. Print. -------------. Intermediate Language Practice with Key. English Grammar and Vocabulary. Macmillan, 2003. 497